Human Development: A Cultural Approach

  • 72 2,266 6
  • Like this paper and download? You can publish your own PDF file online for free in a few minutes! Sign Up

Human Development: A Cultural Approach

This page intentionally left blank human development A C U LT U R A L A P P R O A C H JEFFREY JENSEN ARNETT Clark Uni

19,174 4,675 76MB

Pages 770 Page size 252 x 304.2 pts Year 2011

Report DMCA / Copyright

DOWNLOAD FILE

Recommend Papers

File loading please wait...
Citation preview

This page intentionally left blank

human development A C U LT U R A L A P P R O A C H

JEFFREY JENSEN ARNETT Clark University

Boston Columbus Indianapolis New York San Francisco Upper Saddle River Amsterdam Cape Town Dubai London Madrid Milan Munich Paris Montreal Toronto Delhi Mexico City Sao Paulo Sydney Hong Kong Seoul Singapore Taipei Tokyo

Editorial Director: Craig Campanella Editor in Chief: Jessica Mosher Executive Editor: Stephen Frail Director of Development: Sharon Geary Senior Development Editor: Julie Swasey Assistant Editor: Kerri Hart-Morris Editorial Assistant: Madelyn Schricker Director of Marketing: Brandy Dawson Executive Marketing Manager: Jeannette Koskinas Senior Marketing Manager: Nicole Kunzmann Market Development Manager: Alison Rodal Marketing Assistant: Craig Deming Senior Managing Editor: Maureen Richardson Production Project Manager: Barbara Reilly Copy Editor: Marne Evans Senior Operations Specialist: Sherry Lewis

AV Production Project Manager: Maria Piper Line Art : Precision Graphics, Inc. Maps: Spatial Graphics Inc. Art Director/Designer: John Christiana Cover Designer: John Christiana Manager, Rights and Permissions: Charles Morris Text Permissions Research: Jane Scelta Cover Art: Isaac Mitchell Digital Media Director: Bryan Hyland Senior Digital Media Editor: Peter Sabatini Full-Service Project Management: Rebecca Dunn, Prepare, Inc. Printer/Binder: Courier Companies, Inc. Cover Printer: Courier Companies, Inc. Text Font: Versailles 9/13

Credits and acknowledgments borrowed from other sources and reproduced, with permission, in this textbook appear on appropriate page within text (or on page 715). Microsoft® and Windows® are registered trademarks of the Microsoft Corporation in the U.S.A. and other countries. Screen shots and icons reprinted with permission from the Microsoft Corporation. This book is not sponsored or endorsed by or affiliated with the Microsoft Corporation. Copyright© 2012 by Pearson Education, Inc. All rights reserved. Printed in the United States of America. This publication is protected by Copyright and permission should be obtained from the publisher prior to any prohibited reproduction, storage in a retrieval system, or transmission in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or likewise. To obtain permission(s) to use material from this work, please submit a written request to Pearson Education, Inc., Permissions Department, One Lake Street, Upper Saddle River, New Jersey 07458 or you may fax your request to 201-236-3290. Many of the designations by manufacturers and seller to distinguish their products are claimed as trademarks. Where those designations appear in this book, and the publisher was aware of a trademark claim, the designations have been printed in initial caps or all caps. Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data Arnett, Jeffrey Jensen. Human development : a cultural approach / Jeffrey Jensen Arnett. — 1st ed. p. cm. ISBN 978-0-205-59526-6 1. Developmental psychology—Cross-cultural studies. I. Title. BF713.A816 2012 305.2—dc23 2011033025

10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Student edition Exam edition À la carte

ISBN 10: 0-205-59526-X ISBN 13: 978-0-205-59526-6 ISBN 10: 0-205-18638-6 ISBN 13: 978-0-205-18638-9 ISBN 10: 0-205-22946-8 ISBN 13: 978-0-205-22946-8

To my mom, who loved it all, from start to finish.

This page intentionally left blank

Contents

Preface

Methods and Designs in Research

xiv

Acknowledgments

1

xxiv

CULTURAL FOCUS: Incredible India! 8 HISTORICAL FOCUS: The Sorcerer of Trois Frères RESEARCH FOCUS: Darwin’s Diary 32

A Cultural Approach to Human Development 1

SECTION 1

2

HUMAN DEVELOPMENT TODAY AND ITS ORIGINS 4

Humanity Today: A Demographic Profile

10

Our Evolutionary Beginnings 11 The Origin of Cultures and Civilizations 12 Human Evolution and Human Development Today

Genetic Basics

GENETIC INFLUENCES ON DEVELOPMENT 45

Ancient Conceptions of Development

45

Genotype and Phenotype 45 The Sex Chromosomes 48

15

Genes and Environment in Human Development 50

THEORIES OF HUMAN DEVELOPMENT 17

Principles of Behavior Genetics 50 Gene–Environment Interactions: Epigenesis and Reaction Ranges 51 The Theory of Genotype l Environment Effects

17

Conceptions of Human Development in Three Traditions 17 Understanding Traditional Conceptions of Life

Genes and Individual Development 19

Scientific Conceptions of Human Development Freud’s Psychosexual Theory 19 Erikson’s Psychosocial Theory 21 Bronfenbrenner’s Ecological Theory A Stage Model for This Book 24

Genetics and Prenatal Development 42

SECTION 1

Human Origins and the Birth of Culture

19

Sperm and Egg Formation Conception 56

The Five Steps of the Scientific Method 26 Ethics in Human Development Research 28

55

55

59

The Germinal Period (First 2 Weeks) 59 The Embryonic Period (Weeks 3–8) 60 The Fetal Period (Week 9–Birth) 61

HOW WE STUDY HUMAN DEVELOPMENT 26

The Scientific Study of Human Development

52

PRENATAL DEVELOPMENT AND PRENATAL CARE 59

SECTION 2

22

Prenatal Development SECTION 3

14

4

Variations Across Countries 5 Variations Within Countries 9

SECTION 2

29

Research Methods 29 Research Designs 35

26

Prenatal Care

62

Prenatal Care in Traditional Cultures 62 Scientifically Based Prenatal Care 63

v

vi

Contents Benefits of Breast Feeding

SECTION 3 Prenatal Problems

PREGNANCY PROBLEMS

67

Social and Emotional Aspects of Neonatal Care 115

67

Chromosomal Disorders Teratogens 68 Prenatal Diagnosis 71

Crying and Soothing 116 Bonding: Myth and Truth 119 Postpartum Depression 120

67

CULTURAL FOCUS: Easing Birth Among the Cuna Indians 93 HISTORICAL FOCUS: The Tragic History of Doctor-Assisted Births in the 19th Century 94 RESEARCH FOCUS: How Much Does Breast Feeding Matter? 113

Infertility 73 Causes of Infertility 73 Infertility Treatments 74 Infertility Worldwide 76 CULTURAL FOCUS: Oskar and Jack: A Story of Genes, Environments, and Cultures 54 HISTORICAL FOCUS: How Are Babies Made? 75 RESEARCH FOCUS: The Human Genome Project 48

3

112

4

Birth and the Newborn Child 82

Infancy 126

SECTION 1

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

Growth and Change in Infancy SECTION 1 The Birth Process

Changes in Height and Weight Teeth and Teething 130 Brain Development 131 Sleep Changes 133

BIRTH AND ITS CULTURAL CONTEXT 85 85

Stages of the Birth Process Birth Complications 87

Infant Health

85

Cultural and Historical Variations in Birth Beliefs and Practices 89 Cultural Variations in Birth Beliefs 89 Cultural Variations in Birth Practices 91 The Peculiar History of Birth in the West 94 Cultural Variations in Neonatal and Maternal Mortality

SECTION 2

THE NEONATE

The Neonate’s Health

SECTION 3

136

Nutritional Needs 136 Infant Mortality 137

Baby on the Move: Motor and Sensory Development 140

SECTION 2

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

Piaget’s Theory of Cognitive Development

147

147

What Drives Cognitive Development? 147 The Sensorimotor Stage 148 Evaluating Piaget’s Sensorimotor Theory 150

100

105

Information Processing in Infancy

105

111

Evolutionary and Historical Perspectives on Breast Feeding 111

151

Attention 152 Memory 153

Assessing Infant Development

CARING FOR THE NEONATE

Nutrition: Is Breast Best?

129

97

99

Physical Functioning of the Neonate Neonatal Sleeping Patterns Neonatal Reflexes 106 Neonatal Senses 107

129

Motor Development 140 Sensory Development 144

99

Measuring Neonatal Health Low Birth Weight 101

129

111

154

Approaches to Assessing Development 154 Can Media Enhance Cognitive Development? The Myth of “Baby Einstein” 155

The Beginnings of Language First Sounds and Words 156 Infant-Directed (ID) speech 157

156

vii

Contents

Temperament

The Birth of the Self 203 Gender Identity and the Biology of Gender Development 204

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 160

SECTION 3

160

Conceptualizing Temperament: Three Approaches Goodness-of-Fit 163

Infants’ Emotions

160

Attachment Theory 206 Quality of Attachment 209 Critiques of Attachment Theory

163

Primary Emotions 164 Infants’ Emotional Perceptions

166

Cultural Themes of Infant Social Life 167 The Foundation of Social Development: Two Theories CULTURAL FOCUS: Infant Care in Rural Turkey 143 HISTORICAL FOCUS: Protecting Infants the Puritan Way RESEARCH FOCUS: Measuring Temperament 162

5

168

139

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

Growth and Change in Years 2 and 3 Bodily Growth 177 Brain Development 179 Sleep and (More) Teething Motor Development 181

177

177

Early Childhood 228

SECTION 1

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

Motor Development

SECTION 2 COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

236

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

187

Cognitive Development in Toddlerhood: Piaget’s Theory 187 Vygotsky’s Cultural Theory of Cognitive Development 190

Language Development

191

The Biological and Evolutionary Bases of Language 192 Milestones of Toddler Language: From First Words to Fluency 193 Learning Language in a Social and Cultural Context 196

SECTION 3

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 200

Emotional Development in Toddlerhood 200 Toddlers’ Emotions

200

240

187 Theories of Cognitive Development

Cognitive Development Theories

232

236

Gross and Fine Motor Skills Handedness 237

Toilet Training 183 Weaning 185

231

231

Bodily Growth 231 Brain Development and “Infantile” Amnesia Health and Safety in Early Childhood 233

180

218

CULTURAL FOCUS: Toddlerhood in Aboriginal Australia 217 HISTORICAL FOCUS: The History of Toilet Training 184 RESEARCH FOCUS: Early Child Care and Its Consequences 211

Growth from Age 3 to 6

Socializing Physical Functions: Toilet Training and Weaning 183

SECTION 2

215

The Role of Fathers 215 The Wider Social World: Siblings, Peers, and Friends Autism: A Disruption in Social Development 220 Media Use in Toddlerhood 221

6

Toddlerhood 174

SECTION 1

212

The Social World of the Toddler

165

The Social World of the Infant

One Special Person: Attachment Theory and Research 206

240

Piaget’s Preoperational Stage of Cognitive Development 240 Understanding Thinking: The Development of “Theory of Mind” 243 Cultural Learning in Early Childhood 244

Early Childhood Education

246

The Importance of Preschool Quality 246 Cross-National Variations 248 Preschool as a Cognitive Intervention 248

Language Development

250

Advances in Vocabulary and Grammar 250 Pragmatics: Social and Cultural Rules of Language

251

viii

Contents

SECTION 3

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 253

SECTION 3

Emotional Regulation and Gender Socialization 253

Emotional and Self-Development

The Social and Cultural Contexts of Middle Childhood 315

259

Parenting “Styles” 259 Parenting in Other Cultures 261 Discipline and Punishment 262

The Child’s Expanding Social World

Family Relations 315 Friends and Peers 319 School Experiences 323 Work 325 Media Use 329

267

Siblings and “Only Children” 268 Peers and Friends 269 Media Use in Early Childhood 274 CULTURAL FOCUS: Shyness in China and Canada 273 HISTORICAL FOCUS: Beat a Child, Save a Soul 265 RESEARCH FOCUS: The Montessori Preschool Program 247

7

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

Growth in Middle Childhood

286

286

291

SECTION 1

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

Health Issues in Adolescence

Theories of Cognitive Development

294

Concrete Operations 294 Information Processing 296 Intelligence and Intelligence Tests 299 Learning the Cognitive Skills of School: Reading and Mathematics 304

306

Vocabulary, Grammar, and Pragmatics Bilingualism 307

342

349

Eating Disorders 349 Substance Use 352

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

Language Development

Adolescence 338

The Physical Changes of Puberty 342 The Timing of Puberty 344 Cultural Responses: Puberty Rituals 347

Gross Motor Development 291 Fine Motor Development 292

SECTION 2

325

The Metamorphosis: Biological Changes of Puberty 342

286

Physical Growth and Sensory Development Nutrition and Malnutrition 287 Illness and Injuries 289

Motor Development

CULTURAL FOCUS: School Socialization in Guatemala HISTORICAL FOCUS: Work Among British Children in the 19th Century 328 RESEARCH FOCUS: TV or Not TV 331

8

Middle Childhood 282

SECTION 1

310

Smooth Sailing: Advances in Emotional SelfRegulation 310 Self-Understanding 311 Gender Development 313

Emotional Regulation 253 Moral Development 254 Gender Development 256

Parenting

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 310

306

294

SECTION 2

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

Piaget’s Theory of Formal Operations

355

Hypothetical-Deductive Reasoning 355 Critiques of Piaget’s Theory of Formal Operations

Other Changes in Adolescent Thinking

355

356

357

Information Processing: Selective Attention and Metamemory 358 Social Cognition: The Imaginary Audience and the Personal Fable 358 Culture and Cognition 360

ix

Contents

SECTION 3

Tertiary Education: College, University, and Training Programs 417

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 362

Emotional and Self-Development

Cultural Variations in Tertiary Education The Benefits of Tertiary Education 421

362

Emotionality in Adolescence: Storm and Stress? Self-Development in Adolescence 364 Gender Intensification in Adolescence 366

Cultural Beliefs: Morality and Religion

362

367 Emotional and Self-Development

Family Relationships 371 Peers and Friends 375 Love and Sexuality 378 Schools: Secondary Education Around the World Work 383 Media Use 386

Cultural Beliefs

429

431

Religious Development 431 Political Development 432 381

The Social and Cultural Contexts of Emerging Adulthood 433 Family Relationships 434 Friendships 436 Love and Sexuality 437 Finding Adult Work 442 Media Use 445

387

Crime and Delinquency 387 Depression 390 Resilience in Adolescence 391 CULTURAL FOCUS: Coming of Age in Samoa 348 HISTORICAL FOCUS: From Fasting Saints to Anorexic Girls 351 RESEARCH FOCUS: The Daily Rhythms of Adolescents’ Family Lives 373

Emerging Adulthood 398

SECTION 1

423

Self-Esteem 423 Identity Development 424 Gender Development: Cultural Beliefs and Stereotypes

The Social and Cultural Contexts of Adolescence 371

9

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 423

SECTION 3

Moral Development 367 Religious Beliefs 370

Problems and Resilience

420

CULTURAL FOCUS: The Young Men of Truk Island 414 HISTORICAL FOCUS: Gender and Cognitive Development in Emerging Adulthood 419 RESEARCH FOCUS: Graduated Driver Licensing 412

10

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

Young Adulthood 454

401 SECTION 1

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

458

The Emergence of Emerging Adulthood 401 Five Features 403 The Cultural Context of Emerging Adulthood

What Makes an Adult? 405

Physical Changes in Emerging Adulthood The Peak of Physical Functioning Sleep Patterns and Deficits 408

407

The Transition to Adulthood: Cross-Cultural Themes 458 The Transition to Adulthood: Cultural Variations 459

Physical Functioning and Health

407

Risk Behavior and Health Issues

410

SECTION 2 COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

Pragmatism 416 Reflective Judgment

416 417

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

416 Adult Intelligence

Postformal Thinking

460

Aging Begins 460 Overweight and Obesity 461 The Importance of Exercise 465

409

Injuries and Fatalities: Automobile Accidents Substance Use and Abuse 412

SECTION 2

458

467

IQ Scores and Career Success 467 Cultural Conceptions of Intelligence

468

467

x

Contents

Cognitive Changes in Young Adulthood

470

SECTION 3

Expertise 470 Creativity 471

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 523

Emotional and Self-Development SECTION 3

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 473

Emotional Development in Young Adulthood Intimacy Versus Isolation: Erikson’s Theory Sternberg’s Theory of Love 474

473

473

Marriage in Young Adulthood 476 Divorce in Young Adulthood 483 Single Adults 485 Gay and Lesbian Partnerships 486 Sexuality in Young Adulthood 487 Becoming a Parent 488 Work 492 Leisure Activities in Young Adulthood

542

CULTURAL FOCUS: Menopause and Middle Adulthood in Japan 510 HISTORICAL FOCUS: Generativity in 19th-Century Women RESEARCH FOCUS: Intelligence in Middle Adulthood: Two Research Approaches 518

12

Late Adulthood 550

SECTION 1

Middle Adulthood 504

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

Cultural Beliefs About Late Adulthood

553

553

How Old Is “Old”? 553 Global Aging Patterns: The Worldwide Boom in Older Adults 555

SECTION 1

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT 507

Physical Changes in Middle Adulthood

Health and Disease

563

Chronic Health Problems 563 Health Care and Health Promotion

564

515

SECTION 2 SECTION 2

558

Health in Late Adulthood

511

Health Problems 511 Midlife Health and Later Development

Physical Changes

Changes in Appearance 559 Changes in the Senses 559 Changes in Sleep Patterns 562

507

Changes in Sensory Abilities 507 Changes in Reproductive Systems 508

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

517 Cognitive Changes and Decline

Intelligence

527

496

CULTURAL FOCUS: Polygyny in Africa 481 HISTORICAL FOCUS: What Killed American Civic Participation? 497 RESEARCH FOCUS: What Is “Overweight”? What Is “Obesity”? 462

11

523

The Social and Cultural Contexts of Middle Adulthood 531 Family Relationships 531 Love and Sexuality 536 Work 540 Community and Leisure Activities

The Social and Cultural Contexts of Young Adulthood 476

523

Changes in Self-Concept and Self-Acceptance The Mostly Mythical Midlife Crisis 525 Generativity 526 Gender Issues in Midlife 528

517

Fluid and Crystallized Intelligence The Peak of Expertise 519

517

Information Processing in Middle Adulthood 520 Processing Speed 520 Attention and Memory

521

569

Changes in Attention and Memory 569 Brain Changes and Brain Diseases: Dementia and Alzheimer’s Disease 571

Alternative Views on Cognitive Changes Wisdom 574 Responding to Cognitive Decline

576

574

569

xi

Contents

SECTION 3

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 579

Emotional and Self-Development

SECTION 3

579

BELIEFS ABOUT DEATH AND THE AFTERLIFE 621

Beliefs About Death Throughout the Life Span 621

Positive Emotions and Self-Concept 579 Theories on Emotions in Late Adulthood 580

Beliefs About Death in Childhood and Adolescence Beliefs About Death in Adulthood 622

The Social and Cultural Contexts of Late Adulthood 582

Afterlife Beliefs and Mourning Rituals

Family Relationships 582 Living Arrangements in Late Adulthood 584 Love and Sexuality 585 Work and Retirement 587 Life Outside Work and Home: Leisure, Community, Religion, and Media Use 589 CULTURAL FOCUS: “A Mountain of Treasures”: Japan’s Aging Society 557 HISTORICAL FOCUS: The Ancient History of Wisdom 575 RESEARCH FOCUS: Do People Become More Religious With Age? 592

CULTURAL FOCUS: Ancestor Worship and Hungry Ghosts in China 631 HISTORICAL FOCUS: Afterlife Beliefs in Ancient Egypt and Greece 625

Epilogue

637

Practice Tests Answer Key Glossary

13

Death and Afterlife Beliefs 600

641

References Credits

651

715

Name Index Subject Index

SECTION 1

PHYSICAL ASPECTS OF DEATH 603

The Demography of Death

603

Historical Variations in Death 603 Major Causes of Death Today 604

Beyond Death? Attempts to Extend the Human Life Span 608 The Sources of Aging: Cellular Clocks and Free Radicals 608 Can Aging Be Reversed? Hormone Replacement and Calorie Restriction 610

SECTION 2

SOCIOCULTURAL AND EMOTIONAL RESPONSES TO DEATH 612

The Sociocultural Contexts of Death

612

Where We Die: Homes and Hospitals 612 Options and Decisions Regarding the End of Life

Bereavement and Grief

617

The Emotional Arc of Grief 617 Variations in Grieving 617 Confronting Death 619

613

623

What Do Individuals Believe About Life After Death? Mourning Rituals of the Major Religions 627 Remembering and Honoring the Dead 630

RESEARCH FOCUS: Growing Telomeres

717 727

639

609

621

623

This page intentionally left blank

Infographic Maps

MAP 1.1:

Projected Ethnic Changes in the U.S. Population to 2050

MAP 1.2:

Worldwide Variations in Population and Income Levels

MAP 2.1:

Ethnic Variations in Prenatal Care within the United States

MAP 2.2:

The “Infertility Belt”

MAP 3.1:

Cesarean Section Rates, Selected Countries

MAP 3.2:

Neonatal and Maternal Mortality Worldwide

MAP 3.3:

Rates of Low Birth Weight Around the World

MAP 4.1:

Infant Mortality Rates Worldwide

MAP 5.1:

Cultural Variations in the Length of Breastfeeding

MAP 5.2:

American Children with Working Parents

MAP 6.1:

Worldwide Mortality Rates and Causes of Death in Children Under Age 5

MAP 7.1:

Childhood Obesity in the United States

MAP 7.2:

Bilingualism in the United States

MAP 7.3:

Child Labor Rates and GDP Worldwide

MAP 8.1:

Secondary School Enrollment Worldwide

MAP 9.1:

Median Age at First Marriage in the United States

MAP 9.2:

Worldwide Enrollment in Tertiary Education

MAP 9.3:

HIV Population Worldwide

MAP 10.1:

Adult Obesity Rates Worldwide (Men)

MAP 10.2:

Single-Parent Households in the United States

MAP 11.1:

Gender Empowerment Measure

MAP 11.2:

World Population Employed in Agricultural Labor

MAP 12.1:

Old Age Dependency Ratio (OADR) Worldwide

MAP 12.2:

Smoking Rates Worldwide

MAP 13.1:

Current and Projected Life Expectancy Worldwide

xiii

Preface Welcome to Human Development: A Cultural Approach. Why a new textbook on human development? After all, there are already many textbooks available. For me, the most important motivation in writing this book was that I wanted to provide students with a portrayal of development that would cover the whole amazing range of human cultural diversity. As someone who has taught human development courses for years and was familiar with the available textbooks, I was struck by how narrow all of them seemed to be. They focused on human development in the United States as if it were the typical pattern for people everywhere, with only the occasional mention of people in other parts of the world. If you knew nothing about human development except what you read in a standard textbook, you would conclude that 95% of the human population must reside in the United States. Yet the United States is actually less than 5% of the world’s population, and there is an immense range of patterns of human development in cultures around the globe, with most of those patterns strikingly different than the mainstream American model. And, even within the United States, cultural diversity is much greater than what is found in the typical textbook. So, in writing this textbook, I decided to take a cultural approach. I set out to portray human development as it takes place across all the different varieties of cultural patterns that people have devised in response to their local conditions and the creative inspiration of their imaginations. My goal was to teach students to think culturally, so that when they apply human development to the work they do or to their own lives, they understand that there is, always and everywhere, a cultural basis to development. The cultural approach also includes learning how to critique research for the extent to which it does or does not take the cultural basis of development into account. I provide this kind of critique at numerous points throughout the book, with the intent that students will learn how to do it themselves by the time they reach the end. There are Thinking Culturally questions in the margins of each chapter to promote students’ abilities to think in this way. I know from my experience as a teacher that students find it fascinating to learn about the different forms that human development takes in various cultures, but there are also practical benefits to the cultural approach. It is more important than ever for students to have knowledge of the wider world because of the increasingly globalized economy and because so many problems, such as terrorism and climate change, cross borders. Whether they travel the globe or remain in their home towns, in a culturally diverse and globalized world students will benefit from being able to apply the cultural approach and think culturally about development, whether in social interactions with friends and neighbors, or in their careers, as they may have patients or students or co-workers who come from different cultures. The Chinese have an expression that loosely translates as “the frog in the well knows not of the great ocean,” and it is often used as a cautionary reminder to look beyond our own experience and not to assume that what is true for ourselves is true for everyone else as well. I think all of us are like that frog, in a way (which is, in case you were wondering, why a frog is featured on the cover of this book). We’ve grown up in a certain cultural context. We’ve learned to think about life in a certain way. We’ve learned to think about development in a certain way. And most of us don’t realize how broad and diverse our world really is. My hope is that this book will help more students lift themselves out of the well and appreciate the wonderful diversity of human development.

xiv

Preface The cultural approach makes this textbook much different from other life-span textbooks, but there are other features that make this textbook distinct. This is the only major textbook to include a separate chapter on toddlerhood, the second and third years of life. I have always been puzzled by the way other textbooks gloss over toddlerhood, usually including the second year of life as part of “infancy” and the third year of life as part of “early childhood.” Yet any parent knows that years 2 and 3 are a lot different from what comes before or after, and I remembered this well from my own experience as a father of twins. Infants cannot walk or talk, and once toddlers learn to do both in years 2 and 3, their experience of life—and their parents’ experiences—change utterly. Toddlers are also different from older children, in that their ability for emotional self-regulation and their awareness of what is and is not acceptable behavior in their culture is much more limited. This textbook is also alone among major textbooks in dividing the adult life span into stages of emerging adulthood, young adulthood, middle adulthood, and late adulthood. Emerging adulthood, roughly ages 18–25, is a new life stage that has arisen in developed countries over the past 50 years, as people have entered later into the commitments that structure adult life in most cultures: marriage, parenthood, and stable work. Other textbooks either call the whole period from age 18–40 “young adulthood” (which makes little sense, in that for most people in developed countries the years from age 18–25 are vastly different than the years 25–40); or they have an emerging adulthood chapter and then lump young and middle adulthood together as “adulthood” (which also makes little sense, given that it means applying one life stage term to ages 25–60). I originally proposed the theory of emerging adulthood in 2000, and it has now become widely used in the social sciences. I think it is a fascinating and dynamic time of life, and I know students enjoy learning about it, as many of them are in that life stage or have recently passed through it. This textbook is somewhat shorter than most other texts on human development. There is one chapter devoted to each phase of life, for a total of 13 chapters. Each chapter is divided into three major sections, which correspond to the physical, the cognitive, and the emotional and social domains of development. This is an introductory textbook, and the goal is not to teach students everything there is to know about every aspect of human development, but to provide them with a foundation of knowledge on human development that hopefully will inspire them to learn more, in other courses and throughout life.

xv

xvi

Preface

Applying the Cultural Approach Cultural Themes of Infant Social Life

Cultural Videos

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

List the main features of infants’ social worlds across cultures. Although cultures vary in their customs of infant care, as they vary in most aspects of human development, there are several themes that occur frequently across cultures. If we combine what scholars have learned from observing infants in a variety of different cultures today, along with what other scholars have learned from studying human evolutionary history and the history of human societies, a common picture of the social world of the infant emerges (DeLoache & Gottlieb, 2000; Leakey, 1994; Levine, 1977; Levine et al., 1994; Richman et al., 2010; Small, 2005), characterized by the following features:

Extensive Cultural Coverage is woven into the narrative and on vivid display in images.

1. Infants are with their mothers almost constantly for the early months of life. Nearly all cultures have a period (usually 1–6 months) following birth when mother and infant do little but rest and recover from the birth together. After this rest period is over, the infant is typically strapped to the mother’s back with a cloth as she goes back to her daily duties. 2. After about 6 months, most daily infant care is done by older girls rather than the mother. Once infants reach about 6 months old their care is delegated to older girls (usually 6 to 10 years old) so that the mother can devote her energy and attention to her work. Most often the girl is an older sister, but it could be any of a range of other people such as an older brother, cousin, grandmother, aunt, or a girl hired from outside the family. However, at night the infant sleeps with the mother. 3. Infants are among many other people in the course of a day. In addition to the mother and the caregiver who takes over at about age 6 months, infants are around many other people in the course of a day, such as siblings, aunts, cousins, grandparents, and neighbors. 4. Infants are held or carried almost constantly. In many traditional cultures, infants rarely touch the ground during their early months of life. This practice comes out of the belief that infants are highly vulnerable and must be shielded from dangers. Holding them close is a way of protecting them, and also a way of keeping them comforted, quiet, and manageable. 5. Fathers are usually remote or absent during the first year. As we saw in Chapter 3, in most cultures only women are allowed to observe and assist at birth, and this exclusion of men often continues during the first year. Fathers are rarely involved in the direct care of infants, partly because mothers breast-feed their infants frequently but also because care of infants is typically believed to be part of a woman’s role but not a man’s.

MyDevelopmentLab Cross-Cultural Videos, filmed in the United States, Mexico, and Botswana, and guided by series editor Ashley Maynard (University of Hawaii, Manoa) with important contributions from Bianca Dahl (Brown University), show how culture impacts development. Video guides, authored by Carol Miller of Anne Arundel Community College, at the end of every chapter section provide discussion questions to connect the videos with chapter content. Videos are available in multiple formats: on an instructor’s DVD, tied to quizzes in MyDevelopmentLab, and linked to QR codes in the book to enable students to access the videos directly from their smart phones. Answers to discussion questions are available in the Instructor’s Manual.

4.22

THINKING CULTURALLY Of the five features of the infant’s social world described here, how many are similar to and how many are different from the culture you are from? What do you think explains the differences?

Infants in many cultures are surrounded by adults all day, but cultures vary in how much the adults interact with infants. Here, two mothers and their babies with other family members and friends in the Samburu culture of Kenya.

Section 2 VIDEO GUIDE Language Development Across Cultures These features are still the dominant worldwide pattern in (Length: developing7:40) countries (Richman et al., 2010; Small, 2005), but the pattern in developed countries has become quite different over the past two centuries, In this video, we talk to parents from different cultural backgrounds about how theyespecially in Western communicate with their infants and ask environment them what, if anything, they countries. Thetoddlers typicaland social for infants in do developed countries is to foster their child’s language development. the “nuclear family” consisting of a mother, father (perhaps), and (perhaps) one sibling. Most infants in Western developed countries sleep in a separate room from the time they are born (Goldberg & Keller, 2007). Mother and infant are alone together for much of the time, and the infant may be left in a crib, stroller, 1. Discuss the three factors mentioned in the clip infant seat for a substantial proportion of the day (Baildum et al., 2000). that influence toddleror language development. What are some additional factors that might also impact toddler language development? 2. Do you think that the U.S. mother interviewed here discussed a situation typical of most children across the U.S.? Why or why not? 3. Discuss your thoughts on the mother from Africa stating that she does not read to her baby because she is too young. What age do you think it is appropriate to begin reading to children and why?

Watch the Video Language Development Across Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab

Applying Your Knowledge and Thinking Culturally Questions nfant what’s new, and it’s quite likely tor development that has recently been hout falling over!” or “Juan is suddenly first steps yesterday!” There are many e first year, including holding the head support, crawling, standing, cruising some) walking. Most children achieve the order of skills varies and somes more variability in the timing of n the sequence. As you can see in ge of variation of several months. n those ranges and still be develop-

Applying Your Knowledge questions ask students to apply the chapter’s content and cultural approach to real-life situations as well as to a wide range of future careers. Thinking Culturally questions encourage students to think critically about the influence of culture on human development. Sample answers are provided in the Instructor’s Manual.

Toilet Training Compare and contrast the process and timing of toilet training in developed countries and traditional cultures. The toddler years are when most children first learn to control their urination and defecation and become “toilet trained.” Expectations for exactly when during the toddler years this should happen have changed substantially over the past half century in the United States (Blum et al., 2004). During the mid-20th century, pediatricians advocated early toilet training—the earlier the better—and in 1957 a study reported that 92% of American toddlers were toilet trained by the time they were 18 months old (Goode, 1999). Gradually, pediatricians and parents concluded there was little reason to require toilet training so early, and in more recent studies only about 25% of toddlers were toilet trained by 18 months old and only about 60% by their third birthday (Barone et al., 2009; Schum et al., 2001). We’ll look at the history of toilet training in more depth in the Historical Focus: The History of Toilet Training feature on page 184.

LEARNING

o whatever they can to make the including infants in their early weeks, m developed out of long and painful

er medical care for their infants, but eir babies from death, as you will see uritan Way feature above. Although illness and had no effective medical uld allow their infants to avoid harm. 1 of every 3 babies died before their common cause of death (Fontanel & an tendency discussed in Chapter 1 OBJECTIVE

5.5

THINKING CULTURALLY How might a culture’s values of individualism or collectivism influence toilet-training practices?

nt is ontogenetic—meaning that it takes al timetable—and how much of it is due of development, both genetics and envient sequence of gross motor milestones vidence for genetic group differences, or milestones earlier than other infants psychologists view gross motor develAPPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE timetable, the maturation of the brain, . . . as a Nurse the skill,toand the child’s How would you respond parents who own efforts to 01).to have their infant express reluctance cross cultures provides a vivid picture vaccinated, fearing it would be harmful ny traditional cultures it is a common instead of helpful? hers’ backs for most of the day, as the crops, preparing food, and other kinds a common infant-care practice in the discussed in Chapter 3. If infants are most of the day, they receive little pracrictive practices are partly to free the s also believe that swaddling protects h (DeLoache & Gottlieb, 2000). In rural st few months and then carried around cussed in the Cultural Focus: Infant

In many traditional cultures infants are strapped to their mothers’ backs for most of the day. Here, a mother and infant in rural Vietnam.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE How would the advances in gross motor development over the first year influence the infant’s social relationships?

xvii

Preface

“Focus” Features CULTURAL FOCUS

Easing Birth Among the Cuna Indians

I

to help push the fetus along the birth n many parts of the world today, birth is a social and religious PANAMA canal. The shaman’s own spirit joins event. Women give birth in their own homes, in the company of the animal spirits inside the womb to their closest female relatives and friends; the birth is assisted by a COSTA COLOMBIA RICA wage combat against Muu. midwife whom the woman knows well. In many places the woman Does any of this do any good to is believed to be especially vulnerable during birth, not just physithe woman suffering a difficult labor? cally but spiritually. Consequently, many cultures have developed Medically, obviously not, but be carereligious beliefs and methods in an attempt to ensure the safety of ful before you dismiss mother and child. the effects of the shaOne example was described by the French man’s song too easily. There is abundant evianthropologist Claude Levi-Strauss, who did dence of the placebo effect, which means that ethnographic research on the Cuna Indians of sometimes if people believe something affects Panama (Levi-Strauss, 1967). Normally, Cuna them, it does, just by virtue of the power of their women are attended during birth by a midwife belief. In the classic example, if people are given and female relatives. However, if labor becomes a sugar pill containing no medicine and told it is difficult, the midwife often calls on spiritual assisa pain reliever, many of them will report experitance from a shaman, a religious leader believed encing reduced pain (Balodis et al., 2011). It was to have special powers and knowledge of the not the sugar pill that reduced their pain but spirit world (see Chapter 1). Shamans are comtheir belief that the pill would reduce their pain. mon in traditional cultures around the world. The shaman’s song may have a placebo efAmong the Cuna Indians, difficult births are fect on the Cuna woman giving birth, if not to believed to be caused by the spirit of the womb, promote her labor than at least to ease her pain. Muu, who may, for no apparent reason, decide Furthermore, according to Levi-Strauss, the shato hold on to the fetus and prevent it from comman’s song and the spiritual world it invokes aling out. The shaman’s job is to invoke magic that stick into the baby’s rectum at precise times each day (U.S. Departpproaches to toilet training have shifted substantially in low the woman to make sense of her pain. By will release the fetus from Muu’s grip. He sits ment of Labor, 1935). Western societies over the past century. These shifts provide connecting her labor pain to the symbolic worlddown next to the woman giving birth and beThese early, harsh approaches to toilet training reflected a an instructive example of how changes in cultural beliefs view of her culture, she gives it meaning and orgins by singing a long and detailed song describcultural belief in the appropriateness of strong parental authority about children can interact with changes in technology. der. For a woman who believes in the spiritual ing why he has been summoned to help her and (Dewar, 2010). Toddlers were to be toilet trained as soon as possible In the historical record of the past 200 to 300 years, the emworld the shaman describes, “The impact of how he and his fellow spirits plan to launch an so that parents would be relieved of the mess and work of changing phasis was on teaching children to use the toilet at the earliest the symbolic environment is to concentrate the attack on Muu. Then, as the song continues, he and cleaning their diapers; the needs of the parents were the top age possible (Mechling, 2008). Methods were often coercive, inwhole of the woman’s being, psychologically and physiologically, calls upon the spirits of other animals for assistance, such as woodpriority, not the needs of the children (Mechling, 2008). However, cluding scolding or physical punishment upon the task at hand” (Bates & Turner, 2003, pp. 93–94). boring insects to cut through Muu’s fingers and burrowing insects technological reasons—more precisely, the lack of technologies— in case of an “accident.” One U.S. were also involved. Keep in mind that before the late 20th century government manual even urged all diapers were cloth and had to be washed by hand. This certainly parents to enforce the regulargave parents a strong incentive to toilet train their children early. ity of bowel movements for Keep in mind, too, that families before the late 20th century typiinfants by inserting a curved cally had three, four, or more children, and by the time the youngest one was in diapers, parents would have been changing and washing diapers for a long, long time. Approaches to toilet training Methods of toilet training evolved in the late 20th century, suphave changed in recent ported by changes in parenting beliefs as well as developments in decades with experts now technology. Parents became less concerned with establishing authorrecommending a “childcentered” approach. ity over children and more concerned with children’s psychological

Cultural Focus features offer in-depth coverage of development in a non-U.S. culture. Each Cultural Focus feature also includes a “locator” map that situates the culture being discussed in its larger geographic context.

Historical Focus features examine a developmental topic in its historical context to show how our views toward different stages of development change over time.

HISTORICAL FOCUS

Research Focus features offer a detailed description of a

A

research study including its premises, methods, results, and limitations.

The History of Toilet Training

RESEARCH FOCUS

Early Child Care and Its Consequences

O

examined, including physical, social, emotional, cognitive, and ne of the most striking changes of the last half cenlanguage development. tury in Western countries is that mothers of young There were many notable and illuminating findings in the children now generally work outside the home (see study. About three-fourths of the children in the study began Map 5.2 on page 212). For example, in 1960 only 17% of nonmaternal child care by the age of 4 months. During infancy American mothers of children under a year old were employed, and toddlerhood most of this care was provided by relatives, but but by the year 2000 this proportion had risen to over 60% enrollment in child-care centers increased during toddlerhood, (Smith et al., 2001). Similar changes took place in other Western and beyond age 2 most children receiving nonmaternal care were countries (Scheiwe & Willekins, 2009). Because this change in centers. Infants and toddlers averaged 33 hours a week in nonhas happened so quickly and so recently, and because mothmaternal care. African American infants and toddlers experienced ers have never before been employed in such large numbers, the highest number of hours per week of nonmaternal care and there has been a great deal of concern expressed about the White infants and toddlers potential consequence of the lowest, with Latinos in this change for young chilbetween. dren’s development. ConThe most important varisequently, a great deal of ables related to children’s research has been underdevelopment were hours per taken to explore this issue. week in care and quality of Beginning in the 1990s, care. Quality of care was asthe largest and most compresessed in three ways: (1) the hensive study of early child caregivers’ education, training care and its consequences in child care, and child-care was conducted in the Unitexperience; (2) the ratio of ed States, sponsored by the children to caregivers and the National Institute of Child number of children per group; Health and Human Developand (3) the interactions bement (NICHD). The “NICHD tween caregivers and chilStudy of Early Child Care” bedren (based on observations gan in 1991 with over 1,300 of mothers and nonmaternal young children (from infancy caregivers). Notably, children through early childhood) at Toddlers in high-quality child-care centers are as likely as from the highest and lowest 10 sites around the United children in home care to have secure attachments. SES backgrounds received the States. The children and their highest quality care and the children from near-poor backgrounds families were followed longitudinally for 7 years (NICHD Early received the lowest, because the parents of the poorest children Child Care Research Network, 2005). The sample was diverse in qualified for subsidies for high-quality care, whereas the parents of socioeconomic (SES) background, ethnicity, and geographical re-

Infographic Maps

Number of deaths during the first 28 days of life per 1,000 live births

Infographic Maps in every chapter provide a quick and effective way

Neonatal Mortality Rate

More than 45 31–45 16–30 30° 6–15 1–5 No data

for students to visualize cultural, socioeconomic and geopolitical variations in development.

30°





30°

WA

VT MT

ND

MN

OR ID NV

WI

SD

WY

AZ

CO

PA

IA

NE UT

CA

IL KS OK

NM

NY

MI

MO

OH

IN

KY

WV VA NC

TN

AR

ME

 TPSSPVU

NH MA RI NJ CT DE MD D.C.

    

SC MS AL

GA

TX LA AK

Minority population as a percentage of population* Less than 10%

10– 24.9%

25– 34.9%

35– 49.9%

More than 50%

*Minority refers to people who reported their ethnicity and race as something other than non-Hispanic White alone







150° 60°

;^VVYTVYLYHJLZ (TLYPJHU0UKPHU(SHZRH5H[P]L 5H[P]L/H^HPPHU7HJPMPJ0ZSHUKLY (ZPHU(TLYPJHU (MYPJHU(TLYPJHU 3H[PUV >OP[L



120°

90°

60°

30°



30°

60°

90°

120°

150°

   Deaths of mothers per 100,000 live births

Maternal Mortality Rate

More than 700 400–699 100–399 10–99 30° Less than 10 No data



FL HI

 TPSSPVU

30°

30°







30°

30°

(J[\HS

Map 1.1 s Projected Ethnic Changes in U.S. Population to 2050 Which ethnic group is projected to change the most in the coming decades, and why?

7YVQLJ[LK 150° 60°

120°

90°

60°

30°



30°

60°

90°

120°

150°

Map 3.2 s Neonatal and Maternal Mortality Worldwide How do neonatal and maternal mortality rates compare? What factors might explain why mortality rates are higher in developing countries than in developed countries?

xviii

Preface

Teaching and Learning Aids Motor Development Describe the advances in motor development that take place during toddlerhood

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.4

Toddlerhood is a time of dramatic advances in motor development. There are few physical advances more life changing than going from barely standing to walking, running, climbing, and jumping—and all this progress in gross motor development takes place during the toddler years. With regard to fine motor development, toddlers go from being able to place a small object inside a large object to holding a cup and building a tower of blocks. GROSS MOTOR DEVELOPMENT: FROM TODDLING TO RUNNING, JUMPING, AND CLIMBING Next time you see a child about a year old trying to walk, observe closely. When children first begin to walk they spread their feet apart and take small, stiff-legged steps, shifting their weight from one leg to the other. In short, they toddle! This is, in fact, where the word toddler comes from, in reference to their tentative, unsteady, wide-stance steps. On average, children begin to walk without support at about 11 months old, just as they are about to enter toddlerhood; but there is a wide range of normal variation around this average, from about 9 to 17 months (Adolph & Berger, 2006; Bayley, 2005). Children who walk at 9 months are no more likely than children who walk at 17 months to become Olympic athletes some day, they simply have different biological time lines for learning to walk. By 15 months most toddlers can stand (briefly) on one leg and have begun to climb, although once they have climbed onto something, they are much less skilled at climbing down. For example, most can climb up stairs at this age but not (safely) down. By 18 months most can run, although at first they run with the same stiff-legged, wide-stance posture as they use for walking. By 24 months they can kick a ball or throw a small object, and their running has become more flexible and fluid. At this age they can now go down the stairs that they earlier learned to climb up, and more: They can squat for minutes at a time, stand on tiptoes, and jump up and down. Small wonder toddlers move around so much, with so many new abilities to try out!

Learning Objectives Learning objectives for each chapter are listed at the start of each chapter section as well as within the chapter alongside every section heading. Based on Bloom’s taxonomy, these numbered objectives help students better organize and understand the material. The end-of-chapter summary is organized around these same objectives, as are all of the supplements and assessment material.

What Have You Learned? Questions WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? Review questions appear after each section to help students assess their comprehension of the material and their understanding of the influence that culture has on development. Sample answers are provided in the Instructor’s Manual, making these questions ideally suited for classroom discussion or homework assignments.

1. What are the most important nutritional deficiencies in toddlerhood, and how do they influence health? 2. How do synaptic density and synaptic pruning change during toddlerhood? 3. What are the two reasons why night-waking increases from 1½ to 2 years of age? 4. How do sleeping arrangements change in the course of toddlerhood in traditional cultures? 5. To what extent do cultures restrict toddlers’ movements, and why? 6. What specific fine motor abilities do toddlers lack at their first birthday but develop by their third birthday?

MyDevelopmentLab Icons MyDevelopmentLab icons throughout the text provide numerous opportunities for students to learn the way they want to learn, including videos, simulations, and by providing additional information on particular topics. Watch (dozens of videos, including the new Cross-Cultural videos) Listen (streaming audio of the chapter) Explore (step by step tutorials on important concepts) Simulate (online simulations) Study and Review (online Study Plan, Chapter Quizzes and Quick Reviews) Read (online readings feature additional information or more in-depth coverage of topics discussed in the text)

Preface

Chapter Summary and Practice Test End-of-Chapter Summary and Practice Tests, organized by learning objective, help students review and study, while MyDevelopmentLab provides additional resources online to help students achieve mastery of the material.

Summing Up Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab Listen at MyDevelopmentLab

SECTION 1

Listen to an audio file of your chapter at MyDevelopmentLab

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

5.1 Describe the typical changes in physical growth that take place in toddlerhood and explain the harmful effects of nutritional deficiencies on growth. Toddlers’ physical growth continues at a pace that is slightly reduced from infancy but is nevertheless faster than at any later time of life. Toddlers in developing countries often suffer protein and micronutrient deficiencies that impede their physical and cognitive development.

5.2 Describe the changes in brain development that take place during toddlerhood, and identify the two most common methods of measuring brain activity. The brain’s synaptic density peaks at the end of toddlerhood, followed by many years of synaptic pruning. The two most common methods of measuring brain activity are the EEG and the fMRI.

5.3 Describe the changes in sleeping patterns and sleeping arrangements that take place during toddlerhood. Toddlers’ episodes of night-waking increase from 18 to 24 months of age, in part due to teething of molars. In traditional cultures, toddlers sleep with their mothers until the next child is born, after which they sleep with other family members. Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

Practice Test

1. ______________ is a condition specific to toddlerhood in which protein deficiencies lead to varied symptoms such as swollen bellies, hair loss, and lack of energy. a. Kwashiorkor b. SIDS c. Marasmus d. Dysentery 2. What most characterizes early brain development in toddlerhood is a. the formation of the cerebral cortex. b. the steep increase in the density of synaptic connections among neurons. c. activity in the amygdala. d. the production of new brain cells. 3. During toddlerhood, a. sleeping alone is rare in traditional cultures. b. children sleep more than they did in infancy (because they are so much more active). c. naps are no longer needed. d. children sleep consistently throughout the night. 4. Toddlers a. who do not walk by 1 year are likely to have a gross motor problem.

5.4 Describe the advances in motor development that take place during toddlerhood. In their gross motor development, toddlers learn to walk, run, climb, and kick a ball. Toddlers in traditional cultures are often restricted in their movements to protect them from danger—especially cooking fires. Advances in fine motor development include holding a cup and building a tower of blocks. In their third year, toddlers may be able to brush their teeth, with some assistance.

5.5 Compare and contrast the process and timing of toilet training in developed countries and traditional cultures. Children vary widely in the timing of learning toilet training, but most are toilet trained by the end of toddlerhood. In traditional cultures, toddlers usually learn controlled elimination through observing and imitating older children.

5.6 Distinguish the weaning process early in infancy from weaning later in toddlerhood. When weaning takes place in the second or third year of life, toddlers often resist. Customs in traditional cultures for promoting weaning include sending the toddler to a relative’s household for awhile or coating the mother’s breast with an unpleasant substance.

b. in traditional cultures are equal to toddlers from Western cultures in the development of their gross motor skills. c. can usually run before they can stand briefly on one leg. d. show the same pace of gross motor development as fine motor development. 5. In the West, a. most children show signs of readiness for toilet training by their first birthday. b. views about toilet training have stayed the same over the last several decades. c. children are toilet trained in a nearly identical way as their counterparts in traditional cultures. d. a sign of being ready to begin toilet training is when the child can stay “dry” for an hour or two during the day. 6. If you are a toddler from a traditional culture, you would likely a. have experienced some customary practice for being weaned. b. be abruptly weaned at age 1. c. be given formula instead of breast milk. d. still be breast-feeding at age 5.

xix

MyDevelopmentLab™ MyDevelopmentLab combines proven learning applications with powerful assessment to engage students, assess their learning, and help them succeed.

s An individualized study plan for each student, based on performance on chapter pre-tests, helps students focus on the specific topics where they need the most support. The personalized study plan arranges content from less-complex thinking, like remembering and understanding—to morecomplex critical thinking skills—like applying and analyzing, and is based on Bloom’s taxonomy. Every level of the study plan provides a formative assessment quiz.

s MyVirtualChild and MyVirtualLife. MyVirtualChild is an interactive simulation that allows students to play the role of a parent and raise their own virtual child. By making decisions about specific scenarios, students can raise their children from birth to age 18 and learn firsthand how their own decisions and other parenting actions affect their child over time. In MyVirtualLife, students make decisions for a virtual version of themselves from emerging adulthood through the end of life.

xx

Preface

xxi

s Media assignments for each chapter—including videos with assignable questions—feed directly into the gradebook, enabling instructors to track student progress automatically. s The Pearson eText lets students access their textbook anytime and anywhere, and any way they want, including listening online.

193

Frontmatter Ch. 1: A Cultural Approach to Human Development Ch. 2: Genetics and Prenatal Development Ch. 3: Birth and the Newborn Child Ch. 4: Infancy Ch. 5: Toddlerhood Ch. 6: Early Childhood Ch. 7: Middle Childhood Ch. 8: Adolescence Ch. 9: Emerging Adulthood Ch. 10: Young Adulthood Ch. 11: Middle Adulthood Ch. 12: Late Adulthood Ch. 13: Death and Afterlife Beliefs

s The MyDevelopmentLab Question Library provides over 2,400 test items in the form of Pre-Tests, Post-Tests, and Chapter Exams. These questions are parallel forms of questions found in the instructor test bank, ensuring that students using MyDevelopmentLab for review and practice will find their tests to be of similar tone and difficulty, while protecting the integrity of the instructor test bank. With assessment tied to every video, application, and chapter, students get immediate feedback, and instructors can see what their students know with just a few clicks. Instructors can also personalize MyDevelopmentLab to meet the needs of their students.

Teaching and Learning Package A textbook is but one component of a comprehensive learning package. The author team that prepared the teaching and learning package had as its goal to deliver the most comprehensive and integrated package on the market. Dorothy Marsil of Kennesaw State University oversaw the development of all instructor supplements to help ensure consistency and quality. All supplements were developed around the textbook’s carefully constructed learning objectives. The authors are grateful to reviewers and focus group members who provided invaluable feedback and suggestions for improving various elements of the program.

TEST BANK Cowritten by David Hurford (Pittsburg

Chapter 04: Infancy Chapter 04: Quick Quiz 1 Chapter 04: Quick Quiz 2 Chapter 04: Multiple-Choice Questions 1) Compared to other animals, the human brain is very large at birth, but it is also: a) Well developed b) Malformed  c) Relatively immature d) Nearly adultlike 2) According to the text, infants need more ____ in their diets than at any later point in life, for the growth of their bodies and (especially) their brains. a) fluoride  b) fat c) folic acid d) iron

ANS: b, p. 305, A, LO=8.4, (2)

ANS: a, p. 305, A, LO=8.4, (2)

State University), Yuthika Kim (Oklahoma City Community College), and Julie McIntyre (Russell Sage College), the Test Bank contains over 4,000 questions, many of which were class-tested in multiple classes at both 2-year and 4-year institutions across the country prior to publication. Item analysis is provided for all class-tested items. All conceptual and applied multiple-choice questions include rationales for each correct answer and the key distracter. The item analysis helps instructors create balanced tests while the rationales serve both as an added guarantee of quality and as a time-saver when students challenge the keyed answer for a specific item. Each chapter of the test bank includes a two-page Total Assessment Guide, an easy-to-reference grid that organizes all test items by learning objective and question type. The test bank comes with Pearson MyTest, a powerful test generation program that helps instructors easily create and print quizzes and exams. Questions and tests can be authored online, allowing instructors ultimate flexibility and the ability to efficiently manage assessments wherever and whenever they want. Instructors can easily access existing questions and then edit, create, and store, using simple drag-and-drop and Wordlike controls. Data on each question provides information relevant to difficulty level and page number. In addition, each question maps to the text’s major section and learning objective. For more information go to www.PearsonMyTest.com.

2.1 Distinguish between genotype and phenotype and identify the different forms of genetic inheritance. 2.2 Describe the sex chromosomes and identify what makes them different from other chromosomes.

2.3 Describe how behavior geneticists use heritability estimates and concordance rates in their research.

xxii

ENHANCED LECTURE POWERPOINT SLIDES WITH EMBEDDED VIDEOS Written by Marvin Tobias (St. Charles Community College), the Enhanced Lecture PowerPoints offer detailed outlines of key points for each chapter supported by selected visuals from the textbook, and include the videos featured in the in-text Video Guides. Standard Lecture PowerPoints without embedded videos are also available. A separate Art and Figure version of these presentations contains all art from the textbook for which Pearson has been granted electronic permissions. Clicker Powerpoints are also available for instructors who use personal response systems.

Preface

INSTRUCTOR’S MANUAL Written and compiled by Dorothy Marsil (Kennesaw State University), the Instructor’s Manual includes suggestions for preparing for the course, sample syllabi, and current trends and strategies for successful teaching. Each chapter offers integrated teaching outlines, lists of the key terms for each chapter for quick reference, and includes an extensive bank of lecture launchers, handouts, and activities, and suggestions for integrating third-party videos and web resources. Answers to the in-text features Applying Your Knowledge, Thinking Culturally, and What Have You Learned? are provided, as well as answers to each chapter’s Video Guide. Detailed critical thinking problems with accompanying rubrics were written by Diana Joy of the Community College of Denver. A set of questions for using MyVirtualChild with the cultural approach, written by Guyla Davis of Ouachita Baptist University, is also included. The electronic format features click-and-view hotlinks that allow instructors to quickly review or print any resource from a particular chapter. This tool saves prep work and helps you maximize your classroom time. CLASSPREP Finding, sorting, organizing and presenting your instructor resources is faster and easier than ever before with ClassPrep. This fully searchable database contains hundreds and hundreds of our best teacher resources, including lecture launchers and discussion topics, in-class and out-of-class activities and assignments, handouts, video clips, photos, illustrations, charts, graphs and animations. Instructors can browse by topic, search by keyword, and filter results by asset type (photo, document, video, animation). Instructors can sort the resources into their own filing system, tag, rate and comment on individual resources, and even download most of the resources. ClassPrep also offers instructors the option to upload their own resources and present directly from ClassPrep. ClassPrep is available for instructors through MyDevelopmentLab. Please contact your Pearson representative for access.

ACCESSING ALL RESOURCES For a list of all student resources available with Human Development: A Cultural Approach, First Edition, go to www.mypearsonstore.com, enter the text ISBN (0-205-59526-X) and check out the “Everything That Goes with It” section under the book cover. For access to all instructor supplements for Human Development: A Cultural Approach, First Edition go to www.pearsonhighered.com/irc and follow the directions to register (or log in if you already have a Pearson user name and password). Once you have registered and your status as an instructor is verified, you will be e-mailed a log-in name and password. Use your log-in name and password to access the catalog. You can request hard copies of the supplements through your Pearson sales representative. If you do not know your sales representative, go to www.pearsonhighered. com/replocator and follow the directions. For technical support for any of your Pearson products, you and your students can contact http://247.pearsoned.com.

xxiii

xxiv

Preface

Acknowledgments Writing a new life span textbook is an enormous enterprise, and this one has involved many talented and dedicated people. I am grateful to all who contributed. I would especially like to thank Stephen Frail, the Executive Editor, who enthusiastically supported my vision for the book and mobilized all the resources necessary to bring it to fruition. Julie Swasey performed superbly as the Senior Development Editor, going over every line of my writing multiple times and repeatedly making it better. Thanks also go to Barbara Reilly and Rebecca Dunn for handling all aspects of production and Marne Evans for copyediting the manuscript. Katie Toulmin, Nick Kaufman, Howard Stern, and others at NKP Media, advised by Ashley Maynard and Bianca Dahl, filmed a fabulous collection of video clips that will bring the cultural approach alive to students in every chapter of the book. Kerri Hart-Morris coordinated the supplements package and Peter Sabatini produced the MyDevelopmentLab site. Nicole Kunzmann, Senior Marketing Manager, handled the marketing of the text and Alison Rodal, Market Development Manager, organized class testing, surveys, and focus groups that provided valuable feedback at every stage of the book’s development. Carly Bergey and Ben Ferrini found the photos that do a great job of reflecting the cultural approach of the book. John Christiana created the beautiful interior and cover design. I’d also like to thank Maria Piper, and J.C. Morgan at Precision Graphics, for their work on the art; Kevin Lear at Spatial Graphics, for the creation of the maps; Charles Morris and Jane Scelta, for their help with permissions; and Maddy Schricker, for coordinating the reviews. Finally, I would like to thank the hundreds of reviewers who reviewed chapters, sections, and other materials in the course of the development of the book. I benefited greatly from their suggestions and corrections, and now instructors and students reading the book will benefit, too.

The Development of Human Development: A Cultural Approach The textbook you hold in your hands is the product of the most extensive development effort this market has ever witnessed. Human Development: A Cultural Approach reflects the countless hours and extraordinary efforts of a team of authors, editors, and reviewers that shared a vision for not only a unique human development textbook, but also the most comprehensive and integrated supplements program on the market. Over 200 manuscript reviewers provided invaluable feedback for making text as accessible and relevant to students as possible. Each chapter was also reviewed by a panel of subject-matter experts to ensure accuracy and currency. Dozens of focus-group participants helped guide every aspect of the program, from content coverage to the art style and design to the configuration of the supplements. In fact, some of those focus-group participants were so invested in the project that they became members of the supplements author team themselves. Dozens of students compared the manuscript to their current textbooks and provided suggestions for improving the prose and design. We thank everyone who participated in ways great and small, and hope that you are as pleased with the finished product as we are!

INSTRUCTORS Alabama Sarah Luckadoo, Jefferson State Community College Carroll Tingle, University of Alabama

Arizona Richard Detzel, Arizona State University and Northern Arizona University

Elaine Groppenbacher, Chandler Gilbert Community College and Western International University

Lenore Frigo, Shasta College

California

Arthur Gonchar, University of La Verne

Patricia Bellas, Irvine Valley College Bella DePaulo, University of California, Santa Barbara Ann Englert, California State Polytechnic University, Pomona

Mary Gauvain, University of California, Riverside

Richard Kandus, Mt. San Jacinto College Michelle Pilati, Rio Hondo College Susan Siaw, California State Polytechnic University, Pomona

Preface Colorado Jessica Herrick, Mesa State College Diana Joy, Community College of Denver David MacPhee, Colorado State University Peggy Norwood, Community College of Aurora

Connecticut Carol LaLiberte, Asnuntuck Community College

Florida Maggie Anderson, Valencia Community College Diana Ciesko, Valencia Community College Seth Schwartz, University of Miami Anne Van Landingham, Orlando Tech Lois Willoughby, Miami Dade College

Georgia

Carol Miller, Anne Arundel Community College Gary Popoli, Harford Community College

Massachusetts Barbara Madden, Fitchburg State University Candace J. Schulenburg, Cape Cod Community College

Minnesota Jarilyn Gess, Minnesota State University Moorhead Dana Gross, St. Olaf College

Mississippi Linda Fayard, Mississippi Gulf Coast Community College Donna Carol Gainer, Mississippi State University Linda Morse, Mississippi State University

xxv

James Jordan, Lorain County Community College William Kimberlin, Lorain County Community College Michelle Slattery, North Central State College Jennifer King-Cooper, Sinclair Community College

Oklahoma Matthew Brosi, Oklahoma State University Yuthika Kim, Oklahoma City Community College Gregory Parks, Oklahoma City Community College John Phelan, Western Oklahoma State College

Oregon Alishia Huntoon, Oregon Institute of Technology

Jennie Dilworth, Georgia Southern University Nicole Rossi, Augusta State University Amy Skinner, Gordon College Sharon Todd, Southern Crescent Technical College

Missouri

Hawaii

Nevada

Katherine Aumer, Hawaii Pacific University

Bridget Walsh, University of Nevada, Reno

Illinois

New Jersey

Christine Grela, McHenry County College Kathy Kufskie, Southwestern Illinois College Mikki Meadows, Eastern Illinois University

Melissa Sapio, Hudson County Community College

Brantlee Haire, Florence-Darlington Technical College Salvador Macias, University of South Carolina Sumter

New Mexico

Tennessee

Katherine Demitrakis, Central New Mexico Community College

Clark McKinney, Southwest Tennessee Community College

New York

Texas

Kansas

Paul Anderer, SUNY Canton Sybillyn Jennings, Russell Sage College Judith Kuppersmith, College of Staten Island Jonathan Lang, Borough of Manhattan Community College Steven McCloud, Borough of Manhattan Community College Julie McIntyre, The Sage Colleges Elisa Perram, The Graduate Center, The City University of New York

David P. Hurford, Pittsburg State University

North Carolina

Terra Bartee, Cisco College Wanda Clark, South Plains College Trina Cowan, Northwest Vista College Stephanie Ding, Del Mar College Robert Gates, Cisco College Jerry Green, Tarrant County College Heather Hill, St. Mary’s University Jean Raniseski, Alvin Community College Darla Rocha, San Jacinto College Victoria Van Wie, Lone Star College-CyFair Kim Wombles, Cisco College

Louisiana

Paul Foos, University of North Carolina, Charlotte Donna Henderson, Wake Forest University Amy Holmes, Davidson County Community College Andrew Supple, The University of North Carolina at Greensboro Maureen Vandermaas-Peeler, Elon University

Indiana Kimberly Bays, Ball State University

Iowa Shawn Haake, Iowa Central Community College Brenda Lohman, Iowa State University Jennifer Meehan Brennom, Kirkwood Community College James Rodgers, Hawkeye Community College Kari Terzino, Iowa State University

Kim Herrington, Louisiana State University at Alexandria

Maine Diane Lemay, University of Maine at Augusta Elena Perrello, The University of Maine and Husson University Ed Raymaker, Eastern Maine Community College

Maryland Diane Finley, Prince George’s Community College

Scott Brandhorst, Southeast Missouri State University Sabrina Brinson, Missouri State University Peter J. Green, Maryville University

Ohio Amie Dunstan, Lorain County Community College James Jackson, Clark State Community College

Pennsylvania Martin Packer, Duquesne University

Rhode Island Clare Sartori, University of Rhode Island

South Carolina

Utah Ann M. Berghout Austin, Utah State University Thomas J. Farrer, Brigham Young University Sam Hardy, Brigham Young University Shirlene Law, Utah State University Volkan Sahin, Weber State University Julie Smart, Utah State University

Virginia Geri M. Lotze, Virginia Commonwealth University Stephan Prifti, George Mason University

xxvi

Preface

Steve Wisecarver, Lord Fairfax Community College

Washington Dan Ferguson, Walla Walla Community College Amy Kassler, South Puget Sound Community College

Australia Laurie Chapin, Victoria University

Canada Lauren Polvere, Concordia University

REVIEWER CONFERENCE PARTICIPANTS Ann Englert, California State Polytechnic University, Pomona David P. Hurford, Pittsburg State University Diana Joy, Community College of Denver Richard Kandus, Mt. San Jacinto College Yuthika Kim, Oklahoma City Community College Dorothy Marsil, Kennesaw State University Julie McIntyre, The Sage Colleges Carol Miller, Anne Arundel Community College Steve Wisecarver, Lord Fairfax Community College

TEXT FOCUS GROUPS Tenelnger Abrom-Johnson, Prairie View A&M University Triin Anton, University of Arizona A. Nayena Blankson, Valencia Community College Gina Brelsford, Penn State Harrisburg Guyla Davis, Ouachita Baptist University Mark Davis, University of West Alabama Ann Englert, California State Polytechnic University, Pomona Jessica Hehman, University of Redlands Richard Kandus, Mt. San Jacinto College Yuthika Kim, Oklahoma City Community College Carolyn Lorente, North Virginia Community College Connie Manos-Andrea, Inver Hills Community College Dorothy Marsil, Kennesaw State University Denise McClung, West Virginia University at Parkersburg David F. McGrevy, San Diego Mesa College and University of San Diego Julie McIntyre, The Sage Colleges Robin Montvilo, Rhode Island College Natasha Otto, Morgan State University Rachel M. Petty, University of the District of Columbia

Marc Wolpoff, Riverside City College Christine Ziegler, Kennesaw State University

SUPPLEMENTS FOCUS GROUP Darin LaMar Baskin, Houston Community College Trina Cowan, Northwest Vista College Mark Evans, Tarrant County College Jerry Green, Tarrant County College David P. Hurford, Pittsburg State University Rose Mary Istre, San Jacinto College Yuthika Kim, Oklahoma City Community College Franz Klutschkowski, North Central Texas College Dorothy Marsil, Kennesaw State University Darla Rocha, San Jacinto College-North

STUDENT REVIEWERS Kacie Farrar Easha Khanam Christina Kroder Heather Lacis Samantha Piterniak Kaleigh Sankowski

STUDENT FOCUS GROUP PARTICIPANTS Krista Anderson Noelle Armstrong Tori Bailey Alaynah Bakosh Kevin Barnes Blake Bender Heather Bennett Ashlie Bogenschutz Chelsea Boyd Bianca Brown Jasmine Brown Kelsie Brown Victor Calderon Myndi Casey Flor Cerda Kolbi Chaffin Jose Gabriel Checo Percilla Colley Nicole Collier Alexandria Cornell

Brandon Culver Jayson De Leon Cody Decker Tiarra Edwards Michelle England Nicole Evans Emma Fialka-Feldman Hope Foreback Bailey Francis Leslie Frantz David Garcia Shannon Gogel Eric Gould Che Grippon Dolly M. Guadalupe Lucia Guerrero Daniel Guillen Cassandra Hagan Jamie Hall Ashton Hooper

Antony Karanja Jesse Klaucke Joshua Laboy Ashley Lacy Abta Laylor Janella Leach Julien Lima Kelsey Love Erica Lynn Chelsey Mann Melissa Methaney Nick McCommon Kristie McCormick Emily McWilliams Claudia Mendez Krystle Mercado Ashley Minning Paul Mitchell Sarah Mocherniak Francisco Moncada

Isaiah Moore Juan Moreno Austin Morris Jodie Mudd Tia Nguyen Jacob Nieves Tiffany Potemra Veronica Poul Michelle Richardson David Riffle Trey Robb Kristin Serkowski Richard Stillman Amber Thichangthong Marilyn Toribio Tugce Tuskan Kelci Wallace Edyta Werner Ashley Williams

About the Author

Jeffrey Jensen Arnett is a Research Professor in the Department of Psychology at Clark University in Worcester, Massachusetts. He received his Ph.D. in developmental psychology in 1986 from the University of Virginia, and did 3 years of postdoctoral work at the University of Chicago. From 1992–1998 he was Associate Professor in the Department of Human Development and Family Studies at the University of Missouri where he taught a 300-student life-span development course every semester. From 1998–2005 he was a Visiting Associate Professor in the Department of Human Development at the University of Maryland. In the fall of 2005 he was a Fulbright Scholar at the University of Copenhagen in Denmark. His primary scholarly interest for the past 10 years has been in emerging adulthood. He coined the term, and has conducted research on emerging adults concerning a wide variety of topics, involving several different ethnic groups in American society. He is the editor of the Journal of Adolescent Research, and is on the Editorial Board of four other journals. He has published many theoretical and research papers on emerging adulthood in peer-reviewed journals, as well as the books Adolescence and Emerging Adulthood: A Cultural Approach (2013, 5th edition, Pearson), and Emerging Adulthood: The Winding Road from the Late Teens Through the Twenties (2004, Oxford University Press). He lives in Worcester, Massachusetts, with his wife Lene Jensen and their twins, Miles and Paris. For more information on Dr. Arnett and his research, see www.jeffreyarnett.com.

xxvii

xxviii C h ap ter 1 A Cultural Approach to Human Development

1

A Cultural Approach to Human Development

Section 1 Human Development Today and Its Origins

1

Section 1 HUMAN DEVELOPMENT TODAY AND ITS ORIGINS Humanity Today: A Demographic Profile Variations Across Countries Variations Within Countries

Human Origins and the Birth of Culture Our Evolutionary Beginnings The Origin of Cultures and Civilizations Human Evolution and Human Development Today

Section 2 THEORIES OF HUMAN DEVELOPMENT Ancient Conceptions of Development Conceptions of Human Development in Three Traditions Understanding Traditional Conceptions of Life

Scientific Conceptions of Human Development Freud’s Psychosexual Theory Erikson’s Psychosocial Theory Bronfenbrenner’s Ecological Theory A Stage Model for This Book

Section 3 HOW WE STUDY HUMAN DEVELOPMENT The Scientific Study of Human Development The Five Steps of the Scientific Method Ethics in Human Development Research

Methods and Designs in Research Research Methods Research Designs

Summing Up

1

THE

CHINESE HAVE AN EXPRESSION FOR THE LIMITED Biology is important, too, of course, and at various points we WAY ALL OF US LEARN TO SEE THE WORLD: jing di zhi wa, will discuss the interaction between biological and cultural or social meaning “frog in the bottom of a well.” The expression comes from a influences. However, human beings everywhere have essentially the fable about a frog that has lived its entire life in a small well. Swimming same biological constitution, yet their paths through the life span are around in the water, the frog assumes that its tiny world is all there is. remarkably different depending on the culture in which their developThe frog believes that its perception is complete, but it has no idea how ment takes place. vast the world really is. It is only when a passing turtle tells the frog of The tendency in most social science research, especially in psythe great ocean to the east that the frog realizes there is much more to chology, has been to ignore or strip away culture in pursuit of univerthe world than it had known. sal principles of development (Jensen, 2011; Rozin, 2006). Research All of us are like that frog. We grow up as members of a culture has focused mostly on studying human development in the Ameriand learn, through direct and indirect can middle class, because most teaching, to see the world from the perresearchers were American and spective that becomes most familiar to they assumed that the processes From the day we are born, all of us us. Because the people around us usually of development they observed in share that perspective, we seldom have experience our lives as members of a the United States were universal cause to question it. Like the frog, we (Arnett, 2008). But this is changrarely suspect how big and diverse our culture ing, and in recent years there has human species really is. been increasing attention in psyThe goal of this book is to lift you chology and other social science out of the well, by taking a cultural approach to understanding hufields to the cultural context of human development (Shweder, 2011; man development, the ways people grow and change across the life Shweder et al., 2006). By now, researchers have presented descriptions span. This means that the emphasis of the book is on how persons of human development in places all over the world, and researchers develop as members of a culture. Culture is the total pattern of a studying American society have increased their attention to cultures group’s customs, beliefs, art, and technology. In other words, a culture within the United States that are outside of the White middle class. is a group’s common way of life, passed on from one generation to Central to this book is the view that an emphasis on cultural conthe next. From the day we are born, all of us experience our lives as text is essential to understanding human development. What it is like members of a culture (sometimes more than one), and this profoundly to go through life in the American middle class is different in many influences how we develop, how we behave, how we see the world, ways from going through life in Egypt, or Thailand, or Brazil—and also and how we experience life. different from going through life in certain American minority cultures,

2





such as urban African American culture or the culture of recent Mexican American immigrants. Throughout this book, we’ll explore human development from the perspectives of many different cultures around the world. We’ll also learn to analyze and critique research based on whether it does or does not take culture into account. By the time you finish this book, you should be able to think culturally. Why is it important for you to understand human development using the cultural approach? Hopefully you will find it fascinating to learn about the marvelous diversity in the ways of life that people experience in different cultures, from prenatal growth to late adulthood, and even after death. In addition, the cultural approach has many practical applications. Increasingly the world is approaching the global village that the social philosopher Marshall McLuhan (1960) forecast over half a century ago. In recent decades there has been an acceleration in the process of globalization, which refers to the increasing connections between different parts of the world in trade, travel, migration, and communication (Arnett, 2002; Giddens, 2000; Ridley, 2010). Consequently, wherever you live in the world, in the course of your personal and professional life you are likely to have many contacts with people of other cultures. Those of you going into the nursing profession may one day have patients who have a cultural background in various parts of Asia or South America. Those of you pursuing careers in education will likely teach students whose families emigrated from countries in Africa or Europe. Your coworkers, your neighbors, possibly even your friends and family members may include people from a variety of different cultural backgrounds. Through the Internet you may have contact with people all over the world, via e-mail, Facebook and other social media, YouTube, and new technologies to come. Thus, understanding the cultural approach to human development is likely to be useful in all aspects of life, helping you to communicate with and understand the perspectives of others in a diverse, globalized world. Not least, the cultural approach to human development will help you understand more deeply your own life and your place in the world. Think for a moment, of which culture or cultures are you a member? How has your cultural membership shaped your development and your view of the world? I am an American, and I have lived in the United States all my life. I am also White (or European American), ethnically, and a man; I am middle class and an urban resident. I am married to a Dane, and our family has spent a lot of time in Denmark. Those cultural contexts have shaped how I have learned to understand the world, as your cultural contexts have shaped your own understanding. In the course of this book I will be your fellow frog, your guide and companion as we rise together out of the well to gaze at the broad, diverse, remarkable cultural panorama of the human journey. The book will introduce you to many variations in human development and

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE

cultural practices you did not know about before, which may lead you to see your own

In the profession you are in or will one day be in, what is one way the cultural approach to human development might be applied to your work?

development and your own cultural practices in a new light. Whether you think toddlers breast-feeding until age 3 is normal or abnormal, whether you think adolescents “naturally” draw closer to or farther away from their parents, whether you think continuing to be sexually active in middle adulthood is healthy or spiritually contaminating, you are about to meet cultures with assumptions very different from your own. This will enrich your awareness of the variety of human experiences and may allow you to draw from a wider range of options of how you wish to live. In this chapter we set the stage for the rest of the book. The first section provides a broad summary of human life today around the world as well as an examination of how culture developed out of our evolutionary history. In the second section, we look at the history of theoretical conceptions of human development along with two current theories that contribute to human development research. Finally, the third section provides an overview of human development as a scientific field.

human development way people grow and change across the life span; includes people’s biological, cognitive, psychological, and social functioning culture total pattern of a group’s customs, beliefs, art, and technology globalization increasing connections between different parts of the world in trade, travel, migration, and communication

3

SECTION 1

HUMAN DEVELOPMENT TODAY AND ITS ORIGINS

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 1.1 Distinguish between the demographic profiles of developed countries and developing countries in terms of population, income, and education. 1.2 Define the term socioeconomic status (SES) and explain why SES, gender, and ethnicity are important aspects of human development within countries. 1.3 Explain the process of natural selection and trace the evolutionary origins of the human species. 1.4 Summarize the evidence that human cultures first developed during the Upper Paleolithic period, and identify the features of the Neolithic period and early civilizations. 1.5 Apply information about human evolution to how human development takes place today.

Humanity Today: A Demographic Profile

total fertility rate (TFR) in a population, the number of births per woman

4

Since the goal of this book is to provide you with an understanding of how human development takes place in cultures all around the world, let’s begin with a demographic profile of the world’s human population in the early 21st century. Perhaps the most striking demographic feature of the human population today is the sheer size of it. For most of history the total human population was under 10 million (McFalls, 2007). Women typically had from four to eight children, but most of the children died in infancy or childhood and never reached reproductive age. The human population began to increase notably around 10,000 years ago, with the development of agriculture and domestication of animals (Diamond, 1992). Population growth in the millennia that followed was very slow, and it was not until about 400 years ago that the world population reached 500 million persons. Since that time, and especially in the past century, population growth has accelerated at an astonishing rate (see Figure 1.1; McFalls, 2007). It took just 150 years for the human population to double from 500 million to 1 billion, passing that threshold around the year 1800. Then came the medical advances of the 20th century, and the elimination or sharp reduction of deadly diseases like smallpox, typhus, diphtheria, and cholera. Subsequently, the human population reached 2 billion by 1930, then tripled to 6 billion by 1999. The 7-billion threshold was surpassed just 12 years later, in early 2011. How high will the human population go? This is difficult to say, but most projections indicate it will rise to 9 billion by about 2050 and thereafter stabilize and perhaps slightly decline. This forecast is based on the worldwide decline in birthrates that has taken place in recent years. The total fertility rate (TFR) (number of births per woman) worldwide is currently 2.8, which is substantially higher than the rate of 2.1 that is the replacement rate of a stable population. However, the TFR has been declining sharply for over a decade and will decline to 2.1 by 2050 if current trends continue (Ridley, 2010).

Section 1 Human Development Today and Its Origins

Figure 1.1 s World Population Growth, Past 10,000 years What happened in recent human history to cause population to rise so dramatically?

 

7VW\SH[PVUIPSSPVUZ

5

Source: Ember (2007).

      



  5\TILYVM`LHYZHNV



;VKH`

Variations Across Countries Distinguish between the demographic profiles of developed countries and developing countries in terms of population, income, and education. The population increase from now to 2050 will not take place equally around the world. On the contrary, there is a stark “global demographic divide” between the wealthy, economically developed countries that make up less than 20% of the world’s population, and the economically developing countries that contain the majority of the world’s population (Kent & Haub, 2005). Nearly all the population growth in the decades to come will take place in the economically developing countries. In contrast, nearly all wealthy countries are expected to decline in population during this period and beyond, because they have current fertility rates that are well below replacement rate. For the purposes of this text, we’ll use the term developed countries to refer to the most affluent countries in the world. Classifications of developed countries vary, but usually this designation includes the United States, Canada, Japan, South Korea, Australia, New Zealand, Argentina, Chile, and nearly all the countries of Europe (Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development [OECD], 2010). For our discussion, developed countries will be contrasted with developing countries, which have less wealth than the developed countries but are experiencing rapid economic growth as they join the globalized economy. A brief profile of the developing country of India is presented in the Cultural Focus: Incredible India! feature on page 8. The current population of developed countries is 1.2 billion, about 18% of the total world population, and the population of developing countries is about 5.8 billion, about 82% of the world’s population. Among developed countries, the United States is one of the few likely to gain rather than lose population in the next few decades. Currently there are about 310 million persons in the United States, but by 2050 there will be 439 million (Kotkin, 2010). Nearly all the other developed countries are expected to decline in population between now and 2050 (OECD, 2010). The decline will be steepest in Japan, which is projected to drop from a current population of 120 million to just 90 million by 2050, due to a low fertility rate and virtually no immigration. There are two reasons why the United States is following a different demographic path than most other developed countries. First, the United States has a Total Fertility Rate of 2.0, which is slightly below the replacement rate of 2.1 but still higher than the TFR in most other

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

1.1

Read the Document Developed Countries (OECD Classification) at MyDevelopmentLab

THINKING CULTURALLY What are some potential political and social consequences of populations rising in developing countries and falling in developed countries in the coming decades?

developed countries world’s most economically developed and affluent countries, with the highest median levels of income and education developing countries countries that have lower levels of income and education than developed countries but are experiencing rapid economic growth

6

C h ap ter 1

A Cultural Approach to Human Development

Nearly all the world population growth from now to 2050 will take place in developing countries. Here, a busy street in Delhi, India.

developed countries (Population Reference Bureau, 2010). Second, and more importantly, the United States allows more legal immigration than most other developed countries do, and there are tens of millions of undocumented immigrants as well. The increase in population in the United States between now and 2050 will result entirely from immigration (Martin & Midgley, 2010). Both legal and undocumented immigrants to the United States come mainly from Mexico and Latin America, although many also come from Asia and other parts of the world. Consequently, as Map 1.1 shows, by 2050 the proportion of the U.S. population that is Latino is projected to rise from 16% to 30% (Martin & Midgley, 2010). Canada, the United Kingdom, and Australia also have relatively open immigration policies, so they, too, may avoid the population decline that is projected for most developed countries (DeParle, 2010). The demographic contrast of developed countries compared to the rest of the world is stark not only with respect to population but also in other key areas, such as income and

THINKING CULTURALLY What kinds of public policy changes might be necessary in the United States between now and 2050 to adapt to nearly 100 million more immigrants and a rise in the proportion of Latinos to 30%?

WA

VT MT

ND

MN

OR ID NV

WI

SD

WY

CA AZ

CO

PA

IA

NE UT

IL KS OK

NM

NY

MI

MO

OH

IN

KY

WV VA NC

TN

AR

ME

 TPSSPVU

NH MA RI NJ CT DE MD D.C.

    

SC MS AL

GA

TX LA AK

Minority population as a percentage of population* Less than 10%

10– 24.9%

25– 34.9%

35– 49.9%

More than 50%

*Minority refers to people who reported their ethnicity and race as something other than non-Hispanic White alone









FL HI

 TPSSPVU

;^VVYTVYLYHJLZ (TLYPJHU0UKPHU(SHZRH5H[P]L 5H[P]L/H^HPPHU7HJPMPJ0ZSHUKLY (ZPHU(TLYPJHU (MYPJHU(TLYPJHU 3H[PUV >OP[L



(J[\HS

Map 1.1 s Projected Ethnic Changes in the U.S. Population to 2050 Which ethnic group is projected to change the most in the coming decades, and why?



7YVQLJ[LK

  

Section 1 Human Development Today and Its Origins

7

Population

30°

30°





Developed countries = 18.0% of the world population

30°

30°

Developing countries = 82.0% of the world population

120° 60° 150°

90°

60°

30°



30°

60°

90°

120°

150°

Gross Domestic Product (GDP)

30°

30°





Developed countries = 55.4% of the world GDP Developing countries = 44.6% of the world GDP 150°

30°

30°

120° 60° 150°

90°

60°

30°



30°

60°

90°

120°

150°

education (see Map 1.2). With respect to income, about 40% of the world’s population lives on less than two dollars per day, and 80% of the world’s population lives on a family income of less than $6,000 per year (Kent & Haub, 2005; UNDP, 2006). At one extreme are the developed countries, where 9 of 10 persons are in the top 20% of the global income distribution, and at the other extreme is southern Africa, where half of the population is in the bottom 20% of global income. Africa’s economic growth has been strong for the past decade, but it remains the poorest region in the world (McKinsey Global Institute, 2010). A similar contrast between rich and poor countries exists regarding education. Your experience as a college student is a rare and privileged status in most of the world. In developed countries, virtually all children obtain primary and secondary education, and about 50% go on to tertiary education (college or other postsecondary training). However, in developing countries about 20% of children do not complete primary school and only about half are enrolled in secondary school (UNDP, 2006). College and other postsecondary education is only for the wealthy elite. There are also some broad cultural differences between developed and developing countries, even though each category is very diverse. One important difference is that

Map 1.2 s Worldwide Variations in Population and Income Levels Developed countries represent only 18% of the world population yet they are much wealthier than developing countries. At what point in its economic development should a developing country be reclassified as a developed country?

8

C h ap ter 1

A Cultural Approach to Human Development

By age 10, many children in developing countries are no longer in school. Here, a child in Cameroon helps his mother make flour.

Watch the Video Differences Between Collectivistic and Individualistic Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab individualistic cultural values such as independence and self-expression collectivistic cultural values such as obedience and group harmony traditional culture in developing countries, a rural culture that adheres more closely to cultural traditions than people in urban areas do caste system in Hindu culture of India, an inherited social hierarchy, determined by birth

CULTURAL FOCUS

O

the cultures of developed countries tend to be based on individualistic values such as independence and self-expression (Greenfield, 2005). In contrast, developing countries tend to prize collectivistic values such as obedience and group harmony (Sullivan & Cottone, 2010). These are not mutually exclusive categories and each country has some balance between individualistic and collectivistic values. Furthermore, most countries contain a variety of cultures, some of which may be relatively individualistic whereas others are relatively collectivistic. Nevertheless, the overall distinction between individualism and collectivism is useful for describing broad differences between human groups. Within developing countries there is often a sharp divide between rural and urban areas, with people in urban areas having higher incomes and receiving more education and better medical care. Often, the lives of middleclass persons in urban areas of developing countries resemble the lives of people in developed countries in many ways, yet they are much different than people in rural areas of their own countries (UNDP, 2006). In this book, the term traditional cultures will be used to refer to people in the rural areas of developing countries, who tend to adhere more closely to the historical traditions of their culture than people in urban areas do. Traditional cultures tend to be more collectivistic than other cultures are, in part because in rural areas close ties with others are often an economic necessity (Sullivan & Cottone, 2010). This demographic profile of humanity today demonstrates that if you wish to understand human development, it is crucial to understand the lives of people in developing countries who comprise the majority of the world’s population. Most research on human development is on the 18% of the world’s population that lives in developed countries— especially the 5% of the world’s population that lives in the United States—because research requires money and developed countries can afford more of it than developing countries can (Arnett, 2008). However, it is clear that it would be inadequate to focus only on people in developed countries in a book on human development. In this book, you will learn about human development as people experience it all over the world.

Incredible India!

ne of the most fascinating and diverse places in the world, for anyone interested in human development, is India. The current population of India is 1.2 billion, making it the second most populous country in the world (after China), and by 2050 it will have more people than any other country, 1.5 billion (United Nations Development Programme [UNDP], 2011). Indians speak over 400 different languages, and there are over 200 distinct ethnic groups. Most Indians are Hindu (80%), but India also has millions of Muslims, Christians, Sikhs, Buddhists, and followers of other religions. Although India is fabulously diverse, there are cultural traits across groups that are characteristically Indian (Kakar & Kakar, 2007). Family closeness is highly valued in India, and most households are multigenerational (Chaudhary & Sharma, 2012). Traditionally, women entered their husband’s family household upon marriage, and the couples’ children then grew up around the paternal grandparents and many aunts, uncles, and cousins. This system is still followed by most Indians, although in urban areas

some middle-class couples choose to have their own household. Most marriages CHINA BHUTAN are arranged by parents and other reNEPAL MYANMAR (BURMA) spected family members (Chaudhary INDIA & Sharma, 2012). Traditionally, bride PAKISTAN and groom did not meet until their BANGLADESH wedding today, but now in most cases SRI LANKA they meet each other briefly before marriage, in the presence of other family members. One unique feature of Indian society is the caste system, which is an inherited social hierarchy. Indians believe in reincarnation, and this includes the belief that people are born into a caste position in the social hierarchy that reflects their moral and spiritual conduct in their previous life. People in high ranked castes tend to have the most economic resources and the best access to education and health care, whereas people in the lowest castes tend to have little in the way of money or other resources. Attempts

Section 1 Human Development Today and Its Origins have been made to abolish the caste system in the past century, but it persists as a strong influence in Indian life (Kakar & Kakar, 2007). India is a developing country, and most of its people live on an income of less than two dollars a day (UNDP, 2011). About half of Indian children are underweight and malnourished (World Bank, 2011). Less than half of Indian adolescents complete secondary school. Only about half of adult women are literate, and about three-fourths of adult men. About two-thirds of India’s population lives in rural villages, although there is a massive migration occurring from rural to urban areas, led mostly by young people. Like many developing countries India is rapidly changing. Its economy has been booming for the past 2 decades, lifting hun-

9

dreds of millions of Indians out of poverty (UNDP, 2011). India is now a world leader in manufacturing, telecommunications, and services. If the economy continues to grow at its present pace India will lead the world in economic production by 2050 (Price Waterhouse Coopers, 2011). Life is changing rapidly for Indians, and children born today are likely to experience much different economic and cultural contexts than their parents or grandparents have known. India will be a country to watch in the decades to come, and we will learn about many aspects of human development in India in the course of this book.

Variations Within Countries Define the term socioeconomic status (SES) and explain why SES, gender, and ethnicity are important aspects of human development within countries. The contrast between developed countries and developing countries will be used often in this book, as a general way of drawing a contrast between human development in relatively rich and relatively poor countries. However, it should be noted that there is substantial variation within each of these categories. All developed countries are relatively wealthy, but human development in Japan is quite different from human development in France or Canada. All developing countries are less wealthy than developed countries, but human development in China is quite different than human development in Brazil or Nigeria. At various points we will explore variations in human development within the broad categories of developed countries and developing countries. Not only is there important variation in human development within each category of “developed” and “developing” countries, but there is additional variation within each country. Most countries today have a majority culture that sets most of the norms and standards and holds most of the positions of political, economic, intellectual, and media power. In addition, there may be many minority cultures defined by ethnicity, religion, language, or other characteristics. Variations in human development also occur due to differences within countries in the settings and circumstances of individual lives. The settings and circumstances that contribute to variations in pathways of human development are called contexts. Contexts include environmental settings such as family, school, community, media, and culture, all of which will be discussed in this book. Three other important aspects of variation that will be highlighted are socioeconomic status, gender, and ethnicity. The term socioeconomic status (SES) is often used to refer to a person’s social class, which includes educational level, income level, and occupational status. For children and adolescents, because they have not yet reached the social-class level they will have as adults, SES is usually used in reference to their parents’ levels of education, income, and occupation. In most countries, SES is highly important in shaping human development. It influences everything from the risk of infant mortality to the quality and duration of children’s education to the kind of work adults do to the likelihood of obtaining health care in late adulthood. Differences in SES are especially sharp in developing countries. In a country such as India or Saudi Arabia

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

1.2

majority culture within a country, the cultural group that sets most of the norms and standards and holds most of the positions of political, economic, intellectual, and media power contexts settings and circumstances that contribute to variations in pathways of human development, including SES, gender, and ethnicity, as well as family, school, community, media, and culture socioeconomic status (SES) person’s social class, including educational level, income level, and occupational status

Within each country, SES is an influential context of human development. Here, a low-SES family in the United States.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse You are treating a child from a middleclass family from Mexico City. The parents speak English, and they are comfortable in the hospital setting in the U.S. Do you think this family has more in common with those from the urban setting where you work, or are they more like people from rural areas?

THINKING CULTURALLY What are some of the gender-specific expectations that exist in your culture (e.g., in the family, the school, the workplace, and the media)?

or Mexico, growing up as a member of the upper-class SES elite is very different from growing up as a member of the relatively poor majority, in terms of access to resources such as health care and education. However, even in developed countries there are important SES differences in access to resources throughout the course of human development. For example, in the United States infant mortality is higher among low-SES families than among high-SES families, in part because low-SES mothers are less likely to receive prenatal care (Daniels et al., 2006). Gender is a key factor in development throughout the life span, in every culture (Carroll & Wolpe, 2005; Chinas, 1992). The expectations cultures have for males and females are different from the time they are born (Hatfield & Rapson, 2005). However, the degree of the differences varies greatly among cultures. In most developed countries today, the differences are relatively blurred: Men and women hold many of the same jobs, wear many of the same clothes (e.g., jeans, T-shirts), and enjoy many of the same entertainments. If you have grown up in a developed country, you may be surprised to learn in the chapters to come how deep gender differences go in many other cultures. Nevertheless, gender-specific expectations exist in developed countries, too, as we will see. Finally, ethnicity is a crucial part of human development. Ethnicity may include a variety of components, such as cultural origin, cultural traditions, race, religion, and language. Minority ethnic groups may arise as a consequence of immigration. There are also countries in which ethnic groups have a long-standing presence and may even have arrived before the majority culture. For example, Aboriginal peoples lived in Australia for many generations before the first European settlers arrived. Many African countries were constructed by European colonial powers in the 19th century and consist of people of a variety of ethnicities, each of whom has lived in their region for many generations. Often, ethnic minorities within countries have distinct cultural patterns that are different from those of the majority culture. For example, in the Canadian majority culture, premarital sex is common, but in the large Asian Canadian minority group, female virginity at marriage is still highly valued (Sears, 2012). In many developed countries, most of the ethnic minority groups have values that are less individualistic and more collectivistic than in the majority culture (Greenfield, 2005).

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What factors have contributed to the massive growth of the human population in recent centuries? 2. Why are the populations of the United States and Canada expected to increase between now and 2050? 3. How do developed countries and developing countries differ with respect to population, income, and education?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

ethnicity group identity that may include components such as cultural origin, cultural traditions, race, religion, and language ontogenetic characteristic pattern of individual development in a species phylogenetic pertaining to the development of a species

10

4. How do SES, gender, and ethnicity contribute to variations in human development within countries?

Human Origins and the Birth of Culture Using a cultural approach to human development, we will see that humans are fabulously diverse in how they live. But how did this diversity arise? Humans are one species, so how did so many different ways of life develop from one biological origin? Before we turn our attention to the development of individuals—called ontogenetic development—it is important to understand our phylogenetic development, that is, the development of the

Section 1 Human Development Today and Its Origins human species. Let’s take a brief tour now of human evolutionary history, as a foundation for understanding the birth of culture and the historical context of individual human development today. For students who hold religious beliefs that may lead them to object to evolutionary theory, I understand that you may find this part of the book challenging, but it is nevertheless important to know about the theory of evolution and the evidence supporting it, as this is the view of human origins accepted by virtually all scientists.

11

Read the Document A More Extensive Account of Human Evolution at MyDevelopmentLab

Our Evolutionary Beginnings Explain the process of natural selection and trace the evolutionary origins of the human species. To understand human origins it is important to know a few basic principles of the theory of evolution, first proposed by Charles Darwin in 1859 in his book The Origin of Species. At the heart of the theory of evolution is the proposition that species change through the process of natural selection. In natural selection, the young of any species are born with variations on a wide range of characteristics. Some may be relatively large and others relatively small, some relatively fast and others relatively slow, and so on. Among the young, those who will be most likely to survive until they can reproduce will be the ones whose variations are best adapted to their environment. To use a famous example from evolutionary research, in a town in England the wings of a local butterfly were patterned in black and white. Over the years, as air pollution worsened in the town and a coat of black soot often covered everything, the butterflies became blacker because the ones with relatively more black on their wings were most likely to blend in with the sooty background, least likely to be seen by predators, and consequently more likely to survive to reproductive age. After the town implemented antipollution measures the air quality improved, and over the butterfly generations their wings gradually became less black and more white again, as the blacker butterflies stood out more and became increasingly vulnerable to predators. So, the process of natural selection took place as first the blacker butterflies, and then the whiter butterflies, were better adapted to the environment and therefore better able to survive until they could reproduce. Through natural selection, species change little by little with each generation, and over a long period of time they can develop into new species. It is sometimes hard for us to grasp how the evolution of new species can take place, in part because the amounts of time involved are often vast, far longer than we are familiar with from our own experience. It probably seems like a “long time ago” since you were 10 years old, and on the scale of a human lifetime, it is. But on the scale of evolutionary time, especially for mammals like us, changes often take place over thousands, tens of thousands, hundreds of thousands, even millions of years. Nevertheless, since Darwin first proposed the theory of evolution an enormous amount of evidence has accumulated that has verified the theory and supported the principle of natural selection as the main mechanism of evolutionary change (Dennett, 1996). When did human evolution begin? According to evolutionary biologists, humans, chimpanzees, and gorillas had a common primate ancestor until 6 to 8 million years ago (Shreeve, 2010). At about that time, this common ancestor split into three paths, leading to the development of humans as well as to chimpanzees and gorillas. The evolutionary line that eventually led to humans is known as the hominid line. The primate ancestor we share with chimpanzees and gorillas lived in Africa, and so did the early hominids, as chimpanzees and gorillas do today. The most important difference between early hominids and other primates was the development of bipedal locomotion, or walking on two legs. Evolutionary biologists have suggested that bipedal locomotion may have been a useful adaptation because it freed the hands for other things, such as carrying food, using a tool, or wielding a weapon against predators or prey (or other hominids) (Ember et al., 2011). The length of the early hominid’s arms indicates that it was adept at climbing and moving in trees.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

1.3

natural selection evolutionary process in which the offspring best adapted to their environment survive to produce offspring of their own hominid evolutionary line that led to modern humans

12

C h ap ter 1

A Cultural Approach to Human Development

Figure 1.2 s Changes in Brain Size in Early Humans

Early Hominid 440 cc

The mastery of fire by the early Homo species resulted in a sharp increase in brain size. hunter-gatherer social and economic system in which economic life is based on hunting (mostly by males) and gathering edible plants (mostly by females) Homo sapiens species of modern humans

Early Homo 1,000 cc

Homo sapiens 1,300+ cc

About three and half million years ago the hominid line split into two, with one line eventually dying out and the other a line of Homo species leading to modern humans (Shreeve, 2010). The most striking and important change during this period was the size of early Homo’s brain, which became over twice as large as the brain of early hominids (see Figure 1.2; brain sizes are shown in cubic centimeters [cc]). Simultaneously, the female Homo’s pelvis became wider to allow the birth of bigger-brained babies. Evolutionary biologists believe that the larger brains of early Homo babies meant that babies were born less mature than they were for earlier hominids, resulting in a longer period of infant dependency. This long period of infant dependency may have made it difficult for early Homo mothers to travel for long distances to accompany the males on hunting or scavenging expeditions (Wrangham, 2009). So, a hunter-gatherer way of life developed, in which females remained in a relatively stable home base, caring for children and perhaps gathering edible plants in the local area, while males went out to hunt or scavenge. As the Homo species continued to evolve, it developed the ability to make tools and control fire. The earliest tools were apparently made by striking one stone against another to create a sharp edge. The tools may have been used for purposes such as slicing up animal meat and whittling wood into sharp sticks. There is evidence that early Homo’s diet included animals such as antelopes, wild pigs, giraffes, and even elephants. Controlling fire enabled our early ancestors to cook food, and because cooked food is used much more efficiently by the body than raw food, this led to another burst in brain size (Wrangham, 2009). Another evolutionary change during this period was that the size of the teeth and jaws diminished, because cooked food was easier to eat than raw food. By 200,000 years ago the early hominid species had evolved into our species, Homo sapiens (Shreve, 2011). Homo sapiens was different from earlier Homo species, with thinner and lighter bones—perhaps evolved for better running and hunting—smaller teeth and jaws, and most importantly, a brain about 30% larger than the brain of the Homo species that had just preceded us (refer again to Figure 1.2).

The Origin of Cultures and Civilizations

1.4

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Upper Paleolithic period period of human history from 40,000 to 10,000 years ago, when distinct human cultures first developed Neolithic period era of human history from 10,000 to 5,000 years ago, when animals and plants were first domesticated civilization form of human social life, beginning about 5,000 years ago, that includes cities, writing, occupational specialization, and states

Summarize the evidence that human cultures first developed during the Upper Paleolithic period, and identify the features of the Neolithic period and early civilizations. Physically, Homo sapiens has changed little from 200,000 years ago to the present. However, a dramatic change in the development of the human species took place during the Upper Paleolithic period from 40,000 to about 10,000 years ago (Ember et al., 2011; Johnson, 2005). For the first time, art appeared: musical instruments; paintings on cave walls (see the Historical Focus: The Sorcerer of Trois Frères feature on page 14); small ivory beads attached to clothes; decorative objects made from bone, antler, or shell; and human and animal figures carved from ivory or sculpted from clay. Several other important changes mark the Upper Paleolithic, in addition to the sudden burst of artistic production (see Figure 1.3):

Section 1 Human Development Today and Its Origins s ( UMANS BEGAN TO BURY THEIR DEAD SOMETIMES INCLUDING ART objects in the graves.

s 4RADETOOKPLACEBETWEENHUMANGROUPS s 4 HEREWASARAPIDACCELERATIONINTHEDEVELOPMENTOFTOOLS INcluding the bow and arrow, a spear thrower that could launch a spear at an animal (or perhaps at human enemies), and the harpoon.

@LHYZ(NV `LHYZHNV¶WYLZLU[! *P]PSPaH[PVUZ

s & ORTHElRSTTIMECULTURALDIFFERENCESDEVELOPEDBETWEENHUMAN groups, as reflected in their art and tools.

13

*P]PSPaH[PVUKL]LSVWZPU:V\[O(TLYPJH 4LKP[LYYHULHUJP]PSPaH[PVUZ -PYZ[^YP[PUN,N`W[HUK:\TLY *P]PSPaH[PVUKL]LSVWZPUZV\[OLYU(MYPJH *P]PSPaH[PVUKL]LSVWZPU*OPUH *OPJRLUZKVTLZ[PJH[LK *P]PSPaH[PVUKL]LSVWZPU0UKPH -PYZ[JP]PSPaH[PVUZPU,N`W[HUK:\TLY /VYZLZKVTLZ[PJH[LK -PYZ[KVTLZ[PJH[LKWSHU[Z^OLH[VH[ZSLU[PSZ *H[[SLHUKWPNZKVTLZ[PJH[LK .VH[ZHUKZOLLWKVTLZ[PJH[LK

s 4 HE lRST BOATS WERE INVENTED ALLOWING HUMANS TO REACH AND populate Australia and New Guinea. ¶`LHYZHNV! ;OL5LVSP[OPJWLYPVK

/\THUZILNPU[VTPNYH[L[V[OL(TLYPJHZ

¶`LHYZHNV! ;OLLLRZ

4VU[OZ

¶4VU[OZ

Section 3 Caring for the Neonate TABLE 3.3 PURPLE Crying in the Early Months

117

swaddling practice of infant care that involves wrapping an infant tightly in cloths or blankets

A crying baby is difficult for others to bear, especially when the crying is frequent and does not appear to take place for an evident reason. Here is a way to remind parents and others of the normal features of crying in the early months of life.

P

Peak pattern

Crying peaks around age 2 months and then declines

U

Unpredictable

Crying in the early months often comes and goes unpredictably, for no apparent reason

R

Resistant to soothing

Crying may continue despite parents’ best soothing efforts

P

Pain-like face

Crying babies may look like they are in pain even though they are not

L

Long lasting

Babies cry for longer in the early months, sometimes 30–40 minutes or more

E

Evening crying

Babies usually cry most in the afternoon and evening

Source: Barr, 2009 [see http://www.purplecrying.info/sections/index.php?sct=1&]

SOOTHING AND RESPONDING TO CRIES Although crying frequency is consistent across cultures, there is wide variation in the duration and intensity of crying in infancy. Crying episodes are longer and more intense in cultures where infants are left on their own a lot and have relatively little time when they are being carried around. Four out of 5 American infants have daily crying episodes in the early months of life of at least 15 minutes that do not have any apparent cause (Eisenberg et al., 2011). In contrast, infants in cultures where babies are held or carried around much of the day rarely have prolonged episodes of crying. For example, in a study comparing infants in South Korea and the United States, the American infants cried for much longer periods, and this appeared to be explained by differences in parenting (Small, 1998). Korean infants spent much less of their time alone than American infants did, Korean mothers carried their infants twice as long per day as the American mothers did, and Korean mothers responded immediately to their infants’ cries whereas American mothers often let the infant cry it out. The relation between parenting and infant crying has also been demonstrated experimentally. In one study, researchers divided American mothers and their newborns into two equal groups (Hunziker & Barr, 1986). The mothers in Group A were asked to carry their babies for at least 3 hours a day, and mothers in Group B were not given any special instructions. Infants’ mothers in both groups kept diaries of when and how long their babies cried. When the infants were 8 weeks old, the frequency of crying was the same in both groups, but the duration of crying was only about half as long in Group A, the babies who were held more often, as it was in Group B. In traditional cultures babies are typically held for most of the day, either by their mothers or by another adult woman or an older sister. When neonates in traditional cultures cry, two common responses are breast-feeding and swaddling (DeLoache & Gottlieb, 2000). Crying often signals hunger, so offering the breast soothes the baby, but even if babies are not hungry they can find consolation in suckling, in the same way that babies in developed countries are soothed by a pacifier. In swaddling, babies are wrapped tightly in cloths so that their arms and legs cannot move. Often the baby is laid on a cradle board and the cloths are wrapped around the board as well as around the baby. Swaddling is an ancient practice, with evidence of it going back 6,000 years (DeMeo, 2006). Swaddling has long been widely used in many cultures, from China to Turkey to South America, in the belief that neonates find it soothing and that it helps them sleep and ensures that their limbs grow properly (van

THINKING CULTURALLY How does the framework of individualism and collectivism from Chapter 1 help to explain the Korean practice of carrying their infants much of the time and responding immediately to their cries and the American practice of leaving infants on their own much of the time and sometimes letting them “cry it out”?

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Day Care Provider You have children of different ages in your day care. Would it be all right for the 5-year-olds to help you care for the newborns?

Crying spells are longer and more intense in cultures where neonates are left alone for a substantial part of the day.

118

C h ap ter 3

Birth and the Newborn Child Sleuwen et al., 2007). It fell out of favor in Western cultures in the 17th century, when it became regarded as cruel and unnatural. However, swaddling has recently become more common in the West as studies have indicated that it reduces crying and does not inhibit motor development (Thach, 2009). What else can parents and other caregivers do to soothe a crying neonate? First, of course, any apparent needs should be addressed, in case the baby is hungry, cold, tired, uncomfortable, injured, or needs a diaper change. For crying that has no apparent source, parents have devised a wide range of methods, such as (Eisenberg et al., 2011): s ,IFTINGBABYUPANDHOLDINGTOTHESHOULDER s 3OOTHING REPETITIVE MOVEMENTS SUCH AS ROCKING GENTLY BACK AND forth or riding in a car or carriage

Swaddling babies to reduce crying spells is a long tradition in many cultures. Here, a Navajo baby in Arizona is swaddled to a traditional backboard.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Researcher Considering that colic places neonates at risk for parental maltreatment, how would you design a program to prevent such maltreatment?

colic infant crying pattern in which the crying goes on for more than 3 hours a day over more than 3 days at a time for more than 3 weeks

s 3OOTHING SOUNDS SUCH AS SINGING A FAN OR VACUUM CLEANER OR recordings of nature sounds like waves breaking on a beach s !WARM WATERBATH s !PACIlERORAlNGERTOSUCKON s $ISTRACTION WITHSOMENEWSIGHTORSOUND The common theme of these methods appears to be offering a new source of sensory stimulation, especially something gently repetitive. When my twins were neonates we usually tried to soothe them by holding them to the shoulder or singing to them, but if those methods did not work their crying was almost always soothed by the gentle movements of THEBATTERY OPERATEDINFANTSEATWECALLEDTHEIRhWIGGLYCHAIRv0ARENTSWITHACRYINGNEOnate will often go to great lengths to make the crying stop, so there are many such items on the market today that promise to help parents achieve this goal. There is also the option of not responding to crying, until the infant stops. For decades, developmental psychologists have debated whether ignoring crying is a good or bad idea. Some argue that ignoring it is a good idea (unless of course the infant has a clear need for food or other care), because parents who respond will reinforce the infant’s crying and thus make crying more likely the next time the infant wants attention (Crncek et al., 2010; Gewirtz, 1977; van Ijzendoorn & Hubbard, 2000). Others argue that ignoring it is a bad idea, because infants whose cries are ignored will cry even more in order to get the attention they need (Bell & Ainsworth, 1972; Lohaus et al., 2004). Different studies have reported different findings, so all that can be concluded at this point is that responses to crying do not appear to be strongly related to infants’ development (Alvarez, 2004; Hiscock & Jordan, ,EWIS2AMSAY   About 1 in 10 Western babies have crying patterns of extreme duration, a condition known as colic. Babies are considered to be colicky if they fit the “rule of threes” (Barr, 2009): the crying goes on for more than 3 hours a day over more than 3 days at a time for more than 3 weeks. Colic usually begins in the second or third week of life and reaches its peak at 6 weeks, thereafter declining until it disappears at about 3 months of age (Barr & 'UNNAR 3T*AMES 2OBERTSETAL   The causes of colic are unknown, but it exists primarily in Western cultures, where INFANTSRECEIVERELATIVELYLITTLECARRYINGTIME2ICHMANETAL  2EMEDIESFORCOLICARE also unknown. Babies with colic are inconsolable. None of the soothing methods described above work with them. Fortunately, there appear to be no long-term effects of colic, in babies’ physical, emotional, or social development (Barr, 2009; Eisenberg et al., 1996). However, this may be of little comfort to parents who must endure the persistent crying of an inconsolable infant for many weeks. Colic is a risk factor for parents’ maltreatment of their babies (Zeskind & Lester, 2001), so it is important for parents to seek help and support if they feel themselves reaching the breaking point.

Section 3 Caring for the Neonate

119

Bonding: Myth and Truth Describe the extent to which human mothers “bond” with their neonates and the extent to which this claim has been exaggerated.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

3.15

In some species, especially among birds such as geese, the first minutes after birth are a critical period for relations between mother and offspring. Geese form an instant and enduring bond to the first moving object they see, a phenomenon known as imprinting. Usually this first object is their mother, of course, and imprinting quickly to her promotes their survival because they will follow her everywhere she goes when they begin waddling around soon after birth. Konrad Lorenz (1957), who first identified the imprinting process, showed that geese would imprint to any moving object they saw soon after birth (including him—see the photo on this page). Some physicians, learning of this research, applied it to humans and asserted that in humans, too, the first few minutes and hours after birth are critical to mother–infant bonding (Klaus & Kennell, 1976). Without contact with the mother shortly after birth, these physicians claimed, the baby’s future development is jeopardized. However, when systematic research was done to test this hypothesis, it turned out not to be true (Lamb,  2EDSHAW  7EINBERG   (UMANS ARE NOT BIRDS AND THEY ARE NOT AT RISK for later emotional and social problems if they do not bond with a caregiver in the first minutes, hours, or days after birth. Nevertheless, this is a rare example of a false idea having good effects. As described earlier in the chapter, in developing countries the birth process had become overly medical by the 1950s and 1960s. Although bonding claims were false, the possibility that they were true led hospitals all over the world to reexamine their policies of sedating the mother and separating mother and child immediately after birth (Lamb, 1994). Subsequently, during the 1970s and after, hospital policies changed so that mother, child, and even father could all be in close contact after the birth. This may not be necessary for the baby’s successful later development, but there is no reason not to allow it, and it does alleviate parents’ anxieties and promotes feelings of warmth and confidence in caring for their newborn child (Bergstrom et al., 2009).

Goslings will imprint to the first moving object they see, which is usually—but not always—the mother goose. Here, the biologist Konrad Lorenz leads three goslings on a swim.

imprinting instant and enduring bond to the first moving object seen after birth; common in birds bonding concept that in humans the first few minutes and hours after birth are critical to mother–infant relationships

120

C h ap ter 3

Birth and the Newborn Child

Postpartum Depression

3.16

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Across countries, about 10% of new mothers experience postpartum depression.

postpartum depression in parents with a new baby, feelings of sadness and anxiety so intense as to interfere with the ability to carry out simple daily tasks

Describe the reasons for postpartum depression and its consequences for children. Although the birth of a child is generally greeted with joy, some parents experience a difficult time emotionally in the early months of their baby’s life. In one study of new mothers in 11 countries, postpartum depression was found at similar rates in all of them, about 10% (Oates et al., 2004). In Western countries this condition was often seen as an illness requiring possible intervention of health professionals, whereas in non-Western countries social support from family members was relied upon for making it through. Studies in the United States and the United Kingdom report that about 4% of fathers also experience postpartum depression in the months following the birth of their child (Dennis, 2004; 2AMCHANDANIETAL   Low emotional states in mothers following birth may be due to rapid hormonal changes, as the high concentrations of estrogen and progesterone in the mother’s body return to normal levels. However, postpartum depression is deeper and more enduring. Feelings of sadness and anxiety become so intense that they interfere with the ability to carry out simple daily tasks. Other symptoms include extreme changes in appetite and DIFlCULTYSLEEPING0OSTPARTUMDEPRESSIONOFTENPEAKSABOUTFOURWEEKSAFTERCHILDBIRTHˆ long after the mother’s hormones would have returned to normal levels—and in 25–50% of mothers who experience postpartum depression it lasts 6 months or longer (Beck, 2002; Clay & Seehusen, 2004). Why do some women and not others develop postpartum depression? Women are more at risk for postpartum depression if they have had previous episodes of major depression or if they have close family members who have experienced major depression (Bloch et al., 2006). This suggests that for postpartum depression, as for other forms of depression, some people may have a genetic vulnerability to becoming depressed when they experience intense life stresses. Women are also more likely to experience postpartum depression if they lack social support from a husband or partner (Iles et al., 2011). Thus even if a mother has a genetic vulnerability to depression, it is unlikely to be expressed unless she also experiences a social and cultural context in which social support is lacking. For fathers, postpartum depression may result from the challenges of reconciling their personal and work-related needs with the demands of being a father (Genesoni & Tallandini, 2009; 2AMCHANANDIETAL   Mothers’ and fathers’ postpartum depression is related to children’s developmental problems in infancy and beyond. Numerous studies of mothers with postpartum depression have found that their infants are more likely than other infants to be irritable, to have problems eating and sleeping, and to have difficulty forming attachments (Herrera et al., 2004; Martins & Griffin, 2000). In later development, the children are at risk for being withdrawn or displaying antisocial behavior (Nylen et al., 2006). Children of fathers with postpartum depression have been found to have similar risks for their development (Kane & 'ARBER 2AMCHANANDIETAL   Of course, all of these studies are subject to the research design problem we discussed in Chapter 2, of passive and evocative genotype m environment effects. That is, the children in these studies received not only their environment from their parents but also their genes, and it is difficult to tell whether the relation between their problems and their parents’ depression is due to genetics or environment (the problem of passive genotype m environment effects). Also, the studies usually assume that the mother’s depression affected the child, but it could also be that the mothers became depressed in part because their infant was especially irritable and difficult (evocative genotype m environment effects). However, observational studies of mothers with postpartum depression have found that they talk to and look at their infant less than other mothers, ANDTHATTHEYALSOTOUCHTHEMLESSANDSMILELESSOFTENATTHEM2IGHETTI 6ELTEMAETAL

Section 3 Caring for the Neonate 2002). This suggests that the behavior of depressed mothers is different in ways that may affect infants, even if passive and evocative genotype m environment effects are also involved.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. Describe the “crying curve.” When does crying reach its peak in neonates? 2. What is the relation, if any, between parenting practices and infant crying? 3. How have claims that humans bond with their neonates influenced hospital policies in the United States? 4. What are the consequences of postpartum depression for children? Why do genotype m environment effects make it difficult to tell?

Section 3 VIDEO GUIDE Breastfeeding Practices Across Cultures (Length: 6:19) In this video mothers, and expectant mothers, from various countries are interviewed about their views on breastfeeding.

1. Were you surprised to see that many of the women interviewed have similar reasons for breastfeeding (regardless of their culture)? What are some of the benefits of breastfeeding that they mentioned? 2. Although she was not asked the question about how she would comfort her child, how do you think the expectant mother from the U.S. would answer? Do you think that she would answer in a way similar to the mothers from the other countries? Would the American mother have additional options that the other mothers may not? 3. What are your thoughts on the lengths of time that the mothers planned to breastfeed and the reasons that they had for the lengths?

Watch the Video Breastfeeding Practices Across Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab

121

Summing Up Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab Listen at MyDevelopmentLab

Listen to an audio file of your chapter at MyDevelopmentLab

SECTION 1 BIRTH AND ITS CULTURAL CONTEXT 3.1 Describe the three stages of the birth process and methods for easing its discomfort. The three stages of the birth process are labor, delivery, and expelling of the placenta and umbilical cord. During labor, the contractions of the muscles in the uterus cause the mother’s cervix to dilate in preparation for the baby’s exit. By the end of labor, the cervix has opened to about 10 centimeters. During delivery, the woman pushes the fetus through the cervix and out of the uterus. In the final stage of the birth process, contractions continue as the placenta and umbilical cord are expelled. Both emotional support and physical methods such as breathing techniques and massage may help ease the discomfort of labor.

3.2 Name two common types of birth complications and explain how they can be overcome by cesarean delivery. Two common birth complications are failure to progress, which occurs when the birth process is taking longer than normal, and the breech presentation of the fetus, which means the fetus is turned around so that the feet or buttocks are positioned to come first out of the birth canal. Both complications can be overcome through the use of a c-section, which today is generally safe for mothers and infants.

3.3 Compare and contrast cultural variations in birth beliefs. Because birth is often dangerous, many traditional cultures–such as the Arapesh of New Guinea and the traditional Vietnamese—have developed beliefs that childbirth puts a woman in a state of being spiritually unclean. The placenta is often disposed of with care in traditional cultures because of beliefs that it is potentially dangerous or even semihuman.

3.4 Explain the role of the midwife and compare and contrast cultural practices and medical methods for easing the birth process. In most cultures, women giving birth are attended by female relatives and an older woman (“midwife” or similar title) who has experience assisting in the birth process. The midwife eases birth pain through massage techniques, reassurance, and herbal medicines. In developed countries, an anesthetic drug called an epidural is often injected into a woman’s spinal fluid to help manage the pain.

3.5 Summarize the history of birth in the West from the 15th century to today. There have been attempts over the past several centuries to make birth safer for baby and mother alike. Some of those attempts were disastrous, such as the deadly infections spread to mothers unwittingly by 19th-century doctors. In the early 20th century the attempts were overzealous and overly medical, as birth was taken over by doctors and hospitals, with the maternal experience disregarded. In the past 50 years most of the West has moved toward a more reasonable middle ground, seeking to minimize medical intervention but making it available when necessary.

3.6 Describe the differences in maternal and neonatal mortality both within and between developed countries and developing countries. In recent decades birth has become routinely safe and humane in developed countries, although there is considerable variation based on SES and ethnicity. Childbirth remains highly dangerous in developing countries where little medical intervention is available, although mortality rates are decreasing due to recent improvements in nutrition and access to health care.

KEY TERMS oxytocin p. 85

episiotomy p. 86

epidural p. 92

obstetrics p. 94

labor p. 86

breech presentation p. 87

placebo effect p. 93

natural childbirth p. 96

delivery p. 86

cesarean delivery (c-section) p. 87

forceps p. 94

electronic fetal monitoring (EFM) p. 96

SECTION 2 THE NEONATE 3.7 Identify the features of the two major scales most often used to assess neonatal health. Two of the most widely used methods of assessing neonatal health are the Apgar scale and the Brazelton

122

Neonatal Behavioral Assessment Scale (NBAS). The Apgar scale, which is administered immediately after birth, assesses infants on 5 subtests with a total rating of 1–10. The NBAS, which is administered any time from 1 day to 2 months after birth, relies on a 27-item scale

Chapt er 3 and assigns infants an overall rating of “worrisome,” “normal,” or “superior.”

3.8 Identify the neonatal classifications for low birth weight and describe the consequences and major treatments. Low-birth-weight neonates weigh less than 5.5 pounds and very low-birth-weight neonates weigh less than 3.3 pounds; extremely low-birth-weight babies weight less than 2.2 pounds. Low birth weight is related to a variety of physical, cognitive, and behavioral problems, not just in infancy but throughout life. Close physical contact and infant massage can help ameliorate the problems.

3.9 Describe neonates’ patterns of waking and sleeping, including how and why these patterns differ across cultures. Neonates sleep an average of 16 to 17 hours a day (in segments of a few hours each), about 50% of it in REM sleep. By 4 months old the typical infant sleeps for 14 of every 24 hours, including about 6 hours straight at night, and the proportion of REM sleep declines to 40%. These patterns may vary across cultures due to

SUMMARY

123

differences in parenting practices such as how much time mothers spend holding their babies.

3.10 Describe the neonatal reflexes, including those that have a functional purpose and those that do not. There are 27 reflexes present at birth or shortly after, including some related to early survival (such as sucking and rooting) and others that have no apparent function (such as the Babkin and Babinski reflexes).

3.11 Describe the neonate’s sensory abilities with respect to touch, taste and smell, hearing, and sight. Touch and taste develop prenatally to a large extent, and neonate’s abilities are similar to adults’. Neonates also quickly begin to discriminate smells after birth, showing a preference for the smell of their mother’s breast. Hearing is also quite mature at birth, although neonates hear highpitched sounds better than other sounds and their ability to localize sound does not mature until about one year old. Sight is the least developed of the senses at birth, due to the physiological immaturity of the visual system at birth, but it reaches maturity by the end of the first year.

KEY TERMS Brazelton Neonatal Behavioral Assessment Scale (NBAS) p. 101

very low birth weight p. 102

reflex p. 106

neonate p. 99

extremely low birth weight p. 102

rooting reflex p. 106

neonatal jaundice p. 99

low birth weight p. 101

surfactant p. 103

Moro reflex p. 106

anoxia p. 100

preterm p. 101

kangaroo care p. 103

sound localization p. 109

Apgar scale p. 100

small for date p. 101

rapid eye movement (REM) sleep p. 105

fontanels p. 99

SECTION 3 CARING FOR THE NEONATE 3.12 Describe the cultural customs surrounding breast feeding across cultures and history. In the human past, evidence indicates that in most cultures children were fed breast milk as their primary or sole food for 2 to 3 years. To ease the burden of frequent feedings, the custom of wet nursing (hiring a lactating woman other than the mother to feed the infant) is a widespread custom as old as recorded human history.

3.13 Identify the advantages conferred by breast feeding and where those advantages are largest. Breast feeding is beneficial to infants in many ways, including offering protection from disease in infancy and better health in childhood and adulthood, healthy cognitive development, and reduced obesity. For mothers, breast-feeding helps their bodies return to normal after pregnancy and serves as a natural contraceptive. The advantages are especially pronounced in developing countries. Nevertheless, worldwide only about half of all infants are breast-fed even for a short time.

3.14 Describe neonates’ types of crying and how crying patterns and soothing methods vary across cultures. Three distinct kinds of crying signals have been identified: fussing, anger, and pain. Crying frequency rises steadily beginning at 3 weeks of age and reaches

a peak by the end of the second month, then declines. This pattern is similar across cultures, but duration and intensity of crying are lower in cultures where babies are held or carried throughout much of the day and night.

3.15 Describe the extent to which human mothers “bond” with their neonates and the extent to which this claim has been exaggerated. Some physicians have claimed on the basis of animal studies that the first few minutes and hours after birth are critical to mother–infant “bonding.” This has now been shown to be false, but the claims had the beneficial effect of changing hospital policies to allow more contact between mothers, fathers, and neonates.

3.16 Describe the reasons for postpartum depression and its consequences for children. Many mothers experience mood fluctuations in the days following birth as their hormones return to normal levels, but some mothers experience an extended period of postpartum depression, as do some fathers. The basis of postpartum depression appears to be a combination of genetic vulnerability to depression and a social and cultural context that does not provide enough social support.

124

C h ap ter 3

Birth S U Mand M A RY the Newborn Child

KEY TERMS mammary glands p. 111

colostrum p. 113

swaddling p. 117

bonding p. 119

let-down reflex p. 111

meta-analysis p. 114

colic p. 118

postpartum depression p. 120

wet nursing p. 111

confounded p. 114

imprinting p. 119

Practice Test Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab 1. Juanita’s cervix is 10 centimeters dilated so she a. is just beginning the labor stage. b. requires an episiotomy. c. has completed labor and is ready to deliver the baby. d. requires a c-section. 2. C-sections a. are performed when the baby is in the breech position and attempts to turn the baby into a head first position have not been successful. b. require the same recovery time as a vaginal birth if they are performed correctly. c. have only been proven safe in the case where there is a failure to progress. d. are performed at equally small rates around the world because they are seen as a last resort. 3. In traditional cultures, birth is only allowed to take place in certain settings. The LEAST LIKELY explanation is a. so others will not be contaminated. b. to feel a sense of control over an often perilous situation. c. to find a place where medical help is available if complications arise. d. so that the mother or her infant will not be endangered. 4. Surita is a midwife in a traditional culture. She is most likely to a. have spent time as an apprentice to a more experienced midwife. b. be childless so she is able to devote more time to this work. c. be a young woman because she will be able to practice midwifery for longer than her older counterparts. d. exclude other relatives from being present to reduce possible contamination. 5. Which of the following is true about birthing practices? a. 2ECENTLY MIDWIFERYHASSEENAREVIVAL ANDABOUTOF births in the United States are assisted by midwives. b. In the early 1900s, the intervention of doctors often made the birth process less dangerous because they now had better expertise and medical equipment. c. In the 1960s, doctors began administering drugs such as ether and chloroform, which offered pain relief without any side effects. d. Twilight Sleep was a drug used in the early 20th century that promoted dilation of the cervix and resulted in mothers forgetting the events of birth.

6. In developing countries a. most pregnant women now have access to modern medical technologies. b. giving birth is relatively free of risks because of modernization and globalization. c. maternal mortality has decreased over the past 30 years. d. rates of infant mortality are lower than in developed countries because of more holistic and natural approaches to childbirth. 7. The five characteristics that are evaluated in the Apgar scale are a. the Babinski, Moro, stepping, swimming, and grasping reflexes. b. color, heart rate, reflex irritability, muscle tone, and breathing. c. reaction to cuddling, startling, intelligence, vocal response, and visual response. d. sucking reflex, responses to social stimulation, and disease symptoms. 8. 0RETERMBABIESARECONSIDEREDATRISKBECAUSE a. their immune systems are immature. b. they have too much surfactant in their lungs. c. their bodies generate too much heat. d. their gestational age is 40 weeks and that is still too early to perform basic functions such as sucking. 9. Compared to adults, neonates a. SPENDALOWERPROPORTIONOFTHEIRSLEEPIN2%- b. ENTER2%-SOONERAFTERFALLINGASLEEP c. spend less time sleeping. d. do not experience eye movements under the eyelids or BRAIN WAVECHANGESDURING2%-SLEEP 10. Which of the following reflexes has no apparent survival value? a. the rooting reflex b. the Moro reflex c. the Babinski reflex d. the grasping reflex 11. The earliest sense to develop is a. taste. b. touch. c. vision. d. hearing.

Chapt er 3 12. Breast feeding a. is more common among women from low socioeconomic status groups. b. increased in popularity as formulas came on to the market because the formulas were very expensive and women worried about product safety. c. is something both mother and baby are biologically prepared to do. d. rates have stayed about the same in the United States since the 1940s. 13. Which of the following statements about breastfeeding is most accurate? a. Babies in developing countries are more at risk for health problems if their mothers do not breast-feed them than are babies in developed countries. b. Breast feeding promotes better health in childhood, but does not have any influence on long-term health. c. Breast-fed babies are more likely than bottle-fed babies to become obese in childhood because they are used to eating on demand. d. The colostrum that mothers produce in the first weeks after birth can be dangerous to babies so doctors advise using formula until the mother begins producing milk.

SUMMARY

125

14. American infants a. are less likely to experience colic than are babies in non-Western cultures. b. typically experience colic until they are about a year of age. c. show the same frequency, intensity, and duration of crying as babies from all over the world. d. have been found to cry more than babies from cultures where they are held or carried for much of the day. 15. Which of the following statements about bonding is most accurate? a. There is a critical period for mother–child relations in all species. b. Imprinting is another name for the stepping reflex. c. In humans, if there is no contact with the mother shortly after birth, the baby’s future development is at risk. d. Konrad Lorenz showed that following the first moving object after birth has survival value. 16. 0OSTPARTUMDEPRESSION a. is less common among women who have had previous episodes of major depression because they tend to seek preventive treatment. b. is experienced by men as well as by women. c. has a genetic component and, therefore, has not been correlated with levels of social support. d. has been linked with developmental outcomes for babies, but only among male babies.

4 126

Infancy

Section 1 PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT Growth and Change in Infancy Changes in Height and Weight Teeth and Teething Brain Development Sleep Changes

Infant Health Nutritional Needs Infant Mortality

Baby on the Move: Motor and Sensory Development Motor Development Sensory Development

Section 2 COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT Piaget’s Theory of Cognitive Development What Drives Cognitive Development? The Sensorimotor Stage Evaluating Piaget’s Sensorimotor Theory

Information Processing in Infancy Attention Memory

Assessing Infant Development Approaches to Assessing Development Can Media Enhance Cognitive Development? The Myth of “Baby Einstein”

The Beginnings of Language First Sounds and Words Infant-Directed (ID) Speech

Section 3 EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT Temperament Conceptualizing Temperament: Three Approaches Goodness-of-Fit

Infants’ Emotions Primary Emotions Infants’ Emotional Perceptions

The Social World of the Infant Cultural Themes of Infant Social Life The Foundation of Social Development: Two Theories

Summing Up

127

DAWN

BREAKS, AND LITTLE MAKORI, AGE 6 MONTHS, Makori feeds frequently from his mother’s breast and watches with WAKES UP IN THE ARMS OF HIS MOTHER. He has been interest as his older siblings play or go about their chores. sleeping next to her all night, as he does every night. Several times he It is rare that anyone speaks directly to Makori—the Gusii believe woke up hungry and nuzzled around until he found her breast and suckthere is no sense in talking to infants, who understand little and led for awhile. Now he finds himself hungry again, and he whimpers softly. cannot reply—but he is always in the arms or on the lap of one of the Drowsily, his mother draws him comfortably next to her and lets him feed. women or his older siblings. In the course of the day, he never touches Elsewhere in the household, others are stirring. Evan, age 10, the ground. The Gusii believe that infants are especially vulnerable to Makori’s oldest brother, is starting a cooking fire in the corner of the hut. disease and to witchcraft, and therefore require constant care and Sister Marisera, age 7, has gone outside with Getonto, age 4, to fetch protection in order to survive their first year of life. water from the well. Their father is not present. Like many men of this Evening falls, and dinner is prepared, enjoyed, and cleaned up afterGusii (goo-SEE) village, he has migrated to a larger city in Kenya to look ward. As night comes on, Makori ends his day just as he began it, sleeping for work, and comes home only rarely. securely against the warm skin of his mother. Makori’s mother now rises and, with Does Makori’s daily life sound quite a bit He is always in the arms Makori on her hip, goes about preparing breakdifferent than the lives of infants you have obfast. When Marisera returns with the water, or on the lap of one of the served? It probably does, given that infants in she takes over care of Makori so the mother developed countries have a daily pattern that women or his older siblings. differs from Makori’s in many ways. Yet Makocan make a simple breakfast of warm cereal. Marisera will be responsible for caring for her ri’s life is far more typical of the human experiyounger siblings for most of the day. ence in infancy, both historically and today, in most parts of the world. After breakfast, their mother departs for the fields, where she will In a sense, little Makori’s daily life is similar to the life of infants work all morning tending the family’s crops. Evan leaves for school, everywhere. In all cultures, infants have limited mobility and do not and Marisera is left with the younger boys. The fields are only a short yet use language (the word infant means literally “without speech”), walk away, and Marisera will come by with the younger children at although they have a variety of ways of communicating. In all cultures, least once an hour so that Makori can feed on his mother’s breast milk. infants cannot do much for themselves and rely heavily on others for Otherwise, Makori spends most of his morning bound to his siscare and protection. However, even in infancy cultural variations are ter’s back with a tightly wound cloth while Marisera goes about her vast. In some cultures infants are carried around for most of the day morning tasks such as cleaning up after breakfast and feeding the and breast-feed often, as in Makori’s case, whereas in others, they lay family’s three goats. Sometimes Makori dozes off for awhile, nuzzled by themselves for a substantial proportion of the day—and night. In against his sister’s warm back. this chapter we will explore both cultural similarities and variations in At lunch time Makori’s mother comes back from the fields and his infants’ development. Beginning in this chapter and throughout the brother from school, and the family has their meal together. Shortly rest of the book (until the final chapter), the chapters will be divided after lunch Makori’s aunt and grandmother come to visit. All afternoon into three major sections: physical development, cognitive developthe women talk together as they prepare food for the evening meal. ment, and emotional and social development.

128





SECTION 1

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 4.1 Explain the gains in height and weight that typically take place in the first year, and the two basic principles of physical growth. 4.2 Explain how and when teething occurs, and how to soothe it. 4.3 Identify the different parts of the brain and describe how the brain changes in the first few years of life. 4.4 Describe how infant sleep changes in the course of the first year and evaluate the risk factors for SIDS, including the research evidence regarding cosleeping. 4.5 Describe how infants’ nutritional needs change during the first year of life and identify the reasons and consequences for malnutrition in infancy. 4.6 List the major causes and preventive methods of infant mortality and describe some cultural approaches to protecting infants. 4.7 Describe the major changes during infancy in gross and fine motor development. 4.8 Describe when and how infants develop depth perception and intermodal perception.

Growth and Change in Infancy We begin this section by examining physical growth (height and weight), the emergence of the first teeth, and infant brain development. Then we’ll examine changes in sleeping patterns, the dangers of SIDS, and cultural variations in where infants sleep (and with whom).

cephalocaudal principle principle of biological development that growth tends to begin at the top, with the head, and then proceeds downward to the rest of the body

Changes in Height and Weight Explain the gains in height and weight that typically take place in the first year, and the two basic principles of physical growth. Babies grow at a faster rate in their first year than at any later time of life (Adolph & Berger, 2005). Birth weight doubles by the time the infant is 5 months old, and triples by the end of the first year, to about 10 kilos (22 lb) on average. If this rate of growth continued for the next 3 years, the average 4-year old would weigh 600 pounds! But the rate of weight gain decreases steeply after the first year. Babies especially accumulate fat in the early months, which helps them maintain a constant body temperature. At 6 months, a well-nourished baby looks on the plump side, but by 1 year children lose much of their “baby fat,” and the trend toward a lower ratio of fat to body weight continues until puberty (Fomon & Nelson, 2002). Height also increases dramatically in the first year, from about 50 centimeters (20 in.) to about 75 centimeters (30 in.), at the rate of about 2 cm per month. Unlike weight, growth in height in the first year is uneven, occurring in spurts rather than steadily. Studies that have monitored height closely have found that infants may grow very little for several days or even weeks, then spurt a half inch in just a day or two (Lampl et al., 2001). Girls tend to be shorter and lighter than boys, at birth and throughout childhood, until puberty when they briefly surpass boys in height (Geary, 2010). Another way growth is uneven in infancy is that it tends to begin at the top, with the head, and then proceed downward to the rest of the body (Adolph & Berger, 2005). This is called the cephalocaudal principle (cephalocaudal is Latin for “head to tail”). So, for example, the head is one-quarter of the neonate’s body length, but only one-eighth of an

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.1

Most babies are plump and have large heads in proportion to their bodies.

129

130

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

Figure 4.1 s The Cephalocaudal Principle of Body Growth Growth begins with the head and then continues downward to the rest of the body.

1/4

1/5

1/6

1/7

1/8

Newborn

2 Years

6 Years

12 Years

25 Years

Age

adult’s (see Figure 4.1). In addition, growth proceeds from the middle of the body outward, which is the proximodistal principle (proximodistal is Latin for “near to far”). So, for example, the trunk and arms grow faster than the hands and fingers.

Teeth and Teething

4.2

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Teething is often uncomfortable and painful.

proximodistal principle principle of biological development that growth proceeds from the middle of the body outward teething period of discomfort and pain experienced by infants as their new teeth break through their gums

Explain how and when teething occurs, and how to soothe it. Babies have no visible teeth at birth, although their teeth have begun to grow beneath their gums. For most infants the first tooth appears between 5 and 9 months of age. As the first teeth break through the skin of the gums, or even in the weeks before, most babies experience discomfort and pain called teething. There is a vast range of variability in teething among infants, from constant pain to no discomfort at all. The first teeth and the molars tend to be especially painful. There are several signs that a baby has begun teething, even if a tooth has not yet broken through (Trajanovska et al., 2010). Teething stimulates saliva production, so parents may notice there is more drooling, more coughing, and perhaps a rash around the mouth. Babies often seize the opportunity for something to bite when teething, including their own hands if nothing else is available, because the counterpressure of the bite relieves the pressure from under the gums. Watch your fingers! You may be surprised how strong a teething baby’s bite can be. Not many of us become more cheerful when in pain, at any age, so it is not surprising that teething babies also tend to become irritable. Some may be reluctant to breast- or bottle-feed, because the suction created from feeding adds to their discomfort (fortunately, most can also eat solid foods by the time they begin teething). And, of course, they become more likely to wake up at night with teething pain. Parents who celebrated when their child began “sleeping through the night” at about 4 months old may find that this was a temporary rather than permanent transition, as the baby now wakes up and cries for relief from teething (Sarrell et al., 2005). Fortunately, there is a range of strategies to help relieve the infant’s teething pain (Trajanovska et al., 2010). Something to bite or chew on, such as a cold wet washcloth or a “teething ring,” can provide the counterpressure on the gums that helps relieve the pain. Something cold to drink or eat can be soothing, and it is a good idea to supplement the fluids lost to drooling with extra fluids to drink. Finally, topical pain relievers rubbed on the gums can also be effective.

Section 1 Physical Development

131

Brain Development Identify the different parts of the brain and describe how the brain changes in the first few years of life.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.3

Recall from Chapter 3 that humans have relatively large brains at birth compared to other animals, thus making the birth process more painful and dangerous. But even though the human brain is relatively large at birth, it is also relatively immature, compared to the brains of other animals (Johnson, 2001). We come out when we do because if we waited any longer, our brains would be too big for us ever to make it through the birth canal. Consequently, much of the basic brain development that takes place prenatally for other animals takes place in the first year for humans. Note, for example, that other animals are mobile at birth or within a few days or weeks, but humans cannot even crawl for about 6 months and cannot walk until the end of their first year. Here we will look first at basics of infant brain growth, then at the specialized functions of different parts of the brain. Then we’ll explore the special sensitivity of brain development during infancy. BRAIN GROWTH As you learned in Chapter 2, during the second trimester of prenatal development neurons are produced at the astonishing rate of 250,000 per minute. The pace then slows considerably in the third trimester, as the focus of development shifts to other organs and to overall size. After birth, the brain resumes its explosive growth. The neonate’s brain is about 25% the size of an adult’s brain, but by age 2 it will reach 70%. There are about 100–200 billion brain cells, or neurons, in the average infant brain (Kostovic et al., 2009). Neurons differ from other cells in the body in that they are not directly connected to each other. Instead, they are separated by tiny gaps called synapses. Neurons communicate across the synapses by releasing chemicals called neurotransmitters. The axon of the neuron releases neurotransmitters, and the dendrites receive them. The brain growth that occurs in the first 2 years of life does not involve production of more and more neurons. In fact, the number of neurons in the brain drops by age 2 to about one-half what it was at birth (de Haan & Johnson, 2003). There are two other ways that brain growth takes place during infancy. First, the dendritic connections between neurons multiply vastly, a process known as overproduction or exuberance (Kostovic et al., 2009). At birth the neurons have few interconnections, but by age 2 each neuron is connected to hundreds or even thousands of other cells. The greatest density of connections appears in toddlerhood, as we’ll see in Chapter 5. The second way the brain grows in infancy is through myelination, the process by which the axons become encased in a myelin sheath, an envelope of fatty material that increases the speed of communication between neurons (Gale et al., 2004). Myelination is especially active in the early years of life but continues at a slower rate until about age 30 (Taylor, 2006). As neurons create vast networks of dendrites to connect to other neurons, a process begins that enhances the precision and efficiency of the connections. “Use it or lose it” is the principle that applies, as dendritic connections that are used become stronger and faster and those that are unused wither away, in a process called synaptic pruning (Kostovic et al., 2009). If you were growing carrots in a backyard garden and you had planted thousands of seeds, how would you ensure that they would thrive? The best way would be to prune or pluck out the weaker shoots to allow the stronger ones more room and resources to grow on. This is what the brain does with synaptic pruning. Through synaptic pruning, the brain eliminates about one-third of its synapses between early childhood and adolescence (Shonkoff & Phillips, 2000). BRAIN SPECIALIZATION Although the entire brain is composed of neurons, the neurons in different parts of the brain have specialized functions. Overall, the brain is divided into three major regions, the hindbrain, the midbrain, and the forebrain. Early in prenatal

Explore the Concept Virtual Brain at MyDevelopmentLab

Explore the Concept of The Synapse at MyDevelopmentLab

Simulate the Experiment Neurotransmitters: Communication Between Neurons at MyDevelopmentLab neurotransmitter chemical that enables neurons to communicate across synapses axon part of a neuron that transmits electric impulses and releases neurotransmitters dendrite part of the neuron that receives neurotransmitters overproduction/exuberance burst in the production of dendritic connections between neurons myelination process of the growth of the myelin sheath around the axon of a neuron synaptic pruning process in brain development in which dendritic connections that are used become stronger and faster and those that are unused whither away

132

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

development, the neurons in these three regions begin to specialize. The hindbrain and midbrain mature earliest and perform the basic biological functions necessary to life. They keep your lungs breathing, your heart beating, and your bodily movements balanced. The forebrain is divided into two main parts, the limbic system and the cerebral cortex. The structures of the limbic system include the hypothalamus, the thalamus, and the hippocampus. The hypothalamus is small, about the size of a peanut, but Occipital plays a key role in monitoring and regulating our basic animal functions, including lobe hunger, thirst, body temperature, sexual desire, and hormonal levels. The thalamus acts as a receiving and transfer center for sensory information from the body to the Temporal rest of the brain. The hippocampus is crucial in memory, especially the transfer of lobe information from short-term to long-term memory. The most distinctively human part of the brain is the outermost part of the forebrain, the cerebral cortex. This part of the human brain is far larger than in other animals. For example, adult humans weigh about as much as adult chimpanzees, but have a cerebral cortex 3 to 4 times larger (Wrangham, 2009). It accounts for 85% of the brain’s total weight, and it is here that most of the brain’s growth takes place after birth. The cerebral cortex is the basis of our distinctively human abilities, including the ability to speak and understand language, to solve complex problems, and to Figure 4.2 s Lobes of the Brain What are the distinct think in terms of concepts, ideas, and symbols. functions of each lobe? The different parts of the cerebral cortex are specialized in two ways. First, the cerebral cortex is divided into two hemispheres, left and right, which are connected by a band of neural fibers called the corpus callosum that allows them to communicate. Lateralization is the term for the specialization of the two hemispheres. In general, the left hemisphere is specialized for language and for processing information in a sequential, step-by-step way cerebral cortex outer portion of the brain, (Tremblay et al., 2004; Wood et al., 2004). The right hemisphere is specialized for spatial containing four regions with distinct functions reasoning and for processing information in a holistic, integrative way (Johnson, 2001). lateralization specialization of functions in the However, the specialization of the hemispheres should not be exaggerated, because they two hemispheres of the brain work together in most aspects of language, emotion, and behavior (Zald, 2003). No one is mainly a “left-brain” or “right-brain” thinker. plasticicty degree to which development can be influenced by environmental circumstances The cerebral cortex is also specialized in that each hemisphere has four regions or lobes with distinct functions (see Figure 4.2). The occipital lobes at the rear of each hemisphere process visual information. The temporal lobes at the lower side of each hemiSimulate the Experiment sphere are involved in processing auditory information, including understanding spoken Cerebral Hemispheres and the Corpus Callosum at MyDevelopmentLab language. The parietal lobes above the temporal lobes process information from bodily sensations. The frontal lobes behind the forehead are the center of the most advanced human brain processes, including producing spoken language, planning for the future, and making decisions. With the lobes as with the hemispheres, it is important not to exaggerate The cognitive recovery of adopted the degree of specialization, as more than one part of the brain is involved in most brain Romanian orphans depended greatly on functions (Knect et al., 2003). the age at which they were adopted. Frontal lobe

Parietal lobe

THE PLASTICITY OF THE INFANT BRAIN Even before birth, the brain is well on its way toward specialization in the ways just described. However, in many ways the cerebral cortex of the neonate and the infant is still immature. Because the infant’s brain is not as specialized as it will be later in development, it is high in plasticity, meaning that it is highly responsive to environmental circumstances. The high plasticity of the infant brain makes it adaptable but also vulnerable (Gale et al., 2004). On the plus side, if a part of the brain is damaged in infancy due to an accident or disease, other parts of the brain can often take over the functions of the damaged portion, whereas this is less possible later in development once greater specialization has taken place. On the minus side, environmental deprivation can have permanent effects if it takes place in infancy, whereas later its effects would not be as profound or long lasting.

Section 1 Physical Development

133

:JVYLZVM*VNUP[P]L(IPSP[PLZH[(NL

 Imagine that, starting tomorrow, for 3 years you lived in conditions )YP[PZO of great deprivation, with little food, little interaction with others, and  9VTHUPHU nothing interesting to do. At the end of it, you might be very hungry and  not very happy, but it is likely your weight would soon return to normal and your intellectual skills and abilities would be unaffected in the long  run. This is what has usually happened to prisoners of war who have  been subject to such grim conditions (Moore, 2010). If the same kind of deprivation had happened to you in the first 3  years of your life, the effects would have been much worse. We know  this because of a horrible natural experiment that took place in Romania  about 20 years ago. In the early 1990s, after Communist regimes fell in Eastern European countries, Western visitors to Romania were shocked  at the conditions in the country’s orphanages. Infants and young chil dren in the orphanages had been given little in the way of nutrition and even less in love, attention, and cognitive stimulation. They were kept in  large, dim, bare rooms, attended by a small number of indifferent care givers. In response to widespread outrage, the orphanages were soon #TVZ #TVZ ¶TVZ ¶TVZ closed and the children were adopted into homes in other countries, (NLH[(KVW[PVU mostly in Canada and Great Britain. The children had all been deprived, but they were adopted at different ages. Over the Figure 4.3 s Romanian Adoptees’ Cognitive course of the next several years, it was possible to see how much difference the age at Abilities, by Age of Adoption The later the age of adoption, the lower their cognitive abilities. adoption made in their cognitive development (O’Connor et al., 2000; Rutter et al., 2004). Source: Based on Beckett et al. (2006) Age at adoption made an enormous difference. All the children recovered dramatically in physical size after a year or two in their new homes, but cognitive recovery depended strongly on age at adoption. As shown in Figure 4.3, by age 6 the Romanian children who had been adopted when less than 6 months old were no different in their rate of cognitive impairment than British children adopted at the same age (Beckett et al., 2006). However, Romanian children adopted at 6–24 months old had cognitive abilities significantly lower than the Romanian or British children adopted earlier, and Romanian children adopted at age 24–42 months had cognitive abilities that were lower still. This indicates that after about 6 months of age, the damage to the brain due to early deprivation often could not be entirely undone even by years of exposure to a more stimulating environment. Plasticity of the infant brain is high but diminishes steeply over the first few years of life.

Sleep Changes Describe how infant sleep changes in the course of the first year and evaluate the risk factors for SIDS, including the research evidence regarding cosleeping. As described in Chapter 3, neonates’ sleep for 16–17 hours a day in periods of a few hours, and are in REM sleep about half this time. By 3–4 months old, infants sleep for longer periods, up to 6–7 hours in a row at night, and REM sleep has declined to about 40%. By age 6 months, cultural practices influence how much infants sleep. American infants sleep about 14 hours a day at this age, including daytime naps (Murkoff et al., 2003). However, among the Kipsigis people of Kenya studied by Charles Super and Sara Harkness (1986), infants slept only about 12 hours a day at 6 months of age, perhaps because they spent much of the day strapped to their mothers or an older sibling, and so expended less energy than American infants do. Super and colleagues (1996) also studied infants in the Netherlands and compared their sleep patterns to American infants. The Dutch infants slept about 16 hours a day at 6 months, 2 hours more than the Americans, due to Dutch cultural beliefs emphasizing rest and early bedtimes for young children. Two important issues of sleep in infancy are the risk of dying during sleep and the issue of whom infants should sleep with. For both issues, there are important cultural variations.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.4

134

C h ap ter 4

Infancy SUDDEN INFANT DEATH SYNDROME (SIDS) When infants are 2–4 months of age, they are at highest risk for sudden infant death syndrome (SIDS). Infants who die of SIDS do not have any apparent illness or disorder, they simply fall asleep and never wake up. SIDS is the leading cause of death for infants 1–12 months of age in developed countries (Moon et al., 2007). Infants of Asian descent are less likely to die of SIDS than those of European or African descent, and African American and Native American infants are at especially high risk, with rates 4–6 times higher than White Americans (Pickett et al., 2005). The higher rates of SIDS among African Americans and Native Americans are part of a larger pattern than begins with poorer prenatal care and continues with greater vulnerability in the first year of life. Although deaths from SIDS have no clear cause, there are several factors known to put infants at risk (Kinney & Thach, 2009; Moon et al., 2007), including:

SIDS Mortality Rates (# deaths per 1,000 live births per year)

2.0 1990 2005

1.5

1.0

.5

Figure 4.4 s The Impact of Reduction Campaigns on Sids Rates Why did rates of SIDS decline so much over this period?

Watch the Video SIDS at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Co-sleeping at MyDevelopmentLab

sudden infant death syndrome (SIDS) death within the first year of life due to unknown reasons, with no apparent illness or disorder cosleeping cultural practice in which infants and sometimes older children sleep with one or both parents

Ja pa n

ali a Au str

ay

ge nt ina Ar

rw No

an y Ge rm

Fr an ce

Ca na da

Un ite d

St at es

0

s SLEEPINGSTOMACH DOWNINSTEADOFmATONTHEBACK s LOWBIRTHWEIGHTANDLOW!PGARSCORES s HAVINGAMOTHERWHOSMOKEDDURINGPREGNANCY ORBEINGAROUND smoke during infancy; s SOFT BEDDING SLEEPING IN AN OVERHEATED ROOM OR WEARING TWO or more layers of clothing during sleep (most SIDS deaths take place in autumn and winter).

One theory is that babies’ vulnerability to SIDS at 2–4 months old reflects the transition from reflex behavior to intentional behavior (Lipsitt, 2003). For their first 2 months of life, when infants’ breathing is blocked, a reflex causes them to shake their heads, bring their hands to their face, and push away the cause of the obstruction. After 2 months of age, once the reflex disappears, most babies are able to do this as intentional, learned behavior, but some are unable to make the transition, perhaps due in part to respiratory and muscular vulnerabilities. When these infants experience breathing difficulties during sleep, instead of being able to shake off the difficulty, they die. One thing that is certain is that sleeping on the back instead of the stomach makes an enormous difference in lowering the risk of SIDS. In 1994, in response to growing research evidence of the risks of stomach-sleeping, pediatricians in the United States launched a major “BACK to Sleep” campaign to inform parents and health professionals of the importance of putting infants to sleep on their backs. Over the next decade, the prevalence of stomachsleeping among American infants declined from 70% to 20% and SIDS deaths declined by nearly one-half (Kochanek et al., 2004; National Center for Health Statistics, 2005). In response to similar campaigns in other countries, SIDS declined by 90% in the United Kingdom and by over 50% in many other developed countries (see Figure 4.4; National Sudden and Unexpected Infant/Child Death & Pregnancy Loss Resource Center, 2010). COSLEEPING: WHO SLEEPS WITH WHOM? With whom should infants sleep? Should they sleep by themselves, in a crib or even a room of their own, or should they sleep alongside a parent or a sibling? If you are a member of a Western culture, you may assume that it is better for infants to have their own crib and room within a few weeks after birth, so that they can learn to be independent and the parents can enjoy their marital intimacy without disruption (or without as much disruption, at least). Prominent pediatricians and health authorities in the United States and other Western countries warn against cosleeping, in which the infant sleeps in the same bed as the parents, arguing that it leads to excessive dependence by infants and can endanger the emotional health of infants or even lead to SIDS (American Academy of Pediatrics [AAP] Task Force on Infant Positioning and SIDS, 2000; Spock & Needleman, 2004). In a survey of American pediatricians, 88% recommended that babies sleep in a crib in a room of their own (Small, 1998). However, this is one of many issues in this book where what is normal and seems healthy and “natural” in Western countries is actually extremely unusual worldwide. Outside of the

Section 1 Physical Development West, nearly all cultures have some form of cosleeping during infancy (Small, 2005). Many of the parents in these cultures view the Western practice of nightly isolation of infants as “a form of child neglect or worse” (DeLoache & Gottlieb, 2000, pp. 16–17). They believe infants are highly vulnerable to injury, illness, and death, and that sleeping beside the mother is necessary to protect them. This arrangement also makes it easy for the infant to breast-feed when necessary during the night, without disturbing others and arousing the mother only slightly. Typically a child sleeps beside the mother until the next child is born, which is usually when the child is 2–4 years old. In a study comparing sleeping arrangements among Guatemalan Maya and European Americans, all the Mayan mothers coslept with their infants until the next child was born, whereupon the child would cosleep with the father or in a bed alongside the mother and the new baby (Morelli et al., 1992). The mothers explained that cosleeping helped promote a close parent–child attachment, highly valued in their collectivistic culture. The Mayan mothers were appalled when they heard how American infants typically sleep alone, and regarded this practice as cold and cruel. In contrast, few of the American mothers coslept with their infants, explaining that they wanted the child to become independent and that cosleeping would foster a degree of dependency that would be emotionally unhealthy. But it is not just in traditional cultures like the Guatemalan Maya that cosleeping is the norm. In Japan and South Korea, two of the most technologically advanced countries in the world, almost all infants cosleep with their mothers, and children continue to sleep with or near their mothers until puberty (Mindell et al., 2010). Like the Mayan mothers, Asian mothers justify their cosleeping practices on the basis of collectivistic values, explaining that this is one way for children to learn from a very early age that they are closely tied to others in bonds of interdependence and mutual obligation. Cultural customs regarding infant sleeping arrangements are a good example of a custom complex, that is, a distinctive cultural pattern of behavior that is based on underlying cultural beliefs. Cosleeping tends to reflect collectivistic beliefs, that members of the culture are closely bound to one another (Small, 1998). In contrast, having infants sleep alone tends to reflect an individualistic belief that each person should learn to be selfsufficient and not rely on others any more than necessary. Parents in an individualistic culture may fear that cosleeping will make infants and children too dependent. However, children who cosleep with their parents in infancy are actually more self-reliant (e.g,. able to dress themselves) and more socially independent (e.g., can make friends by themselves) than other children are (Keller & Goldbert, 2004). What about the danger of SIDS? Don’t cultures where cosleeping is the norm have high rates of SIDS, if cosleeping is a risk factor for SIDS as most American pediatricians believe? On the contrary, SIDS is almost unknown in cultures where cosleeping is the norm. In the United States, however, where most parents do not cosleep, rates of SIDS are among the highest in the world. There appear to be several reasons for this pattern (McKenna & McDade, 2005). First, most parents and infants in cosleeping cultures sleep on relatively hard surfaces such as a mat on the floor or a futon, thus avoiding the soft bedding that is sometimes implicated in SIDS. Second, infants who cosleep breast-feed more often and longer than infants who do not, and these frequent episodes of arousal in the course of the night make SIDS less likely. Third, cosleeping mothers tend to lay their infants on their backs to make the mother’s breast more easily accessible for breast feeding. Thus back-sleeping developed as a widespread cultural practice for practical reasons long before research showed that it lessened the risk of SIDS. Some American cultures have a long tradition of infant cosleeping. It is a common practice among African Americans (Milan et al., 2007), and in the rural culture of the Appalachian Mountains children typically sleep alongside their parents for the first 2 years of life (Abbott, 1992). In many developed countries, the prevalence of cosleeping in infancy has grown in recent years as research has shown that it causes no emotional harm and may even be protective against SIDS (Mindell et al., 2010; Willinger et al., 2003). Cosleeping infants may be at risk for SIDS if their parents are obese or consume alcohol or other drugs

135

In most cultures, mothers and infants cosleep.

THINKING CULTURALLY What might cosleeping indicate about expectations for marital relations in a culture that practices it?

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Parent You want to co-sleep with your newborn daughter, but your spouse is afraid the child will not learn to become independent. What might you tell him or her in response?

custom complex distinctive cultural pattern of behavior that reflects underlying cultural beliefs

136

C h ap ter 4

Infancy before sleeping, but otherwise cosleeping is more often a protective factor than a risk factor for SIDS (McKenna & McDade, 2005).

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. How do the cephalocaudal and proximodistal principles apply to infant growth? 2. How can parents tell when teething is occurring? 3. How “plastic” is the infant brain and how does plasticity change beyond infancy? 4. How and why do cultures vary in who sleeps with whom during infancy? Does cosleeping make SIDS more likely or less likely?

Infant Health Infants’ health depends a great deal on where they happened to be born, that is, on their cultural, economic, and social context. Here we look first at how nutritional needs change over the first year, then at the prevalence and effects of malnutrition. This will be followed by an examination of infant mortality rates and causes, immunizations, and cultural beliefs and practices to protect babies.

Nutritional Needs

4.5

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe how infants’ nutritional needs change during the first year of life and identify the reasons and consequences for malnutrition in infancy. Infants need a lot of food, and they need it often. In fact, during the first year of life nutritional energy needs are greater than at any other time of life, per pound/kilo of body weight (Vlaardingerbroek et al., 2009). Infants also need more fat in their diets than at any later point in life, to fuel the growth of their bodies and (especially) their brains. INTRODUCTION OF SOLID FOODS As noted in Chapter 3, the best way to obtain good high-fat nutrition during infancy is through breast milk. Whether they breast-feed or not, infants also start eating some solid foods during the first year of life. Cultures vary widely in when they introduce solid food to infants, ranging from those that introduce it after just a few weeks of life to those that wait until the second half of the first year. Age 4–5 months is common, in part because that is an age when infants can sit up with support and also the age when they often begin to show an interest in what others are eating (Small, 2005). At 4–5 months old infants still have a gag reflex that causes them to spit out any solid item that enters their mouths. Consequently, at first more food usually ends up on them than in them! The ability to chew and swallow does not develop until the second half of the first year (Napier & Meister, 2000). In the West, pediatricians generally recommend introducing solid food during the fifth or sixth month of life (Seach et al., 2010). Usually the first solid food is rice cereal mixed with breast milk or formula, made thin when first introduced and gradually thickened as the baby becomes used to eating it (National Center for Education in Maternal and Child Health, 2002). This is followed by pureed fruits and vegetables (at about 6 months), then pureed meats (at 7–8 months). In traditional cultures, too, the first foods to be introduced have been mashed, pureed, or prechewed. For example, among the Balinese in Indonesia, even in the first weeks of life mothers give their babies soft prechewed foods such as bananas to supplement breast milk (Deiner, 2000). In the course of the first year, the range of foods provided to the baby widens, but the mother typically chews the food first.

Section 1 Physical Development MALNUTRITION IN INFANCY Because infants have such great nutritional needs, and because their brains and bodies are growing at a faster rate than at any later time of life, the effects of malnutrition in infancy are especially severe and enduring. Infants are capable of thriving mainly on breast milk, along with a little solid food after the early months, so malnutrition in infancy is usually due to the mother being unable or unwilling to breast-feed. Often the problem is that the mother is so ill or malnourished herself that she is unable to produce an adequate supply of breast milk. Or, she may have a disease that can be communicated through breast milk, such as tuberculosis or HIV, and she has been advised not to breast-feed. She may also have been misled to believe that infant formula is better for her baby than breast milk (see Chapter 3), so she has stopped breast-feeding and instead gives her infant the formula substitute, which may not be available in sufficient quantity. If the infant’s mother has died—not uncommon in the areas of the world where infant malnutrition is most common—there may be no one else who can breast-feed the baby or otherwise provide adequate nutrition. Malnourished infants are at risk for marasmus, a disease in which the body wastes away from lack of nutrients. The body stops growing, the muscles atrophy, the baby becomes increasingly lethargic, and eventually death results. Even among infants who survive, malnutrition impairs normal development for years to come (Galler et al., 2010; Nolan et al., 2002). However, studies in Guatemala and several other countries have found that nutritional supplements for infants in poor families have enduring beneficial effects on their physical, cognitive, and social development (Pollitt et al., 1996).

137

Infants with marasmus waste away from lack of nourishment.

Infant Mortality List the major causes and preventive methods of infant mortality and describe some cultural approaches to protecting infants.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.6

The first year of life has always been a perilous period for the human species. Human females typically have a reproductive span of at least 20 years, from the late teens through the late thirties, and with regular sexual intercourse most would have at least 3–7 children during that span. Yet, as we saw in Chapter 1, until recently in human history there was little increase in the total human population. This means that many children died before reaching reproductive age, and based on current patterns it seems likely that many of them died in infancy. Even now, worldwide, the first year of life has the highest risk of death of any period in the entire life span (UNICEF, 2008). CAUSES AND PREVENTION OF INFANT MORTALITY As noted in Chapter 3, most infant mortality is in fact neonatal mortality. That is, it takes place during the first month of life and is usually due to severe birth defects or low birth weight, or is an indirect consequence of the death of the mother during childbirth (UNICEF, 2008). As with neonatal mortality, rates of infant mortality vary vastly between developed countries and developing countries (see Map 4.1 on page 138). With regard to deaths beyond the first month but within the first year, in addition to deaths due to malnutrition, diseases are another major cause of infant mortality worldwide. Malaria, a blood disease spread by mosquitoes (see Chapter 2), is a major killer of infants, responsible for about 1 million infant deaths per year, mainly in Africa (Finkel, 2007). Dysentery, an illness of the digestive system, is also one of the top sources of infant mortality, especially in tropical regions where dysentery bacteria thrive. Overall, the number-one source of infant mortality beyond the first month but within the first year is diarrhea (UNICEF, 2008). Infants with diarrhea lose fluids and eventually die from dehydration if untreated. Diarrhea may be caused by a range of digestive illnesses,

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Researcher In Hawaii, a “Baby Luau” is a big party held to mark a baby’s first birthday. What might be a cultural-historical reason for this?

marasmus disease in which the body wastes away from lack of nutrients

138

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

Number of deaths during the first year of life per 1,000 live births More than 100 50–100 25–49.9 30° 10–24.9 1–9.9 No data

30°





30°

30°

150° 60°

120°

90°

60°

30°



30°

60°

90°

120°

150°

Map 4.1 s Infant Mortality Rates Worldwide How do infant mortality rates compare with neonatal mortality rates (as shown in Map 3.2)? What are some potential causes of the high infant mortality rates in developing countries?

Increased prevalence of vaccinations in infancy has greatly reduced infant mortality worldwide. Here, an infant receives a vaccination in Mozambique.

and is often a consequence of bottle-feeding in unsanitary conditions. In developing countries, infants who bottle-feed have a mortality rate 5 times higher than those who breastfeed (Grant, 1997), and many of the deaths are due to diarrhea caused by mixing formula powder with unclean water. Diarrhea can be cured easily through simple, inexpensive oral rehydration therapy (ORT). ORT involves having infants with diarrhea drink a solution of salt and glucose mixed with (clean) water. Since 1980 the World Health Organization (WHO) has led an international effort to reduce infant deaths through providing ORT, and the effort has reduced the worldwide rate of infant deaths due to diarrhea from 4.5 million per year to less than 2 million (Boschi-Pinto et al., 2009). However, the reason the rate is still as high as 2 million per year is that even now, in the parts of the world where infant diarrhea is most common, this simple, inexpensive remedy is often unavailable. Although millions of infants worldwide die yearly from lack of adequate nutrition and medical care, in the past half century many diseases that formerly killed infants and young children have been reduced or even eliminated due to vaccines that provide immunization (Centers for Disease Control and Prevention [CDC], 2006). Smallpox has been eradicated, measles and polio have been eliminated in large regions of the world, and diphtheria, tetanus, and yellow fever have been greatly reduced in prevalence, all due to immunization programs. Typically, children receive vaccinations for these diseases in the first or second year of life. However, there is a great deal of variability worldwide in how likely children are to be vaccinated. As of 2006, coverage was 66% of children in Africa, 69% in South Asia, and over 90% in Europe and the Americas (CDC, 2006). In recent years, a major effort to provide immunization to all children has been made by the WHO, UNICEF, and private foundations, and the rate of immunization has been increasing, especially in Africa (UNICEF, 2008). Although rumors have circulated that some vaccinations may actually cause harm to children, for example by triggering autism, scientific studies have found no basis for these claims (Rodier, 2009). Unfortunately, some parents have been deceived by these claims and consequently refused to have their children vaccinated, which, ironically— and sadly—exposes their children and other people’s children to the genuine danger of contracting infectious diseases.

Section 1 Physical Development

139

HISTORICAL FOCUS Protecting Infants the Puritan Way

I

n the year 1630 about 1,000 people sailed from England to America, where they hoped to build a new society free from the corruptions they perceived as widespread in English society (Reese, 2000). In the new land they wished to “purify” the practice of the Christian religion by disposing of the hierarchy and elaborate ceremonies that went along with religious services in the Church of England, and for this reason they became known as “Puritans.” A few months after leaving England they arrived in Massachusetts Bay, and they soon settled in small villages throughout the northeastern part of what eventually became the United States. It was important to the Puritans to protect their children from the “common corruptions of this evil world,” and they sought to do so from the beginning, naming their newborns after elements of their faith such as “Grace,” “Redeemed,” and “Mercy.” Puritans believed that infants were born depraved and prone to sin, and that newborns should be baptized as soon as possible, no longer than 8 days after birth. But they saw baptism as only the first step toward a child’s redemption from sin. All through infancy, in the course of daily activities like feeding and bathing, mothers were counseled to quote the Bible to their infants to lay a foundation of godly thinking. In some ways Puritan parents were more nurturing toward their children than other English parents were. Unlike many parents in the England they had left behind, Puritans generally did not send their

children to a wet nurse and did not swaddle them. Breast feeding was recommended for the first year, and at weaning parents often sent their child to a relative”s home for a period, in an effort to make the transition easier for both mother and child. Like children in many cultures, Puritan children were subject to a variety of illnesses, and like adults in many cultures, Puritan adults developed a wide range of treatments that were useless at best and sometimes harmful. For colic, the recommended treatment was to feed the infant a broth made from the boiled intestines and skin of a wolf. For the flu, the recommended treatment was to place a spider in a nut shell, wrap it with silk, and hang it around the infant’s neck. For illnesses of all kinds, bloodletting (making a cut in the arm and letting a quantity of blood run out) was the standard treatment. It is probably not necessary to emphasize how unwise this was. Of course, the Puritans’ intentions were good. They believed were helping their children, not harming them. Although from a modern perspective Puritans are often seen as overly strict and rigid in what they required of children as well as adults, they understood that infants were too immature to follow rules and limits. Parents were encouraged to be kind and indulgent with their infants, the better to win their trust and eventually win them to God’s will. Restrictions and punishments would come soon enough, in the second year of life and beyond.

CULTURAL BELIEFS AND PRACTICES TO PROTECT INFANTS Perhaps the most striking feature of the infant’s social environment in traditional cultures is the parents’ acute awareness of infants’ vulnerability and their resulting motive to do whatever they can to make the infant’s survival most likely. The cultural practices of secluding infants in their early weeks, cosleeping with them, and constantly carrying them developed out of long and painful human experience with high infant mortality. Historically, parents had no immunizations or other medical care for their infants, but they often went to great lengths to try and protect their babies from death, as you will see in the Historical Focus: Protecting Infants the Puritan Way feature above. Although they knew nothing about the physiological causes of illness and had no effective medical remedies, they attempted to devise practices that would allow their infants to avoid harm. In medieval Europe, for example, where an estimated 1 of every 3 babies died before their first birthday, a popular belief was that teething was a common cause of death (Fontanel & d’Hartcourt, 1997). This is a case of the common human tendency, discussed in Chapter 1, to confuse correlation and causation. Teething often takes place about midway through the first year. When their infants began suffering symptoms such as fevers and diarrhea after teething began, the parents concluded that teething was the cause, having no idea that the real source of the symptoms was a disease such as malaria, typhus, or cholera. So, they addressed the illness by placing a charm or amulet around the child’s neck, or by placing leeches on the baby’s gums, sadly to no good effect.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse How would you respond to parents who express reluctance to have their infant vaccinated, fearing it would be harmful instead of helpful?

oral rehydration therapy (ORT) treatment for infant diarrhea that involves drinking a solution of salt and glucose mixed with clean water

Many cultures resort to magic in an effort to protect their babies. Here, a baby from the Hamer Tribe of Ethiopia wears jewelry the mother has adorned her with to ward off disease.

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

Today, too, in cultures where medical remedies for infant illness are scarce, parents often resort to magical practices intended to protect their babies from disease and death. Observations today in places with little access to medical care offer many poignant examples of the cultural practices that have developed to try to protect infants. For example, the people of Bali, in Indonesia, believe that infants should be treated like gods, since they have just arrived from the spirit world, where the gods dwell (Diener, 2000). Consequently, infants should be held constantly and should never touch the ground, out of respect for their godly status. If an infant dies, this is often interpreted as indicating that the infant was not shown the proper respect and so decided to return to the spirit world. The Fulani people of West Africa believe that a sharp knife should always be kept near the baby to ward off the witches and evil spirits that may try to take its soul (Johnson, 2000). Compliments to the baby should avoided at all costs, as this may only make the baby seem more valuable and beautiful and so all the more attractive to the evil spirits. Instead, the Fulani people believe parents should give the infant an unattractive nickname like “Cow Turd,” so that the evil spirits will think the baby is not worth taking. Finally, the Ifalaluk of Micronesia believe that neonates should be covered with cloths in the weeks after birth to encourage sweating, which they believe helps babies grow properly (Le, 2000). Babies should be washed three times a day, morning, noon, and afternoon, but not in the evening, because evil spirits are out then. Any time babies are outside they should be covered with a cloth so that they will not be spied by evil spirits.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What kinds of solid foods should infants eat; beginning when? 2. Can the consequences of malnutrition be reversed if later nutrition improves? 3. What is the major cause of infant mortality, and why is the rate so high if there is a simple remedy? 4. How do the rates of infant vaccination vary in different world regions and how have vaccinations influenced rates of infant mortality over the past century? 5. How is the correlation–causation error reflected in the ways some cultures have sought to protect infants from harm?

Baby on the Move: Motor and Sensory Development

Watch the Video Motor Development in Infants and Toddlers at MyDevelopmentLab

One of the most striking features of human neonates is how little they are able to move around. Even if you hold neonates up, their heads flop to one side because their neck muscles are not yet strong enough to support their heads. But over the course of the first year they develop from immobile to highly mobile, a huge change not just in their lives but in the lives of those who care for them. Sensory development in the first year is more subtle, but advances take place, especially in the sense of sight.

Motor Development

4.7

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe the major changes during infancy in gross and fine motor development. Over the first year of life remarkable advances take place in motor development. The changes occur in gross motor development, which includes balance and posture as

140

Section 1 Physical Development

141

well as whole-body movements such as crawling, and in fine motor development, which entails more finely tuned movements of the hands such as grasping and manipulating objects. GROSS MOTOR DEVELOPMENT Ask a parent of an infant what’s new, and it’s quite likely you’ll hear about some new milestone of gross motor development that has recently been achieved. “Emma can now sit up on her own without falling over!” or “Juan is suddenly crawling all over the house!” or “Maru took her first steps yesterday!” There are many achievements of gross motor development over the first year, including holding the head up without support, rolling over, sitting without support, crawling, standing, cruising (walking while holding on to something), and (for some) walking. Most children achieve these skills in this sequence, although sometimes the order of skills varies and sometimes children skip steps in the sequence. There is more variability in the timing of each milestone of gross motor development than in the sequence. As you can see in Table 4.1, for each milestone there is a normal range of variation of several months. Infants could reach the milestones anywhere within those ranges and still be developing normally. How much of infants’ gross motor development is ontogenetic—meaning that it takes place due to an inborn, genetically based, individual timetable—and how much of it is due to experience and learning? As with most aspects of development, both genetics and environment are involved. Certainly the highly consistent sequence of gross motor milestones suggests an ontogenetic timetable. There is also evidence for genetic group differences, with infants of African heritage reaching most motor milestones earlier than other infants (Kelly et al., 2006). However, most developmental psychologists view gross motor development in infancy as a combination of the genetic timetable, the maturation of the brain, support and assistance from adults for developing the skill, and the child’s own efforts to practice the skill (Adolf & Berger, 2006; Thelen, 2001). Looking at infant gross motor development across cultures provides a vivid picture of how genetics and environment interact. In many traditional cultures it is a common practice for infants to be strapped onto their mothers’ backs for most of the day, as the mothers go about their daily business of tending crops, preparing food, and other kinds of work (Pretorious et al., 2002). In some cultures a common infant-care practice in the first few months of life is swaddling, which was discussed in Chapter 3. If infants are strapped to their mothers’ backs or swaddled for most of the day, they receive little practice in developing gross motor skills. These restrictive practices are partly to free the mother to work, but cultures that swaddle infants also believe that swaddling protects the infant from sickness and other threats to health (DeLoache & Gottlieb, 2000). In rural regions of Turkey, infants are swaddled for the first few months and then carried around by their mother and other family members, as discussed in the Cultural Focus: Infant Care in Rural Turkey feature on page 143.

In many traditional cultures infants are strapped to their mothers’ backs for most of the day. Here, a mother and infant in rural Vietnam.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE How would the advances in gross motor development over the first year influence the infant’s social relationships?

TABLE 4.1 Milestones of Gross Motor Development in Infancy Milestone

Average age

Age range*

Holding head up unsupported

6 weeks

3 weeks–4 months

Rolling over

4½ months

2–7 months

Sitting without support

7 months

5–9 months

Crawling

7 months

5–11 months

Standing

11 months

5–12 months

Walking with support (cruising)

11½ months

7–12 months

Walking

12 months

9–17 months

*Age ranges provided are for 90% of American infants. Based on: Bayley (2005).

gross motor development development of motor abilities including balance and posture as well as whole-body movements such as crawling fine motor development development of motor abilities involving finely tuned movements of the hands such as grasping and manipulating objects

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

Figure 4.5 s Holding of Gusii Infants by Age How does the percentage during the first year compare to infants in your culture? Source: Levine et al. (1994)

100 Percentage of Observations

142

80 60 40 20

0–3

3–6

6–9

9–12 12–15 15–18 18–21 21–24 24–27 27–30 Age in Months

Watch the Video Gross Motor Skills at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Researcher You are conducting research with Mayan Indians in Mexico. You notice that babies younger than one year are always held or carried on someone’s back. They never get the chance to crawl. Yet they walk at about the same time as other infants you’ve seen at home (around their first birthday). How can you explain this?

Even after they learn to crawl at about 6 months old and walk at about one year, infants in traditional cultures are restricted in their exercise of these new motor skills. If they are allowed to crawl around and explore they might wander into the cooking fire, or be trampled by livestock, or tumble off a cliff, or any number of other bad things, so it is viewed as best to keep them in someone’s arms at all times. As we saw with the story of Makori that opened the chapter, infants from the Gusii culture of Kenya are held or carried the majority of their waking hours throughout the first year (see Figure 4.5; Levine et al., 1994, p. 160). In contrast, some cultures actively promote infants’ gross motor development. For example, the Kipsigis people of Kenya begin encouraging gross motor skills from early on (Super & Harkness, 2009). When only 2–3 months old, infants are placed in shallow holes, kept upright by rolled blankets, months before they would be able to sit on their own. At about the same age, parents start encouraging their infants to practice walking by holding them up and bouncing their feet on the ground. Similarly, in Jamaica mothers massage and stretch their babies’ arms and legs beginning in early infancy to promote strength and growth, and like the Kipsigis, beginning at 2–3 months of age they help them practice walking (Hopkins & Westra, 1990). In some Western countries, pediatricians now recommend “tummy time” for infants, that is, placing them on their stomachs for a short period each day to encourage them to learn to push up, roll over, sit up, and stand (Ianelli, 2007). Tummy time is viewed as more important now than it was in the past because infants are now supposed to sleep on their backs to reduce the risk of SIDS, and so spend less time on their stomachs. How much does it matter, ultimately, if cultural practices hinder or promote infants’ gross motor development? A little in the short run, perhaps, but not much in the long run. For the most part, infants in cultures where they are strapped to the mother’s back or swaddled learn to crawl and walk at about the same age as infants in cultures that neither bind their infants nor make special efforts to support gross motor development (Adolph et al., 2010). One exception is the Ache people, a South American Indian culture (Kaplan & Dove, 1987). Ache mothers have extremely close contact with their infants, strapping, carrying, or holding them 93% of daylight time and 100% of the night hours. Consequently, Ache children do not typically begin walking until about age two, a year later than the norm across cultures. However, this appears to be partly because Ache infants enjoy being carried around so much that they often refuse to walk even after they are able! In any case, there is no difference in gross motor development by age 6 between Ache children and children in less restrictive cultures. Infants in cultures where gross motor development is actively stimulated may develop slightly earlier than in cultures where parents make no special efforts. In a study comparing Jamaican immigrant infants in England with native-born English mothers, the Jamaican immigrant infants walked slightly earlier, evidently because their mothers

Section 1 Physical Development encouraged them to walk and practiced with them, but the two groups were no different in when crawling began (Hopkins & Westra, 1990). In some African cultures that actively stimulate gross motor development, infants walk a few weeks earlier than children in the West (Adolph et al., 2010). Here again, however, by age 6 there are no differences in gross motor development between children in the cultures that promote early motor achievement and cultures that do not. Thus it appears that cultural practices can slightly speed up or slow down the ontogenetic timetable for gross motor development in infancy, but the influence of the environment is relatively small and transient for this particular area of development.

143

THINKING CULTURALLY In the United States, there seem to be a lot of books on getting your baby to sleep through the night. Why aren’t there similar books on teaching children to walk sooner?

CULTURAL FOCUS Infant Care in Rural Turkey

T

to marry just as biological siblings are. urkey is a Muslim country of about 70 million people located Today, however, women who cannot at the intersection of Asia and Europe. It has experienced produce milk usually obtain bottles rapid economic development in recent decades, but as in TURKEY and formula rather than arranging many developing countries, the changes are taking place mainly in GREECE for a milk mother. urban areas and the lives of people in rural areas continue to follow SYRIA IRAQ Infants are swaddled most of the the traditional ways (DeLoache & Gottlieb, 2000). time during their first months of life. Rural villagers in Turkey make their livelihood mainly by farmTurkish people believe that swaddling ing. Most families have enough land to raise crops to provide for makes infants feel secure and helps them their own needs, with a little left over to sell at the market. Most sleep soundly. They also believe that swaddling also have sheep, goats, and perhaps a few cows, to provide dairy protects infants’ health and well-being. products and meat. Houses are made of mudbrick and usually have After swaddling has ended, infants are held almost constantly two large rooms used for all activities, from eating and sleeping to by their mothers and other family members and family friends. They entertaining. Since the 1970s the villages have had electricity, and are rarely allowed to crawl around once they become capable of families typically have a washing machine, a television, and a few doing so, because of the fear other electronic devices. that they will find something The Turks regard children as dirty or dangerous and put it in a great blessing and celebrate their mouths. But there is almost the birth of each child. They bealways someone around who is lieve that it is essential to have happy to hold a baby, given the children in order to have a happy child-focused beliefs of rural life, and that children strengthen Turkish culture. the parents’ marriage. Infants Turkish villagers do not and young children are typically celebrate or even keep track of treated with a great deal of love birthdays, but they often have and indulgence. a party when the infant’s first Infants are breast-fed for tooth comes in. There is music at least the first 18 months of and dancing, and a special food life. Turks believe that breastis prepared for the occasion, feeding the infant gives the “tooth bulgur” made of bulgur mother “milk rights,” meaning wheat and chickpeas cooked that in return the grown child into a soft paste. Turks believe will be obligated to take care of Turks value children highly and treat infants with abundant love and indulgence. this paste helps infants’ teeth her in her old age. Traditionally, come in without pain. Wishful if the mother was unable to prothinking, perhaps, but it also reflects the Turkish belief that baduce sufficient milk, another woman in the village would become bies should experience as little pain and as much joy and love as the infant’s “milk mother.” That woman’s children would become possible. the infant’s “milk siblings,” and in adulthood they would be forbidden

144

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

opposable thumb position of the thumb apart from the fingers, unique to humans, that makes possible fine motor movements

By 9–12 months infants are able to grasp small objects.

FINE MOTOR DEVELOPMENT One of the evolutionary developments that makes humans anatomically distinctive among animals is the opposable thumb, that is, the position of our thumbs opposite our fingers. (Place your thumb now against your fingers and you will see what I mean.) The opposable thumb is the basis of fine motor development, the deft movements of our hands that enable us to make a tool, pick up a small object, or thread a needle. During the first year of life the ability for fine motor movements makes remarkable progress. The principal milestones of fine motor development in infancy are reaching and grasping. Oddly, infants are better at reaching during the first month of life than they are at 2 months of age (Spencer et al., 2000). Neonates will extend their arms awkwardly toward an interesting object, an action called prereaching, although it is more like a swipe or a swing than a well-coordinated reach. By 2 months, however, prereaching no longer takes place (Lee et al., 2008). Prereaching is a reflex that occurs in response to an object, and like many reflexes it disappears within the first months of life. At about 3 months of age, reaching reappears, but in a more coordinated and accurate way than in the neonate. Reaching continues to develop over the course of the first year, becoming smoother, more direct, and more capable of adjusting to changes in the movement and position of the object (Berthier & Carrico, 2010). Grasping is also a neonatal reflex, and this means it is not under intentional control (Schott & Rossor, 2003). Neonates will automatically grasp whatever is placed in their hands. Like reaching, grasping becomes smoother and more accurate during the first year, as infants learn to adjust the positions of their fingers and thumbs even before their hand reaches the object, and to adjust further once they grasp the object, in response to its size, shape, and weight (Daum & Prinz, 2011). By the end of the first year, infants are able to grasp a spoon well enough to begin to feed themselves—although this does not guarantee the food will always end up in their mouths! At the same time as infants’ abilities for reaching and grasping are advancing, they are learning to coordinate the two. They use the combination to help them explore the environment around them. By 5 months of age, once they reach and grasp an object, they might hold it with one hand as they explore it with the other, or transfer it from one hand to the other (Keen, 2005). Learning to coordinate reaching and grasping is the basis of further development of fine motor skills, and an essential part of human motor functioning. However, during infancy it can also be a dangerous ability to have. Beginning at about 4 to 5 months, what is the first thing infants do with an object after reaching and grasping it? They put it in their mouths, of course—whether it is edible or not. (How this tendency somehow survived natural selection is a good question.) At this age they can mainly grasp objects that pose no danger, because their grasping ability is not yet fine enough to enable them to grasp objects they could choke on. However, by 9–12 months of age infants learn the “pincer grasp” that allows them to hold a small object between their thumb and forefinger, such as a marble, a coin, or a crayon stub (Murkoff et al., 2003). This allows them to begin feeding themselves small pieces of food, but the tendency to taste even the untasteable remains at this age, so others have to be especially vigilant in monitoring what infants reach, grasp, and place in their mouths.

Sensory Development

4.8

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe when and how infants develop depth perception and intermodal perception. As described in Chapter 3, the senses vary in how developed they are at birth. Taste and touch are nearly mature, hearing is well-developed in most respects, and sight is the least mature of the senses.

Section 1 Physical Development DEPTH PERCEPTION One important aspect of vision that develops during infancy is depth perception, the ability to discern the relative distance of objects in the environment (Kavsec, 2003). The key to depth perception is binocular vision, the ability to combine the images of each eye into one image. Because our two eyes are slightly apart on our faces, they have slightly different angles on the visual field before them, and combining these two angles into one image provides a perception of the depth or distance of the object. That is, it indicates the location of the object in relation to the observer and in relation to other objects in the visual field. Binocular vision begins to develop by about 3 months of age (Brown & Miracle, 2003; Slater et al., 2002). Depth perception becomes especially important once babies become mobile. Prior to that time, their lack of depth perception is harmless, but once they begin to crawl and then walk they may run into things or fall off the edge of surfaces unless they can use depth perception to anticipate hazards. This was first demonstrated in a classic experiment by Eleanor Gibson and James Walk (1960). Gibson’s inspiration for the experiment was a recent trip to the Grand Canyon, where her fear that her young children would tumble over the edge inspired her to wonder when children develop an awareness of depth that allows them to avoid such mishaps. Back in the lab, she and Walk designed a clever experiment. They made a glasscovered table with a checkered pattern below the glass, but on one half of the table the checkered pattern was just below the surface whereas on the other half it was about two feet below, giving the appearance of a “visual cliff” in the middle of the table (see Figure 4.6). The infants in the study (ages 6–14 months) were happy to crawl around on the “shallow” side of the cliff, but most would not cross over to the “deep” side, even when their mothers stood on the other side of it and beckoned them encouragingly. This showed that they had learned depth perception. But when did they learn it? All the infants in the study could crawl or walk, otherwise they would not have had much chance of crossing the cliff even if they wanted to, but by that age they already had depth perception. A subsequent experiment added further information. The researchers used 2–3 month old infants as the participants, and placed them first on the shallow side of the visual cliff and then on the deep side, while monitoring the babies’ heart rates (Campos et al., 1970). Their heart rates decreased when they were placed on the deep side, indicating that they were interested but not afraid. This was taken to indicate that at 2–3 months of age, before they could crawl, infants lacked depth perception and therefore did not experience fear of the visual cliff. INTERMODAL PERCEPTION Studies of infants’ sensory abilities typically try to isolate a single sense so that it can be studied without interference from the others, but of course this is not how the senses function in real life. Shake a rattle in front of 6-month-old baby and she sees it, hears it, reaches out and touches it, then tastes it, effortlessly coordinating all her senses at once. The integration and coordination of sensory information is called intermodal perception. Even neonates possess a rudimentary form of this ability. When they hear a sound they look in the direction it came from, indicating coordination of auditory and visual responses (Morrongiello et al., 1994). Over the course of the first year intermodal perception develops further. One-month-old infants recognize objects they have put in their mouths but have not seen before, indicating integration of touch and sight (Schweinle & Wilcox, 2004). Four-month-old infants look longer at a video of a puppet jumping up and down in time with music than at the same puppet when the jumping

145

Figure 4.6 s The Visual Cliff Experiment Infants’ reluctance to cross the “visual cliff” shows their ability for depth perception. Simulate the Experiment The Visual Cliff at MyDevelopmentLab

depth perception ability to discern the relative distance of objects in the environment binocular vision ability to combine the images of the two eyes into one image intermodal perception integration and coordination of information from the various senses

146

C h ap ter 4

Infancy does not match the music, suggesting that the correspondence of visual and auditory stimuli appeals to them (Spelke, 1979). By 8 months, infants can even match an unfamiliar person’s face with the correct voice when the faces and voices vary on the basis of age and gender, indicating a developing ability to coordinate visual and auditory information (Patterson & Werker, 2002). Thus the early development of intermodal perception helps infants learn about their physical and social world (Banks, 2005).

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. How do cultural practices such as swaddling influence the timing of gross motor development? 2. What is the pincer grasp and at what age do infants master it? 3. How does the visual cliff experiment demonstrate when and how infants learn depth perception? 4. Give an example of intermodal perception in an 8-month-old infant.

Section 1 VIDEO GUIDE Infant Fine Motor Development Across Cultures (Length: 3:26) This video displays several instances of babies from various countries at differing stages of fine motor development.

1. The narrator tells us that certain developmental milestones occur at very similar ages across cultures, does this surprise you? Why or why not? 2. Can you think of any related skills that the pincer grasp might be a precursor for? What about skills related to grasping? In what ways would these primitive skills be so important across cultures? 3. Many first attempts of grasping by young babies are unsuccessful. Why do you think they continue to try and eventually succeed?

Watch the Video Infant Fine Motor Development Across Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab

SECTION 2

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 4.9 Describe the meaning of maturation, schemes, assimilation, and accommodation. 4.10 Describe the first four sensorimotor substages and explain how object permanence develops over the course of the first year. 4.11 Summarize the major critiques of Piaget’s sensorimotor theory. 4.12 Explain how attention and habituation change during infancy. 4.13 Explain how short-term and long-term memory expand during infancy. 4.14 Describe the major scales used in measuring infant development and explain how habituation assessments are used to predict later intelligence. 4.15 Evaluate the claim that educational media enhance infants’ cognitive development. 4.16 Describe the course of language development over the first year of life. 4.17 Describe how cultures vary in their stimulation of language development.

Piaget’s Theory of Cognitive Development Unquestionably, the most influential theory of cognitive development from infancy through adolescence is the one developed by the Swiss psychologist Jean Piaget (pee-ah-JAY), who lived from 1896 to 1980. Piaget’s observations convinced him that children of different ages think differently, and that changes in cognitive development proceed in distinct stages (Piaget, 1954). Each stage involves a different way of thinking about the world. The idea of cognitive stages means that each person’s cognitive abilities are organized into coherent mental structures; a person who thinks within a particular stage in one aspect of life should think within that stage in all other aspects of life as well, because all thinking is part of the same mental structure (Keating, 1991). Because Piaget focused on how cognition changes with age, his approach (and the approach of those who have followed in his tradition) is known as the cognitive-developmental approach.

What Drives Cognitive Development? Describe the meaning of maturation, schemes, assimilation, and accommodation.

mental structure in Piaget’s theory of cognitive development, the cognitive systems that organize thinking into coherent patterns so that all thinking takes place on the same level of cognitive functioning cognitive-developmental approach focus on how cognitive abilities change with age in stage sequence of development, pioneered by Piaget and since taken up by other researchers maturation concept that an innate, biologically based program is the driving force behind development

Explore the Concept Piaget’s Stages of Cognitive Development at MyDevelopmentLab

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.9

According to Piaget, the driving force behind development from one stage to the next is maturation, a biologically driven program of developmental change (Inhelder & Piaget, 1958; Piaget, 2002). Each of us has within our genotype a prescription for cognitive development that prepares us for certain changes at certain ages. A reasonably normal environment is necessary for cognitive development to occur, but the effect of the environment is limited. You cannot teach a 1-year-old something that only a 4-year-old can learn, no matter how sophisticated your teaching techniques are. By the time the 1-year-old reaches age 4,

147

148

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE Can you think of an example of something a 4-year-old could learn easily but a 1-year-old could not learn even with special teaching?

Explore the Concept Infant’s Perceptual and Cognitive Milestones at MyDevelopmentLab

the biological processes of maturation will make it easy to understand the world as a typical child of 4 understands it, and no special teaching will be required. Along with maturation, Piaget emphasized that cognitive development is driven by the child’s efforts to understand and influence the surrounding environment (Demetriou & Ratopoulos, 2004; Piaget, 2002). Children actively construct their understanding of the world, rather than being merely the passive recipients of environmental influences. Piaget’s view was in sharp contrast to the behaviorists (the leading theorists prior to Piaget), who viewed the environment as acting on the child through rewards and punishments rather than seeing the child as an active agent. Piaget proposed that the child’s construction of reality takes place through the use of schemes, which are cognitive structures for processing, organizing, and interpreting information. For infants, schemes are based on sensory and motor processes such as sucking and grasping, but after infancy, schemes become symbolic and representational, as words, ideas, and concepts. For example, all nouns are schemes—tree, chair, dog—because thinking of these words evokes a cognitive structure that allows you to process, organize, and interpret information. The two processes involved in the use of schemes are assimilation and accommodation. Assimilation occurs when new information is altered to fit an existing scheme. In contrast, accommodation entails changing the scheme to adapt to the new information. Assimilation and accommodation usually take place together in varying degrees; they are “two sides of the same cognitive coin” (Flavell et al., 2002, p. 5). For example, an infant who has been breast-feeding may use mostly assimilation and a slight degree of accommodation when learning to suck from the nipple on a bottle, but if sucking on a ball or a parent’s finger the infant would be able to use assimilation less and need to use accommodation more. People of other ages, too, use both assimilation and accommodation whenever they are processing cognitive information. One example is right in front of you. In the course of reading this textbook, you will read things that sound familiar to you from your own experience, so that you can easily assimilate them to what you already know. Other information, especially the information from cultures other than your own, will be contrary to the schemes you have developed from living in your culture and will require you to use accommodation in order to expand your knowledge and understanding of human development across the life span.

The Sensorimotor Stage

4.10

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Watch the Video Sensorimotor Development at MyDevelopmentLab schemes cognitive structures for processing, organizing, and interpreting information assimilation cognitive process of altering new information to fit an existing scheme

Describe the first four sensorimotor substages and explain how object permanence develops over the course of the first year. Based on his own research and his collaborations with his colleague Barbel Inhelder, Piaget devised a theory of cognitive development to describe the stages that children’s thinking passes through as they grow up (Inhelder & Piaget, 1958; Piaget, 1972; see Table 4.2). The first 2 years of life Piaget termed the sensorimotor stage. Cognitive development in this stage involves learning how to coordinate the activities of the senses (such as watching an object as it moves across your field of vision) with motor activities (such as reaching out to grasp the object). During infancy, the two major cognitive achievements, according to Piaget, are the advance in sensorimotor development from reflex behavior to intentional action and the attainment of object permanence.

accommodation cognitive process of changing a scheme to adapt to new information sensorimotor stage in Piaget’s theory, the first 2 years of cognitive development, which involves learning how to coordinate the activities of the senses with motor activities

SENSORIMOTOR SUBSTAGES According to Piaget, the sensorimotor stage can be divided into six substages (Piaget, 1952, 1954). The first four substages take place during the first year of life and will be described here. The last two sensorimotor stages develop in the second year and will be covered in Chapter 5, on toddlerhood.

Section 2 Cognitive Development

149

TABLE 4.2 Stages of Cognitive Development in Piaget’s Theory Ages

Stage

Characteristics

0–2

Sensorimotor

Capable of coordinating the activities of the senses with motor activities

2–7

Preoperational

Capable of symbolic representation, such as in language, but with limited ability to use mental operations

7–11

Concrete operations

Capable of using mental operations, but only in concrete, immediate experience; difficulty thinking hypothetically

11–15 and up

Formal operations

Capable of thinking logically and abstractly; capable of formulating hypotheses and testing them systematically; thinking is more complex; and can think about thinking (metacognition)

Substage 1: Simple reflexes (0–1 month). In this substage, cognitive activity is based mainly on the neonatal reflexes described in Chapter 3, such as sucking, rooting, and grasping. Reflexes are a type of scheme, because they are a way of processing and organizing information. However, unlike most schemes, for which there is a balance of assimilation and accommodation, reflex schemes are weighted heavily toward assimilation, because they do not adapt much in response to the environment. Substage 2: First habits and primary circular reactions (1–4 months). In this substage, infants’ activities in relation to the world become based less on reflexes and more on the infants’ purposeful behavior. Specifically, infants in this substage learn to repeat bodily movements that occurred initially by chance. For example, infants often discover how tasty their hands and fingers can be in this substage. While moving their hands around randomly one ends up in their mouth and they begin sucking on it. Finding this sensation pleasurable, they repeat the movement, now intentionally. The movement is primary because it focuses on the infant’s own body, and circular because once it is discovered it is repeated intentionally. Substage 3: Secondary circular reactions (4–8 months). Like primary circular reactions, secondary circular reactions entail the repetition of movements that originally occurred by chance. The difference is that primary circular reactions involve activity that is restricted to the infant’s own body, whereas secondary circular reactions involve activity in relation to the external world. For example, Piaget recorded how his daughter Lucienne at this age accidentally kicked a mobile hanging over her crib. Delighted at the effect, she now repeated the behavior intentionally, over and over, each time squealing with laughter (Crain, 2000). Substage 4: Coordination of secondary schemes (8–12 months). In this substage, for the first time the baby’s actions begin not as accidents but as intentional, goaldirected behavior. Furthermore, rather than exercising one scheme at a time, the infant can now coordinate schemes. For example, at this age Piaget’s son Laurent was able to move an object (Piaget’s hand) out of the way in order to reach another object (a matchbox), thus coordinating three schemes: moving something aside, reaching, and grasping.

OBJECT PERMANENCE Another important cognitive advance in infancy is the initial understanding of object permanence. This is the awareness that objects (including people) continue to exist even when we are not in direct sensory or motor contact with them. From his observations and simple experiments, Piaget concluded that infants have little understanding of object permanence for much of the first year of life (Piaget, 1952). When infants under 4 months drop an object, they do not look to see where it went. Piaget interpreted this as indicating that, to the infants, the object ceased to exist once they could not see or touch it. From 4 to 8 months, infants who drop an object will look briefly to see where it has gone, but only briefly, which Piaget interpreted as indicating that they

Watch the Video Object Permanance at MyDevelopmentLab

object permanence awareness that objects (including people) continue to exist even when we are not in direct sensory or motor contact with them

150

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

At age 8–12 months infants still have an incomplete understanding of object permanence.

Watch the Video Hidden Elephant at MyDevelopmentLab

are unsure whether the object still exists. If infants at this age are shown an interesting object—Piaget liked to use his pocket watch—and then the object is placed under a blanket, they will not lift up the blanket to look for it. It is only at 8–12 months that infants begin to show a developing awareness of object permanence. Now, when shown an interesting object that then disappears under a blanket, they will pick up the blanket to find it. However, their grasp of object permanence at this age is still rudimentary, as Piaget showed by making the task slightly more complicated. After an 8–12 month old successfully solved the object-under-the-blanket task several times, Piaget introduced a second blanket next to the first, showed the infant the object, and this time placed it under the second blanket. Infants at this age then looked for the object—but not under the second blanket, where they had just seen it hidden, but under the first blanket, where they had found it before! Piaget called this the A-not-B error. The infants were used to finding the object under blanket A, so they continued to look under blanket A, not blanket B, even after they had seen the object hidden under blanket B. To Piaget, this error indicated that the infants believed that their own action of looking under blanket A was what had caused the object to reappear. They did not understand that the object continued to exist irrespective of their actions, so they did not yet fully grasp object permanence. Limited understanding of object permanence could explain why infants love the game “peek-a-boo,” in which adults cover their face with their hands or an object (such as a cloth), then suddenly reveal it. One study found that this game was played by adults and infants across a diverse range of cultures, including Brazil, Greece, India, Iran, Indonesia, South Korea, and South Africa (Fernald & O’Neill, 1993). Infants everywhere delighted in the game, and across cultures there were developmental changes. In the early months, infants enjoyed the game but responded only when the other person’s face reappeared. Beginning at about 5 months, babies would begin to smile and laugh even before the other person reappeared, indicating that they were anticipating the event. By 12 months old infants would initiate the game themselves, by holding a cloth up to the adult’s face or putting it over their own. Perhaps infants everywhere love “peek-a-boo” because to them, given their limited understanding of object permanence, the other person’s face seems to disappear when it is obscured, then suddenly, magically reappears.

Evaluating Piaget’s Sensorimotor Theory

4.11

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Summarize the major critiques of Piaget’s sensorimotor theory. You may have noticed that some of the examples discussed previously involved Piaget’s children. Actually, Piaget initially based his theory of sensorimotor development on his careful observations and experiments with his own three children, Laurent, Lucienne, and Jacqueline. It is remarkable—and it is a testimony to Piaget’s brilliance—that a theory based on just three children within the same Swiss family became the reigning theory of infant cognitive development. Even today, over 70 years after he first proposed it, Piaget’s theory of infant cognitive development remains influential. Like all good theories, it has inspired a wealth of research (by Piaget and many others) to test its assertions and implications. And, like even the best theories, it has been modified and altered on the basis of research (Morra et al., 2008). In recent decades, methods of testing infants’ cognitive abilities have become much more technologically advanced. Studies using these methods have generally concluded that Piaget’s theory was correct in its overall description of infant cognitive development (Marcovitch et al., 2003). However, some critics argue that the theory may have underestimated infants’ cognitive abilities, especially with regard to object permanence.

Section 2 Cognitive Development Infants’ motor development occurs along with their cognitive development, so when they fail to look under a blanket for a hidden object, could it be they lack the motor coordination to search for the object rather than that they believe it is has disappeared? One line of research by Renee Baillargeon and colleagues has tested this hypothesis by using the “violation of expectations method.” This method is based on the assumption that infants will look longer at an event that has violated their expectations, and if they look longer at an event violating the rule of object permanence this indicates some understanding of object permanence, without requiring any motor movements. For example, at age 5–6 months, infants will look longer when a toy they have seen hidden at one spot in a sandbox emerges from a different spot (Baillargeon, 2008; Newcombe & Huttenlocher, 2006). This seems to indicate an expectation that it should have emerged from the same spot, as a permanent object would. Even at 2–3 months infants look longer at events that are physically impossible (Wang et al., 2005), perhaps showing a more advanced understanding of objects than Piaget would have predicted. Some critics of Piaget’s sensorimotor theory argue that mistakes regarding object permanence may reflect memory development rather than a failure to understand the properties of objects. For example, with respect to the A-not-B error, the longer the delay between hiding the object under blanket B and the infant’s attempts to find it, the higher the likelihood of making the error, suggesting that with a longer delay the infant may simply have forgotten where it was placed (Diamond, 1985). Another criticism of Piaget’s sensorimotor theory is cultural (Maynard, 2008). The theory was originally based on his own three Swiss children, and nearly all subsequent research has been on children in the West (Mistry & Saraswathi, 2003). However, one of the few non-Western studies, of infants in Ivory Coast, found that infants there developed through the sensorimotor stages earlier than Piaget had described (Dasen et al., 1978), perhaps because their parents encouraged them to develop motor skills. Overall, however, Piaget’s sensorimotor theory has held up well over many decades. Many parts of it have been supported by research, and so far no other comprehensive theory has come along to replace it. However, the information processing approach described next views infant cognitive development quite differently.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

151

THINKING CULTURALLY Among some cultures, such as the Maya of Mexico, parents view a child’s development as proceeding along a set course and therefore offer little external stimulation. How does this contrast to the American ideal of providing a lot of cognitive stimulation?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. According to Piaget, how much of an effect does the environment have on our cognitive development? 2. How do secondary circular reactions differ from primary circular reactions? 3. What is the A-not-B error and how is it used to measure infants’ understanding of object permanence? 4. What role does memory play in infants’ mastery of object permanence?

Information Processing in Infancy Piaget’s theory and the research it inspired focuses on how thinking changes with age. To Piaget, we do not simply have a greater cognitive capacity as we age and develop, we actually think differently at each life stage. The information processing approach to understanding cognitive development is quite different. Rather than viewing cognitive development as discontinuous, that is, as separated into distinct stages, the way Piaget did, the information processing approach views cognitive change as continuous, meaning gradual and steady. In this view, cognitive processes remain essentially the same over time (Halford, 2005). The focus is not on how mental structures and ways of thinking change with age but on the thinking processes that exist at all ages. Nevertheless, some studies of information processing

information processing approach approach to understanding cognitive functioning that focuses on cognitive processes that exist at all ages, rather than on viewing cognitive developing in terms of discontinuous stages

152

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

compare people of various ages to show how thinking capacities change developmentally. The original model for the information processing approach was the computer (Hunt, 1989). Information processing researchers Attention Stimulus and theorists have tried to break down human thinking into sepaInformation Sensory Short-term/ Response rate parts in the same way the functions of a computer are sepamemory working memory rated into capacities for attention, processing, and memory. In the case of object permanence, for example, someone taking the inforFigure 4.7 s Information Processing Model mation processing approach would examine how infants draw their attention to the most The components of the model operate relevant aspects of the problem, process the results of each trial, remember the results, and simultaneously. retrieve the results from previous trials to compare to the most recent trial. In this way the information processing approach is a componential approach (Sternberg, 1983), because it involves breaking down the thinking process into its various components. Recent models of information processing have moved away from a simple computer analogy and recognize that the brain is more complex than any computer (Ashcraft, 2009). Rather than occurring in a step-by-step fashion as in a computer, in humans the different components of thinking operate simultaneously, as Figure 4.7 illustrates. Nevertheless, the focus of Simulate the Experiment information processing remains on the components of the thinking process, especially attenThe Information Processing Model tion and memory. Let’s look next at how attention and memory develop during infancy. at MyDevelopmentLab Long-term memory

Attention

4.12

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

habituation gradual decrease in attention to a stimulus aftere repeated presentations dishabituation following habituation, the revival of attention when a new stimulus is presented

Explain how attention and habituation change during infancy. Information processing begins with stimulus information that enters the senses, but much of what you see, hear, and touch is processed no further. For example, as you read this, there may be sounds in the environment, other sights in your visual field, and the feeling of your body in the seat where you are reading, but if you are focusing on what you are reading most of this information goes no further than sensory memory. The only information you proceed to process is the information on which you focus your attention. In infants the study of attention has focused on habituation, which is the gradual decrease in attention to a stimulus after repeated presentations. For example, infants will look longer at a toy the first time it is presented than the fourth or fifth time. A complementary concept, dishabituation, is the revival of attention when a new stimulus is presented following several presentations of a previous stimulus. For example, if you show infants a picture of the same face several times in a row, then show a new face, they will generally dishabituate to the new face, that is, they will pay more attention to it than to the “old” face. Habituation and dishabituation can be studied by monitoring infants’ looking behavior, but infants rarely lay still for long even if they are paying attention to something, so two other methods have been frequently used: heart rate (heart rate declines when a new stimulus is presented and gradually rises as habituation takes place) and sucking rate (infants suck on a pacifier more frequently when a new stimulus is presented and gradually decline in their sucking rate with habituation). During the course of the first year of life, it takes less and less time for habituation to occur. When presented with a visual stimulus, neonates may take several minutes before they show signs of habituating (by changing their looking time, heart rate, or sucking rate). By 4–5 months old, habituation in a similar experiment takes only about 10 seconds, and by 7–8 months only a few seconds (Domsch et al., 2010; Kavsek & Bornstein, 2010). This appears to be because with age infants become more efficient at perceiving and processing a stimulus. Even when they are a few months old, infants of the same age vary in their rates of habituation, and these individual differences tend to be stable over time. Some infants are more efficient than others at processing information; consequently, they habituate more quickly. Infants who habituate relatively slowly appear to do so not because they are especially good at sustaining their attention but because they seem to get stuck on the stimulus and have difficulty disengaging from it. Speed of habituation positively predicts memory

Section 2 Cognitive Development

153

ability on other tasks in infancy, as well as later performance on intelligence tests (Courage et al., 2004; Rose et al., 2005). In the second half of the first year, infants’ patterns of attention become increasingly social. They direct their attention not just to whatever sensations are most stimulating but to what the people around them are attending to, engaging in joint attention. By the end of the first year they often notice what important people around them are paying attention to, and will look or point in the same direction. One experiment showed that 10-month-old infants were less likely to look or point in the direction an adult was faced if the adult’s eyes were closed or blindfolded, indicating that the infants were aware of the adults’ attentional patterns and matched their own to them (Brooks & Meltzoff, 2005). Joint attention is the basis not just of infants’ information processing development but of language and emotional communication (Van Hecke et al., 2007). This makes sense; one way infants and children learn new words is to observe what another person is doing or looking at when they use a word. Often this takes place during social interactions between infants and others, but it can also take place from infants observing where the attention of another person is directed. As we will see in more detail later in the chapter, not all cultures encourage social interactions with infants. A cultural analysis of this issue showed that in cultures where social interactions with adults are limited, infants and young children learn a great deal of their language by observing adults’ language use and “listening in,” that is, using joint attention to discern the meaning of words (Akhtar, 2005).

Memory Explain how short-term and long-term memory expand during infancy. Infants’ memory abilities expand greatly during the first year of life, both for short-term and for long-term memory. One reflection of the development of short-term memory is their improvement in the object permanence task. As noted earlier, object permanence is a test of short-term memory as well as a test of knowledge of the properties of objects. Memory studies using object permanence tasks show that the number of locations infants can remember and search to look for a hidden object increases sharply in the second half of the first year (Morra et al., 2008). Long-term memory also improves notably over the course of the first year. In one experiment, researchers tied a string to the foot of infants 2 to 6 months old and taught them to move a mobile hanging above their cribs by kicking their foot (Rovee-Collier, 1999). The 2-month-olds forgot the training within a week—they no longer kicked to make the mobile move when the string was tied to their legs—but the 6-month-olds remembered it for about three weeks, demonstrating their longer long-term memories. Further experiments showed an interesting distinction between recognition memory and recall memory (Hildreth et al., 2003). After the mobile-kicking trick appeared to be lost from the infants’ memories, the researchers gave the infants a hint by making the mobile move. The infants recognized this clue and began kicking again to make the mobile move, up to a month later, even though they had been unable to recall the memory before being prompted. The older the infant was, the more effective the prompting. From infancy onward, recognition memory comes easier to us than recall memory (Flavell et al., 2002).

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What are the key features of the information processing approach and how does it differ from the cognitive-developmental approach? 2. What is the difference between habituation and dishabituation? 3. How is joint attention related to language development? 4. How does memory change during infancy, especially with regard to recognition and recall memory?

Joint attention develops by the end of the first year.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.13

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE Are the cognitive-developmental and information processing approaches to cognitive development incompatible, or could they combined?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

154

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

Assessing Infant Development Given the many remarkable changes in development that happen over the course of the first year, researchers have long been interested in evaluating infants to see if they are developing normally. These assessments include cognitive development as well as other aspects of development. We’ll also evaluate efforts to improve infants’ cognitive development through media stimulation.

Approaches to Assessing Development

4.14

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe the major scales used in measuring infant development and explain how habituation assessments are used to predict later intelligence. There are a variety of methods used to measure infant development, including the scales approach of Gesell and Bayley. More recently, research on infants’ cognitive development has focused on information processing, especially the processes of attention and memory. THE SCALES OF GESELL AND BAYLEY One approach to assessing infant development was pioneered by Arnold Gesell (1934, 1946). Gesell constructed an assessment of infant development that included four subscales: motor skills (such as sitting), language use, adaptive behavior (such as exploring a new object), and personal–social behavior (such as using a spoon). Following the model of intelligence tests, which produce an intelligence quotient (IQ) as an overall measure of mental abilities, Gesell combined the results of his assessment into a developmental quotient (DQ) as an overall measure of infants’ developmental progress. Just as for IQs, for DQs 100 is set as the median or middle score. Gesell recognized that what he had produced was different from an IQ test, but he hoped it would be similarly useful for assessing current abilities and predicting future development. Gesell’s scale for infants is no longer used, but his approach was continued by Nancy Bayley, who produced the Bayley Scales of Infant Development, now in their third edition, the Bayley-III (Bayley, 2005). The Bayley-III can assess development from age 3 months to age 3½ years. There are three main scales on the Bayley-III: 1. Cognitive Scale. This scale measures mental abilities such as attention and exploration. For example, at 6 months it assesses whether the baby looks at pictures in a book; at 23–25 months it assesses whether a child can match similar pictures. 2. Language Scale. This scale measures use and understanding of language. For example, at 17–19 months it assesses whether the child can identify objects in a picture, and at 38–42 months it assesses whether the child can name four colors. 3. Motor Scale. This scale measures fine and gross motor abilities, such as sitting alone for 30 seconds at 6 months, or hopping twice on one foot at 38–42 months.

developmental quotient (DQ) in assessments of infant development, the overall score indicating developmental progress median in a distribution of data, the score that is precisely in the middle, with half the distribution lying above and half below Bayley Scales of Infant Development widely used assessment of infant development from age 3 months to 3½ years

As with Gesell’s scales, the Bayley scales produce an overall DQ. However, one problem with the Bayley scales is that the reliability of the scales is low (see Chapter 1 for information on reliability). Consequently, especially at the youngest ages, an infant’s score on one occasion may be quite different than the same infant’s score a week or a month later (Bornstein et al., 1997). Infants’ states of arousal and motivation vary greatly from one hour or even minute to the next, so an infant’s DQ in the testing session may simply reflect the state that he or she was in at the moment rather than more enduring and stable mental abilities. Neither Gesell’s assessment nor the Bayley scales predict later IQ or school performance well. In fact, Bayley scores in infancy hardly predict later development at all (Hack et al., 2005). If you look closely at the examples above, this should not be surprising, as the Bayley scales measure quite different kinds of abilities than the verbal and spatial abilities

Section 2 Cognitive Development

155

that later IQ tests measure and that school work requires. (Let’s face it, hopping on one foot is not likely to be predictive of any kind of school performance or any kind of work you are likely to do as an adult, unless you become a ballet dancer). The only exception to this is at the lower extreme. An infant who scores very low on the Bayley scales may have serious developmental problems. Consequently, the Bayley scales are used mainly as a screening tool, to identify infants who have serious problems in need of immediate attention, rather than as predictors of later development for children within the normal range. INFORMATION PROCESSING APPROACHES TO INFANT ASSESSMENT Efforts to predict later intelligence using information-processing approaches have shown greater promise. The focus of these approaches has been on habituation. As noted earlier, infants vary in how long it takes them to habituate to a new stimulus, such as a sight or a sound (Columbo, 2002). Some are “short-lookers” who habituate quickly, others are “long-lookers” who take more time and more presentations of the stimulus before they habituate. The shorter the habituation time, the more efficient the infant’s information processing abilities. They look for a shorter length of time because it takes them less time to take in and process information about the stimulus. Longitudinal studies have found that short-lookers in infancy tend to have higher IQ scores later in development than long-lookers do (Kavsek, 2004; Rose et al., 2005; Sigman et al., 2000). In one study, short-lookers in infancy had higher IQs and higher educational achievement when they were followed up 20 years later, in emerging adulthood (Fagan et al., 2007). Habituation assessments in infancy have also been found to be useful for identifying infants who have developmental problems (Kavsek & Bornstein, 2008). Furthermore, habituation assessments tend to be more reliable than assessments of DQ, that is, they are more likely to be consistent when measured across more than one occasion (Kavsek, 2004). The most recent version of the Bayley scales now includes a measure of habituation (Bayley, 2005), which may improve reliability and predictive validity above previous versions of the scale.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse You are a nurse in a West African village. You decide to use the Bayley Scales of Infant Development to assess infants’ development and discover that the children are all considered very low-performing. What might explain this?

Can Media Enhance Cognitive Development? The Myth of “Baby Einstein” Evaluate the claim that educational media enhance infants’ cognitive development. In addition to efforts to assess infants’ cognitive development, efforts have also been made to enhance it. One effort of this kind that has become popular in some developed countries is educational media products for infants. In the early 1990s a study was published claiming that listening to the music of Mozart enhanced cognitive functioning (Rauscher et al., 1993). The study was conducted with university students, not babies, and the “effect” lasted only 10 minutes, and subsequent studies failed to replicate even a 10-minute effect (Rauscher, 2003). Nevertheless, the study received worldwide attention and inspired the creation of a vast range of educational media products claiming to promote infants’ cognitive development. Do they work? The answer appears to be no. Many studies investigating this question have concluded that educational media products have no effect on infants’ cognitive development. In fact, one study of 8- to 16-month-olds found that for every hour of “educational” DVDs viewed per day, the DVD viewers understood 8 to 16 fewer words than babies who watched no DVDs (Guernsey, 2007). The authors interpreted this surprising finding as due to the fact that the DVD viewers may have spent less time interacting with the people around them. That is, they were watching DVDs instead of interacting socially, and the DVD watching did not compensate for the deficit in social interaction. Similar results were found

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.15

Educational media products for infants have not been demonstrated to enhance cognitive development.

156

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

Watch the Video Baby TV at MyDevelopmentLab

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

in another study (DeLoache et al., 2010). Fortunately, national studies have found that only 17% of babies in the United States watch educational media products for an hour or more per day, and the average is only about 13 minutes (Guernsey, 2007; Roberts & Foehr, 2004). These findings suggest that Piaget was right that children’s cognitive maturity has its own innate timetable and that it is fruitless (and perhaps even detrimental) to try to hurry it along. So what can you do to promote infants’ healthy cognitive development? Talk to them, read to them, respond to them—and be patient. They will grow up soon enough.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What was Gesell’s approach to measuring infant intelligence? 2. What are the features of the Bayley scale? How accurate are the scales in predicting later intelligence? 3. What is a new way of measuring infant intelligence and how successful is it? 4. Why should we be cautious about applying the “Mozart effect” to infants?

The Beginnings of Language

Watch the Video Language Development at MyDevelopmentLab

According to the traditional beliefs of the Beng people of Ivory Coast (in Africa), in the spirit world all people understand all languages (Gottlieb, 2000). Babies have just come from the spirit world when they are born, so they understand whatever is said in any language. However, during the first year, memory of all other languages fades and babies come to understand only the language they hear around them. Except for the part about the spirit world, this is actually a pretty accurate summary of how babies’ language development takes place in the course of the first year of life, as we will learn next. (See Table 4.3 for the milestones of infant language development.)

First Sounds and Words

4.16

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Watch the Video Language Learning at MyDevelopmentLab

Describe the course of language development over the first year of life. Very early on, babies begin to make the sounds that will eventually develop into language (Waxman & Lidz, 2006). First is cooing, the “oo-ing” and “ah-ing” and gurgling sounds babies make beginning at about 2 months old. Often cooing takes place in interactions with others, but sometimes it takes place without interactions, as if babies are discovering their vocal apparatus and trying out the sounds it can make.

TABLE 4.3 Milestones of Infant Language Development

cooing prelanguage “oo-ing” and “ah-ing,” and gurgling sounds babies make beginning at about 2 months old

Age

Milestone

2 months

Cooing (preverbal and gurgling sounds)

4–10 months

Babbling (repetitive consonant–vowel combinations)

8–10 months

First gestures (such as “bye-bye”)

10–12 months

Comprehension of words and simple sentences

12 months

First spoken word

Note: For each milestone there is a normal range, and babies who are somewhat later in reaching the milestones may nevertheless have normal language development.

Section 2 Cognitive Development By about 4-6 months old, cooing develops into babbling, repetitive consonant–vowel combinations such as “ba-ba-ba” or “do-do-do-do.” When my son Miles was 3-4 months old he repeated the sounds “ah-gee” so often that for awhile we called him “Mr. Ah-Gee.” Babbling appears to be universal among infants. In fact, babies the world over appear to babble with the same sounds initially, regardless of the language of their culture (Lee at al., 2010). Deaf infants exposed to sign language have a form of babbling, too, using their hands instead of sounds (van Beinum, 2008). However, after a couple of months, infants begin to babble in the sounds distinctive to their culture and cease to babble in sounds they have not heard used by the people around them. By the time infants are about 9 months old, untrained listeners can distinguish whether a recording of babbling is from an infant raised amidst French, Arabic, or Chinese (Oller et al., 1997). By around 8–10 months, infants begin to use gestures to communicate (GoldinMeadow, 2009). They may lift their arms up to indicate they wish to be picked up, or point to an object they would like to have brought to them, or hold out an object to offer it to someone else, or wave bye-bye. Using gestures is a way of evoking behavior from others (for example, being picked up after lifting their arms in request), and also a way of evoking verbal responses from others (such as a spoken “bye-bye” in response to the infant’s gestured bye-bye), at a time when infants still cannot produce words of their own. Infants’ first words usually are spoken a month or two before or after their first birthday. Typical first words include important people (“Mama,” “Dada”), familiar animals (“dog”), moving objects (“car”), foods (“milk”), and greetings or farewells (“hi,” “bye-bye”) (Waxman & Lidz, 2006). Most infants can speak only a few words, at most, by the end of their first year, but they understand many more words than they can speak. In fact, at all ages, language comprehension (the words we understand) exceeds language production (the words we use), but the difference is especially striking and notable during infancy. Even as early as 4 months old infants can recognize their own name (Mandel et al., 1995). By their first birthday, although infants can speak only a word or two they understand about 50 words (Menyuk et al., 1995). The foundations of language comprehension are evident very early, in the abilities of infants to recognize changes in language sounds (Werker & Fennell, 2009). To test this ability, researchers play a spoken sound repeatedly for an infant (for example, “ba, ba, ba, ba”), then change it slightly (“pa, pa, pa pa”). If an infant looks in the direction of the sound when it changes, this is taken to indicate awareness of the change. Even when only a few weeks old, infants show this awareness (Saffran et al., 2006). Furthermore, like babbling, discrimination of simple sounds appears to be universal at first, but becomes more specialized toward the end of the first year to the language of the infant’s culture. In one study, American and Japanese infants were compared at 6 and 12 months (Iverson et al., 2003). At 6 months, the American and Japanese infants were equally responsive to the distinction between “ra” and “la,” even though there are no “r” or “l” sounds in the Japanese language, so the Japanese infants would not have heard this distinction before. However, by 12 months old the American infants could still recognize the “r” versus “l” distinction but the Japanese infants could not, as their language skills were now more specialized to their own language.

157

babbling repetitive prelanguage consonant–vowel combinations such as “ba-ba-ba” or “do-do-dodo,” made by infants universally beginnning at about 6 months old

Watch the Video Speech Development at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Stimulating Language Development at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE How do the findings just presented on language development relate to Piaget’s concept of maturation?

Infant-Directed (ID) speech Describe how cultures vary in their stimulation of language development. Suppose you were to say to an adult, “Would you like something to eat?” How would you say it? Now imagine saying the same thing to an infant. Would you change how you said it?

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.17

158

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

Adults in many cultures use infant-directed speech, with high pitch and exaggerated intonation.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Researcher You are conducting research in Samoa and notice that parents there do not use “baby talk” or infant-directed speech with their infants. You thought that this was a universal practice. How can infants learn to talk if no one is talking to them, especially in simpler “baby talk?”

infant-directed (ID) speech special form of speech that adults in many cultures direct toward infants, in which the pitch of the voice becomes higher than in normal speech, the intonation is exaggerated, and words and phrases are repeated

In many cultures, people speak in a special way to infants, called infant-directed (ID) speech (Bryant & Barrett, 2007). In ID speech, the pitch of the voice becomes higher than in normal speech, and the intonation is exaggerated. Grammar is simplified, and words and phrases are more likely to be repeated than in normal speech. Topics of ID speech often pertain to objects (“Look at the birdie! See the birdie?”) or emotional communication (“What a good girl! You ate your applesauce!”). Why do people often use ID speech with infants? One reason is that the infants seem to like it. Even when ID speech is in a language they do not understand, infants show a preference for it by the time they are 4 months old, as indicated by paying greater attention to ID speech in an unfamiliar language than to non-ID speech in the same language (Singh, 2009). And why do infants like ID speech? One theory is that infants prefer it because it is more emotionally charged than other speech (Trainor et al., 2000). Also, at a time when language is still new to them, ID speech helps infants unravel language’s mysteries. The exaggeration and repetition of words gives infants cues to their meaning (Soderstrom, 2007). By exaggerating the sounds used in making words, ID speech provides infants with information about the building blocks of speech they will use in the language of their culture (Kuhl, 2004). The exaggerations of ID speech also separate speech into specific words and phrases more clearly than normal speech does (Thiessen et al., 2005). ID speech is common in Western cultures (Bryant & Barrett, 2007). Japanese studies have also found that ID speech is common (Mazuka & Tadahis, 2008). Outside the developed countries, however, there is more variability. Some traditional cultures use ID speech, such as the Fulani of West Africa, who say single words and phrases to their infants from their very first days of life in an effort to stimulate their language development (Johnson, 2000). However, in other traditional cultures parents do not use ID speech and make no special effort to speak to infants. For example, among the Gusii of Kenya, parents speak to infants substantially less than American parents do (Levine, 1994; Richman et al., 2010). Remember little Makori, the Gusii baby introduced at the beginning of the chapter? The Gusii, like people in many traditional cultures, carry their infants around almost constantly and have a great deal of physical contact with them, including cosleeping at night, but they do not view it as necessary or useful to speak to infants. Similarly, the Ifaluk people of Micronesia believe there is no point in speaking to infants because they cannot understand what you say (Le, 2000). Nevertheless, despite receiving no ID speech, children in these cultures learn their language fluently within a few years, just as children in cultures with ID speech do. Does this mean you do not need to speak to your own infants, in your culture? Definitely not. In cultures such as the Gusii and the Ifaluk parents may not speak directly to their infants very often, but infants are part of a language-rich environment all day long. Although no one spoke directly to Makori, he was surrounded by conversation from his mother, sister, and other relatives. Instead of spending the day with one parent and perhaps a sibling, as infants do in cultures where ID speech is common, infants in traditional cultures typically have many adults and children around them in the course of the day. Families are bigger, extended family members live either in the same household or nearby, and interactions with other community members are more common (Akhtar & Tomasello, 2000). Perhaps ID speech developed because, in the small nuclear families that are typical of Western countries today, without ID speech infants may have very little other language stimulation. The success of children in traditional cultures in learning their languages despite having no ID speech shows that listening to others’ conversations in a language-rich environment is also an effective way of acquiring a language (Akhtar, 2005).

Section 2 Cognitive Development By the end of their first year infants have laid an important foundation for language and can comprehend many words, but their language production is still very limited. The real explosion in language development comes in the second year, so in the next chapter we will examine the origins and growth of language in greater detail.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

159

Watch the Video Child-Directed Speech at MyDevelopmentLab

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. Which develops first in infants’ language, comprehension or production? How do we know this? 2. At what age are infants able to distinguish between their native language and other languages? 3. What is ID speech and why do infants prefer it? 4. Why is ID speech more common in Western cultures? Are children in cultures without ID speech delayed in their language development? Why or why not?

Section 2 VIDEO GUIDE Object Permanence Across Cultures (Length: 3:56) In this video we see demonstrations of children at various ages being tested to see if they grasp the concept of object permanence or not. The children from many different cultures show that this is a universal concept.

1. According to this video, object permanence is universal across cultures. Why would this be such an important concept for children to acquire? 2. What game is commonly played with babies that can be connected to object permanence and why? 3. Do you feel that object permanence can be related to the early development of trust? Why or why not?

Watch the Video Object Permanence Across Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab

SECTION 3

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 4.18 Define infant temperament and describe three ways of conceptualizing it. 4.19 Explain how the idea of goodness-of-fit pertains to temperament on both a family level and a cultural level. 4.20 Identify the primary emotions and describe how they develop during infancy. 4.21 Describe infants’ emotional perceptions and how their emotions become increasingly social over the first year. 4.22 List the main features of infants’ social worlds across cultures. 4.23 Compare and contrast the two major theories of infants’ social development.

Temperament

Watch the Video Temperament at MyDevelopmentLab

Have you had any experience in caring for infants, perhaps as a babysitter, older sibling, or parent? If so, you have probably observed that they differ from early on in how they respond to you and to the environment. As a parent I have certainly observed this in my twins, who have had virtually the same environment all their lives and yet are very different in their emotional responses and expressions. Ask any parents of more than one child about this issue, and they will probably tell a similar tale (Reiss et al., 2006). In the study of human development, these kinds of differences in emotionality are viewed as indicators of temperament. Temperament includes qualities such as activity level, irritability, soothability, emotional reactivity, and sociability. You can think of temperament as the biologically based raw material of personality (Goldsmith 2009; Rothbart et al., 2000). Researchers on temperament believe that all infants are born with certain tendencies toward behavior and personality development, and the environment then shapes those tendencies in the course of development. Let’s look at three related ways of conceptualizing temperament, then at some of the challenges involved in measuring and studying it (see Table 4.4 for a summary).

Conceptualizing Temperament: Three Approaches

4.18

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

temperament innate responses to the physical and social environment, including qualities of activity level, irritability, soothability, emotional reactivity, and sociability

160

Define infant temperament and describe three ways of conceptualizing it. Temperament was originally proposed as a psychological concept by Alexander Thomas and Stella Chess, who in 1956 began the New York Longitudinal Study (NYLS). Thomas and Chess wanted to see how infants’ innate tendencies would be shaped into personality in the course of development through childhood and adolescence. Using parents’ reports, which we will discuss in detail in the Research Focus: Measuring Temperament feature on page 162, they assessed infant temperament by judging qualities such as activity level, adaptability, intensity of reactions, and quality of mood. On this basis the infants were classified into three categories: easy, difficult, and slow-to-warm-up.

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

161

TABLE 4.4 Three Conceptions of Infant Temperament Thomas and Chess

Rothbart

Buss and Plomin

Quality

Description

Quality

Description

Quality

Description

Activity level

Ratio of active time to inactive time

Activity level

Frequency and intensity of gross motor activity

Activity

Overall activity level

Attention span

Length of time devoted to an activity before moving on to the next

Attention span/ Persistence

Duration of attention to a single activity

Attention span

Duration of attention to a single activity

Intensity of reaction

Emotional expressiveness, e.g., crying, laughing

Fearful distress

Fear/distress in response to novel or intense stimulation

Emotionality

Emotional reactivity

Rhythmicity

Regularity of physical functions such as feeding and sleeping

Irritable distress

Expression of distress when frustrated

Soothability

Responsiveness to attempts to soothe when distressed

Distractibility

Extent to which new stimulation stops current behavior, e.g. when crying

Positive affect

Frequency of expression of happiness and other positive emotions

Sociability

Degree of interest in others, positive or negative responses to social Interactions

Approach/ Withdrawal

Response to new object or person

Self-regulation

Ability to suppress an initial response to a situation and execute a more adaptive response

Adaptability

Adjustment to changes in routines

Threshold of responsiveness

Stimulation required to evoke a response

Quality of mood

General level of happy versus unhappy mood

Based on: Buss & Plomin (1984); Rothbart et al. (2000); Thomas & Chess (1977).

1. Easy babies (40% of the sample) were those whose moods were generally positive. They adapted well to new situations and were generally moderate rather than extreme in their emotional reactions. 2. Difficult babies (10%) did not adapt well to new situations, and their moods were intensely negative more frequently than other babies. 3. Slow-to-warm-up babies (15%) were notably low in activity level, reacted negatively to new situations, and had fewer positive or negative emotional extremes than other babies. By following these babies into adulthood in their longitudinal study, Thomas and Chess were able to show that temperament in infancy predicted later development in some respects (Chess & Thomas, 1984; Ramos et al., 2005; Thomas et al., 1968). The difficult babies in their study were at high risk for problems in childhood, such as aggressive behavior, anxiety, and social withdrawal. Slow-to-warm-up babies rarely seemed to have problems in early childhood, but once they entered school they were sometimes fearful and had problems academically and with peers because of their relatively slow responsiveness. Perhaps you noticed that the three categories in the classic Thomas and Chess study only added up to 65% of the infants they studied. The other 35% could not be classified as easy, difficult, or slow-to-warm-up. It is clearly a problem to exclude 35% of infants, so other temperament researchers have avoided categories, instead rating all infants on the basis of temperamental traits.

Watch the Video Temperament: Easy at MyDevelopmentLab Watch the Video Temperament: Difficult at MyDevelopmentLab Watch the Video Temperament: Inhibited at MyDevelopmentLab

162

C h ap ter 4

Infancy Mary Rothbart and her colleagues have kept some of the Thomas and Chess temperament qualities, such as activity level and attention span, but they added a dimension of self-regulation, the ability to manage negative emotions (Rothbart, 2004; Rothbart et al., 2009). Similarly, David Buss and Robert Plomin (1984) include activity level and intensity of emotional reactions (which they call “emotionality”) in their model, but add sociability, which refers to positive or negative responses to social interactions. Both models have been moderately successful in predicting children’s functioning from infant temperament (Buss, 1995; Rothbart & Bates, 2006).

RESEARCH FOCUS

T

Measuring Temperament

casion when the infant may have been in an unusually bad or emperament is conceptualized as an innate, biologigood mood. Of course, this takes considerably more time and cally based quality that is the basis of personality demoney than a simple parental questionnaire, and even a series velopment. However, when Thomas and Chess began of observations may not be as valid as the experiences parents studying temperament, no biological measurements were accumulate over months of caring for their infants. Another available, so they used parents’ reports of infants’ behavior approach has been to have parents keep daily diaries of their as the source of their temperament classifications. Even toinfants’ behavior (e.g., sleeping, fussing, crying). Reports using day, most studies of infant temperament are based on parthis method have been shown to correlate ents’ reports (Rothbart & Bates, 2006). well with temperament ratings based on paThere are some clear advantages to using rental reports or performance on laboratory parents’ reports. After all, parents see their intasks (Atella et al., 2003; St. James-Roberts fants in many different situations on a daily & Plewis, 1996). basis over a long period of time. In contrast, Because temperament is regarded as a researcher who assesses temperament on biologically based, it makes sense to have the basis of the infants’ performance on tasks biological assessments of it, especially now administered in the laboratory sees the infant that the tools for such assessments are widely only on that one occasion. Because infants’ available (Joyce, 2010). One simple but efstates change so frequently, the researcher fective biological measure of infant temperamay assess infants as having a “difficult” temment is heart rate. Extremely shy children perament when in fact the infant is simply in a tend to have consistently high heart rates, temporary state of distress—hungry, perhaps, beginning in infancy (Kagan, 2003). Also, or tired, or cold, or hot, or in need of a diaper their heart rates show a greater increase in change. Parental reports of infant temperaresponse to new stimulation such as new ment on questionnaires are also quick, inextoys, new smells, or new people; compared to pensive, and easy to administer. other children (Kagan, 1998). In one longituHowever, parents are not always accurate dinal study, infants who were highly reactive appraisers of their infants’ behavior. For examto new stimulation at 4 months of age had ple, mothers’ prenatal beliefs about children’s higher heart rates before birth as well as at 2 tendencies predict their later ratings of their inweeks of age (Kagan, 1994). fants’ temperament (Kiang et al., 2004). MothOther biological assessments of temperaers who are depressed are more likely to rate ment have been developed, including meatheir infants’ temperament negatively, perhaps Temperament is difficult to assess in sures of brain activity. We will discuss those asbecause they find even normal infant behavior a research setting because infants’ sessments in later chapters, as they have been more stressful than other mothers do (Clarke- emotional states fluctuate so much. made in toddlerhood and early childhood Stewart et al., 2000). Mothers’ and fathers’ rather than in infancy. Although infant temperament can predict ratings of their infants’ temperament show only low to moderate later development to some extent, predictions are more accurate levels of agreement (Atella et al., 2003). Parents tend to rate their when assessments of temperament are made after age 2 (Joyce, twins or other siblings as less similar in temperament than research2010; Kagan & Fox, 2006). Fussing, crying, and rapid changes in ers do, and this has been interpreted as indicating that parents exstates are common in infancy across a wide range of infants. It is aggerate the differences between their children (Saudino, 2003). only after age 2 that children’s moods and behavior settle into more What are the options besides parents’ reports? Thomas and stable patterns that predict later development. But can temperaChess recommend that researchers observe infants’ behavior ment still be assumed to be innate and biologically-based once the in naturalistic settings (e.g., at home, at the park) on several environment has been experienced for two years or more? occasions, to avoid the problem of observing on just one oc-

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

163

Goodness-of-Fit Explain how the idea of goodness-of-fit pertains to temperament on both a family level and a cultural level. Across the three conceptualizations, the core of temperament seems to be in activity level, attention span, and a general tendency toward positive or negative emotions. All three approaches also view temperament as the raw material of personality, which is then shaped by the environment. Thomas and Chess (1977) proposed the concept of goodness-of-fit, meaning that children develop best if there is a good fit between the temperament of the child and environmental demands. In their view, difficult and slow-to-warm-up babies need parents who are aware of their temperaments and willing to be especially patient and nurturing. Subsequent studies have provided support for the idea of goodness-of-fit, finding that babies with negative temperamental qualities were able to learn to control their emotional reactions better by age 3 if their parents were understanding and tolerant (Warren & Simmens, 2005). Other research has shown that babies who are low in emotional reactivity respond more favorably to face-to-face interaction with a parent than babies who are high in emotional reactivity (Jahromi et al., 2004). Conversely, parents who respond to an infant’s difficult temperament with anger and frustration are likely to find that the infant becomes a child who is defiant and disobedient, leading to further conflict and frustration for both parents and children (Calkins, 2002). There may also be something like a cultural goodness-of-fit, given that different cultures have different views of the value of personality traits such as activity level and emotional expressiveness. In general, Asian babies have been found to be less active and irritable than babies in the United States and Canada, and appear to learn self-regulation earlier and easier (Chen et al., 2005; Lewis et al., 1993). This temperamental difference may be, in part, the basis for differences later in childhood, such as Asian children being more likely to be shy. However, in contrast to the North American view of shyness as a problem to be overcome, in Asian cultures, shyness is viewed more positively. The child—and the adult—who listens rather than speaks is respected and admired. Consequently, studies of Chinese children have shown that shyness is associated with academic success and being well liked by peers (Chen et al., 1995). Now that China is changing so rapidly, both culturally and economically, there is some evidence that shyness is becoming less valued and related to poor rather than favorable adjustment in childhood (Chen, 2011; Chen et al., 2005). We’ll cover more on this in later chapters.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What do the main ways of conceptualizing and measuring temperament have in common? 2. What dimension did Mary Rothbart and her colleagues add to the Thomas and Chess model of temperament? 3. What does sociability refer to, as conceptualized by Buss and Plomin? 4. Give an example of how goodness-of-fit varies from one culture to the next.

Infants’ Emotions Expressing and understanding emotions goes deep into our biological nature. As Charles Darwin observed in 1872 in The Expression of Emotions in Man and Animals, the strong similarity between emotional expressions in humans and other mammals indicates that human emotional expressions are part of a long evolutionary history. Tigers

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.19

goodness-of-fit theoretical principle that children develop best if there is a good fit between the temperament of the child and environmental demands

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

164

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

primary emotions most basic emotions, such as anger, fear, disgust, surprise, and happiness secondary emotions emotions that require social learning, such as embarrassment, shame, and guilt; also called sociomoral emotions

snarl, wolves growl, chimpanzees—and humans, too—bare their teeth and scream. Darwin also observed that emotional expressions were highly similar among humans in different cultures. Recent researchers have confirmed that people in various cultures can easily identify the emotions expressed in photographs of people from outside their culture (Ekman, 2003).

Primary Emotions

4.20

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Identify the primary emotions and describe how they develop during infancy.

Infants are born with a limited range of emotions that become differentiated into a wider range in the course of the early years of life. Studies of emotional development distinguish between two broad classes of emotion (Lewis, 2008). Primary emotions are the most basic emotions, the ones we share with animals, such as anger, fear, disgust, surprise, and happiness. Primary emotions are all evident within the first year of life. Secondary Simulate the Experiment Facial emotions are emotions that require social learning, such as embarrassment, shame, and Expressions of Emotion at MyDevelopmentLab guilt. Secondary emotions are also called sociomoral emotions, because infants are not born knowing what is embarrassing or shameful but have to learn this from their social environment. Secondary emotions develop mostly in the second year of life, so we will look at the development of primary emotions here and secondary emotions in Chapter 5. Three primary emotions are evident in the early weeks of life: distress, interest, and pleasure (Lewis, 2008; 2002). Distress is evident in crying, of course, and we have seen in this chapter how infants’ interest can be assessed from the first days of life by where they turn their attention. We have also seen, in Chapter 3, that neonates show a facial expression of pleasure when tasting a sweet substance. Gradually in the first months of life these three emotions become differentiated into other primary emotions: distress into anger, sadness, and fear; interest into surprise; and pleasure into happiness. Let’s look at how each of these primary emotions develops over the first year. Anger is expressed early in the form of a distinctive anger cry, as described in Chapter 3, but as an emotional expression separate from crying it shows development over the course of the first year (Dodge et al., 2006; Lewis, 2010). In one study of infants at 1, 4, and 7 months of age, the babies’ responses were observed as their forearms were held down so that they could not move them for a few minutes, a condition none of them liked much (Oster et al., 1992). The 1-month-old infants showed clear distress, but raters (who did not know the hypotheses of the study) did not classify their distress responses as anger. The 4-month-old infants were also distressed, but about half of them showed their distress in facial expressions that could be clearly identified as anger. By 7 months, nearly all the infants showed a definite anger response. Another study also observed the clear expression of anger in 7-month-olds, in response to having an attractive object taken away (Stenberg et al., 1983). As infants become capable of intentional behavior in the second half of the first year, their expressions of anger often occur when their intentions are thwarted (Izard & Ackerman, 2000). Sadness is rare in the first year of life, except for infants with depressed mothers. When mothers are depressed, by 2–3 Infants universally exhibit the primary emotions. Can you tell months old infants, too, show facial expressions of sadness which primary emotion is represented in each photograph?

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development (Herrera et al., 2004). Could this be a case of passive genotype l environment interactions? Perhaps both infants and mothers have a genetic predisposition toward sadness in such families. This is something to consider, but in one study nondepressed mothers were instructed to look depressed in a 3-minute interaction with their infants (Cohn & Tronick, 1983). The infants responded with distress, suggesting that sad infants with depressed mothers are responding to their mothers’ sadness rather than being genetically predisposed to sad emotional expressions. Fear develops by 6 months of age (Gartstein et al., 2010). By then infants show facial expressions of fear, for example in response to a toy that moves toward them suddenly and unexpectedly (Buss & Goldsmith, 1998). Fear also becomes social at this age, as infants begin to show stranger anxiety in response to unfamiliar adults (Grossman et al., 2005). Stranger anxiety is a sign that the infant has begun to develop attachments to familiar persons, a topic we will discuss in detail in Chapter 5. Surprise, indicated by an open mouth and raised eyebrows, is first evident about half way through the first year (Camras et al., 1996). It is most often elicited by something in the infant’s perceptual world that violates expectations. For example, a toy such as a jack-inthe-box might elicit surprise, especially the first time the jack pops out. Finally, the development of happiness is evident in changes in infants’ smiles and laughter that take place during the early months. After a few weeks, infants begin to smile in response to certain kinds of sensory stimulation—after feeding, or while urinating, or while having their cheeks stroked (Murkoff et al., 2003). However, it is not until the second or third month of life that the first social smile appears, an expression of happiness in response to interacting with others (Fogel et al., 2006). The first laughs occur about a month after the first smiles (Nwokah et al., 1999). Beginning at this age both smiles and laughs can be elicited by social interactions or by sensory or perceptual events, such as tickling or kisses or games such as peek-a-boo (Fogel et al., 2006). By the end of the first year, infants have several different kinds of smiles that they show in response to different people and in different situations (Bolzani et al., 2002).

165

Watch the Video Basic Emotions at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Social and Personality Development at MyDevelopmentLab

Infants’ Emotional Perceptions Describe infants’ emotional perceptions and how their emotions become increasingly social over the first year. Infants not only communicate emotions from the first days of life, they also perceive others’ emotions. At just a few days old, neonates who hear another neonate cry often begin crying themselves, a phenomenon called emotional contagion (Geangu et al., 2010). This response shows that they recognize and respond to the cry as a signal of distress (Gazzaniga, 2009). Furthermore, they are more likely to cry in response to the cry of a fellow neonate than in response to an older infant’s cry, a chimpanzee’s cry, or a recording of their own cry, showing that they are remarkably perceptive at discriminating among cries. At first, infants are better at perceiving emotions by hearing than by seeing. Remember, their auditory system is more developed than their visual system in the early weeks of life. When shown faces in the early weeks, neonates tend to look mainly at the boundaries and edges rather than at the internal features such as mouth and eyes that are most likely to express emotion. By 2–3 months old, infants’ eyesight has improved substantially and they have begun to be able to discriminate between happy, sad, and angry faces (Haan et al., 2009; Hunnius et al., 2011). To test this, researchers often use a habituation method. In this method, infants are presented with the same photograph of the same facial expression repeatedly until they no longer show any interest in it, that is, they become habituated. Then they are shown the same face with a different facial expression, and if they look longer at the new facial expression this is taken to indicate that they have noticed the difference. Another interesting way of showing that infants perceive emotions is to show no emotion at all. By age 2–3 months, when parents interacting with their infants are told by

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.21

social smile expression of happiness in response to interacting with others, first appearing at age 2–3 months emotional contagion in infants, crying in response to hearing another infant cry, evident beginning at just a few days old

166

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

social referencing term for process of becoming more adept at observing others’ emotional responses to ambiguous and uncertain situations, and using that information to shape one’s own emotional responses

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

researchers to show no emotion for a time, the infants respond with distress (Adamson & Frick, 2003; Tronick, 2007). This method, known as the still-face paradigm, shows that infants quickly learn to expect certain emotional reactions from others, especially others who are familiar and important to them (Mesman et al., 2009). More generally, infants’ responses to the still-face paradigm demonstrate that from early on emotions are experienced through relations with others rather than originating only within the individual (Tronick, 2007). In the early weeks of life infants have smiles that are stimulated by internal states and cries that may be due to being hungry, tired, or cold, but infants soon learn to discern others’ emotions and adjust their own emotions in response. By the time they are just 2–3 months old, when infants vocalize or smile they expect the others they know and trust to respond in expected ways, as they have in the past, which is why the still-face paradigm disturbs infants so much. Another indicator of the development of emotional perception during the first year is in infants’ abilities to match auditory and visual emotion. In studies on this topic, infants in the laboratory are shown two photographs with markedly different emotions, such as happiness and sadness. Then a vocal recording is played, matching one of the facial emotions but not the other, and the infants’ attention is monitored. By the time they are 7 months old, infants look more at the face that matches the emotion of the voice, showing that they expect the two to go together (Kahana-Kalman & Walker-Andrews, 2001; Soken & Pick, 1999). Gradually over the first year, infants become more adept at observing others’ emotional responses to ambiguous and uncertain situations and using that information to shape their own emotional responses. Known as social referencing, this is an important way that infants learn about the world around them. In studies testing social referencing abilities, typically a mother and infant in a laboratory situation are given an unfamiliar toy to play with, and the mother is instructed by the researchers to show positive or negative emotion in relation to the toy. Subsequently, the infant will generally play with the toy if the mother showed positive emotion toward it but avoid it if the mother’s emotion was negative. This response appears by the time infants are about 9–10 months old (Mumme & Fernald, 2003).

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. How do secondary emotions differ from primary emotions? 2. At what age do infants develop stranger anxiety to unfamiliar adults? 3. What do infant responses to the still-face paradigm demonstrate about their emotions? 4. How do researchers test social referencing in an experimental setting?

The Social World of the Infant The social world of the infant is a crucial part of understanding infant development, because it affects every aspect of development, from physical and motor development to cognitive, emotional, and, of course, social development. Humans are built for social interactions and social relationships from Day 1. We have seen many examples of this here and in Chapter 3. Human infants recognize the smell and voice of their mother from the first few days of life. When they cry it is often some kind of social interaction that soothes them. They learn about the world through joint attention and social referencing. And so on. Humans’ social environments grow gradually more complex in the course of development as they enter new contexts such as school, community, and workplace. During

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

167

infancy, social experience and social development occurs within a relatively small circle, a group of persons who are part of the infant’s daily environment, and usually there is one person who provides the most love and care—typically, but not always, the mother. Here, let’s look first at the broad cultural pattern of the infant’s social world, then at two theories of infant social development.

Cultural Themes of Infant Social Life List the main features of infants’ social worlds across cultures. Although cultures vary in their customs of infant care, as they vary in most aspects of human development, there are several themes that occur frequently across cultures. If we combine what scholars have learned from observing infants in a variety of different cultures today, along with what other scholars have learned from studying human evolutionary history and the history of human societies, a common picture of the social world of the infant emerges (DeLoache & Gottlieb, 2000; Leakey, 1994; Levine, 1977; Levine et al., 1994; Richman et al., 2010; Small, 2005), characterized by the following features: 1. Infants are with their mothers almost constantly for the early months of life. Nearly all cultures have a period (usually 1–6 months) following birth when mother and infant do little but rest and recover from the birth together. After this rest period is over, the infant is typically strapped to the mother’s back with a cloth as she goes back to her daily duties. 2. After about 6 months, most daily infant care is done by older girls rather than the mother. Once infants reach about 6 months old their care is delegated to older girls (usually 6 to 10 years old) so that the mother can devote her energy and attention to her work. Most often the girl is an older sister, but it could be any of a range of other people such as an older brother, cousin, grandmother, aunt, or a girl hired from outside the family. However, at night the infant sleeps with the mother. 3. Infants are among many other people in the course of a day. In addition to the mother and the caregiver who takes over at about age 6 months, infants are around many other people in the course of a day, such as siblings, aunts, cousins, grandparents, and neighbors. 4. Infants are held or carried almost constantly. In many traditional cultures, infants rarely touch the ground during their early months of life. This practice comes out of the belief that infants are highly vulnerable and must be shielded from dangers. Holding them close is a way of protecting them, and also a way of keeping them comforted, quiet, and manageable. 5. Fathers are usually remote or absent during the first year. As we saw in Chapter 3, in most cultures only women are allowed to observe and assist at birth, and this exclusion of men often continues during the first year. Fathers are rarely involved in the direct care of infants, partly because mothers breast-feed their infants frequently but also because care of infants is typically believed to be part of a woman’s role but not a man’s. These features are still the dominant worldwide pattern in developing countries (Richman et al., 2010; Small, 2005), but the pattern in developed countries has become quite different over the past two centuries, especially in Western countries. The typical social environment for infants in developed countries is the “nuclear family” consisting of a mother, father (perhaps), and (perhaps) one sibling. Most infants in Western developed countries sleep in a separate room from the time they are born (Goldberg & Keller, 2007). Mother and infant are alone together for much of the time, and the infant may be left in a crib, stroller, or infant seat for a substantial proportion of the day (Baildum et al., 2000).

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

4.22

THINKING CULTURALLY Of the five features of the infant’s social world described here, how many are similar to and how many are different from the culture you are from? What do you think explains the differences?

Infants in many cultures are surrounded by adults all day, but cultures vary in how much the adults interact with infants. Here, two mothers and their babies with other family members and friends in the Samburu culture of Kenya.

168

C h ap ter 4

Infancy

trust-versus-mistrust in Erikson’s psychosocial theory, the first stage of development, during infancy, in which the central crisis is the need to establish a stable attachment to a loving and nurturing caregiver attachment theory Bowlby’s theory of emotional and social development, focusing on the crucial importance of the infant’s relationship with the primary caregiver

Watch the Video Parent-Child Attachments at MyDevelopmentLab

Fathers in developed countries today are more involved than ever in infant care, although still not usually as much as mothers are (Hawkins et al., 2008; Lewis et al., 2009). Nevertheless, like infants in developing countries, infants in developed countries nearly always grow up to be capable of functioning well socially in their culture. They develop friendships with peers, they find adults outside the family with whom they form relationships, such as teachers, and they grow to adulthood and form work relationships and intimate relationships with persons outside the family, with most eventually starting a new family of their own. Clearly infants can develop well socially in a variety of cultural contexts. What seems to be crucial to infants’ social development across cultures is to have at least one social relationship with someone who is devoted to their care, as we will see next.

The Foundation of Social Development: Two Theories

4.23

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Both Erikson and Bowlby viewed the first attachment relationship as crucial to future emotional and social development.

Compare and contrast the two major theories of infants’ social development. The two most influential theories of infants’ social development are by Erik Erikson and John Bowlby. As introduced in Chapter 1, Erikson proposed an eight-stage theory of the life span, with a specific developmental challenge or “crisis” for each stage. For infancy, the central crisis in Erikson’ theory is trust versus mistrust (Erikson, 1950). Erikson recognized how dependent infants are on others for their survival, and this dependence is at the heart of the idea of trust versus mistrust. Because they require others to provide for their needs, they must have someone who can be trusted to care for them and to be a reliable source of nourishment, warmth, love, and protection. Usually this caregiver is the mother, in most cultures, but it could also be a father, grandmother, older sister, or anyone else who provided love and care on a consistent basis. It is not the biological tie that is important but the emotional and social bond. When infants have a caregiver who provides for them in these ways, they develop a basic trust in their social world. They come to believe that others will be trustworthy, and to believe that they themselves are worthy of love. However, if adequate love and care are lacking in the first year, infants may come to mistrust not only their first caregiver but others in their social world. They learn that they cannot count on the goodwill of others, and they may shrink from social relations in a world that seems harsh and unfriendly. This basic trust or mistrust lasts long beyond infancy. Remember, in Erikson’s theory each stage builds on previous stages, for better or worse. Developing trust in infancy provides a strong foundation for all future social development, whereas developing mistrust is likely to be problematic not only in infancy but in future life stages. A similar theory of infant social development was proposed a few years later by John Bowlby (1967). Like Erikson’s theory, Bowlby’s attachment theory focused on the crucial importance of the infant’s relationship with the primary caregiver. Like Erikson, Bowlby believed that the quality of this first important social relationship influenced emotional and social development not only in infancy but in later stages of development as well. Like Erikson, Bowlby viewed trust as the key issue in the infant’s first attachment to another person. In Bowlby’s terms, if the primary caregiver is sensitive and responsive in caring for the infant, the infant will learn that others, too, can be trusted in social relationships. However, if these qualities are lacking in the primary caregiver, the infant will come to expect—in infancy and in later development—that others, too, may not be reliable social partners. There are also important differences between the two theories. As we learned in Chapter 1, Erikson’s psychosocial theory was a deliberate contrast to Freud’s psychosexual theory. However, Bowlby’s theory had quite different origins, in evolutionary theory and in research on mother–offspring relationships in animal species. Also, Bowlby’s theory inspired methods for evaluating the infant–caregiver

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development relationship that led to a research literature that now comprises thousands of studies (Cassidy & Shaver, 2008; Grossman et al., 2005). Most of this research has been on toddlers rather than infants, so we will save a detailed analysis of Bowlby’s theory and the research it generated for the next chapter.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

Watch the Video Attachment at MyDevelopmentLab

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. What are some common themes of infant social life in non-Western cultures, and how do typical practices in Western cultures differ? 2. Why are infants in traditional cultures held or carried almost constantly? 3. According to Erikson’s theory, how does the development of trust or mistrust in infancy affect later development? 4. What two qualities did Bowlby identify as important for the primary caregiver to have?

Section 3 VIDEO GUIDE Social Referencing (Length: 1:04) This is a brief video of a demonstration of an adult and child interacting.

1. In this demonstration, the adult stops singing and begins to ignore the child. What was the purpose of this ceasing of the interaction? 2. We see the child smile at a person or object off camera, but then choosing to still interact with the adult on camera. Does this have any significance and why? 3. What do you feel is the objective of the demonstration in this video?

Watch the Video Social Referencing at MyDevelopmentLab

169

Summing Up Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab Listen at MyDevelopmentLab

Listen to an audio file of your chapter at MyDevelopmentLab

SECTION 1 PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT 4.1 Explain the gains in height and weight that typically take place in the first year, and the two basic principles of physical growth. The physical developments of infancy include a tripling of weight and an inch-per-month growth in height. The cephalocaudal principle means that physical growth tends to begin at the top, with the head, and then proceeds downward to the rest of the body. The proximodistal principle means that growth proceeds from the middle of the body outward.

4.2 Explain how and when teething occurs, and how to soothe it. For most infants the first tooth appears between 5 and 9 months of age. Teething pain can be soothed with something to bite or chew on or something cold to drink or eat, or by using medications.

4.3 Identify the different parts of the brain and describe how the brain changes in the first few years of life. The brain is separated into two hemispheres connected by the corpus callosum, and each hemisphere has four lobes with distinct functions. Brain development in infancy is concentrated in the expansion of dendritic connections and myelination. Studies of infants and children exposed to extreme deprivation indicate that the brain is especially vulnerable in the first year of life.

4.4 Describe how infant sleep changes in the course of the first year and evaluate the risk factors for SIDS, including the research evidence regarding cosleeping. Sleep needs for American infants decline during the first year. SIDS is most common at age 2–4 months. Sleeping on the back rather than the stomach greatly reduces the risk of SIDS. In cultures where infants sleep alongside their mothers on a firm surface the risk of SIDS is very low. Historically and worldwide today, mother–infant cosleeping is far more common than putting babies to sleep in a room of their own.

4.5 Describe how infants’ nutritional needs change during the first year of life and identify the reasons and consequences for malnutrition in infancy. The best way to obtain good high-fat nutrition during infancy is through breast milk. The timing of the introduction of solid food varies among cultures, from the first week of life to some time in the second half of the first year. Malnutrition in infancy is usually due mainly to the mother being unable or unwilling to breast-feed.

4.6 List the major causes and preventive methods of infant mortality and describe some cultural approaches to protecting infants. Malnutrition is a common source of infant mortality, but the most common source is diarrhea. Diarrhea can be cured by oral rehydration therapy (ORT), though access to clean water makes this treatment unavailable in some parts of the world. The cultural practices of secluding infants in their early weeks, cosleeping with them, and constantly carrying them developed out of long and painful human experience with high infant mortality.

4.7 Describe the major changes during infancy in gross and fine motor development. Achievements in gross motor development in infancy include rolling over, crawling, and standing. Cultural differences in restricting or encouraging gross motor development make a slight difference in the timing of gross motor achievements, but little difference in the long run. Reaching and grasping are two of the fine motor milestones of the first year.

4.8 Describe when and how infants develop depth perception and intermodal perception. Increased adeptness at binocular vision around 3 months of age enables infants to develop depth perception during the first year. Infants also become better at intermodal perception or coordinating their senses.

KEY TERMS cephalocaudal principle p. 129

overproduction/exuberance p. 131 myelination p. 131

sudden infant death syndrome (SIDS) p. 134

gross motor development p. 140

proximodistal principle p. 130 teething p. 130

synaptic pruning p. 131

cosleeping p. 134

opposable thumb p. 144

neurotransmitter p. 131

cerebral cortex p. 132

custom complex p. 135

depth perception p. 145

axon p. 131

lateralization p. 132

marasmus p. 137

binocular vision p. 145

dendrite p. 131

plasticity p. 132

oral rehydration therapy (ORT) p. 138

intermodal perception p. 145

170

fine motor development p. 141

Chapt er 4

SECTION 2

SUMMARY

171

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

4.9 Describe the meaning of maturation, schemes, assimilation, and accommodation. Maturation is the biologically-based program of development. Piaget proposed that the child’s construction of reality takes place through the use of schemes, which are cognitive structures for processing, organizing, and interpreting information. The two processes involved in the use of schemes are assimilation and accommodation. Assimilation occurs when new information is altered to fit an existing scheme. In contrast, accommodation entails changing the scheme to adapt to the new information.

4.10 Describe the first four sensorimotor substages and explain how object permanence develops over the course of the first year. Substage 1 is based on neonatal reflexes; 2 is based more on purposeful behavior; 3 entails the repetition of movements that first occurred by chance; and 4 is based on intentional, goal-directed behavior. Object permanence has begun to develop by the end of infancy, but it is not complete until the end of the second year.

4.11 Summarize the major critiques of Piaget’s sensorimotor theory. Some critics argue that the theory may have underestimated infants’ cognitive abilities. Another criticism of Piaget is cultural, because nearly all research has been on children in the West.

4.12 Explain how attention and habituation change during infancy. Infants pay more attention to a stimulus they have not seen before. Habituation develops more quickly during the course of the first year, and at any given age, quickness of habituation is positively related to later cognitive achievements. Increasingly during the first year, infants learn from joint attention with others.

4.13 Explain how short-term and long-term memory expand during infancy. Both short-term and long-term memory improve notably over the course of the first year, though recognition memory comes easier than recall memory.

4.14 Describe the major scales used in measuring infant development and explain how habituation assessments are used to predict later intelligence. The Bayley scales are widely used to measure infants’ development, but scores on the Bayley do not predict later cognitive development. Efforts to predict later intelligence using information processing approaches have shown greater promise. These assessments measure habituation by distinguish between “shortlookers” and “long-lookers,” with short-lookers higher in later intelligence.

4.15 Evaluate the claim that educational media enhance infants’ cognitive development. Many studies investigating this question have concluded that educational media products have no effect on infants’ cognitive development and may even be detrimental.

4.16 Describe the course of language development over the first year of life. When they first begin to babble at about 6 months, infants use a wide range of sounds, but within a few months they more often make the sounds from main language they hear around them. First words are usually spoken around the end of the first year; infants can already understand about 50 words by this time.

4.17 Describe how cultures vary in their stimulation of language development. Many cultures use infant-directed (ID) speech to their babies, and babies appear to enjoy hearing it. However, even in cultures that do not use ID speech children become adept users of language by the time they are a few years old.

KEY TERMS Bayley Scales of Infant Development p. 154

mental structure p. 147

assimilation p. 148

habituation p. 152

cognitive-developmental approach p. 147

accommodation p. 148

dishabituation p. 152

sensorimotor stage p. 148 object permanence p. 149

developmental quotient (DQ) p. 154

cooing p. 156

maturation p. 147 schemes p. 148

information processing approach p. 151

median p. 154

infant-directed (ID) speech p. 158

babbling p. 157

SECTION 3 SOCIAL AND EMOTIONAL DEVELOPMENT 4.18 Define infant temperament and describe three ways of conceptualizing it. Temperament includes qualities such as activity level, attention span, and emotional reactivity. Thomas and Chess conceptualized temperament by classifying

infants as easy, difficult, and slow-to-warm-up. Rothbart and colleagues added a dimension of self-regulation, the ability to manage negative emotions, and Buss and Plomin added sociability, which refers to positive or negative responses to social interactions.

172

C h ap ter 4

S U M M A RY

4.19 Explain how the idea of goodness-of-fit pertains to temperament on both a family level and a cultural level. Goodness-of-fit means that children develop best if there is a “good fit” between the temperament of the child and environmental demands. It varies culturally, given that different cultures have different views of the value of personality traits such as emotional expressiveness.

4.20 Identify the primary emotions and describe how they develop during infancy. Primary emotions such as anger, fear, and happiness are evident within a few months after birth, although sadness tends to develop after infancy.

4.21 Describe infants’ emotional perceptions and how their emotions become increasingly social over the first year. Infants are socially aware of others’ emotions from the first days of life, and respond with distress to the distress

of others. Toward the end of the first year they draw emotional cues from how others respond to ambiguous situations.

4.22 List the main features of infants’ social worlds across cultures. Infants are typically cared for by their mothers (in early months) and then by older siblings. They are surrounded by other people and held or carried often. In Western developed countries infants have a smaller social world and more time alone, but they also learn to function socially.

4.23 Compare and contrast the two major theories of infants’ social development. The key to healthy social development, according to Erikson and Bowlby, is a strong, reliable attachment to a primary caregiver. Their theories differ in their origins and Bowlby’s theory has inspired thousands of studies.

KEY TERMS temperament p. 160

secondary emotions p. 164

emotional contagion p. 165

trust-versus-mistrust p. 168

goodness-of-fit p. 163

social smile p. 165

social referencing p. 166

attachment theory p. 168

primary emotions p. 164

Practice Test Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab 1. Siwen goes to the doctor and expresses concern that her infant’s head is too big for his body. The doctor tells her that this is normal because of a. the fact that head size varies widely. b. the cephalocaudal principle. c. the proximodistal principle. d. the fact that after infancy, growth slows down considerably. 2. If Salma is typical of most infants, a. his first tooth will appear at 18 months. b. his teething will be accompanied by increased saliva production. c. he will experience colic throughout the entire teething process. d. he will sleep better than he did before teething because sleep provides relief from the pain. 3. Tara and Paul adopted their baby daughter, Oksana, from a Romanian orphanage 5 years ago. She was physically and emotionally deprived until they adopted her at age 2½. It is most likely that Oksana a. stayed underweight for much of her life. b. had more cognitive impairment than she would have had if she had been adopted before 6 months of age. c. will have greater brain plasticity later in development because of her nurturing environment. d. will show no signs of cognitive impairment due to synaptic pruning. 4. SIDS is almost unknown in cultures where cosleeping is the norm because a. babies tend to sleep on hard mats.

b. parents tend to put cloth on both sides of their babies so they remain on their sides. c. babies are less likely to be breast-fed and therefore, parents are less likely to roll over on them. d. babies are less likely to be aroused during the night in these quieter settings. 5. Marasmus is a. a disease common among malnourished women with HIV. b. most common during childhood and contracted through breast milk. c. an infant disease characterized by muscle atrophy and abnormal drowsiness. d. a deadly disease resulting from contaminated water being used to dilute formula. 6. If you were a pediatrician working in a developing country, you would likely use oral rehydration therapy to treat a. dysentery. b. diarrhea. c. small pox and malaria. d. yellow fever. 7. Mahori was strapped to his mother’s back for the first year of his life. Which of the following statements is true? a. Mahori’s parents gave him extra “tummy time” to develop his muscles. b. Mahori’s motor development will be similar to an American child if they are compared during kindergarten. c. The sequence of his motor development will be different from that of babies in cultures where walking during infancy is actively encouraged.

Chapt er 4 d. When it comes to Mahori’s motor development, environment plays a stronger role than genetics. 8. The key to depth perception is a. the development of the pincer grasp. b. the development of intermodal perception. c. being able to walk. d. binocular vision, the ability to combine the images of each eye into one image. 9. Little Rupert goes to the market with his mother and calls all men he sees “Dada.” This is an example of a. a secondary circular reaction. b. The A-not-B error. c. assimilation. d. coordination of secondary schemes. 10. Maha starts to begin rooting while being held by her mother’s friend, who quickly passes Maha back to her mother to be breast-fed. Based on Piaget’s sensorimotor substages, how old is Maha? a. 0–1 month b. 1–4 months c. 4–8 months d. 8–12 months 11. Critics of Piaget’s sensorimotor theory argue that the likelihood of making the A-not-B error depends on a. the sex of the child. b. the time of day the child is tested. c. the delay between hiding and searching. d. the color of the object. 12. Speed of ______________ is a good predictor of later memory and intelligence. a. habituation b. making the A-not-B error c. accommodation d. secondary circular reactions 13. John is able to name all of the state capitals without his teacher providing any hints. This is an example of a. recognition memory. b. joint attention. c. recall memory. d. habituation. 14. Scores on the Bayley Scales of Infant Development a. are useful as a screening tool because those who score very low may have developmental problems. b. are predictive of later IQ or school performance. c. are no longer used because they are considered out of date. d. are calculated for use with children ages 3 months to 9 years. 15. Compared to infants who do not watch educational programming, those who watch 2-3 hours per day a. learn to speak earlier. b. score higher on cognitive tests. c. show no verbal or cognitive advantage. d. develop better attention spans. 16. Babbling a. is found only in infants from the Western Hemisphere. b. occurs only if the infant can hear.

SUMMARY

173

c. develops before cooing. d. is universal. 17. Use of infant-directed speech a. is less common in cultures outside the West. b. leads to slower development of language than the style of language typically spoken with adults. c. involves speaking in a lower than normal tone and using less repetition than in normal speech. d. has been shown to be less interesting to babies than normal speech; a reason why many parents do not use this type of “baby talk.” 18. Temperament a. has been measured using the same nine components across various studies. b. has only been assessed using cross-sectional methods. c. is considered to have a biological basis. d. has no bearing whatsoever on later development. 19. Which of the following best illustrates a good fit between caregiver and child? a. an irritable baby who is reared by parents who are rigid and intolerant b. a “difficult” infant whose parents respond with anger and frustration c. a slow-to-warm-up baby whose parents are understanding and tolerant d. a baby with a tendency toward negative emotions whose parents try to overcome this by encouraging face-to-face interactions with others 20. Of the emotions listed below, ______________ is the emotion an infant would likely display later in development than the others. a. fear b. shame c. disgust d. anger 21. When mothers waiting on the “deep side” of the visual cliff express fearful emotions, none of their 12-month-old infants are willing to cross. This finding illustrates a. habituation. b. social referencing. c. the still-face paradigm. d. goodness-of-fit. 22. Which of the following is a common feature of infant social life in most cultures throughout history? a. Infants spend a lot of their day in the company of their fathers. b. Infants are cared for exclusively by their mothers until they become old enough to walk. c. Infants are often kept away from older adults so that they’ll be less vulnerable to the spread of disease. d. Infants are surrounded by others and carried or held almost constantly. 23. Erikson and Bowlby both view ______________ as the key issue in an infant’s attachment to others. a. love b. trust c. age d. personality

5 174

Toddlerhood

Section 1 PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT Growth and Change in Years 2 and 3 Bodily Growth Brain Development Sleep and (More) Teething Motor Development

Socializing Physical Functions: Toilet Training and Weaning Toilet Training Weaning

Section 2 COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT Cognitive Development Theories Cognitive Development in Toddlerhood: Piaget’s Theory Vygotsky’s Cultural Theory of Cognitive Development

Language Development The Biological and Evolutionary Bases of Language Milestones of Toddler Language: From First Words to Fluency Learning Language in a Social and Cultural Context

Section 3 EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT Emotional Development in Toddlerhood Toddlers’ Emotions The Birth of the Self Gender Identity and the Biology of Gender Development

One Special Person: Attachment Theory and Research Attachment Theory Quality of Attachment Critiques of Attachment Theory

The Social World of the Toddler The Role of Fathers The Wider Social World: Siblings, Peers, and Friends Autism: A Disruption in Social Development Media Use in Toddlerhood

Summing Up

175

SOMETIMES ON A PLEASANT DAY I WALK TO A NEARBY PARK TO HAVE MY LUNCH, and one day recently as I was sitting

walk without support; by their third birthday toddlers can run, jump, and climb stairs. On their first birthday infants speak only a handful

at a picnic table eating my chili dog and potato chips, I observed two

of words; by their third birthday toddlers have achieved remarkable

moms and their young children at the adjacent table. Each mom had an

fluency in the language of their culture and are able to understand

infant about 6 months old in a stroller, and the infants lay in their stroll-

and speak about nearly any topic under the sun. On their first birth-

ers peacefully, each of them examining a soft colorful toy the mom had

day infants have little in the way of emotional regulation, and show

given them. One mom also had a boy who appeared to be perhaps 3 or

their anger and their exuberance with equal unrestraint; by their third

4 years old. The boy wandered back and forth between the moms and

birthday, toddlers have begun to grasp well the moral worldview of

the playground, climbing on the ladders and sliding down slides, return-

their culture, and they exhibit the sociomoral emotions of guilt, em-

ing to the picnic table occasionally for food or just to check in.

barrassment, and shame. On their first birthday the social world

The other mom had a girl who appeared to be perhaps 2 years

of most infants is limited to parents, siblings, and perhaps some ex-

old, and it was this toddler who drew the

tended family members; but by their third birth-

most attention. Unlike the infants, who were

day toddlers’ social world has greatly expanded.

knowledge and consent, the toddler was

moving around constantly, climbing on the

picnic table, peering into the stroller at her little sister, chasing a squirrel, curiously pick-





not going anywhere without their moms’

“By their third birthday, toddlers’ social world has greatly expanded.

ing up items off the ground. Unlike the older

Anthropologist Margaret Mead (1930/2001) described the change from infancy to toddlerhood as going from being a “lap child,” in almost constant physical contact with the mother, to being a “knee child” who is attached to the mother but also spends a lot of time in a wider social

boy, the toddler could not be allowed to go off on her own because

circle—especially with siblings and older children as part of a mixed-

she had less of a sense of what was safe and what to avoid. At one

age play group.

point she climbed on the picnic table and stood precariously on one of

In this chapter we examine all of these changes in detail, begin-

the seats, then slipped and hurt her leg, crying until her mother came

ning with the physical changes of toddlerhood, including physical

and soothed her. She did not speak much herself, unlike the older boy,

growth, motor development, and the socialization of physical func-

but she was the subject of many statements from her mother and

tions through toilet training and weaning. Then we focus on theories

she seemed to understand whatever she was told: “Would you like

of cognitive development and look at language development, from the

some juice?” “Look at the squirrel!” “Don’t pick that up, it’s yucky.”

evolutionary basis of language to the burst of language use that begins

When the moms and their children finally left the park, the boy helped

at about 18 months of age, to the social and cultural context of lan-

his mother push the stroller, while the other mom carried her toddler

guage development. Finally, we look at socioemotional development

daughter on her hip as she pushed her other daughter along.

in toddlerhood, including the development of the sociomoral emotions

Development during toddlerhood, the second and third years

and emotional regulation, the birth of the self, gender development,

of life, rivals development during infancy for events of drama and

attachments to mothers and others, and the toddler’s widening social

importance. On their first birthday most infants are barely able to

world.

176

SECTION 1

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 5.1 Describe the typical changes in physical growth that take place in toddlerhood and explain the harmful effects of nutritional deficiencies on growth. 5.2 Describe the changes in brain development that take place during toddlerhood, and identify the two most common methods of measuring brain activity. 5.3 Describe the changes in sleeping patterns and sleeping arrangements that take place during toddlerhood. 5.4 Describe the advances in motor development that take place during toddlerhood. 5.5 Compare and contrast the process and timing of toilet training in developed countries and traditional cultures. 5.6 Distinguish the weaning process early in infancy from weaning later in toddlerhood.

Growth and Change in Years 2 and 3 During the second and third years of life, physical growth slows down from its blazing pace of the first year, but it remains more rapid than it will be at any later time of life. This is true for bodily growth as well as for brain development. Sleep patterns change substantially, too, in years 2 and 3. Toddlerhood is also a time of dramatic advances in both gross and fine motor development.

Bodily Growth Describe the typical changes in physical growth that take place in toddlerhood and explain the harmful effects of nutritional deficiencies on growth.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.1

The growth of the body is swift and steady during the toddler years. Figure 5.1 on page 178 shows the changes in height and weight for American girls. Patterns of growth are similar in other developed countries (UNICEF, 2009). Throughout childhood the average boy is slightly taller and heavier than the average girl. During toddlerhood, children lose the “baby fat” of infancy and become leaner as they become longer (Fomon & Nelson, 2002). They no longer need as much fat to keep their bodies at a constant temperature. Also, the head, which was one-fourth of the neonate’s length, is one-fifth of the 2-year-old’s height. The rest of the body will continue to grow faster than the head, and by adulthood the head will be one-eighth the size of the whole body. Toddlers in developing countries often do not grow as rapidly as toddlers in developed countries. Typically, at birth and for the first 6 months of life, rates of growth are similar in developed countries and developing countries (Levine et al., 1994), because during the early months infants in most cultures rely mainly on breast milk or infant formula and eat little solid food. However, starting around 6 months of age, when they begin eating solid food as a larger part of their diet, children in developing countries receive less protein and begin to lag in their growth. According to the World Health Organization (WHO, 2010), about one-fourth of children worldwide have diets that are deficient in protein, nearly all of them in developing countries. By the time they reach

177

178

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

in

cm

41.3 105

Height Weight

~37 in

Percentiles: Birth to 36 Months (Girls)

39.4 100 37.4

95

35.4

90

33.5

85

31.5

80

95th 90th 75th 50th 25th 10th 5th

~34 in

kg

lb

17

37.5

16

35.3

15

33.1

14

30.9

13

28.7

12

26.5

11

24.3

45

10

22.0

40

9

19.8

8

17.6

7

15.4

6

13.2

5

11.0

4

8.8

3

6.6

2

4.4

~29 in

29.5

95th

75

90th 27.6

70

25.6

65

23.6

19.7

50th

60

25th

55

10th 5th

50

~30 lb 17.7 15.7

~26 lb

~21 lb

Toddlers lose a lot of their “baby fat” and often become leaner as they grow longer. This is my daughter Paris at 4 months and 18 months.

Birth

3

6

9

12

15 18 21 Age in Months

24

27

30

33

Percentiles: Birth to 36 Months (Girls)

21.7

75th

36

Figure 5.1 s Growth Chart for American Girls From Birth Through Age 3 Growth slows from infancy to toddlerhood but remains rapid. Source: Based on National Center for Health Statistics

kwashiorkor protein deficiency in childhood, leading to symptoms such as lethargy, irritability, thinning hair, and swollen body, which may be fatal if not treated micronutrients dietary ingredients essential to optimal physical growth, including iodine, iron, zinc, and vitamins A, B12, C, and D

Toddlers who do not receive enough protein in their diets sometimes suffer from kwashiorkor, as in this boy in Uganda.

their first birthday, the height and weight of average children in developing countries are comparable to the bottom 5% of children in developed countries, and this pattern continues through childhood into adulthood. Protein deficiency not only limits the growth of children in developing countries but it makes them vulnerable to disease and early death. One outcome specific to toddlerhood is kwashiorkor, in which protein deficiency leads to a range of symptoms such as lethargy, irritability, and thinning hair (Medline, 2008). Often the body swells with water, especially the belly. Toddlers with kwashiorkor may be getting enough food in the form of starches such as rice, bread, or potatoes, but not enough protein. Kwashiorkor lowers the effectiveness of the immune system, making toddlers more vulnerable to disease, and over time can lead to coma followed by death. Improved protein intake can relieve the symptoms of kwashiorkor, but earlier damage to physical and cognitive development is likely to be permanent. In addition to protein, toddlers need a diet that contains micronutrients such as iron, zinc, and vitamins A, B12, C, and D. Perhaps the most crucial micronutrient deficiency worldwide is iodine. About one-third of the world’s population has a dietary deficiency of iodine, especially in Africa and South Asia (Zimmermann et al., 2008). In young children a lack of iodine inhibits cognitive development, resulting in an estimated IQ (intelligence quotient) deficiency of 10 to 15 points, a substantial margin. Fortunately, adding iodine to a diet is simple—through iodized salt—and cheap, costing only a few cents per person per year. Unfortunately, one-third of the world’s children still lack this simple micronutrient. Some children in developed countries also lack sufficient micronutrients. One national study of toddlers in the United States found that iron deficiency prevalence rates were about 7% overall and were twice as high among Latino toddlers (12%) as among White or African American toddlers (both 6%; Brotanek et al., 2007). Iron deficiency makes toddlers tired and irritable.

Section 1 Physical Development

179

Brain Development Describe the changes in brain development that take place during toddlerhood, and identify the two most common methods of measuring brain activity. The brain continues its rapid growth during the toddler years. As noted in Chapter 4, it is not the production of new brain cells that marks early brain development. In fact, the brain has only about one-half as many neurons at age 2 as it did at birth. What most distinguishes early brain development is the steep increase in synaptic density, the number of synaptic connections among neurons (Huttenlocher, 2003). These connections multiply immensely in the first 3 years, and toddlerhood is when peak production of new synapses is reached in the frontal lobes, the part of our brain that is the location of many of our most distinctively human cognitive qualities, such as reasoning, planning, and creativity. During toddlerhood new synapses in the frontal cortex are produced at the mind-boggling rate of 2 million per second, reaching a total by age 2 of more than 100 trillion (see Figure 5.2; Johnson, 2001; Shonkoff & Phillips, 2000). The peak of synaptic density comes right at the end of toddlerhood, around the third birthday (Thompson & Nelson, 2001). After the peak of synaptic density, a long process of synaptic pruning begins. In synaptic pruning, the connections between neurons become fewer but more efficient, with the synapses that are used becoming more developed, while unused synapses wither away (see Chapter 4). Synaptic pruning will remove about one-third of synapses in the frontal cortex from early childhood to adolescence, and after a new burst of synaptic density in early adolescence the process of synaptic pruning will continue at a slower rate through adolescence and into adulthood (Blakemore, 2008; Thompson, 2001). Methods of assessing brain activity provide evidence of the rapid growth of the toddler brain. One widely used method, the EEG (electroencephalogram), measures the electrical activity of the cerebral cortex. Every time a synapse fires it emits a tiny burst of electricity, which allows researchers to measure the overall activity of the cerebral cortex as well as activation of specific parts of it. EEG research on toddlers has found a sharp increase in overall cortical activity from 18 to 24 months (Bell & Wolfe, 2008), reflecting important advances in cognitive and language development that we will examine later in this chapter. Another common method, fMRI (functional magnetic resonance imaging), requires a person to lie still inside a machine that uses a magnetic field to record changes in blood flow and oxygen use in the brain in response to different kinds of stimulation, such as music (see Figure 5.3 on page 180). Unlike the EEG, an fMRI can detect activity in any

At birth

1 month

3 months

15 months

24 months

Figure 5.2 s Changes in Synaptic Density From Birth to Age 2 Synaptic connections increase throughout the first 2 years, with the greatest density occurring at the end of toddlerhood. Source: Conel, 1930/1963

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.2

synaptic density density of synapses among neurons in the brain; peaks around age 3 EEG (electroencephalogram) device that measures the electrical activity of the cerebral cortex, allowing researchers to measure overall activity of the cerebral cortex as well as activation of specific parts of it fMRI (functional magnetic resonance imaging) method of monitoring brain activity in which a person lies inside a machine that uses a magnetic field to record changes in blood flow and oxygen use in the brain in response to different kinds of stimulation

180

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

Figure 5.3 s fMRI Machine It is not until after toddlerhood that most children can lie still long enough to have an fMRI.

part of the brain, not just the cerebral cortex. The fMRI method is not often used with toddlers, perhaps because they are too wiggly and incapable of restraining their movements. However, one study solved this problem by assessing toddlers (age 21 months) and 3-yearolds as they slept, and found that toddlers showed greater frontal lobe activity in response to speech than the older children did, reflecting the brain’s readiness for rapid language acquisition during the toddler period (Redcay et al., 2008).

Sleep and (More) Teething

5.3

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse One of your patients is an American grandmother who is very critical of her Japanese daughter-in-law, who co-sleeps with her two-year-old granddaughter. The grandmother asserts that this is unhealthy for the granddaughter. How do you respond?

Describe the changes in sleeping patterns and sleeping arrangements that take place during toddlerhood. Sleep declines from 16 to 18 hours a day in the neonate to about 15 hours a day by the first birthday, and further to about 12 to 13 hours by the second birthday. The toddler not only sleeps less than the infant but also has more of a night-sleeping, day-waking arousal schedule. This comes as a great relief to their parents! Most toddlers take only one nap during the day by the time they reach 18 months old, compared to the two or more naps a day typical of infants (Iglowstein et al., 2003). However, this does not mean that toddlers consistently sleep through the night. In fact, one study of toddlers in Israel, England, and Australia found that episodes of waking in the night increased in frequency from 1½ to 2 years of age (Scher et al., 2004). There are two reasons why waking at night often increases during this time. First, there is a resurgence of teething between 13 and 19 months of age (Bong et al., 2008). This time it is the molars—the large teeth in the back of the mouth—which are bigger and more painful as they emerge than were the teeth that emerged in infancy. Second, toddlers develop a more definite sense of themselves and others as they approach age 2, and if they sleep in a bed separate from their parents they become more aware of this separation and more intentional about relieving it by summoning a parent or going into the parents’ room. What about the toddlers in traditional cultures, who have been sleeping alongside their mothers through infancy? This sleeping arrangement continues through the beginning of toddlerhood, but it will not last forever. When mothers become pregnant with another child, usually when the toddler reaches 2 or perhaps 3 years old, the toddler is ousted from that cozy spot beside her at night to make room for the new baby. However, this does not mean that toddlers now sleep alone. Instead, they now sleep alongside older siblings, or perhaps the father (Owens, 2004). Throughout life, sleeping alone is rare in traditional cultures.

Section 1 Physical Development

181

Motor Development Describe the advances in motor development that take place during toddlerhood

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.4

Toddlerhood is a time of dramatic advances in motor development. There are few physical advances more life changing than going from barely standing to walking, running, climbing, and jumping—and all this progress in gross motor development takes place during the toddler years. With regard to fine motor development, toddlers go from being able to place a small object inside a large object to holding a cup and building a tower of blocks. GROSS MOTOR DEVELOPMENT: FROM TODDLING TO RUNNING, JUMPING, AND CLIMBING Next time you see a child about a year old trying to walk, observe closely. When children first begin to walk they spread their feet apart and take small, stiff-legged steps, shifting their weight from one leg to the other. In short, they toddle! This is, in fact, where the word toddler comes from, in reference to their tentative, unsteady, wide-stance steps. On average, children begin to walk without support at about 11 months old, just as they are about to enter toddlerhood; but there is a wide range of normal variation around this average, from about 9 to 17 months (Adolph & Berger, 2006; Bayley, 2005). Children who walk at 9 months are no more likely than children who walk at 17 months to become Olympic athletes some day, they simply have different biological time lines for learning to walk. By 15 months most toddlers can stand (briefly) on one leg and have begun to climb, although once they have climbed onto something, they are much less skilled at climbing down. For example, most can climb up stairs at this age but not (safely) down. By 18 months most can run, although at first they run with the same stiff-legged, wide-stance posture as they use for walking. By 24 months they can kick a ball or throw a small object, and their running has become more flexible and fluid. At this age they can now go down the stairs that they earlier learned to climb up, and more: They can squat for minutes at a time, stand on tiptoes, and jump up and down. Small wonder toddlers move around so much, with so many new abilities to try out! Through the third year, toddlers’ gross motor skills continue to develop as they gain more flexibility and balance. They become better at using visual information to adjust their walking and running in response to changes in surfaces, so they become less likely to stumble and fall (Berger et al., 2005). Table 5.1 on page 182 summarizes the major milestones in gross motor development during toddlerhood. The research just described is based on Western, mostly American toddlers. What about toddlers in traditional cultures? As you will recall from Chapter 4, infants in traditional cultures are held or carried most of the time to keep them safe and secure. Toddlers in traditional cultures are allowed slightly more mobility—it is much harder to keep a toddler still than it is an infant—but they continue to be held and carried for about half their waking hours (Levine, 1977; Levine et al., 1994). Nevertheless, they are equal to toddlers in developed countries in the development of their gross motor skills (Greenfield, 2003). In fact, toddlers in Africa (as well as African Americans) tend to reach gross motor milestones earlier than toddlers of European backgrounds (Kelly et al., 2006).

At 12–18 months many toddlers can barely walk, but by their third year they can run and jump.

182

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

TABLE 5.1 Milestones of Gross Motor Development in Toddlerhood Age (Months)

Milestone

9–16

Stand alone

9–17

Walk without support

11–19

Stand on one leg

11–21

Climb onto chairs, beds, up stairs, etc.

13–17

Walk backward

14–22

Run

17–30

Jump in place

16–30

Walk on tiptoes

22–36

Walk up and down stairs

Source: Based on Adolph & Berger (2006); Bayley (2005); Coovadia & Wittenberg (2004); Frankenburg et al. (1992); Murkoff et al. (2006). Note: The range shown is the age period at which 90% of toddlers achieve the milestone.

THINKING CULTURALLY In your culture, what are some potential dangers to toddlers (other than those named here) and how do adults protect against these dangers?

Toddlers become capable of eating with a spoon and show a right- or left-hand preference for self-feeding.

The reason for restricting toddlers’ movements is the same as for infants: to keep them safe and away from harm. Fire is especially a danger, as many traditional cultures have a cooking fire burning perpetually—during the day for cooking meals, during the night for warmth. Because toddlers are so active and so heedless of potential dangers, and because they trip and tumble a lot as they develop their walking and running skills, there is a danger that they will fall into a cooking fire unless their movements are restricted. For toddlers in traditional cultures, other common potential dangers are falling off a cliff, falling into a lake or river, or being trampled by livestock. Holding and carrying toddlers for much of their waking hours makes mishaps less likely. For the same safety reasons, parents in developed countries “baby proof” their homes once their children become mobile, removing sharp objects and other potential sources of harm (McKenzie, 2004). Parents of toddlers should also place gates at the top of stairs to prevent the child from falling, add locks to cabinets containing sharp objects and household chemicals, install outlet covers to prevent electrocution, and take other measures to protect against potential sources of harm or injury (Eisenberg et al., 2008). FINE MOTOR DEVELOPMENT: FROM SCRIBBLING TO BUILDING WITH BLOCKS Toddler gains in fine motor development are not as revolutionary as their gains in gross motor development, but they are certainly substantial. Already at 12 months they have come a long way in the course of infancy, and can hold an object in one hand while performing an action on it with the other; for example, they can hold a container with the right hand while placing rocks into it with the left hand (Kopp, 2003). At 12 months most have come to show a definite right- or left-hand preference for self-feeding, and over the next 6 months they try a variety of grips on their spoons until they find a grip they will use consistently (McCarty et al., 2001). During the first year of toddlerhood they also learn to hold a cup, scribble with a pencil or crayon, build a tower of 3 to 4 blocks, and turn the pages of a book (Kopp, 2003). The second year of toddlerhood, from the second to the third birthday, is marked by fewer major advances and more by extending the advances of the previous year. The block tower rises to 8 to 10 blocks, the scribbling becomes skillful enough to draw a semistraight line, and an attempt to copy a circle may result in something that actually looks somewhat like a circle (Chen et al., 2010). Toddlers in their third year of life can even begin to brush their teeth, with a little assistance. Table 5.2 summarizes the major milestones in fine motor development during toddlerhood.

Section 1 Physical Development

183

TABLE 5.2 Milestones of Fine Motor Development in Toddlerhood Age (Months)

Milestone

7–15

Hold writing instrument (e.g., pencil, crayon)

8–16

Coordinate actions of both hands

10–19

Build tower of 2 blocks

10–21

Scribble vigorously

12–18

Feed self with spoon

15–23

Build tower of 3–4 blocks

20–28

Draw straight line on paper

24–32

Brush teeth

26–34

Build tower of 8–10 blocks

29–37

Copy circle

Source: Based on Adolph & Berger (2006); Bayley (2005); Coovadia & Wittenberg (2004); Frankenburg et al. (1992); Murkoff et al. (2006). Note: The range shown is the age period at which 90% of toddlers achieve the milestone.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. What are the most important nutritional deficiencies in toddlerhood, and how do they influence health? 2. How do synaptic density and synaptic pruning change during toddlerhood? 3. What are the two reasons why night-waking increases from 1½ to 2 years of age? 4. How do sleeping arrangements change in the course of toddlerhood in traditional cultures? 5. To what extent do cultures restrict toddlers’ movements, and why? 6. What specific fine motor abilities do toddlers lack at their first birthday but develop by their third birthday?

Socializing Physical Functions: Toilet Training and Weaning Eating and eliminating wastes are two physical functions that humans share with other animals, but for humans these functions become socialized from an early age. Here we look at how toddlers become toilet trained and weaned.

Toilet Training Compare and contrast the process and timing of toilet training in developed countries and traditional cultures. The toddler years are when most children first learn to control their urination and defecation and become “toilet trained.” Expectations for exactly when during the toddler years this should happen have changed substantially over the past half century in the United States (Blum et al., 2004). During the mid-20th century, pediatricians advocated early toilet training—the earlier the better—and in 1957 a study reported that 92% of American toddlers were toilet trained by the time they were 18 months old (Goode, 1999). Gradually, pediatricians and parents concluded there was little reason to require toilet training so early, and in more recent studies only about 25% of toddlers were toilet trained by 18 months old and only about 60% by their third birthday (Barone et al., 2009; Schum et al., 2001). We’ll look at the history of toilet training in more depth in the Historical Focus: The History of Toilet Training feature on page 184.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.5

THINKING CULTURALLY How might a culture’s values of individualism or collectivism influence toilet-training practices?

184

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood Today, most American pediatricians believe it is best to be patient with toddlers’ progress toward toilet training, and to time it according to when the toddler seems ready (American Academy of Pediatrics [AAP], 2001). Most toddlers show signs of readiness some time between 18 and 30 months of age. Some key signs are s s s s

STAYINGhDRYvFORANHOURORTWODURINGTHEDAY regular bowel movements, occurring at about the same time each day; increased anticipation of the event, expressed through looks or words; directly asking to use the toilet or to wear underwear instead of a diaper.

Although toilet training usually begins during the toddler years, it rarely happens overnight. Typically it is a process that continues over several weeks, months, or even years. The earlier toilet training begins, the longer it takes to complete it (Blum et al., 2003). After children are generally able to control urination and defecation, they may occasionally have an “accident” when they are especially tired, excited, or stressed (Murkoff et al., 1996). Even after children have ceased having accidents during the day, they may not have consistent control at night. For this reason, it is common for children to wear “training pants”—in between diapers and underwear—for a period after learning toilet training. Even at age 5, about one-fourth of children have an occasional accident, usually at night (Fritz & Rockney, 2004). Toddlers in developed countries usually have this process guided and supervised by parents, but for toddlers in traditional cultures, older siblings and other older children are often the guides. Toilet training is probably not the right term to use to refer to this process in traditional cultures, because they rarely have toilets—so let’s call it “controlled elimination.” By age 2 or 3 most toddlers in traditional cultures spend the majority of their waking hours in groups with children of mixed ages, and they learn controlled elimination from watching and imitating other children (LeVine, 1994). Parents may be involved as well. For example, among the Ifaluk people on the Pacific Ocean islands of Micronesia, when toddlers reach about age 2 their parents encourage them to relieve themselves in the nearby lagoon, not in or near the house, and reprimand them if they fail to comply (Le, 2000).

HISTORICAL FOCUS

The History of Toilet Training

A

pproaches to toilet training have shifted substantially in Western societies over the past century. These shifts provide an instructive example of how changes in cultural beliefs about children can interact with changes in technology. In the historical record of the past 200 to 300 years, the emphasis was on teaching children to use the toilet at the earliest age possible (Mechling, 2008). Methods were often coercive, including scolding or physical punishment in case of an “accident.” One U.S. government manual even urged parents to enforce the regularity of bowel movements for infants by inserting a curved

Approaches to toilet training have changed in recent decades with experts now recommending a “childcentered” approach.

stick into the baby’s rectum at precise times each day (U.S. Department of Labor, 1935). These early, harsh approaches to toilet training reflected a cultural belief in the appropriateness of strong parental authority (Dewar, 2010). Toddlers were to be toilet trained as soon as possible so that parents would be relieved of the mess and work of changing and cleaning their diapers; the needs of the parents were the top priority, not the needs of the children (Mechling, 2008). However, technological reasons—more precisely, the lack of technologies— were also involved. Keep in mind that before the late 20th century all diapers were cloth and had to be washed by hand. This certainly gave parents a strong incentive to toilet train their children early. Keep in mind, too, that families before the late 20th century typically had three, four, or more children, and by the time the youngest one was in diapers, parents would have been changing and washing diapers for a long, long time. Methods of toilet training evolved in the late 20th century, supported by changes in parenting beliefs as well as developments in technology. Parents became less concerned with establishing authority over children and more concerned with children’s psychological

Section 1 Physical Development well-being (Alwin, 1988). Child-care authorities warned that harsh, early toilet training could be psychologically damaging and that parents should be patient and allow the timing of toilet training to be determined by the toddler’s readiness, as shown by their interest in using the toilet (Spock, 1966). Two key technological changes of the 1950s also contributed to more tolerant and patient methods: the invention of the disposable diaper and the electric washer and dryer. It was easier for parents to be more tolerant of their toddler’s individual pace of toilet training once the parents no longer had to wash diapers by hand and could instead wash them in the electric washer or use disposables. Today in developed countries most parents use disposable diapers. In the United States, from 1950 to today, there has been a

185

steady rise in the proportion of parents using disposable diapers and a steady decline in the proportion of toddlers becoming toilet trained before 18 months old. A “child-centered” approach to toilet training is recommended by experts, part of a more general child-centered approach to parenting that places the needs of children above the needs of parents—a reversal of the historical pattern (Brazelton & Sparrow, 2004). Some experts now advocate “toilet learning” because “toilet training” carries the baggage of the harsh, bad old days (Eisenberg et al., 1996). Parents use books and videos to introduce the idea of toilet training to their children and gradually teach them how to use the toilet regularly, often beginning with a child-sized training toilet. Disposable diapers make the wait a lot easier for parents to bear!

Weaning Distinguish the weaning process early in infancy from weaning later in toddlerhood.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

As mentioned in Chapter 3, cultures vary widely in whether and how long mothers breastfeed their children. However, based on what we know of human history and of practices today in traditional cultures, it is clear that breast feeding for 2 to 3 years has been the most typical human custom (see Map 5.1; Small, 1998). If breast feeding takes place for only a few weeks or months during infancy, the transition from breast to bottle usually takes place fairly smoothly, especially if the bottle is introduced gradually (Murkoff et al., 2003). Infants may protest at first the change from the familiar breast to the unfamiliar bottle, especially if the nipple of the bottle requires a substantial accommodation in sucking technique. But this usually passes quickly: They get hungry, they want to eat, the bottle contains milk, so they drink from the bottle. However, the longer breast feeding continues into toddlerhood, the more challenging weaning becomes when the mother decides the time has come for the child to stop drinking breast milk. As we will see in more detail later in the chapter, the toddler is much more socially aware than

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Researcher Toddlers in many cultures are weaned around age 2. What is an evolutionary explanation for weaning around this age?

weaning

cessation of breast feeding

Percentage of children who are still breastfed at 20–23 months More than 80% 60–79% 40–59% 30° 20–39% 0–19% No data

30°





30°

30°

150°

60°

120°

90°

60°

30°



30°

60°

90°

120°

5.6

150°

Map 5.1 s Cultural Variations in the Length of Breastfeeding Which countries and regions have the highest rates of breast feeding at 20-23 months, and which the lowest? What cultural and economic differences might explain these variations?

186

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

Toddlers in traditional cultures often breast-feed until they are about 2 years old. Here, a mother of the Yanomamo people of the Amazon rain forest nurses her toddler.

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

the infant, and much more capable of exercising intentional behavior. The toddler can also speak up, in a way the infant cannot, to make demands and protest prohibitions. Consequently, most traditional cultures have customary practices for weaning toddlers from the breast. Often, the approach is gentle and gradual at first, but becomes harsher if the toddler resists. For example, in Bali (an island that is part of Indonesia) parents feed their babies some solid food from the first few days of life, and attempt gradual weaning beginning about age 2. However, if the gradual approach does not work, mothers coat their breasts with bitter-tasting herbs (Deiner, 2000). Similarly, toddlers in rural villages in Turkey are weaned at about age 2, but if they persist in trying to breast-feed, the mother coats her breasts with tomato paste. The child usually cries and protests, but the method works without fail (Delaney, 2000). Other cultures separate mother and toddler during weaning, so that the toddler will have no choice but to get used to life without breast feeding. Among the Fulani people of West Africa, toddlers are sent to their grandmother’s household during weaning. If the toddler complains about not breast feeding, the grandmother may offer her own breast, but the toddler quickly loses interest upon discovering that there is no milk in it (Johnson, 2000).

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. How have views on toilet training changed throughout history? 2. What are the signs that toddlers are ready to begin toilet training? 3. How does controlled elimination in traditional cultures differ from toilet training in developed countries? 4. Why is weaning more difficult in toddlerhood than in infancy? 5. What practices do traditional cultures use if toddlers resist weaning?

Section 1 VIDEO GUIDE Gross Motor Development Across Cultures (Length: 4:22) In this video, we observe how gross motor skills such as crawling and walking proceed at different rates within and across cultures. We also interview Karen Adolph, a leading researcher of motor development. 1. Karen Adolph notes that in some cultures, toddlers do not crawl at all or learn to crawl only after they have mastered walking. What cultural factors might influence this? 2. Should parents be concerned if their child takes longer than other children to achieve a gross motor milestone, such as learning to walk? Why or why not? 3. According to Adolph’s longitudinal research, at what point do infants and toddlers have a solid grasp of their gross motor abilities? What is the relevance of this for parents who are trying to baby-proof their house?

Watch the Video Gross Motor Development Across Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab

SECTION 2 COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT LEARNING OBJECTIVES 5.7

Outline the cognitive achievements of toddlerhood in Piaget’s theory.

5.8

Explain Vygotsky’s sociocultural theory of cognitive development and contrast it with Piaget’s theory.

5.9

Summarize the evidence for the biological and evolutionary bases of language.

5.10 Describe the milestones in language development that take place during the toddler years. 5.11 Identify how parents’ stimulation of toddlers’ language varies across cultures and evaluate how these variations relate to language development.

Cognitive Development Theories You have already been introduced to Piaget and his theory of infant cognitive development (see Chapter 4). Here his theory continues into toddlerhood. Also, a more cultural perspective on children’s cognitive development is presented, in the theory of Lev Vygotsky.

Cognitive Development in Toddlerhood: Piaget’s Theory Outline the cognitive achievements of toddlerhood in Piaget’s theory.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.7

Piaget proposed that cognitive development during the first 2 years of life follows a sequence of six sensorimotor stages. As we saw in Chapter 4, during infancy the primary cognitive advance of the first four stages of sensorimotor development is from simple reflexes to intentional, coordinated behavior. Neonates have a wide range of reflexes and little intentional control over their behavior, but by the end of the first year infants have lost most of their reflexes and can perform intentional actions that combine schemes, such as moving one object aside in order to reach another. In the second year of life—during toddlerhood—the final two stages of sensorimotor development are completed. SENSORIMOTOR STAGE 5: TERTIARY CIRCULAR REACTIONS Piaget called the fifth stage of sensorimotor development tertiary circular reactions (age 12–18 months). In this stage, toddlers intentionally try out different behaviors to see what the effects will be. In the previous stage, secondary circular reactions, the action first occurs by accident and then is intentionally repeated, but in tertiary circular reactions the action is intentional from the beginning. Like secondary circular reactions, tertiary circular reactions are circular because they are performed repeatedly. For example, at 17 months my twins discovered how to flush the toilet, and one day they flushed and flushed and flushed until the flushing system broke and the water began overflowing. I discovered this as I sat downstairs reading the newspaper and suddenly observed water whooshing out of the vents in the ceiling! I ran upstairs and there they were, standing in three inches of water, giggling with glee, absolutely delighted. I don’t recall thinking of Piaget at that moment, but I’ll bet he would have been pleased. To Piaget, in this stage toddlers become like little scientists, experimenting on the objects around them in order to learn more about how the world works. My twins certainly learned that day about what happens when you flush a toilet repeatedly. SENSORIMOTOR STAGE 6: MENTAL REPRESENTATIONS The final stage of sensorimotor development, from 18 to 24 months, is the stage of mental representations. Now, instead of

mental representations Piaget’s final stage of sensorimotor development in which toddlers first think about the range of possibilities and then select the action most likely to achieve the desired outcome

187

188

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

deferred imitation ability to repeat actions observed at an earlier time

Toddlers’ play is often based on deferred imitation. Here, a toddler in Peru offers a bottle to her doll.

trying out a range of actions as in tertiary circular reactions, toddlers first think about the possibilities and select the action most likely to achieve the desired outcome. Piaget gave the example of his daughter Lucienne, who sought to obtain a small chain from inside the matchbox where her father had placed it. First she turned the box upside down; then she tried to jam her finger into it, but neither of these methods worked. She paused for a moment, holding the matchbox and considering it intently. Then she opened and closed her mouth, and suddenly slid back the cover of the matchbox to reveal the chain (Crain, 2000). To Piaget, opening and closing her mouth showed that she was pondering potential solutions, then mimicking the solution that had occurred to her. Mental representation is a crucial milestone in cognitive development, because it is the basis of the most important and most distinctly human cognitive abilities, including language. The words we use are mental representations of objects, people, actions, and ideas.

OBJECT PERMANENCE IN TODDLERHOOD Object permanence also develops further during toddlerhood. As described in Chapter 4, by their first birthday infants will look for an object that they observe being hidden behind or under another object. However, even at 12 months they still make the “A-not-B error.” That is, if they find an object under blanket A, and then a second blanket B is added and they observe the object being hidden under blanket B, they nevertheless tend to look under blanket A, where they found the object the first time. Toddlers learn to avoid the A-not-B error and search for the object where they last saw it hidden. However, even though the A-not-B error is less common in toddlerhood than in infancy, search errors happen occasionally on this task in toddlerhood and even into early childhood, up to ages 4 and 5 (Hood et al., 2003; Newcombe & Huttenlocher, 2006). But we can say with some confidence that toddlers have attained object permanence once they generally avoid the A-not-B error. Object permanence is a major advance of cognitive development in toddlerhood, but it is not a distinctly human achievement. In fact, chimpanzees and human toddlers have equal success on object permanence tasks at age 2 (Call, 2001; Collier-Baker & Suddendorf, 2006). Understanding the permanence of the physical world is crucial to being able to function in that world, so it is not surprising that humans and nonhuman primates would share this fundamental ability (Brownell & Kopp, 2007).

DEFERRED IMITATION The ability for mental representation of actions also makes possible deferred imitation, which is the ability to repeat actions observed at an earlier time. Piaget’s favorite example of deferred imitation involved his daughter Jacqueline, who witnessed another child exploding into an elaborate public tantrum and then repeated the tantrum herself at home the next day (Crain, 2000). Deferred imitation is a crucial ability for learning because it means that when we observe something important to know, we can repeat it later ourselves. Deferred imitation is a frequent part of toddlers’ pretend play, as they observe the actions of other children or adults—making a meal, feeding a baby, digging a hole—and then imitate those actions later in their play (Lillard, 2007). Piaget proposed that deferred imitation begins at about 18 months, but subsequent research has shown that it develops much earlier than he had thought (Bauer, 2006). Deferred imitation of facial expressions has been reported as early as 6 weeks of age, when infants exposed to an unusual facial expression from an unfamiliar adult imitated it when the same adult appeared before them the next day (Meltzoff & Moore, 1994). At 6 months of age, infants can imitate a simple sequence of events a day later, such as taking off a puppet’s glove and shaking it to ring a bell inside the glove (Barr et al., 2003).

Section 2 Cognitive Development However, if there is a longer delay, toddlers are more proficient at deferred imitation than infants are. In a series of studies, children 9, 13, and 20 months old were shown twostep sequences of events such as placing a car on a track to make a light go on, then pushing a rod to make the car run down a ramp (Bauer et al., 2000; 2001; 2003). After a 1-month interval, shown the same materials, fewer than half of the 9-month-olds could imitate the steps they had seen previously, compared with about two-thirds of the 13-month-olds and nearly all the 20-month-olds. Other studies have shown that better deferred imitation among toddlers than among infants may be due principally to advances in the maturity of the brain. Specifically, the hippocampus, that part of the brain especially important in long-term memory encoding and recall, is still in a highly immature state of development during infancy but matures substantially during toddlerhood (Bauer et al., 2003; Liston & Kagan, 2002). CATEGORIZATION Piaget also believed that mental representation in toddlerhood is the basis of categorization. Once we are able to represent an image of a house mentally, for example, we can understand the category “house” and understand that different houses are all part of that category. A toddler can observe houses of different colors, styles, and sizes and still recognize that they all fall under the same general category of “house.” These categories, in turn, become the basis for language, because each noun and verb represents a category (Waxman, 2003). The word truck represents the category “truck” containing every possible variety of truck; the word run represents the category “run” containing all varieties of running, and so on. Here, too, recent experiments seem to indicate that Piaget underestimated children’s early abilities. Infants and toddlers are able to do more than he had thought. Even infants as young as a few months old have been shown to have a rudimentary understanding of categories. This can be demonstrated by their patterns of looking at a series of images. As we have seen, infants tend to look longer at images that are new or unfamiliar, and their attention to images is often used in research to infer what they know and do not know. In one study, 3- and 4-month-old infants were shown photographs of cats (Quinn et al., 1993). After a series of cat photos, the infants were shown two new photos, one of a cat and one of a dog. They looked longer at the dog photo, indicating that they had been using a category for “cat,” and looked longer at the dog photo because it did not fit. However, research has generally confirmed Piaget’s insight that categorization becomes more advanced during toddlerhood. For example, one study compared children who were 9, 12, and 18 months old (Gopnik et al., 1999). The children were given four different toy horses and four different pencils. At 9 months, they played with the objects but made no effort to separate them into categories. At 12 months, some of the children would place the objects into categories and some would not. By 18 months, nearly all the children would systematically and deliberately separate the objects into a “horse” category and a “pencil” category. By the time they are 2 years old, toddlers can go beyond the appearance of objects to categorize them on the basis of their functions or qualities. In a study demonstrating this ability, 2-year-olds were shown a machine and a collection of blocks that appeared to be identical (Gopnik et al., 1999). Then they were shown that two of the blocks made the machine light up when placed on it, whereas others did not. The researcher picked up one of the blocks that had made the machine light up and said, “This is a blicket. Can you show me the other blicket?” The 2-year-olds were able to choose the other block that had made the machine light go on, even though it looked the same as the blocks that had not had that effect. Although blicket was a nonsense word the toddlers had not heard before, they were able to understand that the category “blicket” was defined by causing the machine to light up.

189

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE Give an example of real-life learning by deferred imitation at age 2, 7, 14, and 25.

Explore the Concept Encoding, Storage, and Retrieval in Memory at MyDevelopmentLab

190

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

Vygotsky’s Cultural Theory of Cognitive Development

5.8

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

zone of proximal development difference between skills or tasks that children can accomplish alone and those they are capable of performing if guided by an adult or a more competent peer private speech in Vygotsky’s theory, self-guiding and self-directing comments children make to themselves as they learn in the zone of proximal development and have conversations with those guiding them; first spoken aloud, then internally scaffolding degree of assistance provided to the learner in the zone of proximal development, gradually decreasing as the learner’s skills develop

Watch the Video Zone of Proximal Development at MyDevelopmentLab

Explain Vygotsky’s sociocultural theory of cognitive development and contrast it with Piaget’s theory. Although most studies of toddlers’ cognitive development pay little attention to cultural context, in recent years a cultural approach to cognition has gained increased attention from scholars of human development. This approach is founded on the ideas of the Russian psychologist Lev Vygotsky (1896–1934). Vygotsky died of tuberculosis when he was just 37, and it took decades before his ideas about cognitive development were translated and recognized by scholars outside Russia. It is only in recent decades that his work has been widely influential among Western scholars, but his influence is increasing as interest in understanding the cultural basis of development continues to grow (Gardiner, 2001; Maynard & Martini, 2005; Segall et al., 1999). Vygotsky’s theory is often referred to as a sociocultural theory, because in his view cognitive development is always both a social and a cultural process (Daniels et al., 2007). It is social, because children learn through interactions with others and require assistance from others in order to learn what they need to know. It is cultural, because what children need to know is determined by the culture they live in. Vygotsky recognized that there are distinct cultural differences in the knowledge children must acquire—from agricultural skills in rural Asia, to caring for cattle in eastern Africa, to the verbal and scientific reasoning skills taught in Western schools. This is very different from Piaget’s theory described earlier, which emphasizes the child’s interactions with the physical environment and views cognitive development as essentially the same across cultures.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE Think of a recent time when you have used private speech. What was it about the task that evoked private speech on that occasion?

In Vygotsky’s theory, children’s cognitive development is always both social and cultural. Here, a father in the Middle Eastern country of Oman shows his son how to weave a basket.

THE ZONE OF PROXIMAL DEVELOPMENT Two of Vygotsky’s most influential ideas are the zone of proximal development and scaffolding. The zone of proximal development is the difference between skills or tasks that children can accomplish alone and those they are capable of performing if guided by an adult or a more competent peer. According to Vygotsky, children learn best if the instruction they are provided is within the zone of proximal development, so that they need assistance at first but gradually become capable of performing the task on their own. For example, children learning a musical instrument may be lost or overwhelmed if learning entirely on their own, but can make progress if guided by someone who already knows how to play the instrument. As they learn in the zone of proximal development and have conversations with those guiding them, children begin to speak to themselves in a self-guiding and self-directing way, first aloud and then internally. Vygotsky called this private speech (Winsler, 2009). As children become more competent in what they are learning, they internalize their private speech and gradually decrease its use. Toddlerhood and early childhood are crucial periods in Vygotsky’s theory, because it is during these life stages that children are most likely to use private speech and make the transition from using it aloud to using it internally (Feigenbaum, 2002). However, private speech continues throughout life. In fact, Vygotsky believed that private speech was necessary to all higher order cognitive functioning. In recent years, studies have shown that adolescents and adults use private speech when solving tasks of diverse kinds and diverse levels of difficulty (Medina et al., 2009). Another key idea in Vygotsky’s theory is scaffolding, which is the degree of assistance provided to children in the zone of proximal development. According to Vygotsky,

Section 2 Cognitive Development scaffolding should gradually decrease as children become more competent at a task. When children begin learning a task, they require substantial instruction and involvement from an adult or more capable peer; but as they gain knowledge and skill, the teacher should gradually scale back the amount of direct instruction provided. For example, when infants and toddlers first learn language, parents’ statements to them are usually very simple, but they become more complex as children’s language mastery grows (Capone & McGregor, 2005). Scaffolding can occur at any age, whenever there is someone who is learning a skill or gaining knowledge from someone else. Scaffolding and the zone of proximal development underscore the social nature of learning in Vygotsky’s theory. In his view, learning always takes place via a social process, through the interactions between someone who possesses knowledge and someone who is in the process of obtaining knowledge. The ideas of the zone of proximal development and scaffolding have been applied to older children’s learning as well, and will be explored further in later chapters. GUIDED PARTICIPATION One scholar who has been important in extending Vygotsky’s theory is Barbara Rogoff (1990; 1995; 1998; 2003). Her idea of guided participation refers to the interaction between two people (often an adult and a child) as they participate in a culturally valued activity. The guidance is “the direction offered by cultural and social values, as well as social partners” (Rogoff, 1995, p. 142) as learning takes place. As an example of guided participation, Rogoff (2003) describes a toddler and caregiver in Taiwan “playing school” together. As part of the game, the caregiver teaches the toddler to stand up and bow down to the teacher at the beginning and end of class, teaching not only the routine of the classroom but the cultural value of respect for teachers’ authority. The teaching in guided participation may also be indirect. For example, from her research with the Mayan people of Guatemala, Rogoff (2003) describes how toddlers observe their mother making tortillas and attempt to imitate them. Mothers give them a small piece of dough and help their efforts along by rolling the dough into a ball and starting the flattening process but otherwise do not provide explicit teaching, allowing toddlers to learn through observing and then attempting to imitate their mother’s actions.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. How does toddlers’ understanding of object permanence develop beyond what infants know? 2. Describe the concepts of deferred imitation and categorization and explain how they develop during toddlerhood. 3. In what way is Vygotsky’s theory a sociocultural theory? 4. How is scaffolding related to the zone of proximal development? 5. How is Rogoff’s idea of guided participation similar to Vygotsky’s zone of proximal development?

Language Development Of all the qualities that distinguish humans from other animals, language may be the most important. Other species of animals have their own ways of communicating, but language allows humans to communicate about a vastly broader range of topics. Using language, humans can communicate about not just what is observable in the present, the way other

191

Watch the Video Scaffolding at MyDevelopmentLab

THINKING CULTURALLY Think of something that a toddler in your own culture would have to learn, and describe how you would teach the skill using the principles of the zone of proximal development and scaffolding.

guided participation teaching interaction between two people (often an adult and a child) as they participate in a culturally valued activity

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

192

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood animals might communicate about food or predators in their immediate environment, but about an infinite range of things beyond the present moment. With language, too, we can communicate not just about things that exist but about things that might exist, things that we imagine. As linguist Derrick Bickerton remarks, “Only language could have broken through the prison of immediate experience in which every other creature is locked, releasing us into infinite freedoms of space and time” (Leakey, 1994, p. 119). In Chapter 4 we looked at the beginnings of language in infancy. However, by the end of infancy most children can only speak a few words. It is during toddlerhood that language development has its most rapid and important advances. Toddlers go from speaking a few words at their first birthday to being fluent users of language by their third birthday. Let’s examine the course of this remarkable achievement, looking first at the biological and evolutionary bases of language, then at specific language milestones of toddlerhood, and finally, at the cultural and social context of toddlers’ language use.

The Biological and Evolutionary Bases of Language

5.9

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

infinite generativity ability to take the word symbols of a language and combine them in a virtually infinite number of new ways Broca’s area portion of the left frontal lobe of the human brain that is specialized for language production Wernicke’s area portion of the left temporal lobe of the human brain that is specialized for language comprehension

Chimpanzees can learn to use some sign language in a limited way, but they lack the infinite generativity of human language.

Summarize the evidence for the biological and evolutionary bases of language. You may have heard that some primates have learned how to use language. Attempts to teach language to apes have a long history in the social sciences, going back over a half century. In the earliest attempts, researchers treated baby chimpanzees as closely as possible to how a human infant would be treated, having the chimpanzees live in the researcher’s household as part of the family and making daily efforts to teach the chimps how to speak. Years of these efforts yielded nothing but the single word “mama”—and a badly disordered household. It turned out that chimpanzees, like other nonhuman primates, lack the vocal apparatus that makes human speech possible. In the 1960s, researchers hit on the clever idea of teaching apes sign language; these attempts were much more successful. One famous chimpanzee, Washoe, learned to use about 100 signs, mostly involving requests for food (Small, 2001). She even learned to lie and to make jokes. However, she never learned to make original combinations of signs (with one possible exception, when she saw a duck for the first time and signed “water bird”). Mostly, Washoe and other primates who have learned sign language simply mimic the signs they have been taught by their human teachers. They lack the most important and distinctive feature of human language, which is infinite generativity, the ability to take the word symbols of a language and combine them in a virtually infinite number of new ways. A variety of human biological characteristics shows that we are a species uniquely built for language (Kenneally, 2007). First, humans have a unique vocal apparatus. We are able to make a much wider range of sounds than the other primates because, for us, the larynx is located lower in the throat, which creates a large sound chamber, the pharynx, above the vocal cords. We also have a relatively small and mobile tongue that can push the air coming past the larynx in various ways to make different sounds, and lips that are flexible enough to stop and start the passage of air. Second, two areas in the left hemisphere of the human brain are specifically devoted to language functions (Nakano & Blumstein, 2004; Pizzamiglio et al., 2005). Broca’s area in the left frontal lobe is specialized for language production, and Wernicke’s area in the left temporal lobe is specialized for language comprehension (see Figure 5.4). If damage to one of these areas occurs in adulthood the specialized language function of the area is also damaged; but if damage takes place in childhood, other areas of the brain can compensate—with compensation being greater the younger the brain injury takes

Section 2 Cognitive Development place (Akshoomoff et al., 2002; Huttenlocher, 2002). In addition to Broca’s and Wernicke’s areas, many other regions of the brain contribute to language use (Dick et al., 2004). In fact, some linguists argue that the extraordinary size of the human brain in comparison to other species is due mainly to the evolution of language (Pinker, 2004). Third, genes specifically devoted to language development have recently been identified (Gazzaniga, 2008; Pinker, 2004). Because Broca’s and Wernicke’s areas have long been known to be part of normal brain anatomy, the genetic basis of language was clear. However, identifying the specific genes for language strengthens our knowledge of how deeply language is embedded in human phylogenetic (species) development. Although modern humans are biologically equipped for language, our earliest ancestors were not. Early hominids (see Chapter 1) had a larynx similar in placement to modern nonhuman primates, and so must have been incapable of language (Leakey, 1994). The placement of the larynx is notably lower beginning nearly 2 million years ago, and Homo sapiens 200,000 years ago had a vocal apparatus that was not much different from yours. Undoubtedly the development of language gave humans a substantial evolutionary advantage (Small, 2001). Language would have made it easier to communicate about the location of food sources and about how to make tools, which would in turn enhance survival. If your clan could craft a better spear, you would have a better chance of killing the prey that would provide the necessary nourishment. If your group could construct a boat, you could potentially travel to new food sources if the local ones became depleted. Many evolutionary biologists believe that language also conferred an evolutionary advantage because of its social function. During the course of human evolution, the size of human groups gradually increased (Leakey, 1994), leading to an increased need for communication that would allow them to function effectively. Because language abilities improved the efficiency of group functioning, groups that excelled in language would have been more likely than other groups to survive and reproduce. Within groups, too, using language effectively would have given people an advantage in obtaining mates, food, and status, so natural selection would have favored language abilities in the course of human evolutionary history (Pinker, 2004).

Broca’s area

Frontal lobe

193

Parietal lobe

Occipital lobe

Temporal lobe

Wernicke’s area

Figure 5.4 s Illustration of the Brain Lobes Showing Location of Broca’s Area and Wernicke’s Area Simulate the Experiment Broca’s Area and Wernicke’s Area at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE How, specifically, would language have conferred an evolutionary advantage to early humans in obtaining mates, food, and status?

Milestones of Toddler Language: From First Words to Fluency Describe the milestones in language development that take place during the toddler years. Toddlers’ advances in language begin slowly but then rise sharply, so that in less than two years they go from speaking a few words to being highly adept language users. Especially notable is the amazing burst of language development that occurs at 18 to 24 months.

TWELVE MONTHS TO 18 MONTHS: SLOW EXPANSION For the first 6 months of toddlerhood, language develops at a steady but slow pace. From 12 to 18 months old, toddlers learn to speak one to three new words a week, reaching ten words by 15 months old and fifty words by about 18 months old, on average, in American studies (Bloom, 1998). There is a wide range of variability around these averages. Toddlers may speak their tenth word anywhere from 13 to 19 months old, and their fiftieth word anywhere from 14 to 24 months old, and still be considered within the normal range (Newman, 2007). Just as the timing of taking first steps has no relation to later athletic ability, timing of speaking the first, tenth, or fiftieth word has no relation to later verbal ability. The first fifty words tend to be words that are part of toddler’s daily routines (Waxman & Lidz, 2006), and include s IMPORTANTPEOPLEh-AMA vh$ADAv s FAMILIARANIMALShDOG vhKITTYv

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.10

194

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood s s s s s s s

Toddlers exhibit overextension when they use a single word (such as “raspberry”) to represent a variety of related objects (such as strawberries and other red berries).

holophrase single word that is used to represent a whole sentence overextension use of a single word to represent a variety of related objects underextension applying a general word to a specific object fast mapping learning and remembering a word for an object after just one time of being told what the object is called

BODYPARTShHAIR vhTUMMYv MOVINGOBJECTShCAR vhTRUCKv FOODShMILK vhCOOKIEv ACTIONShEAT vhBATHv HOUSEHOLDITEMShCUP vhCHAIRv TOYShBALL vhBEARv GREETINGSORFAREWELLShHI vhBYE BYEv 

Toddlers first learn words they need to use in practical ways to communicate with the people around them, usually as part of shared activities (Newman, 2007). Often at this age they speak in partial words, for example, “bah” for bird, “meh” for milk, or “na-na” for “banana.” From 12 to 18 months most toddlers use one word at a time, but a single word can have varied meanings. Toddler’s single words are called holophrases, meaning that for them a single word can be used to represent different forms of whole sentences (Flavell et al., 2002). For example, “cup” could mean “Fill my cup with juice,” or “I dropped the cup on the floor,” or “Hand me my cup, I can’t reach it,” or “Here, take this cup,” depending on when and how and to whom it is said. Another way toddlers make the most of their limited vocabulary is to have a single word represent a variety of related objects. This is called overextension (Bloom, 2000). For example, when the son of two language researchers learned the name of the furry family dog, Nunu, he applied it not only to the original Nunu but to all dogs, as well as to other fuzzy objects such as slippers, and even to a salad with a large black olive that apparently reminded him of Nunu’s nose (de Villiers & de Villiers, 1978). Toddlers also exhibit underextension, applying a general word to a specific object (Woodward & Markman, 1998). When I was a child, my family had a cat named Kitty, who received that name because my brother was told that it was “the kitty,” and began calling it Kitty, and the name stuck. He did not realize that kitty was the (slang) name for the larger category, “cats,” but mistook it for the proper name of that particular cat. Underextension often occurs in this way, with a toddler first applying a new word to a specific object, then learning later to apply it to a category of objects. Here, as at all ages, production (speaking) lags behind comprehension (understanding) in language development. Although toddlers do not reach the fifty-word milestone in production until about 18 months old, they usually achieve fifty-word comprehension by about 13 months old (Menyuk et al., 1995). During toddlerhood, comprehension is a better predictor of later verbal intelligence than production is (Reznick et al., 1997).

EIGHTEEN MONTHS TO 24 MONTHS: THE NAMING EXPLOSION After learning to speak words at a slow rate for the first half of their second year, toddlers’ word production suddenly takes off from 18 to 24 months. The pace of learning new words doubles, from one to three words per week to five or six words per week (Kopp, 2003). This is known as the naming explosion or vocabulary spurt (Bloom et al., 1985; Goldfield & Reznick, 1990). After just one time of being told what an object is called, toddlers this age will learn it and remember it, a process called fast mapping (Gopnik et al., 1999; Markman & Jaswal, 2004). Fast mapping is due not just to memory but to toddlers’ ability to quickly infer the meaning of words based on how the word is used in a sentence and how it seems to be related to words they already know (Dixon et al., 2006). By their second birthday, toddlers have an average vocabulary of about 200 words (Dale & Goodman, 2004). This rapid pace of learning and remembering words will continue for years, but it is especially striking at 18 to 24 months because this is when it begins (Ganger & Brent, 2004). Girls’ vocabulary increases faster than boys’ vocabulary during this period, initiating a gender difference in verbal abilities that will persist throughout childhood (Lovas, 2011). Two of the most notable words toddlers learn during this period are gone and no. Using “gone” reflects their growing awareness of object permanence, as it signifies that

Section 2 Cognitive Development

195

something has disappeared from view but still exists somewhere (Gopnik et al., 1999). Using “no” reflects their budding sense of self (“me,” “my,” and “mine” also begin to be used at this age). Saying “no” can be short for “You may want me to do to that, but I don’t want to do it!” Of course, they also begin to hear “No!” more often around this age, as their mobility and curiosity leads them to behavior that the adults around them may regard as dangerous or destructive (Kopp, 2003). During this 18- to 24-month period they also learn to name one or two colors, at least six body parts, and emotional states like “tired” and “mad” (Eisenberg et al., 1996; Kopp, 2003). Toward the end of the 18- to 24-month period, toddlers begin to combine spoken words for the first time. Their first word combinations are usually two words, in what is called telegraphic speech (Bloom, 1998; Brown, 1973). Telegraphic speech takes similar forms in a variety of languages, from English to German to Finnish to Samoan: “See doggie,” “Big car,” “My ball,” “More cookie,” or “Mommy gone” (Bochner & Jones, 2003; Slobin, 1972). Like a telegram in the old days, telegraphic speech strips away connecting words like the and and, getting right to the point with nouns, verbs, and modifiers. An interesting feature of telegraphic speech is that it already shows an initial knowledge of syntax (word order). Toddlers say “See doggie,” not “Doggie see”; they say “My ball,” not “Ball my.” Similar to the one-word holophrases used earlier, telegraphic speech implies more understanding of language than it states explicitly: “Big car” means “Look at the big car,” “My ball” means “This is my ball,” and so on. Verbal production is the most striking advance of the 18- to 24-month period, but comprehension also advances notably as toddlers become faster and more efficient in processing words. In one series of experiments, toddlers 15 to 24 months old were shown pictures of two objects at a time while a recorded voice said “Where’s the ______________?” and named one of the objects (Fernald et al., 2006). At 15 months, toddlers waited until the whole word had been spoken before looking at the object the word referred to, but by 24 months they would shift their gaze even before the word had been completely spoken, for example looking at the shoe as soon as they heard the “sh” part spoken. TWENTY-FOUR MONTHS TO 36 MONTHS: BECOMING ADEPT AT LANGUAGE During the third year, toddlers continue to expand their speaking vocabulary at the same rapid pace that began at 18 to 24 months. They learn to use prepositions such as under, over, and through (Eisenberg et al., 1996). They also use words that reflect a more complex understanding of categories. For example, they understand that a bear is not only a bear but also an animal (Kopp, 2003). They continue to exhibit overextension and underextension, but with diminishing frequency as their vocabulary expands. They continue to use telegraphic speech as well, but now in three- and four-word statements (“Ball under bed!”) rather than two words. Increasingly during the third year they begin to speak in short, complete sentences. At this age my son Miles would point to the moon and protest, “It’s too high!” as if he expected us to do something about it. By the end of the third year most toddlers are remarkably skilled language users (Maratsos, 1998). They can communicate with others about a wide range of topics. They can speak about events that are happening in the present as well as about past and future events. Toddlers raised in homes where Chinese is spoken have learned that raising or lowering the pitch of a word changes its meaning. French toddlers have learned how to make nasal sounds and say “Voilà!” and !Kung San toddlers in Botswana have learned how to click their tongues against various parts of their mouths to make the words of their language (Small, 2001). Although their pronunciation of words is not as precise as it will become later, by the time they reach age 3 most toddlers can speak clearly enough to make themselves understood about nearly anything they wish. Furthermore, without any explicit instruction, by the end of the third year toddlers have learned the rules of their language, no matter how complex those rules may seem to someone who does not speak it. Consider this example, from Turkish (Slobin, 1982). In

Watch the Video EMT Program and Language Development at MyDevelopmentLab

telegraphic speech two-word phrases that strip away connecting words, such as the and and

196

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE Give some examples of overregularization in addition to the ones provided here.

Turkish, the rules of syntax (word order) are different from English. In English, “The girl fed the dog” has quite a different meaning from “The dog fed the girl.” The subject (girl) is supposed to go first, followed by the verb (fed) and then the object (dog). However, in Turkish the object is indicated not by the syntax but by attaching the suffix u. So, “The girl fed the dog-u” means the same as “The dog-u fed the girl.” Turkish toddlers use the u rule correctly by their third year, just as English-speaking children learn the correct use of English syntax by their third year (Aksoy & Slobin, 1985). The marvelous ability that young children have to learn the rules of their language is one more indication of the biological basis of language. A half century ago, at a time when many psychologists were arguing that language has no biological origin and children learn it solely through imitation and parent’s reinforcement, linguist Noam Chomsky (1957, 1969) protested that language is too complex to be learned in this way. Observing that all children learn the basic rules of grammar of their language at about the same age, 2 to 3 years old, Chomsky proposed that children are born with a language acquisition device (LAD) that enables them to perceive and grasp quickly the grammatical rules in the language around them. Today language researchers generally agree that language development is a biological potential that is then nurtured by social interaction, although there is still a lively debate about the nature of the biological foundation of language and the kinds of social stimulation needed to develop it (Hoff, 2009). Toddlers’ language mastery is evident not only in how well they use the rules of their language but also in the mistakes they make. As they learn the grammar of their language, they make mistakes that reflect overregularization, which means applying grammatical rules even to words that are an exception to the rule. Here are two examples from English that illustrate overregularization. First, the plural of most English nouns can be obtained by adding s to the singular form, but there are irregular exceptions, such as “mice” as the plural of “mouse,” and “feet” as the plural of “foot.” In the third year, toddlers sometimes make mistakes with these kinds of words, saying “mouses” instead of “mice” and “foots” instead of “feet.” Second, the rule for the past tense of an English verb is to add ed to the end, but there are irregular exceptions, such as “went” as the past tense of “go” and “threw” as the past tense of “throw.” In the third year toddlers sometimes make mistakes with these exceptions, saying “Mommy goed to the store” or “I throwed the ball.” However, it is a testament to toddlers’ language mastery that even by the third year, mistakes of this kind are rare (Bohner & Jones, 2003).

Learning Language in a Social and Cultural Context

5.11

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

language acquisition device (LAD) according to Chomsky, innate feature of the brain that that enables children to perceive and grasp quickly the grammatical rules in the language around them overregularization applying grammatical rules even to words that are the exception to the rule

Identify how parents’ stimulation of toddlers’ language varies across cultures and evaluate how these variations relate to language development. Humans are biologically built for learning language, but not for learning any specific language. There are over 60,000 different human languages in the world (Small, 2001), but none of them come preinscribed on our brains. Whatever language we learn must come from our social and cultural environment. This was first shown in a bizarre experiment conducted about 800 years ago. Frederick II, the Holy Roman Emperor (1194–1250), decided he wanted to find out what language infants would speak “naturally,” if they were left to their own resources. He chose a group of neonates in an orphanage and instructed their caregivers never to speak in their presence. What language would the babies begin to speak spontaneously, on their own? Would it be Latin, the language of scholars at that time? Would it be German, Frederick’s own language, or (God forbid) French, the language of his chief rivals? The answer turned out to be, as you may have guessed, none of the above. Tragically, all of the infants died. This is a poignant illustration of how we are poised for language to be part of the human social environment, and of how humans need language to develop properly, not just in their language development but in their social development.

Section 2 Cognitive Development PARENTS’ STIMULATION OF TODDLERS’ LANGUAGE DEVELOPMENT What kind of social environment do toddlers need in order to develop their language skills? In American research, the focus has been on how parents foster language development in young children. Several studies have examined social-class differences in parents’ language stimulation and how this is related to the pace of toddlers’ language development (Hoff, 2004; Lee & Burkam, 2002). For example, one study videotaped parent–child interactions in the homes of low-, middle-, and high-income families on several occasions, beginning when the children were 7 to 9 months old and continuing until they were about 30 months old (Hart & Risley, 1999). There were striking differences in how many words were spoken to children of different income levels. Parents in high-income families talked the most to their children, averaging about 35 words a minute; parents in middle-income families talked to their children an average of about 20 words a minute; and parents of low-income families provided the least language stimulation, just 10 words per minute. By 30 months old there were substantial differences in the toddlers’ vocabularies, averaging 766 words in the high-income families and just 357 words in the low-income families. In another study, children and mothers were videotaped in laboratories, first when the children were 9 months old and then when they were 13 months old; each mother–child pair engaged in free play with toys provided by the experimenters (Tamis-LeMonda et al., 2001). The study focused on maternal responsiveness to the children’s vocalizations and how this related to attaining language milestones when the children were reassessed later in toddlerhood, in their third year. Maternal responsiveness included affirmations (“Good job!” for speaking a word correctly), imitations (saying “cup” after the child said “ca” and pointed to a cup), and expansions (saying “Where did the ball go?” after the child said “ba?”). Maternal responsiveness was positively correlated with earlier timing of all four language milestones later in toddlerhood: first word, 50-word spoken vocabulary, first word combinations, and first use of past tense. That is, children whose mothers responded more often to their vocalizations tended to reach these milestones earlier than other children. So, it seems there is solid evidence that the family language environment in infancy and toddlerhood influences children’s language development at least through toddlerhood, right? Well, not so fast. These studies provide classic examples of the hazards of interpreting relations between parents’ behavior and children’s outcomes in biological families, due to passive genotype–environment effects (see Chapter 2). Can you see why? The studies do show that parents’ language stimulation is related to toddlers’ language achievements. However, the parents provided not only the language environment to the children in the study but their genotype as well. There is ample evidence from adoption and twin studies that verbal abilities are inherited to a substantial extent (Loehlin et al., 1997). Consequently, it is not clear how much the relation between parental behavior and children’s development was due to parents’ behavior and how much of it was due to genes—including the genes that influence verbal abilities. In studies of parents and children in biological families, genes and environment are confounded, which means they are closely related and difficult to separate. This is not to say that family language environments do not matter in toddlers’ language development. Of course they do. It is just that, in studies with this kind of confound between genetics and environment, it is impossible to tell how much. To identify more definitely how much the family language environment matters, it would be necessary to conduct these kinds of studies in adoptive families or twin families, but so far, in studies of toddler’s language development, this has not been done. In early childhood and beyond, the influence of teacher’s language use on children’s language development provides more definite evidence of an environmental effect, because teachers and children have no genetic relationship (Huttenlocher et al., 2002). CULTURAL VARIATIONS IN TODDLERS’ LANGUAGE ENVIRONMENTS The other notable feature of most research on toddlers’ language development, in addition to the passive genotype– environment issue just described, is its assumption that most toddler language use takes

197

Toddlers in traditional cultures often experience a language-rich environment. Here, a Mongolian family shares a meal and conversation.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Day-Care Provider You notice that some children in your classroom are very quiet while others are very talkative. What factors may contribute to these differences?

THINKING CULTURALLY What are some of the ways that adults in your culture encourage—or discourage—toddlers’ language use?

198

place in a parent–toddler dyad—just the two of them. This assumption may be true for the families being studied in developed countries, but the social environment that most toddlers experience worldwide is much different from this, and consequently their language environment differs as well. Once they learn to walk and begin to talk, toddlers in most cultures spend most of their days not with their parents but in mixed-age groups of other children, including an older girl, often an older sister, who is mainly responsible for caring for them. When toddlers are with their parents, usually many other people are around as well, such as siblings, extended-family members, and neighbors. This makes for a language-rich environment, because there is talking going on around them almost constantly, with so many people present. However, relatively little of this talk may be directed specifically at the toddler, because there are so many other people around and because others may not see it as necessary to speak directly to toddlers in order to stimulate their language development. In fact, the others in a toddlers’ social environment may even see it as bad parenting to speak often with toddlers. The Gusii people of Kenya believe that encouraging young children to speak is a mistake, because it makes it more likely that they will grow up to be selfish and disobedient (see Chapter 4; Levine et al., 1994). Their children learn the Gusii language as proficiently as American children learn English, but they learn it from being frequently in social groups where adults and older children are using language, not from having their language development stimulated directly in frequent daily interactions with their parents. This is not an isolated example. Studies comparing children in different cultures have found that direct stimulation of toddlers’ language development is a practice encouraged in some cultures but discouraged in others. One study compared Japanese mothers and Canadian mothers in their interactions with their young children (Minami & McCabe, 1995). In Japanese culture, being talkative is considered impolite and undesirable, especially for males, because the Japanese believe it is better to blend in harmoniously with the group than to call attention to yourself (Markus & Kitayama, 2003; Rothbaum et al., 2001). Consequently, the Japanese mothers in the study often discouraged their children from talking, especially their boys. In contrast, the Canadian mothers encouraged their children to talk more, by asking them questions and suggesting they provide more details. This approach was interpreted by the researchers as being based on a belief system favoring individualism and self-expression. As this study illustrates, in learning language children also learn a way of seeing the world and the values and beliefs of their culture. Another example of this can be found in Bambi Schieffelin’s (1986, 1990) ethnography of the Kaluli people of New Guinea, a traditional culture where the people sustain life through hunting, fishing, and growing crops. In this culture, children spend most of their daily lives in a multiage extendedfamily group. Mothers rarely speak directly to infants, because they believe their babies would not understand. Instead, they sometimes speak on the infant’s behalf, in a highpitched voice (e.g., “Please feed me!”). Once infants grow to be toddlers and begin to talk, mothers and others direct speech at them. However, the emphasis is not on the toddlers expressing themselves and saying what they want and need, but on repeating what the other person has said. Mothers will say something on behalf of the toddler, such as “Give me the stick,” then say the phrase “Say like that,” encouraging the toddler to repeat what the mother has said just like she said it. Instead of the Western value of “Be yourself,” which is promoted by asking toddlers questions about child-oriented topics, toddlers are being taught the value predominant among the Kaluli and many other cultures: “Do as you’re told.” In this way, the acquisition of language is simultaneously the acquisition of cultural beliefs.

Section 2 Cognitive Development

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. What biological characteristics do humans have that makes language possible? 2. When did our biological capacity for language evolve, and how would the development of language have provided an evolutionary advantage? 3. What is the “naming explosion” and when does it occur? 4. What changes in language development take place during the third year, and what kinds of mistakes are 2- and 3-year-olds most likely to make? 5. What do American studies indicate about parental stimulation of toddlers’ language development, and why are the results of these studies difficult to interpret? 6. How do Japanese and Canadian parents differ in the way they stimulate language in toddlers, and how are these variations related to cultural values?

Section 2 VIDEO GUIDE Language Development Across Cultures (Length: 7:40) In this video, we talk to parents from different cultural backgrounds about how they communicate with their infants and toddlers and ask them what, if anything, they do to foster their child’s language development.

1. Discuss the three factors mentioned in the clip that influence toddler language development. What are some additional factors that might also impact toddler language development? 2. Do you think that the U.S. mother interviewed here discussed a situation typical of most children across the U.S.? Why or why not? 3. Discuss your thoughts on the mother from Africa stating that she does not read to her baby because she is too young. What age do you think it is appropriate to begin reading to children and why?

Watch the Video Language Development Across Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab

199

SECTION 3

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 5.12 Describe how emotional development advances during toddlerhood and identify the impact of culture on these changes. 5.13 Describe the changes in self-development that take place during toddlerhood. 5.14 Distinguish between sex and gender and summarize the evidence for the biological basis of gender development. 5.15 Describe the essential features of attachment theory and identify the four classifications of attachment. 5.16 Identify the key factors influencing the quality of toddlers’ attachment to their mothers, and explain what effect attachment quality has on development. 5.17 Summarize the major critiques of attachment theory, including the cultural critique. 5.18 Compare and contrast the typical patterns of father involvement with infants and toddlers in traditional cultures and developed countries. 5.19 Describe relationships with siblings, peers, and friends during toddlerhood. 5.20 Identify the characteristics of autism and recognize how autism affects prospects for children as they grow to adulthood. 5.21 Identify the typical rates of television use in toddlerhood and explain some consequences of toddlers’ TV watching.

Emotional Development in Toddlerhood Toddlerhood is the stage of life when we first learn how to regulate our emotions. As part of this process we learn emotions such as shame and guilt that reflect our responses to the expectations and requirements of others.

Toddlers’ Emotions

5.12

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe how emotional development advances during toddlerhood and identify the impact of culture on these changes. As toddlers become more self-aware, they learn that the people in their cultural environment regard some behaviors as good and others as bad, some as right and some as wrong, and they learn to feel negative emotions when they do something defined as bad or wrong. They also begin to learn how to regulate their emotions. EMOTIONAL SELF-REGULATION From the early months of life, infants tend to show how they feel. Happy or sad, hungry or mad, they let you know. Gradually during the first year, infants develop the rudiments of emotional regulation. They learn to turn their attention away from unpleasant stimulation (Axia et al., 1999). The people around them soothe their distress with the kinds of strategies we discussed in Chapter 4, such as cuddling and rocking. In many cultures, frequent breast feeding is used as an emotional regulator, to quiet babies whenever they begin to fuss (DeLoache & Gottlieb, 2000; Levine et al., 1994). During toddlerhood, emotional self-regulation advances in four ways (Kopp, 1989; Thompson & Goodvin, 2007). 1. First, toddlers develop behaviors that can help them regulate their emotions. For example, toddlers who are frightened may run to a trusted adult or older sibling, or cling to a comforting blanket or stuffed animal.

200

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

201

2. Second, toddlers use language to promote emotional self-regulation. As noted earlier in the chapter, from about 18 months old toddlers begin to use words to identify and talk about their emotions. Throughout toddlerhood and beyond, talking about feelings with others enhances children’s understanding of their own and others’ emotions, which in turn promotes their emotional self-regulation (Bugental & Grusec, 2006; Parke & Buriel, 2006). 3. Third, external requirements by others extend toddlers’ capacities for emotional self-regulation. In toddlerhood, parents begin to convey and enforce rules that require emotional self-regulation: no hitting others no matter how angry you are, no jumping on the table no matter how happy you are, and so on (Calkins, 2007). Cultures vary in their requirements for emotional self-regulation, with collectivistic cultures such as China and Japan tending toward stiffer requirements than the more individualistic cultures of the West (Bornstein, 2006; Laible, 2004; Shweder et al., 2006). 4. Fourth and finally, emotional self-regulation in toddlerhood is promoted by the development of the sociomoral emotions (Thompson & Goodvin, 2007). Becoming capable of guilt, shame, and embarrassment motivates toddlers to avoid these unpleasant emotional states. Because they may be admonished by others for expressing primary emotions too strongly (e.g., yelling angrily in a grocery store) or in the wrong context (e.g., laughing loudly in a quiet restaurant), they learn emotional self-regulation as part of an effort to win approval from others and avoid their disapproval. If emotional self-regulation increases from infancy to toddlerhood, why is it toddlerhood that is associated with tantrums—and why is age 2 popularly known in some cultures as the “terrible twos”? Perhaps it is that for toddlers, abilities for emotional self-regulation increase but so do expectations for emotional control. Consequently, when they have the brief but intense outburst of anger, crying, and distress that constitutes a tantrum it is more noticed than the more frequent outbursts of infants (Calkins, 2007). Perhaps it is also that toddlers have a more developed sense of self, including the ability to protest with a tantrum when they don’t get their way (Grolnick et al., 2006). There must also be a cultural explanation involved. It is interesting to observe that in Western countries, such as the United States and the United Kingdom, it is widely accepted that toddlerhood tantrums are normal and even inevitable (Potegal & Davidson, 2003). One popular American advice book for parents of toddlers asserts that “Tantrums are a fact of toddler life, a behavior that’s virtually universal . . . turning little cherubs into little monsters” (Murkoff et al., 2003, p. 336). Yet outside the West, toddler tantrums are rarely mentioned, and toddlerhood is not seen as an age of “terrible” behavior. In African and Asian cultures, by the time toddlerhood is reached, children have already learned that they are expected to control their emotions and their behavior, and they exercise the control required of them (Holodynski, 2009; Miller & Fung, 2010). It may be that tantrums and the allegedly terrible twos are not inevitable at all, but a consequence of Western cultural beliefs in the value of self-expression, which children have already learned well by toddlerhood.

LEARNING THE SOCIOMORAL EMOTIONS As described in Chapter 4, infants across cultures display a range of recognizable primary emotions from early in life, including anger, fear, and happiness. In toddlerhood new emotions appear, including guilt, shame, embarrassment, envy, and pride. These are known as secondary emotions because they develop later than the primary emotions and they are based on what toddlers experience in their social environment (Lewis, 2000). All toddlers have a capacity for developing secondary emotions, as indicated by the fact these emotions appear across a wide range of cultures and are accompanied by characteristic body postures such as, for shame, lowering their eyes, bowing their heads, or covering their faces with their hands (Barrett & Nelson-Goens,

Watch the Video Emotional Regulation in Early Childhood at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Teacher You notice that some children in your pre-school classroom don’t show much emotion and are able to control their behavior better than other children. Might there be a cultural explanation for this variation?

Toddlers beome capable of sociomoral emotions such as shame.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE How do the changes in toddlers’ cognitive development described earlier in the chapter provide the basis for the development of the sociomoral emotions?

sociomoral emotions emotions evoked based on learned culturally based standards of right and wrong; also called secondary emotions empathy ability to understand and respond helpfully to another person’s distress prosocial behavior positive behavior toward others, including kindness, friendliness, and sharing

202

1997). However, what evokes the secondary emotions depends on what toddlers have been taught in their social and cultural environment. The secondary emotions are called sociomoral emotions because they are evoked based on what the toddler has learned about culturally based standards of right and wrong (Mascolo & Fischer, 2007). When toddlers experience guilt, shame, or embarrassment, it is not just because they have made the cognitive comparison between what they have done and what others have expected of them. It is also because they have begun to learn to feel good when they conform to the expected standard and bad when they do not. Thus by age 2 most toddlers have begun to develop a conscience, an internalized set of moral standards that guides their behavior and emotions (Kochanska, 2002; Thompson, 2006). Another important sociomoral emotion that first develops in toddlerhood is empathy, the ability to understand and respond helpfully to another person’s distress. Even neonates have an early form of empathy, as indicated by crying when they hear the cry of another infant. Throughout the first year, infants respond to the distress of others with distress of their own. However, true empathy requires an understanding of the self as separate from others, so it develops along with self-awareness in toddlerhood (Gopnik et al., 1999). It is only in the second and especially the third year that toddlers have enough of a developed self to understand the distress of others and respond, not by becoming distressed themselves but by helping other persons relieve their distress (Brownell et al., 2009). In one study, toddlers responded to a researcher’s feigned distress by offering a hug, a comforting remark, or a favorite stuffed animal or blanket (Hoffman, 2000). This demonstrates the beginning of prosocial behavior, which is behavior intended to help or benefit others (Svetlova et al., 2010). Although the triggers of the sociomoral emotions are learned from the social environment, there are probably some that are universal. Children everywhere seem to be taught not to hurt the people around them and not to damage or destroy things (Rogoff, 2003). However, even in toddlerhood there are cultural differences in how the sociomoral emotions are shaped. Cultural differences are especially sharp regarding the emotions of pride and shame, that is, in how good a person should feel about individual accomplishments and how quickly, easily, and often shame should be evoked. In Western countries, especially in the United States, pride is often viewed positively (Bellah et al., 1985; Twenge, 2006). Children are praised and encouraged to feel good about themselves for accomplishments such as hitting a ball, dancing in a show, or learning something new. Everybody on the soccer team gets a trophy, win or lose. Shame, in contrast, is applied with hesitation, as parents and others worry that shame may harm the development of children’s self-esteem. In most non-Western cultures, however, pride is seen as a greater danger than shame. In Japanese and Chinese cultures, for example, children are taught from early on not to call attention to themselves and not to display pride in response to personal success (Akimoto & Sanbonmatsu, 1999). For example, in one study of mothers’ and 2½ year-olds’ conversations about misbehavior in China and the United States, American mothers tended to frame the misbehavior as an emotionally positive learning experience—“Now you know not to do that next time, don’t you?”—in order to preserve their toddlers’ self-esteem. In contrast, Chinese mothers cultivated shame in their toddlers by emphasizing the negative consequences and negative feelings that resulted from the misbehavior (Miller et al., 1997). To the Chinese mothers, teaching their toddlers shame was a way of teaching them to be considerate of others, and a way of preparing them to grow up in a collectivistic culture that emphasizes the value of consideration for others. Learning the sociomoral emotions is an important part of becoming a member of a culture. To function in a culture it is necessary to know the rules and expectations for behavior

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development and to avoid violating them; the sociomoral emotions are experienced as unpleasant, so children and adults alike generally conform to cultural expectations in order to avoid the sociomoral emotions. However, according to Erik Erikson’s theory (1950), it is important for parents not to press the sociomoral emotions so hard as to thwart the toddler’s budding sense of selfhood. In Erikson’s life-span theory (see Chapter 1), toddlerhood is the stage of autonomy versus shame and doubt. Toddlers are just gaining a sense of themselves as individuals and learning that they can make choices and decisions and express them to others—which is why “No!” is a popular word during this life stage. When parents allow toddlers to exercise autonomy with reasonable limits, for example by allowing them to do something like spoon some food onto their plate when you could do it for them a lot quicker (and more neatly), toddlers gain a healthy confidence in their abilities to handle life’s challenges. However, if parents are harsh and impatient with toddler’s attempts to begin to do some things for themselves, toddlers may experience shame and doubt that will undermine their trust in themselves when they are faced with new tasks and new relationships.

203

autonomy vs. shame and doubt in Erikson’s lifespan theory, the main crisis of the toddlerhood stage, when toddlers gain a healthy confidence in their ability to make choices and express them to others or parents are harsh and impatient and toddlers experience shame and doubt that undermines their trust in themselves self-recognition ability to recognize one’s image in the mirror as one’s self self-reflection capacity to think about one’s self as one would think about other persons and objects

The Birth of the Self Describe the changes in self-development that take place during toddlerhood. Even in the early weeks of life there is evidence that infants have the beginnings of a sense of self, a sense of being distinct from the external environment. Many of the topics introduced in Chapter 4 on infancy can be interpreted as reflecting the beginnings of selfawareness. Infants recognize the smell of their mother’s breast and the sound of her voice after just a few days of life, indicating an awareness of a difference between their own smells and sounds and those of others. In the first month they display a stronger rooting reflex in response to another person touching their cheek than in response to their own hand performing the same movement (Rochat & Hespos, 1997). After a month or two they begin responding in interactions with others by smiling, moving, and vocalizing, thus showing an awareness of themselves and others as distinct social partners. By the middle of the first year they recognize and respond to their own name when it is spoken by others, indicating the beginning of a name-based identity. By the end of the first year, they search for hidden objects and examine objects and put them in their mouths, all behaviors showing an awareness of the distinction between themselves and the external world (Harter, 2006; Thompson, 2006). Although self-awareness begins to develop during infancy, it advances in important ways during toddlerhood. It is during the second and third years of life that children first demonstrate self-recognition. This was demonstrated in a classic experiment in which toddlers were secretly dabbed on the nose with a red spot, then placed in front of a mirror (Lewis & Brooks-Gunn, 1979). Upon seeing the child with the red nose in the mirror, 9- and 12-month-old infants would reach out to touch their reflection as if it were someone else, but by 18 months most toddlers rubbed their own nose, recognizing the image as themselves. About the same time self-recognition first appears (as indicated in the red-nose test) toddlers also begin to use personal pronouns for the first time (“I,” “me,” “mine”), and they begin to refer to themselves by their own names (Lewis & Ramsay, 2004; Pipp et al., 1987). These developments show that by the second half of their second year toddlers have the beginnings of self-reflection, the capacity to think about themselves as they would think about other persons and objects. Self-reflection enables toddlers to develop the sociomoral emotions described earlier. As toddlers become more self-aware, they learn that the people in their cultural environment have expectations for how to behave and they learn to feel negative emotions when they do something defined as bad or wrong.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.13

THINKING CULTURALLY How does the birth of the self in toddlerhood help explain toddlers’ responses to weaning in traditional cultures, as described earlier in the chapter?

Watch the Video Self Awareness Task at MyDevelopmentLab

204

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

Gender Identity and the Biology of Gender Development

5.14 gender identity or female

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

awareness of one’s self as male

sex biological status of being male or female gender cultural categories of “male” and “female”

Explore the Concept Different Gender Stereotypes at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Gender Versus Sex at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Understanding Self and Others at MyDevelopmentLab Gender socialization begins early in all cultures.

Distinguish between sex and gender and summarize the evidence for the biological basis of gender development. Another aspect of self-development that begins in toddlerhood is the formation of a gender identity. Between 18 and 30 months of age is when children first identify themselves and others as male or female (Martin et al., 2002). At age 2 they can also apply gender terms like boy and girl, woman and man to others (Campbell et al., 2004; Raag, 2003). Before proceeding further, let’s clarify the difference between sex and gender. In general, social scientists use the term sex to refer to the biological status of being male or female. Gender, in contrast, refers to the cultural categories of “male” and “female” (Tobach, 2004). Use of the term sex implies that the characteristics of males and females have a biological basis. Use of the term gender implies that characteristics of males and females may be due to cultural and social beliefs, influences, and perceptions. For example, the fact that males are somewhat larger than females throughout life is a sex difference. However, the fact that girls in many cultures have longer hair than boys is a gender difference. The distinction between a sex difference and a gender difference is not always as clear as in these examples, as we will see in this and other chapters. The degree to which differences between males and females are biological or cultural is a subject of great importance and heated debate in the social sciences. Even before toddlerhood, in all cultures people communicate gender expectations to boys and girls by dressing them differently, talking to them differently, and playing with them differently (Hatfield & Rapson, 2006). In a classic experimental study (Sidorowicz & Lunney, 1980), adults were asked to play with a 10-month-old infant they did not know. All adults played with the same infant, but some were told it was a girl, some were told it was a boy, and some were given no information about its sex. There were three toys to play with: a rubber football, a doll, and a teething ring. When the adults thought the child was male, 50% of the men and 80% of the women played with the child using the football. When they thought the child was female, 89% of the men and 73% of the women used the doll in play. In the early years, it is mainly parents who are the deliverers of cultural gender messages (Ruble et al., 2006; Whiting & Edwards, 1988). They give their children names, and usually the names are distinctively male or female. They dress boys differently from girls and provide them with different toys to play with (Bandura & Bussey, 2004). Toys are gender-specific custom complexes, representing distinctive cultural patterns of behavior that are based on underlying cultural beliefs (see Chapter 4). Toys for boys— such as guns, cars, and balls for playing sports—reflect the expectation that boys will be active, aggressive, and competitive. Toys for girls—such as dolls, jewelry, and playhouses—reflect the expectation that girls will be nurturing, cooperative, and attractive in appearance. Children readily learn cultural messages about gender roles in toddlerhood, and by early childhood they help enforce these roles with other children. However, gender development has a biological basis as well; sex and gender are intertwined. Let’s look at the biological basis of gender development here, and then explore gender socialization in depth in Chapter 6. GENDER AND BIOLOGY The cultural and social basis of gender development is wellsubstantiated. However, there is also a biological basis to gender development. To put this in terms of the distinction between sex and gender just described, sex differences sometimes underly gender differences—but not always, as we shall see. There are three elements to the biological basis of gender development: evolutionary, ethological, and hormonal. In the evolutionary view, males and females develop differently because over the course of many millennia of human evolution, different characteristics

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development promoted survival for the two sexes (Buss, 2004; Jackson, 2004). For males, survival was promoted by aggressiveness, competitiveness, and dominance. Males with these characteristics were more likely than their peers to outfight other males for scarce resources and more likely to gain sexual access to females. Consequently, they were more likely to reproduce, and through the process of natural selection, gradually these characteristics became a standard part of being a male human being. The aggressiveness and competitiveness of boys in early childhood is an outcome of a long evolutionary history. For human females, in contrast, over the course of many millennia of evolution, survival was promoted by being nurturing, cooperative, and emotionally responsive to others. Females with these characteristics were more likely than their peers to attract males who would protect them and provide for them. They needed males to protect them from other males, because they would frequently be pregnant or caring for young children. Females with these qualities were also more likely to be effective at caring for children through the long period of vulnerability and dependency that is characteristic of the young of the human species. Consequently, their offspring were more likely to survive to reproductive age, and through natural selection, gradually these qualities became genetically, biologically based tendencies of the human female. The cooperativeness and emotional responsiveness of girls in early childhood, and their interest in playing house and playing with dolls, is an outcome of a long evolutionary history. Ethology, the study of animal behavior, also provides evidence of the biological basis of human gender differences. The gender differences that exist among humans are also true of our closest primate and mammalian relatives (Diamond, 1992; Pinker, 2004). Like human males, the males in those species closely related to us are also more aggressive, competitive, and dominant than females; and males who are highest in these qualities gain greater sexual access to females. Like human females, females in closely related species also are more nurturing and cooperative than males are, and they have primary responsibility for caring for young children. Like human children, the young of closely related species also play in same-sex groups. The similarity of sex-specific behavior across related species is strong evidence for a biological basis for human gender differences. Hormonal evidence also supports the biological basis of human gender differences. Throughout life, beginning even prenatally, males and females differ in their hormonal balances, with males having more androgens and females more estrogens. In fact, males must receive a burst of androgens in their third month of prenatal development in order to develop into males. These hormonal differences influence human development and behavior. The strongest evidence for this is in studies of children who have hormonal abnormalities. Girls who were exposed to high levels of androgens in the womb are more likely than their peers to show male play behavior in early childhood, including playing with “male” toys like trucks and a preference for male playmates (Hines, 2004). Boys who were exposed to high levels of estrogens in the womb are more likely than their peers to show female play behavior in early childhood, including playing with “female” toys like dolls and a preference for female playmates (Knickmeyer & Baron-Cohen, 2006). In animal studies, too, females whose levels of prenatal androgen are increased experimentally show increased aggression and more active play than their animal peers, and less interest in caring for their offspring (Maccoby, 2002). THE LIMITS OF BIOLOGY Taken together, the evidence from evolutionary theory, ethological research, and research on hormonal abnormalities makes a strong case for the biological basis of human gender differences. There is little doubt that gender differences are accentuated and reinforced by the socialization environment, in every culture. At the same time, there is little doubt that human males and females are biologically different and that these differences are evident in their development in toddlerhood and beyond, in all cultures. However, there is good reason to be skeptical and wary of attributing all human gender differences mainly to biology. In the course of human history, especially in the last century, gender roles have changed dramatically, even though biologically we have not changed (Brumberg, 1997). It is only 100 years ago that women were excluded from higher education

205

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE How is the case of children with hormonal abnormalities an example of a natural experiment? Are there any limitations to its validity as a natural experiment?

ethology

study of animal behavior

206

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

Explore the Concept Adults’ Perceptions of Boys and Girls at MyDevelopmentLab

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

and from virtually all professions. It was widely believed, even among scientists—who were all male—that women were biologically incapable of strenuous intellectual work. Today, in an era when women exceed men in university participation in most countries in the world and are close to or equal to men in their representation in medicine, law, business, and other fields, these beliefs seem preposterous. Yet just a century ago, the most knowledgeable people of the time were certain these beliefs were true. That fact should give us pause before we assert that the biological basis of children’s gender differences today is indisputable. The changes in women’s roles over the past century demonstrate the enormous influence that culture can have on the raw material of biology in human development. As cultures change, gender roles can change, even though the underlying biology of human development remains the same. The other issue worth mentioning here is that when we speak of gender differences, we are comparing one-half of the human species to the other, over 3 billion persons to the other 3 billion-plus persons. There is a tendency among social scientists to describe gender differences by stating that “boys are X, whereas girls are Y” (including in the section you just read). However, these generalizations almost always overstate the differences between the two genders. Even where there are legitimate gender differences, in early childhood and beyond, there are also many exceptions. To put it another way, the variability within each gender is usually much greater than the differences between the two genders, for most characteristics. Consequently, we should be careful not to let our perceptions of gender differences prejudge our estimations of the qualities or abilities of individual boys or girls or men or women.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What are four ways that emotional regulation develops during toddlerhood? 2. Why is age 2 described as the “terrible twos” in some cultures but not in others? 3. Why are secondary emotions also called “sociomoral emotions”? 4. What is the red-nose test and how does it demonstrate self-recognition? 5. What is gender identity and when does it first develop? 6. Describe some ways that parents communicate gender-role socialization to infants and toddlers.

One Special Person: Attachment Theory and Research From infancy to toddlerhood, the social world expands. However, crucial to social development remains the relationship with one special person, usually but not always the mother, who provides love and care reliably. In the field of human development the study of this relationship in infancy and toddlerhood has focused on attachment theory and research based on this theory.

Attachment Theory

5.15

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe the essential features of attachment theory and identify the four classifications of attachment. Because the long dependency of children on adults is such a distinctive characteristic of our species, the question of how the attachments between human children and adults develop has long been of great interest to human development scholars. Attachment theory

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

207

was first introduced in our discussion of infant social development (see Chapter 4). Here we examine the features of attachment theory in more detail, including ways of evaluating the quality of parent–child attachment and critiques of attachment theory. BOWLBY’S THEORY Through most of the 20th century there was strong consensus that human infants become attached to their mothers because mothers provide them with food. Hunger is a distressing physical state, especially for babies, who are growing rapidly and need to be fed often. Mothers relieve this distressing state and provide the pleasure of feeding. Over time, infants come to associate the mother with the relief of distress and the experience of pleasure. This association becomes the basis for the love that infants feel for their mothers. This was the dominant view in psychology in the first half of the 20th century. However, around the middle of the 20th century, the British scholar John Bowlby (1969) began to observe that many research findings that were appearing at the time were inconsistent with this consensus. There were three findings that were especially notable to Bowlby. First, French psychiatrist René Spitz (1946) reported that infants raised in institutions suffered in their physical and emotional development, even if they were fed well. Spitz studied infants who entered an orphanage when they were 3 to 12 months old. Despite adequate physical care, the babies lost weight and seemed listless and passive, a condition Spitz called anaclitic depression. Spitz attributed the infants’ condition to the fact that one nurse had to care for seven infants and spent little time with each except for feeding them and changing their diapers. (Anaclitic means “leaning upon,” and Spitz chose this term because the infants had no one to lean upon.) The infants showed no sign of developing positive feelings toward the nurse, even though the nurse provided them with nourishment. Other studies of institutionalized infants reported similar results (Rutter, 1996). The second set of findings that called feeding into question as the basis of the infant– mother bond involved primates, specifically rhesus monkeys. In a classic study, Harry Harlow (1958) placed baby monkeys in a cage with two kinds of artificial “mothers.” One of the mothers was made of wire mesh, the other of soft terry cloth. Harlow found that even when he placed the feeding bottle in the wire mother, the baby monkeys spent almost all their time on the cloth mother, going to the wire mother only to feed. Again, a simple link between feeding and emotional bonds seemed called into question. The third set of findings noted by Bowlby proved the most important for his thinking. These findings came from the field of ethology, which, as we have noted, is the study of animal behavior. Ethologists reported that for some animals, the bond between newborns and their mothers was instantaneous and occurred immediately after birth. Konrad Lorenz (1965), a German ethologist, showed that newborn goslings would bond to the first moving object they saw after hatching and follow it closely, a phenomenon he called imprinting (see Chapter 3). To Lorenz and other ethologists, the foundation of the bond between the young of the species and their mothers was not nourishment but protection. Imprinting to the mother would cause the young to stay close to her and thereby be protected from harm. Considering these three sets of findings, Bowlby concluded that the emotional tie between infants and their mothers was based on children’s need for protection and care for many years. Thus as Bowlby described it, the attachment that develops between children and caring adults is an emotional bond that promotes the protection and survival of children during the years they are most vulnerable. The child’s primary attachment figure is the person who is sought out when the child experiences some kind of distress or threat in the environment, such as hunger, pain, an unfamiliar person, or an unfamiliar setting. Usually the primary attachment figure is a parent, and is most often the mother because in nearly all cultures mothers are primarily the ones who are most involved in the care of infants. However, the primary attachment figure could also

John Bowlby, originator of attachment theory. (Photo by Jürgen Schadeberg)

Watch the Video Institution Care/Adoption and Foster Care: Nathan Fox at MyDevelopmentLab primary attachment figure person who is sought out when a child experiences some kind of distress or threat in the environment

Harlow’s studies showed that attachments were not based on nourishment. As shown here, the monkeys preferred the cloth “mother” even though the wire “mother” provided nourishment.

208

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Researcher You are sent to a local Polynesian village to do the “red nose” test with some toddlers aged 12-20 months (refer back to p. 203). The instructions call for the mother to sit near the mirror. However, the toddlers seem to want an older sibling to sit nearby rather than their mothers. Is it ok to change the protocol to include the older sibling instead of the mother?

Watch the Video Stranger Anxiety at MyDevelopmentLab

stranger anxiety fear in response to unfamiliar persons, usually evident in infants by age 6 months secure base role of primary attachment figure, allows child to explore world while seeking comfort when threats arise separation anxiety discomfort experienced by infants and young children when apart from attachment figures, especially when a stranger is present Strange Situation laboratory assessment of attachment entailing a series of introductions, separations, and reunions involving the child, the mother, and an unfamiliar person

be the father, a grandparent, an older sister, or anyone else who is most involved in the infant’s care. Separation from the primary attachment figure is experienced by the child as especially threatening, and the loss of the primary attachment figure is a catastrophe for children’s development (Bowlby, 1980). Although infants can discriminate among the smells and voices of different people in their environment from early on, in their first months they can be held and cared for by a wide range of people, familiar as well as unfamiliar, without protesting. However, by about the middle of the first year of life, this begins to change. Gradually they become more selective, developing stronger preferences for familiar others who have cared for them, and stranger anxiety emerges in response to being approached, held, or even smiled at by people they do not recognize and trust. Stranger anxiety exists in a wide range of cultures beginning at about age 6 months and grows stronger in the months that follow, as Figure 5.5 illustrates (Super & Harkness, 1976). So, if an infant or toddler turns away, frowns, or bursts into tears in response to your friendly overtures, don’t take it personally! There is an evolutionary basis for the development of stranger anxiety at about age 6 months (Bowlby, 1967). This is the age when infants first become mobile, and learning to crawl allows them to begin to explore the environment but also carries the risk that they may crawl themselves into big trouble. Learning to stay close to familiar persons and avoid unfamiliar persons helps infants stay near those who will protect them and keep them safe. Although it promotes survival for children to stay close to caring adults, it also promotes survival for children to learn about the world around them. Consequently, under normal conditions young children use their primary attachment figure as a secure base from which to explore the surrounding environment (Bowlby, 1969). If a threat appears in the environment, attachment behavior is activated and children seek direct physical contact with their attachment figure. According to Bowlby, attachment develops gradually over the first 2 years of life, culminating in a goal-corrected partnership in which both persons use language to communicate about the child’s needs and the primary attachment figure’s responses. Over time, the child becomes steadily less dependent on the care and protection of the primary attachment figure. However, even into adulthood, the child may seek out the primary caregiver for comfort during times of crisis. VARIETIES OF ATTACHMENT: THE STRANGE SITUATION Bowlby was a theorist, not a researcher, and he did not conduct studies to test his theory directly. Research on attachment was pioneered by Mary Ainsworth, a colleague of Bowlby (Ainsworth & Bell, 1969; Ainsworth et al., 1978). Ainsworth followed Bowlby’s theory in viewing the child’s attachment as being most evident in the response to separation from the primary attachment figure. She had observed that along with stranger anxiety, infants and toddlers experience separation anxiety when apart from attachment figures, especially if a stranger is present. To evoke children’s

Percentage of Children Who Cried Following Departure of Mother

100

Figure 5.5 s The Rise and Fall of Stranger Anxiety in the First 3 Years Across Cultures Stranger anxiety peaks around the end of the first year. Source: Kagan et al., 1978

80

African Bushman Antigua, Guatemala Israeli kibbutz

60

40

20

0 5

10

15 20 Age in Months

25

30

35

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

209

attachment behavior, Ainsworth devised a laboratory procedure she called the Strange Situation (Ainsworth et al., 1978). The Strange Situation is a series of introductions, separations, and reunions involving the child, the mother, and an unfamiliar person (see Figure 5.6). It was devised for toddlers, ages 12 to 24 months, because this is an age that is old enough so that attachment has developed to a point where it can be assessed. In the Strange Situation the mother and toddler first come into the laboratory room and are left for a few minutes to become used to it. There are toys and the toddler may begin to play with them. A series of episodes follows in which a “stranger” enters the room, the mother leaves the room, the mother returns, the mother leaves again, and the mother returns again. When she returns the second time, the mother is supposed to pick the child up. On the basis of toddlers’ responses to the Strange Situation, four classifications of attachment were developed (Ainsworth et al., 1978; Ammaniti et al., 2005). The first three were proposed by Ainsworth, and the fourth was added by later researchers. Secure attachment. Toddlers in this category use the mother as a secure base from which to explore, in the first part of the Strange Situation when only the mother and toddler are present. Upon separation, securely attached toddlers usually cry or vocalize in protest. When the mother returns, they greet her happily by smiling and perhaps going to her to be hugged and held. Insecure–avoidant attachment. These toddlers show little or no interaction with the mother when she is present, and no response to the mother’s departure or return. When these toddlers are picked up in the last episode of the Strange Situation, they may immediately seek to get down. Insecure–resistant attachment. Toddlers classified as insecure–resistant are less likely than others to explore the toys when the mother is present, and they show greater distress when she leaves the room. When she returns, they show ambivalence, running to greet the mother in seeming relief but then pushing her away when she attempts to comfort or pick them up. Disorganized–disoriented attachment. Toddlers in this category show extremely unusual behavior in response to the Strange Situation (Ammaniti et al., 2005; van IJzendoorn et al., 1999). They may seem dazed and detached when the mother leaves the room, but with outbursts of anger, and when the mother returns they may seem fearful. Some freeze their movements suddenly in odd postures. This kind of attachment is especially shown by toddlers who show other signs of serious problems, such as autism or Down syndrome. Their mothers are more likely to have used alcohol or drugs during pregnancy and are more likely to have had psychological problems. Although attachment classification is based on behavior throughout the Strange Situation, Ainsworth viewed the toddler’s reunion behavior as the best indicator of the quality of attachment (Ainsworth et al., 1978). Toddlers with secure attachments seemed delighted to see their mothers again after a separation and often sought physical contact with her, whereas toddlers with insecure attachments either responded little to her return (avoidant) or seemed both relieved and angry at her (resistant).

Figure 5.6 s The Strange Situation The Strange Situation features a series of episodes in which (a) the mother leaves the room, (b) the toddler is alone with the stranger, and (c) the mother returns to the room and is reunited with the toddler. secure attachment healthiest classification of parent–child attachment, in which the child uses the parent as a secure base from which to explore, protests when separated from parent, and is happy when the parent returns insecure–avoidant attachment classification of parent–child attachment in which there is relatively little interaction between them and the child shows little response to the parent’s absence and may resist being picked up when the parent returns insecure–resistant attachment classification of parent–child attachment in which the child shows little exploratory behavior when the parent is present, great distress when the parent leaves the room, and ambivalence upon the parent’s return disorganized–disoriented attachment classification of parent–child attachment in which the child seems dazed and detached, with possible outbursts of anger, when the parent leaves the room, and exhibits fear upon parent’s return

Quality of Attachment Identify the key factors influencing the quality of toddlers’ attachment to their mothers, and explain what effect attachment quality has on development. If toddlers differ in the quality of their attachments, what determines those differences? And what implications does attachment quality in toddlerhood have for later development?

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.16

Simulate the Experiment Attachment Classifications in the Strange Situation at MyDevelopmentLab

Attachment behavior is especially activated if the toddler is distressed.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE What are the implications of attachment theory for the debate discussed in Chapter 4 over whether or not a crying baby should be comforted?

DETERMINANTS OF ATTACHMENT QUALITY Ainsworth’s early research indicated that about two-thirds of toddlers had secure attachments to their mothers, with the remaining onethird either insecure–avoidant or insecure–resistant (Ainsworth et al., 1978). Many other studies of American and European children since then have found similar results (NICHD Early Child Care Research Network, 2006; van IJzendoorn & Sagi, 2010). Disorganized– disoriented attachment is rare. But what determines the quality of toddlers’ attachments to their mothers? In her early research, Ainsworth and her colleagues observed families in their homes, including the same mother–child pairs they later observed in the laboratory in the Strange Situation (Ainsworth, 1977). The home observations were extensive: every 3 weeks for four hours, from when the children were 3 weeks old to just past their first birthdays. When considering the mother–child interactions in the home in relation to their behavior as observed in the Strange Situation, Ainsworth concluded that the quality of attachment was based mainly on how sensitive and responsive the mother was. To be sensitive means to be good at judging what the child needs at any given time. For example, sensitive mothers could tell when their children had had enough to eat, whereas others seemed to stop feeding while the children were still hungry or tried to keep feeding them after they seemed full. To be responsive means to be quick to assist or soothe the children when they need it. For example, responsive mothers would hug or pick up or talk soothingly when their children were distressed, whereas others would let them cry for awhile before going to their assistance. According to attachment theory, based on the degree of their mothers’ sensitive and responsive behavior over the first year of life, children develop an internal working model of what to expect about her availability and supportiveness during times of need (Bowlby, 1969, 1980; Bretherton & Mulholland, 1999). Children with secure attachments have developed an internal working model of the mother as someone they can rely upon to provide help and protection. Children with insecure attachments are unsure that the mother will come through when they need her. They have an internal working model of her as someone who is unpredictable and cannot always be trusted. One reason the Strange Situation is first assessed in toddlerhood rather than infancy is that it is only by toddlerhood that children are cognitively mature enough to have developed an internal working model of their primary attachment figure (Ainsworth et al., 1978; Bowlby, 1969). ATTACHMENT QUALITY AND LATER DEVELOPMENT According to Bowlby (1969), the internal working model of the primary caregiver formed in infancy and toddlerhood is later applied to other relationships. Consequently, the attachment to the primary caregiver established in the first 2 years shapes expectations and interactions in relationships with others throughout life, from friends to teachers to romantic partners to one’s own future children. Securely attached children are able to love and trust others because they could love and trust their primary caregiver in their early years. Insecurely attached children display hostility, indifference, or overdependence on others in later relationships, because they find it difficult to believe others will be worthy of their love and trust (Thompson, 1998). This is a bold and intriguing claim. How well does it hold up in research? A number of longitudinal studies on attachment have by now followed samples from toddlerhood through adolescence or emerging adulthood, and they provide mixed support for the predictions of attachment theory. Some longitudinal studies show a relationship between attachment quality assessed in toddlerhood and later emotional and social development, but other studies do not (Egeland & Carlson, 2004). The current view is that attachment quality in infancy and toddlerhood establishes tendencies and expectations that may then be modified by later experiences in childhood, adolescence, and beyond (McCarthy & Maughan, 2010; Thompson, 2008). To put this in terms of the theory, the internal working model established early may be modified substantially by later experiences. Only disorganized–disoriented attachment is highly predictive of later problems (Ammaniti et al., 2005; van IJzendoorn et al., 1999; Vondra & Barnett, 1999). Toddlers

210

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development with this attachment classification exhibit high hostility and aggression in early and middle childhood, and are likely to have cognitive problems as well (Weinfield et al., 2004). In adolescence and beyond, toddlers who had been classified as disorganized– disoriented are at higher risk for behavior problems and psychopathology (van IJzendoorn et al., 1999). However, this type of attachment is believed to be due to underlying problems in neurological development, not to the behavior of the primary caregiver (Barnett et al., 1999; Macfie et al., 2001). Since Ainsworth’s classic studies, researchers have also investigated toddlers’ attachments to fathers and other nonmaternal caregivers. We examine one such study in the Research Focus: Early Child Care and Its Consequences feature.

RESEARCH FOCUS

O

211

Watch the Video Lisa: Adjusting to Day Care: Part 1 at MyDevelopmentLab

Early Child Care and Its Consequences

examined, including physical, social, emotional, cognitive, and ne of the most striking changes of the last half cenlanguage development. tury in Western countries is that mothers of young There were many notable and illuminating findings in the children now generally work outside the home (see study. About three-fourths of the children in the study began Map 5.2 on page 212). For example, in 1960 only 17% of nonmaternal child care by the age of 4 months. During infancy American mothers of children under a year old were employed, and toddlerhood most of this care was provided by relatives, but but by the year 2000 this proportion had risen to over 60% enrollment in child-care centers increased during toddlerhood, (Smith et al., 2001). Similar changes took place in other Western and beyond age 2 most children receiving nonmaternal care were countries (Scheiwe & Willekins, 2009). Because this change in centers. Infants and toddlers averaged 33 hours a week in nonhas happened so quickly and so recently, and because mothmaternal care. African American infants and toddlers experienced ers have never before been employed in such large numbers, the highest number of hours per week of nonmaternal care and there has been a great deal of concern expressed about the White infants and toddlers potential consequence of the lowest, with Latinos in this change for young chilbetween. dren’s development. ConThe most important varisequently, a great deal of ables related to children’s research has been underdevelopment were hours per taken to explore this issue. week in care and quality of Beginning in the 1990s, care. Quality of care was asthe largest and most compresessed in three ways: (1) the hensive study of early child caregivers’ education, training care and its consequences in child care, and child-care was conducted in the Unitexperience; (2) the ratio of ed States, sponsored by the children to caregivers and the National Institute of Child number of children per group; Health and Human Developand (3) the interactions bement (NICHD). The “NICHD tween caregivers and chilStudy of Early Child Care” bedren (based on observations gan in 1991 with over 1,300 of mothers and nonmaternal young children (from infancy caregivers). Notably, children through early childhood) at Toddlers in high-quality child-care centers are as likely as from the highest and lowest 10 sites around the United children in home care to have secure attachments. SES backgrounds received the States. The children and their highest quality care and the children from near-poor backgrounds families were followed longitudinally for 7 years (NICHD Early received the lowest, because the parents of the poorest children Child Care Research Network, 2005). The sample was diverse in qualified for subsidies for high-quality care, whereas the parents of socioeconomic (SES) background, ethnicity, and geographical rethe near-poor children did not. gion. Multiple methods were used to assess the children and their The results of the study regarding early childhood will be disfamilies, including observations, interviews, questionnaires, and cussed in Chapter 6, but for infants and toddlers, the focus of standardized tests. Multiple aspects of the care children received the study was on how child-care arrangements might be related were also assessed, including quantity, stability, quality, and type to attachment (NICHD Early Child Care Research Network, 1997, of care. A wide range of children’s developmental domains were

212

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood This was an impressively ambitious and comprehensive study, but even this study has limitations. Most notably, the children were not randomly assigned into child-care groups. The choices about the care they received and how many hours per week they were in care were made by their parents, not the researchers. Consequently, the outcomes of the children’s child-care experiences were interwoven with many other variables, such as parents’ income, education, and ethnicity. In statistical analyses it is possible to “control for” these other variables in seeking to determine the consequences of child-care experiences, but not so much as to resemble the more definite results that random assignment into child-care groups would have provided. This is an example of how social scientists are rarely able to create an ideal experimental situation in their research, but must usually take human behavior as they find it and do their best to unravel the daunting complexity of real life.

2005). The observations measured how sensitive and responsive caregivers were with the children, the two most important determinants of attachment quality according to attachment theory. As measured by the Strange Situation, attachments to mothers were no different for toddlers receiving nonmaternal care than for toddlers receiving only maternal care. However, insecure attachments were more likely if the nonmaternal care was low in quality, for more than 10 hours per week, or if mothers were low in sensitivity. Maternal sensitivity was especially important. Toddlers whose mothers were relatively high in sensitivity were usually securely attached, even if the quality of nonmaternal care was below average and the number of hours in care was more than 10 per week; in contrast, toddlers whose mothers were relatively low in sensitivity were often insecurely attached even if they received high-quality nonmaternal child care.

WA MT

ND

OR ID

WI

SD

WY UT

CA AZ

CO

PA IL

KS OK

NM

NY

MI IA

NE

NV

VT ME

MN

MO AR

OH

IN

KY

WV VA NC

TN

NH MA RI NJ CT DE MD D.C.

SC MS AL

GA

TX LA AK

FL HI

Percentage of children under 6 years old with both parents in the labor force 49.9– 59.9%

60– 64.9%

65– 69.9%

More than 70%

Map 5.2 s American Children with Working Parents Many American children live in households in which both parents are working. Which states have the highest percentage of working parents? How will this influence the need for early child care in these states?

Critiques of Attachment Theory

5.17

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Summarize the major critiques of attachment theory, including the cultural critique. Attachment theory is undoubtedly one of the most influential theories of human development. It has generated hundreds of studies since Bowlby first articulated it over 40 years ago (Atkinson & Goldberg, 2004; Cassidy & Shaver, 2010; Sroufe et al., 2005). However, it has also generated critiques that have pointed to limitations of the theory.

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development THE CHILD EFFECT CRITIQUE The “child effect” is one of the most common critiques of attachment theory. It claims the theory overstates the mother’s influence and understates the child’s influence on quality of attachment, in two related ways. First, it fails to recognize that children are born with different temperaments (see Chapter 4; Bakermans-Kranenburg et al., 2004). If, in the Strange Situation, a toddler is highly anxious when the mother leaves the room, then behaves aggressively by pushing her away when she returns, it could be due to a difficult temperament, not to the mother’s failure to be sufficiently sensitive and responsive (Atkinson et al., 1999; van IJzendoorn et al., 2004). Second, in attachment theory the direction of influence is one-way, from parents to children, but increasingly in recent decades researchers of human development have emphasized that parent–child relations are reciprocal or bidirectional. Parents influence their children, but children also influence their parents. For example, mothers of toddlers with a disorganized–disoriented attachment classification have been found to behave differently in the Strange Situation than other mothers. They may fail to respond when their toddlers become distressed, and may hold them at arm’s length when picking them up, rather than comforting them by holding them close (Lyons-Ruth et al., 1999; van IJzendoorn et al., 1999). These mothers sometimes appear confused, frustrated, or impatient. This could be a failure to be sensitive and responsive, but it is also possible that the mothers are responding to the toddler’s behavioral difficulties (Barnett et al., 1999). Most likely is that the mothers and disorganized–disoriented toddlers are influencing each other in a negative bidirectional cycle (Lyons-Ruth et al., 1999; Symons, 2001). Jerome Kagan (2000), who has conducted decades of influential research on young children, observes that it is highly unlikely that infants and toddlers are as vulnerable and impressionable to parental influence as the attachment theorists suppose. On the contrary, infants and toddlers have evolved to be capable of developing well in response to a wide range of variations in parenting. Parents do not need to be ideally sensitive and responsive in order for their children to grow up to be capable of forming healthy attachments to others. Although it is now widely acknowledged that child effects contribute to attachment quality, there is evidence from several sources indicating that attachment also depends on parental care. First, toddlers sometimes exhibit different attachments to fathers than to mothers (Shonkoff & Phillips, 2000). If attachment were due mainly to temperament or bidirectional effects, one would expect toddlers’ attachments to be consistent across caregivers. Second, attachment quality has been found to be affected by family events such as parental divorce, job loss, or financial problems (Thompson & Raikes, 2003). Again, if attachment were due primarily to child characteristics, one would expect consistency regardless of external events. Finally, behavior genetics studies have found little genetic contribution to attachment (O’Connor & Croft, 2001). If temperament were a major contributor to attachment quality, one would expect attachment quality to be heritable, as temperament is, yet current evidence indicates it is not.

THE CULTURAL CRITIQUE As we have seen, cultures vary widely in the care they provide for infants and toddlers. Overall, in traditional cultures infants and mothers are in close contact throughout the first year of life, and in the second year toddlers spend most of their time being cared for by an older girl, often a sibling, and playing in mixed-age groups. In the West, infants are also cared for mainly by mothers, but they typically have their own bedroom from the beginning and are left on their own for a considerable amount of time, including at night. Autonomy and independence are encouraged from an early age. To what extent are these differences reflected in attachment relationships? Remember, attachment is supposed to be a universal, species-wide phenomenon. According to Bowlby, it developed in the course of human evolution due to the extended vulnerability

213

Is early attachment the basis of all future love relationships?

214

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood that all human infants, toddlers, and children share. Consequently, attachment should be evident in similar ways across cultures. In the decades of research since Bowlby proposed his theory, researchers have concluded that children’s attachments are “recognizably the same” across cultures (Cassidy & Shaver, 2010, p. xiii). Some aspects of attachment may be universal. In all cultures, infants and toddlers develop attachments to the people around them who provide loving, protective care (van IJzendoorn & Sagi, 2010). There is evidence that parents in many cultures have a common view of what constitutes a securely attached child. One study involved mothers of toddlers in six cultures: China, Columbia, Germany, Israel, Japan, and the United States (Posada et al., 1995). Across cultures, mothers described an “ideally secure” child in similar ways, as relying on the mother in times of need but also being willing to explore the surrounding world—in short, using her as a secure base from which to explore, much as described in attachment theory. Other studies involving multiple cultures have found that secure attachment is the most common classification in all cultures studied so far (van IJzendoorn & Sagi, 2010). However, cultural variations have also been found. One study compared Strange Situation results for toddlers in the United States, Japan, and several northern European countries (van IJzendoorn & Kroonenberg, 1988). In all countries, the majority of toddlers were found to be securely attached (see Figure 5.7). However, the U.S. and northern European toddlers were more likely than Japanese toddlers to be classified as insecure–avoidant. In contrast, insecure–resistant attachment was especially common among the Japanese toddlers, compared to toddlers in the other countries. These differences were attributed to cultural differences in typical patterns of care. Specifically, a U.S. and northern European cultural emphasis on early independence was deemed to make insecure–avoidant attachment more likely, whereas in Japan mothers are rarely apart from their children and encourage a high degree of dependency in children. Consequently, their toddlers may have found the Strange Situation more stressful than the European or American toddlers did, making the insecure–resistant attachment classification more likely. In traditional cultures, any kind of insecure attachment is probably rare. Infants are soothed immediately at the first sign of distress, often with breast feeding. Toddlers are

Mothers and children in Japan often have very close relationships.

80 70

Secure Insecure-resistant Insecure-avoidant

Percentage of Infants

60 50 40 30 20 10 0 United States

Germany

Sweden

Netherlands

Japan

Figure 5.7 s Cultural Variations in the Strange Situation Across cultures, most toddlers exhibit secure attachment in response to the Strange Situation. In this study toddlers in Japan were more likely to be classified as insecure-resistant and less likely to be classified as insecure-avoidant than toddlers in other countries. Source: Based on van IJzendoorn & Kroonenberg, 1988

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development typically cared for by an older sister and also have frequent contact with the mother. However, as we have seen, weaning can be a major event in the lives of toddlers in traditional cultures, and it may have an influence on the security of attachment. In one of Ainsworth’s (1977) earliest studies, on mother–child attachments in Uganda, she observed that toddlers in Uganda often changed in attachment after weaning, suddenly showing a sharp increase in insecurity, including “a remarkable increase in their fear of strangers” (p. 143). In general, the traditional, non-Western norm of maternal care emphasizes interdependence and collectivism to a greater extent than is found in attachment theory (Morelli & Rothbaum, 2007; Rothbaum et al., 2000; Rothbaum & Morelli, 2005). Attachment theorists emphasize that sensitive and responsive maternal care should provide love and care while also encouraging self-expression and independence, but this is not an ideal found in all or even most cultures. For example, Rothbaum and colleagues (2007) describe the Japanese concept of amae (ah-may-uh), which is a very close, physical, indulgent relationship between the mother and her young child. This is the ideal in Japan, but to some attachment researchers it fits the description of the kind of mothering that promotes insecure– resistant attachment (George & Solomon, 1999). Also, attachment researchers describe how toddlers with secure attachments grow up to be children who are self-reliant, socially assertive, and have high self-esteem, but these traits are not viewed as virtues in all cultures (Rothbaum et al., 2000). Overall, attachment theory has held up quite well in the decades since Bowlby first proposed it. However, at this point relatively few studies have been conducted outside Western cultures, so there is more to be learned about the forms attachments may take in different cultures (Morelli & Rothbaum, 2007).

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

215

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Day-Care Provider Katal is a Mayan toddler who has just relocated from Mexico with her parents. Her only other caregivers, her grandparents, stayed behind. You notice Katal is not easily soothed when her parents leave, and when they return, she rushes to them but then seems to shun their attempts to comfort her. Would you classify Katal as an insecure-resistant child?

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE Given the long period of immaturity that the young of the human species have, is attachment necessarily universal? Would it be possible for a child to grow to maturity without forming attachments of some kind?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. What research findings led to Bowlby’s development of attachment theory? 2. How does attachment develop in the first 2 years of life? 3. How did Mary Ainsworth research attachment theory? 4. What have studies on the consequences of early child care found? What are the limitations of such studies? 5. To what extent do longitudinal studies of attachment support Bowlby’s theory? 6. Is attachment universal? What cultural variations have been found?

amae Japanese word for very close, physical, indulgent relationship between the mother and her young child

The Social World of the Toddler In toddlerhood as in infancy, the social world includes ties to family, especially mothers and fathers. However, in toddlerhood relations with siblings, peers, and friends become more prominent. Toddlerhood is also when autism first appears for some children, a serious disruption in their social development. Media use continues to be important in toddlerhood, especially television.

The Role of Fathers Compare and contrast the typical patterns of father involvement with infants and toddlers in traditional cultures and developed countries. In nearly all cultures, mothers play a central role in the care of infants and toddlers. As we have seen, fathers in traditional cultures are often excluded entirely from the birth process; in the weeks after birth, the mother and neonate are usually together constantly, whereas

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.18

216

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

polygyny cultural tradition in which men have more than one wife

Fathers in modern developed countries do more child care than they did in the past, but still not as much as mothers do.

the father may or may not be involved in early care. There are two reasons that mothers have historically been the primary caretakers of infants and toddlers. The first reason is biological. Because breast milk has usually been the main form of nourishment for human infants during the first half year, the mother tends to be the one who cares for the infant, more than anyone else. Consequently, by toddlerhood mothers are usually the primary attachment figure (Bowlby, 1969; Cassidy & Shaver, 2010). The second reason has a cultural basis. In most cultures through nearly all of human history, male and female gender roles have been separate and distinct (Gilmore, 1990; Hatfield & Rapson, 1996). In their adult roles, women have been expected to run the household and care for children, whereas men have been expected to protect and provide for the family (Arnett, 1998). In their leisure time women relax with children and other women, and men relax with other men (Gilmore, 1990). Consequently, in most cultures, historically, fathers have been on the periphery of the emotional lives of children. FATHERS IN TRADITIONAL CULTURES Although fathers are rarely involved in daily child care in traditional cultures, they are part of the child’s social environment in other ways. For example, in China the father’s traditional role is provider and disciplinarian (Ho, 1987). Care and nurturance is left to the mother. In Latin America, too, the tradition is that the father provides for the family and has unquestioned authority over his children, although in many Latin American cultures this role coexists with warm, affectionate relations with his children (Halgunseth et al., 2006). Many cultures in Africa have a tradition of polygyny, meaning that men often have more than one wife (Westoff, 2003). (Polygamy is a more general term referring to having two or more spouses, regardless of whether they are wives or husbands.) Households are composed of each wife and her children, with the father either living separately or rotating among them. Here, too, his role is that of provider and disciplinarian, and the children are not usually emotionally close to him (Nsamenang, 1992). Polygyny has become less common in recent decades. Although the most common cultural pattern worldwide is that fathers serve as providers but are otherwise remote from the emotional lives of infants and toddlers, there are some notable exceptions. Fathers in the Warlpiri culture of aboriginal Australia have a close relationship with their toddlers, but forge a unique bond with their daughters, as we’ll see in the Cultural Focus: Toddlerhood in Aboriginal Australia feature. Among the Manus people of New Guinea studied by Margaret Mead (1930/2001), during the first year of life the infant and mother are together almost constantly, and the father is involved only occasionally. However, once the child enters toddlerhood and begins to walk the father takes over most child care. The toddler sleeps with the father, plays with him, rides on his back, and goes along on his daily fishing expeditions. Later in childhood, if the parents quarrel and separate, the children often choose to stay with the father, indicating that by then he has become the primary attachment figure. A similar nurturing role for the father is found among the Aka people of central Africa, who lived until very recently by hunting and gathering, as all humans did until about 10,000 years ago (Hewlett, 2004). Aka fathers have been called “the most nurturing fathers yet observed” (Engle & Breaux, 1998, p. 5). They frequently hold their infants and toddlers, about five times as much as men in similar hunter-gatherer cultures (Hewlett, 2004). Mothers and fathers share infant and toddler care more or less equally, and both of them have nurturing, affectionate attachments to their children. FATHERS IN DEVELOPED COUNTRIES The examples of the Manus and the Aka show the flexibility and potential variation of human cultural patterns of fatherhood. Here, as in so many aspects of development, humans have no single biologically driven species-wide pattern of behavior, but learn to behave in ways valued in their cultural traditions. Despite the exceptions, there is a clear norm across human cultures of fathers being relatively remote and removed from close care of infants and toddlers.

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development In some ways, the role of fathers in developed countries today is in line with the pattern historically and in traditional societies. Across developed countries, fathers interact less with their infants and toddlers than mothers do, and provide less care such as bathing, feeding, dressing, and soothing (Chuang et al., 2004; Day & Lamb, 2004; Lamb & Lewis, 2005; Schwalb et al., 2004). In the United States, about one-third of toddlers live with single mothers; nonresident fathers are less involved in care of their toddlers than fathers who live in the household, although involvement is greater among nonresident fathers who are African American or Latino than among Whites (Cabrera et al., 2008). When fathers do interact with their infants and toddlers, it tends to be in play rather than care, especially in physical, highly stimulating, rough-and-tumble play (Lamb, 2000; Paquette, 2004). Dad is the one throwing the kids in the air and catching them, or wrestling with them, but usually he has not been the one feeding them applesauce or changing their diapers. However, there is a definite trend toward greater father involvement, as gender roles have become more flexible and egalitarian in developed countries (Pleck & Masciadrelli, 2004). American fathers have been found to spend about 85% as much time as mothers do in caring for their young children, and Canadian fathers about 75% (Pleck & Masciadrelli, 2004; Sandberg & Hofferth, 2001; Zuzanek, 2000). Fathers are more likely to provide nearequal care for young children when the mother and father work similar numbers of hours outside the home, and when marital satisfaction is high (NICHD Early Child Care Network, 2000). Like the examples of the Manus and the Aka, the findings of recent changes in fathers’ care for young children in developed countries show that parenting is to a large extent a learned rather than innate behavioral pattern that can change as a culture changes.

217

Watch the Video Rough and Tumble Play at MyDevelopmentLab

CULTURAL FOCUS Toddlerhood in Aboriginal Australia

H

have read about in this book, believe babies umans first arrived on the island continent of what is now should never be left alone and should known as Australia about 40,000 years ago. The first PAPUA NEW GUINEA rarely, if ever, be placed on the ground. humans brought with them a hunter-gatherer way of life INDONESIA Consequently, it is not until toddlerhood that still is the basis of life for many of their descendants, the AUSTRALIA that the children receive much gross Aboriginal Australians. Groups of a few families migrated accordNEW motor activity. Nevertheless, they begin ing to the change of seasons and the availability of food and waZEALAND to walk around their first birthday and ter, hunting animals such as kangaroos, emus, and lizards, and are soon toddling about the camp. Mothgathering fruits, seeds, and roots. However, immigrants from the ers must spend a substantial portion of their United Kingdom began to arrive in the 18th century, and today, day gathering the fruits, seeds, Aboriginal Australians comand roots that provide nourishprise less than 2% of the total ment for their families. When Australian population of about out gathering, they usually will 15 million (Frydenberg & Lodge, not take their toddler along, so 2007). The culture of Aboriginal they can focus on the work they Australians has been impacted are doing. However, in the camp in many ways by the majority there are always sisters, aunts, or culture, and many of them now grandmothers who can watch live a Western lifestyle in the the toddler while the mother is cities. Others still live the tradiat work. Co-wives also help; the tional nomadic way of life, and Warlpiri are polygynous. they will be the focus here, speWarlpiri toddlers breast-feed cifically the Warlpiri culture of at least through age 2; traditionAboriginal Australians (Peirroutally, they breast-fed until they sakos, 2000). were about 5 years old! Breast The Warlpiri, like people in Walpiri fathers often dote on their daughters. feeding provides nourishment many traditional cultures you

218

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

and also serves as a natural contraceptive, inhibiting ovulation so that children will not be too closely spaced. At night, Walpiri toddlers sleep on the ground in the arms of their mothers by the family campfire. Warlpiri parents are loving, gentle, and generous with their toddlers. Except when they are out gathering food, mothers are with their toddlers nearly all the time, often kissing them and speaking to them in “baby talk” (infant-directed speech, discussed in Chapter 4). Fathers also have close, affectionate relationships with their toddlers, especially doting on their daughters. Part of the father’s role includes protecting his daughters from harm, not just in childhood but through adolescence and adulthood. Both mothers and fathers fear that illness and disease may strike their young children, and they use magical methods to ward off these perils, including singing, storytelling, and body painting. Most Warlpiri children do not speak their first understandable words until about age 2, perhaps because their language

includes few short words. During the first 2 years, parents often mimic their infants’ and toddlers’ vocalizations, as a kind of teasing but affectionate baby talk. Although they begin speaking words later than toddlers in most other cultures, Warlpiri toddlers nevertheless become proficient speakers of their native language by the age of 3. Aboriginal cultures in Australia were nearly destroyed in the 20th century when the government adopted a policy of forced assimilation and relocation from their traditional lands into government settlements. However, in recent decades this policy was repealed and the Australian government has helped Aboriginal groups return to their ancestral lands. Although Aboriginal cultures have been changed through these experiences, and many of them have adopted the urban way of life of the Australian majority, it is remarkable that many others have been able to sustain something like their traditional way of life.

The Wider Social World: Siblings, Peers, and Friends

5.19

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe relationships with siblings, peers, and friends during toddlerhood. In studies of social development in toddlerhood, the focus has been on relations with parents, especially attachments to mothers. However, among the many ways toddlerhood is distinct from infancy is that the toddler’s social world broadens to include a wider range of people, including siblings, peers, and friends.

Watch the Video Sibling Rivalry at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Teacher One of your Mexican students in your Grade 3 classroom tells you that she spends her evening and weekends caring for her younger siblings, one of whom is in kindergarten and one of whom is a toddler. She helps their mother bathe them and she helps prepare meals, sometimes even preparing dinner on her own. Should you be alarmed?

THINKING CULTURALLY What hypothesis could you propose about how sibling relationships in toddlerhood in developing countries might differ from sibling relationships in developed countries, and what would be the basis for your hypothesis?

SIBLINGS: YOUNGER AND OLDER We have seen already how important sibling relationships are for toddlers in traditional cultures, where an older sibling, usually a sister, often takes over the main responsibility for child care from the mother. Toddlers in these cultures most certainly develop an attachment to the older siblings who care for them, but from the limited evidence available, it appears to be a secondary attachment rather than the primary attachment (Ainsworth, 1977; Levine et al., 1994). That is, under most conditions toddlers are content to be under the care of older siblings, but in times of crisis they want the care and comfort of their mothers. In developed countries, too, studies show that toddlers have attachments to siblings (Shumaker et al., 2011). One study used an adaptation of the Strange Situation to examine American toddlers’ attachments to older siblings (Samuels, 1980). Two-year-old toddlers and their mothers were asked to come to the backyard of an unfamiliar home, sometimes with—and sometimes without—a 4-year-old sibling present. When no older sibling was present, the toddlers mostly responded to the mother’s departure with distress and to her return with great relief, much as they do in the standard Strange Situation. However, when the older sibling was there along with the toddler, the toddler rarely showed distress when the mother left the backyard. The older sibling provided the emotional comfort and security of an attachment figure, making this outdoor Strange Situation less strange and intimidating. A substantial amount of research on toddlers’ relations with siblings has focused on how they respond to the birth of a younger sibling. Overall, their reaction tends to be negative. Often, following the birth of a younger sibling, toddlers’ attachment to the mother changes from secure to insecure, as they feel threatened by all the attention given to the new baby (Teti et al., 1996). Some toddlers display problems such as increased aggressiveness toward others, or become increasingly whiny, demanding,

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development and disobedient (Hughes & Dunn, 2007). They may regress in their development toward toilet training or self-feeding. Sometimes mothers become less patient and responsive with their toddlers, under the stress of caring for both a toddler and a new baby (Dunn & Kendrick, 1982). What can parents do to ease the transition for toddlers? Studies indicate that if mothers pay special attention to the toddler before the new baby arrives and explain the feelings and needs of the baby after the birth, toddlers respond more positively to their new sibling (Howe et al., 2001; Hughes & Dunn, 2007; Teti et al., 1996). However, the reality is that across cultures, conflict is more common with siblings than in any other relationship throughout childhood and adolescence, as we will see in more detail in Chapter 6. What if the toddler is the younger sibling rather than the older sibling? Here there is both an upside and a downside. The upside is that once younger siblings are no longer infants but toddlers, and develop the ability to talk, walk, and share in pretend play, older siblings show less resentment and become much more interested in playing with them (Hughes & Dunn, 2007). By their second year of life, toddlers often imitate their older siblings and look to them for cues on what to do and how to do it (Barr & Hayne, 2003). The downside is that conflict rises as toddlers become increasingly capable of asserting their own interests and desires. In one study that followed toddlers and their older siblings from when the toddlers were 14 months old to when they were 24 months old, home observations showed that conflict increased steadily during this period and became more physical (Dunn & Munn, 1985). In another study, 15- to 23-month-old toddlers showed remarkably advanced abilities for annoying their older siblings (Dunn, 1988). For example, one toddler left a fight with an older sibling to go and destroy an object the older sibling cherished; another toddler ran to find a toy spider and pushed it in his older sibling’s face, knowing the older sibling was afraid of spiders! In sum, toddlers’ relations with younger and older siblings are often characterized by ambivalence, a combination of positive and negative emotions. It is important to add that there is a great range of individual differences here. In other words, some toddlers get along a lot better with their siblings than others do, for reasons such as gender similarity or difference, spacing between siblings, and the mesh or clash of personalities (Hughes & Dunn, 2007). PEERS AND . . . FRIENDS? In most cultures, toddlerhood is a time of forming the first social relations outside the family. In traditional cultures, this usually means being part of a peer play group that may include siblings and cousins as well as other children. These play groups usually include children of a variety of ages, but toddlerhood is when children first come into the group after having been cared for during infancy mainly by the mother and an older girl. In developed countries, too, peer relations expand in toddlerhood, often in the form of some kind of group care such as a child-care center (Rubin et al., 2006). Research observing toddlers in these settings has found that their peer play interactions are more advanced than early studies had reported. One influential early study reported that toddlers engaged exclusively in solitary play, all by themselves, or parallel play, in which they would take part in the same activity but without acknowledging each other (Parten, 1932). However, more recent studies have found that toddlers engage in not only solitary and parallel play but in simple social play, where they talk to each other, smile, and give and receive toys, and even in cooperative pretend play, involving a shared fantasy such as pretending to be animals (Howes, 1996; Hughes & Dunn, 2007). Furthermore, toddlers who know each other well tend to engage in more advanced forms of play than unacquainted toddlers. In one study of toddlers attending the same child-care center, even young toddlers (16–17 months old) engaged in simple social play

219

Toddlers often react negatively to the birth of a younger sibling.

Watch the Video Play in Early Childhood at MyDevelopmentLab Toddlers in developed countries engage in advanced forms of play with their friends.

220

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

Toddler friends smile and laugh more with each other than they do with nonfriends. Here, three boys in South Africa share a laugh.

(Howes, 1985). By 24 months, half of the toddlers engaged in cooperative pretend play, and this kind of play was observed in all the toddlers between 30 and 36 months old. This is a striking contrast to studies of social relations among unacquainted toddlers, which had found mainly solitary and parallel play, with cooperative pretend play not appearing until at least age 3 (Howes, 1996; Hughes & Dunn, 2007) Clearly toddlers are capable of playing with each other in a variety of ways, but do they really form friendships? A substantial and growing body of research suggests they do (Goldman & Buysse, 2007). Their friendships appear to have many of the same features of friendships at other ages, such as companionship, mutual affection, and emotional closeness (Rubin et al., 2006). Even shortly after their first birthday, toddlers prefer some of their child-care or play-group peers over others and seek them out as companions when they are together (Shonkoff & Phillips, 2000). Like older children and even adults, toddlers choose each other as friends based partly on similarities, such as activity level and social skills (Rubin et al., 2006). Toddlers who become friends develop favorite games they play when together (Howes, 1996). Toddler friends share emotions more frequently with each other than they do with nonfriends. They smile and laugh more, but also have more conflicts, although conflicts between toddler friends are milder and more quickly resolved than among nonfriends (Ross & Lollis, 1989). Friendships do change in quality with age, as we will see in the chapters to come, but even in toddlerhood many of the features of friendship are evident.

Autism: A Disruption in Social Development

5.20

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Watch the Video Against Odds: Children with Autism at MyDevelopmentLab

autism developmental disorder marked by a lack of interest in social relations, abnormal language development, and repetitive behavior

Identify the characteristics of autism and recognize how autism affects prospects for children as they grow to adulthood. In 1938, a well-known child psychiatrist received a visit from parents concerned about their little boy, Donald (Donovan & Zucker, 2010). According to the parents, even as a baby Donald had displayed “no apparent affection” (p .85) for his parents, and still did not. He never cried when separated from them or wished to be comforted by them. Nor did he seem interested in other adults or children, appearing to “live within himself” (p. 85) with no need for social relations. Furthermore, Donald’s use of language was peculiar. He was often unresponsive to his parents’ instructions and requests, and did not even react to his own name. Yet certain unusual words captivated him and he would repeat them over and over again: trumpet vine, business, chrysanthemum. He enjoyed repetition not only of words but of behaviors, such as spinning round objects. This description became the basis of the initial diagnosis of what became known as autism, and the main features of the diagnosis are the same today as they were for Donald: (1) lack of interest in social relations, (2) abnormal language development, and (3) repetitive behavior. Many children with autism also prefer to have highly predictable routines and hate to have them disrupted. Some also have exceptional, isolated mental skills—Donald, for example, could multiply large numbers instantly in his head—but this is rare. The majority of children with autism are low in intelligence and exhibit some degree of intellectual disability (Lord, 2010). About 1 in 500 children is affected by autism, and another 4 in 100 have some but not all features of autism and are classified as having autistic spectrum disorder (ASD). These rates are consistent across Asia, Europe, and North America, with some variation based on diagnostic criteria used (Centers for Disease Control and Prevention [CDC], 2010). The origins of the disorder are unclear. It is believed to have a genetic basis, as evidence of abnormal brain development is present in the unusually large brains of children who

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development will later develop autism (Hadjikhani et al., 2004). Various environmental causes for autism have been proposed, from dietary contributors to toddlerhood vaccines, but none of them has been supported by research. Rates of autism have increased in recent decades in developed countries, but there is no consensus on the reasons for the increase (CDC, 2010). It may be that disorders once diagnosed as schizophrenia or mental retardation are now diagnosed as autism due to increased awareness of the disorder (Donovan & Zucker, 2010). Physicians in many countries now routinely screen toddlers for the disorder, whereas they did not in the past (CDC, 2010). Usually the diagnosis of autism or ASD is made during toddlerhood, between 18 and 30 months of age (Filipek et al., 2000). However, studies analyzing home videos of infants later diagnosed with autism indicate that signs of the disorder are already present in infancy (Dawson et al., 1998; Werner et al., 2000). Even at 8 to 10 months old, infants with autism show little or no evidence of normal social behaviors. They do not engage in joint attention with parents, or point to objects to show to others, or look at others, or respond to their own name. During infancy some of this behavior could be attributed to differences in temperament, but the diagnosis of autism becomes more definite in toddlerhood with the failure to develop language skills during a period that is normally a time of dramatic advances. About half of children with autism never develop language skills well enough to communicate about even basic needs, and the half who do develop some language skills are nevertheless impaired in their ability to communicate with others (Hale & Tager-Flusberg, 2005). Their social deficits compound their language deficits: Their lack of interest in others and lack of ability to understand others’ perspectives makes it difficult for them to engage in the normal exchange of conversation that other people perform without effort, even in toddlerhood. What happens to children with autism when they grow up? Eighty-five percent of them continue to live with parents, siblings, or other relatives (Donvan & Zucker, 2010). Some live in government-sponsored group homes, and in rare cases they are able to function at a high enough level to live alone, as Donald (now in his 70s) does. In some ways autism becomes more problematic in adulthood than in childhood, because adults with autism often lack emotional regulation as children with autism do but are bigger and can cause more disruption. They also develop sexual desires, without the social knowledge of the appropriate expression of those desires. There is no cure for autism and few effective treatments, but with help, many children and adults with autism can learn some skills for daily living, such as wearing clean clothes, asking for directions (and then following them), and keeping track of money.

221

Toddlers with autism have deficits in their social and language development. Here, a boy plays alone at a school for children with autism in Beijing, China.

Media Use in Toddlerhood Identify the typical rates of television use in toddlerhood and explain some consequences of toddlers’ TV watching. Media use among toddlers is more limited than it will be at later ages, when it will include everything from computers to cell phones to magazines. However, media use, especially television, is a typical part of daily life in most countries, even during toddlerhood. According to a national study in the United States, 58% of children under 3 watch TV every day, and 30% even have a TV in their bedroom (Rideout & Hamel, 2006). African

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

5.21

222

C h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

Television shows with prosocial themes can inspire prosocial behavior in toddlers.

displacement effect in media research, term for how media use occupies time that may have been spent on other activities

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE How does the displacement effect change—if at all—from toddlerhood through adulthood?

American and Latino toddlers watch more TV than toddlers in other ethnic groups, initiating a pattern of ethnic differences that will continue throughout life (Anand et al., 2005). Already in the second year of life, toddlers have begun to understand that the images on the TV screen are not real. In one study, 9-month-old infants and 14- and 19-month-old toddlers were shown a video in which a woman demonstrated how to play with a variety of toys for young children (Pierroutsakos & Troseth, 2003). The infants reached out to the screen and attempted to grasp, hit, or rub the toys, but the toddlers did not. However, other studies have shown that toddlers sometimes interact with televised images by talking to them, which suggests that for toddlers the television/reality boundary is not completely clear (Garrison & Christakis, 2005). How does TV-watching influence toddlers? Surveys indicate that a majority of American parents fear that TV may harm their young children (Rideout et al., 2003; Woodward & Gridina, 2000). However, with television, as with other media we will examine in future chapters, the effects depend very much on the media content. In one American study, one group of 2-year-olds was shown the TV show Barney and Friends, featuring a large, purple, talking dinosaur who encourages behavior such as kindness and sharing. This group was then compared in free play to another group of 2-year-olds who had not seen the show (Singer & Singer, 1998). The toddlers in the Barney group showed more prosocial behavior, such as sharing, and less aggressiveness, along with a greater tendency to engage in symbolic play. In a national (American) study, 70% of parents of children under age 3 reported that their toddlers had imitated positive behavior they had seen on television, such as sharing or helping, whereas only 27% had imitated aggressive behavior such as hitting or kicking (Rideout & Hamel, 2006). With regard to the effects of TV-watching on cognitive development, evidence is mixed, with some studies indicating that watching TV helps toddlers expand their vocabularies and others reporting that it may be detrimental to language development (Courage & Setliff, 2009). Again, content matters. One study had parents report toddlers’ TV-viewing patterns every three months from age 6–30 months, then assessed the toddlers’ language development at 30 months (Linebarger & Walker, 2005). Watching educationally oriented programs such as Dora the Explorer resulted in greater vocabularies and higher expressive language scores than watching other programs did. Other studies have found that TV can inspire imaginative play among toddlers (Weber, 2006). I remember this well from when my twins were toddlers, how they would watch a TV show or a video and then invent their own elaborate games pretending to be characters they had watched, such as the Teletubbies or Peter Pan. We even bought them Teletubbies dolls to facilitate the games. Even if TV sometimes inspires prosocial or creative behavior, a persistent concern about television use from toddlerhood onward is the displacement effect; that is, the fact that time spent watching TV is time not spent doing other activities such as reading or playing with other children (Weber, 2006). In 2001, the American Academy of Pediatrics recommended that children under 2 years old should not watch television at all, and children 2 years and older should be limited to no more than 2 hours of TV a day (American Academy of Pediatrics Committee on Public Education, 2001). The basis for this recommendation was not that television content is damaging but that young children would benefit more from active learning through experiences

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development such as play and conversations with others (Kirkorian et al., 2008). It should be added that in many households the television is on nearly all the time, and consequently even toddlers are exposed to TV content that is a long way from Barney (Rideout & Hamel, 2006).

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

Watch the Video Limitations on TV Commercials for Children at MyDevelopmentLab

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. What are some exceptions to the typical pattern of father involvement with infant and toddlers in traditional cultures? 2. How is the typical pattern of father involvement with infant and toddlers in developed countries changing? 3. How do toddlers respond to the birth of a younger sibling? How do toddlers’ relations with younger siblings differ from their relations with older siblings? 4. What kinds of play are typical between toddlers? 5. What are the main features, causes, and consequences of autism? 6. What are some of the consequences—both positive and negative—of toddlers’ TV use?

Section 3 VIDEO GUIDE Separation Anxiety Across Cultures (Length: 6:10) In this video, we explore the development of attachment among infants and toddlers by observing how children at different ages and from various cultures react to being approached by strangers and separated from their primary caregivers.

1. Describe an instance when you have witnessed a child experiencing separation or stranger anxiety. 2. The clip here shows examples of separation and stranger anxiety. Discuss the difference between pure separation anxiety and the impact that including a stranger can have on a child’s reaction. 3. Which of Piaget’s concepts is linked to separation anxiety? Explain this connection.

Watch the Video Separation Anxiety Across Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab

223

Summing Up Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab Listen at MyDevelopmentLab

Listen to an audio file of your chapter at MyDevelopmentLab

SECTION 1 PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT 5.1 Describe the typical changes in physical growth that take place in toddlerhood and explain the harmful effects of nutritional deficiencies on growth. Toddlers’ physical growth continues at a pace that is slightly reduced from infancy but is nevertheless faster than at any later time of life. Toddlers in developing countries often suffer protein and micronutrient deficiencies that impede their physical and cognitive development.

5.2 Describe the changes in brain development that take place during toddlerhood, and identify the two most common methods of measuring brain activity. The brain’s synaptic density peaks at the end of toddlerhood, followed by many years of synaptic pruning. The two most common methods of measuring brain activity are the EEG and the fMRI.

5.3 Describe the changes in sleeping patterns and sleeping arrangements that take place during toddlerhood. Toddlers’ episodes of night-waking increase from 18 to 24 months of age, in part due to teething of molars. In traditional cultures, toddlers sleep with their mothers until the next child is born, after which they sleep with other family members.

5.4 Describe the advances in motor development that take place during toddlerhood. In their gross motor development, toddlers learn to walk, run, climb, and kick a ball. Toddlers in traditional cultures are often restricted in their movements to protect them from danger—especially cooking fires. Advances in fine motor development include holding a cup and building a tower of blocks. In their third year, toddlers may be able to brush their teeth, with some assistance.

5.5 Compare and contrast the process and timing of toilet training in developed countries and traditional cultures. Children vary widely in the timing of learning toilet training, but most are toilet trained by the end of toddlerhood. In traditional cultures, toddlers usually learn controlled elimination through observing and imitating older children.

5.6 Distinguish the weaning process early in infancy from weaning later in toddlerhood. When weaning takes place in the second or third year of life, toddlers often resist. Customs in traditional cultures for promoting weaning include sending the toddler to a relative’s household for awhile or coating the mother’s breast with an unpleasant substance.

KEY TERMS kwashiorkor p. 178

synaptic density p. 179

micronutrients p. 178

EEG (electroencephalogram) p. 179

SECTION 2

weaning p. 185

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

5.7 Outline the cognitive achievements of toddlerhood in Piaget’s theory. According to Piaget, the ability for mental representations develops in the second half of the second year and is the basis for important aspects of later cognitive functioning, including problem solving and language. Object permanence also reaches nearcompletion during this period. Deferred imitation and categorization also require mental representation.

5.8 Explain Vygotsky’s sociocultural theory of cognitive development and contrast it with Piaget’s theory. Unlike Piaget and most other cognitive theorists and researchers, Vygotsky emphasized the cultural basis

224

fMRI (functional magnetic resonance imaging) p. 179

of cognitive development in childhood. He proposed concepts such as scaffolding and the zone of proximal development to describe how children obtain cultural knowledge from adults.

5.9 Summarize the evidence for the biological and evolutionary bases of language. In humans the larynx is lower in the throat than it is in other primates, making spoken language possible. Humans also have areas in the brain specifically devoted to language functions. Anatomically the capacity for language appears to have developed in early hominids 2 million years ago.

Chapt er 5

5.10 Describe the milestones in language development that take place during the toddler years. At 18 months, most toddlers speak about 50 words, usually in holophrases. By 24 months, most speak about 200 words and combine some words in telegraphic speech. By their third birthdays, most can easily use the language of their culture in full sentences.

SUMMARY

225

5.11 Identify how parents’ stimulation of toddlers’ language varies across cultures and evaluate how these variations relate to language development. Cultures vary widely in how much they encourage toddlers’ language development, from stimulating language use through direct interactions, to allowing toddlers to be present among conversing adults but otherwise not speaking to them much, to actually discouraging them from talking. Regardless of cultural practices, toddlers generally learn to use their language well by the time they reach age 3.

KEY TERMS mental representations p. 187

scaffolding p. 190

Wernicke’s area p. 192

fast mapping p. 194

deferred imitation p. 188

guided participation p. 191

holophrase p. 194

telegraphic speech p. 195

zone of proximal development p. 190

infinite generativity p. 192

overextension p. 194

language acquisition device (LAD) p. 196

private speech p. 190

Broca’s area p. 192

underextension p. 194

overregularization p. 196

SECTION 3 EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 5.12 Describe how emotional development advances during toddlerhood and identify the impact of culture on these changes. Sociomoral emotions developing in toddlerhood include guilt, shame, embarrassment, envy, and pride. They are called sociomoral emotions because they indicate that toddlers have begun to learn the moral standards of their culture. Toddlers in Western cultures have occasional tantrums, perhaps because they have a more developed sense of intentionality than infants do and so are more likely to protest when thwarted. However, tantrums are rare outside the West where cultures place less emphasis on self-expression.

5.13 Describe the changes in self-development that take place during toddlerhood. The birth of the self in toddlerhood is indicated in the development of self-recognition and self-reflection. Gender identity also develops during this time, as children begin to identify themselves and others as male or female and to apply gender terms.

5.14 Distinguish between sex and gender and summarize the evidence for the biological basis of gender development. Sex is the biological status of being male or female, whereas gender refers to the cultural categories of “male” and “female.” The biological basis of gender is indicated in evolutionary theory, ethological studies, and hormonal studies. However, changes in male and female roles in recent times have shown that these roles can change dramatically over a relatively short time and

therefore biological assumptions about gender should be viewed with skepticism.

5.15 Describe the essential features of attachment theory and identify the four classifications of attachment. In formulating attachment theory, Bowlby emphasized the evolutionary need for a person who would provide protection and care during the vulnerable early years of life. Ainsworth developed the Strange Situation to assess attachment quality, and concluded that it showed three distinct types of attachment: secure, insecure– avoidant, and insecure–resistant. The young child forms an internal working model depending on the mother’s sensitivity and responsiveness. Disorganized–disoriented is a fourth classification, added by later researchers.

5.16 Identify the key factors influencing the quality of toddlers’ attachment to their mothers, and explain what effect attachment quality has on development. The quality of attachment is based mainly on how sensitive and responsive a mother is toward her child. Attachment quality as assessed in toddlerhood does not consistently predict later outcomes, except for the unusual disorganized–disoriented attachment type.

5.17 Summarize the major critiques of attachment theory, including the cultural critique. Attachment theory has been criticized for not acknowledging temperament sufficiently and for overlooking bidirectional effects. Toddlers in all cultures appear to become attached to those who care for them most, but there are important cultural variations in patterns and norms of attachment.

226

C hap h ap ter 5

Toddlerhood

5.18 Compare and contrast the typical patterns of father involvement with infants and toddlers in traditional cultures and developed countries. Fathers in traditional cultures usually serve as family providers but are remote from toddlers’ emotional lives, although there are exceptions. Across cultures, fathers tend to provide less physical and emotional care than mothers, but this is changing as gender roles and work responsibilities change.

5.19 Describe relationships with siblings, peers, and friends during toddlerhood. Across cultures, toddlers often react negatively to the birth of a younger sibling. When toddlers themselves are the younger siblings, their older siblings enjoy playing with them more than when they were infants, but conflict tends to rise as toddlers become more capable of asserting their own desires. With friends, toddler play takes a variety of forms, including solitary play, parallel play, simple social play, and cooperative pretend play. Toddlers’ friendships often have qualities similar

to friendships at older ages, including companionship, mutual affection, and emotional closeness.

5.20 Identify the characteristics of autism and recognize how autism affects prospects for children as they grow to adulthood. Autism is a developmental disorder marked by a lack of interest in social relations, abnormal language development, and repetitive behavior. The social and language deficits of autism make social development problematic in childhood and beyond.

5.21 Identify the typical rates of television use in toddlerhood and explain some consequences of toddlers’ TV watching. Toddlers in many countries watch TV every day. Television watching in toddlerhood may promote prosocial behavior if the TV content is prosocial, but there are concerns about the displacement effect, especially for children under 2 years old.

KEY TERMS disorganized–disoriented attachment p. 209

sociomoral emotions p. 202

gender identity p. 204

secure base p. 208

empathy p. 202

sex p. 204

separation anxiety p. 208

prosocial behavior p. 202

gender p. 204

Strange Situation p. 209

amae p. 215

ethology p. 205

secure attachment p. 209

polygyny p. 216

insecure–avoidant attachment p. 209

autism p. 220

self-recognition p. 203

primary attachment figure p. 207

insecure–resistant attachment p. 209

displacement effect p. 222

self-reflection p. 203

stranger anxiety p. 208

autonomy versus shame and doubt p. 203

Practice Test Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab 1. ______________ is a condition specific to toddlerhood in which protein deficiencies lead to varied symptoms such as swollen bellies, hair loss, and lack of energy. a. Kwashiorkor b. SIDS c. Marasmus d. Dysentery 2. What most characterizes early brain development in toddlerhood is a. the formation of the cerebral cortex. b. the steep increase in the density of synaptic connections among neurons. c. activity in the amygdala. d. the production of new brain cells. 3. During toddlerhood, a. sleeping alone is rare in traditional cultures. b. children sleep more than they did in infancy (because they are so much more active). c. naps are no longer needed. d. children sleep consistently throughout the night. 4. Toddlers a. who do not walk by 1 year are likely to have a gross motor problem.

b. in traditional cultures are equal to toddlers from Western cultures in the development of their gross motor skills. c. can usually run before they can stand briefly on one leg. d. show the same pace of gross motor development as fine motor development. 5. In the West, a. most children show signs of readiness for toilet training by their first birthday. b. views about toilet training have stayed the same over the last several decades. c. children are toilet trained in a nearly identical way as their counterparts in traditional cultures. d. a sign of being ready to begin toilet training is when the child can stay “dry” for an hour or two during the day. 6. If you are a toddler from a traditional culture, you would likely a. have experienced some customary practice for being weaned. b. be abruptly weaned at age 1. c. be given formula instead of breast milk. d. still be breast-feeding at age 5.

Chapt er 5 7. When children generally avoid making the A-not-B error, they a. show the ability to categorize. b. have attained object permanence. c. understand scaffolding. d. use tertiary circular reactions. 8. According to Vygotsky, ______________ is required for cognitive development. a. social interaction b. formal education c. strong parent–child attachment d. emotional self-regulation 9. When it comes to learning what we consider language, the most significant difference between apes and humans is a. the inability for apes to learn more than a few signs. b. the faster pace of humans’ sign language. c. the inability of apes to generate word symbols in an infinite number of ways. d. the inability of apes to make requests. 10. Which is an example of overextension? a. A child saying, “He hitted me with a stick.” b. A child saying, “The moon looks happy tonight.” c. A child calling all men “Dada.” d. A child saying “I no like peas.” 11. Research has shown that a. direct stimulation of language development is discouraged in some cultures. b. genetics plays very little role in verbal ability. c. language development in American children is not linked to income-level of parents. d. maternal responsiveness to American children’s vocalizations had no impact on when children reached language milestones. 12. Which of the following is a sociomoral emotion? a. anger b. pride c. fear d. happiness 13. Researchers secretly dabbed a red spot on the nose of babies of different ages and then placed them in front of a mirror. They were testing a. gender identity. b. sex roles. c. stranger anxiety. d. self-recognition. 14. Gender identity a. develops much more quickly in females than males. b. refers to the ability of children to identify themselves as male and female. c. is demonstrated when a child prefers to be with the samesex parent or grandparent. d. develops around age 5. 15. Secure attachment is characterized by a. a willingness to use the caregiver as a secure base to explore the environment. b. a tendency to be self-centered.

SUMMARY

227

c. acting both relieved and angry at their caregiver after seeing her again after separation. d. a dependency on the mother for approval of all activities. 16. Research has shown that a child with a(n) ______________ attachment classification is most likely to have later problems such as hostility, psychopathology, and cognitive deficits. a. insecure–resistant b. insecure–avoidant c. disorganized–disoriented d. goal-corrected 17. Which of the following best describes attachment across cultures? a. Autonomy and independence are encouraged from an early age across cultures. b. In all cultures, infants and toddlers develop attachments to the people around them who provide loving, protective care. c. Insecure–resistant attachment is the most common classification in all cultures because many children find the Strange Situation to be very stressful. d. Children from the United States and Japan tend to be classified the same way in studies employing the Strange Situation paradigm. 18. In developed countries, fathers would most likely be observed in which of the following activity with their infants or toddlers? a. bathing them b. feeding them c. soothing them d. playing with them 19. During toddlerhood a. those who know each other well usually engage in solitary play rather than other forms of play. b. friendships seem to have many of the same features of friendships at other ages. c. there seems to be no preference for play partners; they play equally with whatever children are present. d. children are not yet capable of engaging in simply social play or cooperative pretend play. 20. Which behavior would be most characteristic of a child who has been diagnosed with autism? a. a preoccupation with talking to strangers b. a preoccupation with repetitive movements c. a preoccupation with looking at faces d. a preoccupation with pointing at objects until others look at them 21. Research on media has shown that a. in the United States it is virtually unheard of to have a TV in a young child’s bedroom. b. children are only able to learn to model aggressive behaviors at this age because prosocial behaviors require more advanced cognitive development. c. the effects of television and other media depend on the content. d. the displacement effect is no longer considered a major problem because of all the media options available.

6 228

Early Childhood

Section 1 PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT Growth from Age 3 to 6 Bodily Growth Brain Development and “Infantile” Amnesia Health and Safety in Early Childhood

Motor Development Gross and Fine Motor Skills Handedness

Section 2 COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT Theories of Cognitive Development Piaget’s Preoperational Stage of Cognitive Development Understanding Thinking: The Development of “Theory of Mind” Cultural Learning in Early Childhood

Early Childhood Education The Importance of Preschool Quality Cross-National Variations Preschool as a Cognitive Intervention

Language Development Advances in Vocabulary and Grammar Pragmatics: Social and Cultural Rules of Language

Section 3 EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT Emotional Regulation and Gender Socialization Emotional Regulation Moral Development Gender Development

Parenting Parenting “Styles” Parenting in Other Cultures Discipline and Punishment

The Child’s Expanding Social World Siblings and “Only Children” Peers and Friends Media Use in Early Childhood

Summing Up

229

IT IS MIDMORNING IN A DAY CARE CENTER IN AALBORG, DENMARK, AND LARS OLSEN, AGE 4, IS PLAYING A GAME WITH HIS FRIEND PELLE (PELL-UH). “Look out!” he

for the midday meal, and they run to greet him. Soon Mari’s older brother and sister will be coming home from school to join them. In the afternoon and evening, Mari continues to work alongside her

shouts to Pelle, holding up a toy airplane with a little pilot in it. “There’s

mother and take care of her little brother. There is water to be fetched

gonna be a crash!” Pelle, with no airplane of his own, has taken a

and firewood to be gathered, and Roberto must be watched constantly.

plastic banana from the kitchen play area and straddled a small stuffed

Her aunt and her cousin Gina come by, and she and Gina play with their

bear on it. “You can’t catch me! I’m too fast!” he exclaims, and dashes

dolls, pretending that the dolls are taking tortillas into the village square

away with Lars in pursuit. Lars catches up to him and hits his toy plane

to sell. Mari’s older sister is currently the one who sells the tortillas in

against Pelle’s banana airplane, and the airplanes crash to the ground

town, but Mari knows that within a few years this duty will fall to her.

along with the laughing boys.

In the evening the family gathers around the ever-smoldering fire,

“Come, children!” calls the boys’ preschool teacher, Birgitte. “It’s

and Mari sits on her father’s lap. Before long Mari is asleep, and the

story time.” The children, familiar with this daily ritual, sit on the floor

next morning she will have no memory of being passed from her father

in a semicircle in front of Birgitte as she begins to read the story of

to her older sister, or of falling asleep by her sister’s side next to the fire.

the day. Lars enjoys the story, and the “Let-

In the afternoon his mother picks him up on the way from her job at an accounting firm,



learned most of his letters already, and looks forward to being able to read.

As we have seen in the previous two



ter Learning Time” that comes after it. He has

the materials of their fantasy games are drawn from their cultural environment

and the two of them go home. Soon his father

chapters, from birth onward children’s development can be very different depending on their culture. In early childhood the cultural contexts of development expand in several important ways, as the stories of Lars and Mari show. Children begin to learn culturally specific

arrives home from work, too, and Lars watches television while his par-

skills, through participation in daily tasks with their parents and siblings in

ents prepare dinner.

some cultures, as in Mari’s case, or through participation in group care and

After dinner, Lars watches more TV as his parents clean up, then

preschool in other cultures, as for Lars. Their play comes to include pretend

he and his father play a board game. Bedtime comes at 8 P.M. sharp.

play, and the materials of their fantasy games are drawn from their cultural

His mother puts him to bed, reading him a story before giving him a

environment—airplanes for Lars, tortillas for Mari. They become increas-

kiss and wishing him good night.

ingly aware of their culture’s differential gender expectations for boys and

Meanwhile, an ocean away in a Mayan village in Guatemala, 5-year-old

girls. And they develop an awareness of their culture’s values and moral

Maricela helps her mother make the day’s tortillas. Mari flattens a ball

order. By sleeping alone in his bedroom, Lars is learning the cultural value

of dough into a tortilla as her mother cooks. When her brother Roberto

of individualism; by sleeping alongside others, Mari is learning that she is

toddles over to join them, Mari jumps up to hold him away from the

always intertwined with others in bonds of mutual support and obligation.

fire. He is not yet 2 years old, and she is responsible for keeping him

We will explore all of these areas in the course of this chapter.

away from danger. She carries him outside, where they play a chasing

First, we examine the changes in physical and motor development that

game for awhile. They notice their father coming home from the fields

occur in early childhood.

230

SECTION 1

PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 6.1 Describe the physical growth and change that takes place during early childhood. 6.2 Describe the changes in brain development that take place during early childhood and the aspects of brain development that explain “infantile” amnesia. 6.3 Identify the main nutritional deficiencies and the primary sources of injury, illness, and mortality during early childhood in developed and developing countries. 6.4 Describe changes in gross and fine motor abilities during early childhood, and explain how these changes may have a cultural basis. 6.5 Describe the development of handedness and identify the consequences and cultural views of left-handedness.

Growth from Age 3 to 6 The pace of bodily growth continues to decline in the period from toddlerhood to early childhood, as it did from infancy to toddlerhood. A variety of parts of the brain make crucial strides forward, although brain development still has a long way to go. Optimal growth in the body and the brain require adequate health and nutrition, which are lacking in much of the world during early childhood.

Bodily Growth Describe the physical growth and change that takes place during early childhood.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

6.1

From ages 3 to 6 the typical American child grows 2–3 inches per year and adds 5 to 7 pounds. The typical 3-year-old is about 35 inches tall and weighs about 30 pounds; the typical 6-year-old is about 45 inches tall and weighs about 45 pounds. Throughout this period, boys are slightly taller and heavier than girls, although the average differences are small. Both boys and girls gain more in weight than in height during early childhood, but most add more muscle than fat. From toddlerhood to early childhood, most children lose their remaining “baby fat” and their bodily proportions become similar to those of adults. In developing countries, average heights and weights in early childhood are considerably lower, due to lower nutrition and higher likelihood of childhood diseases. For example, the average 6-year-old in Bangladesh is only as tall as the average 4-year-old in Sweden (Leathers & Foster, 2004). Within developing countries, too, differences in socioeconomic status influence gains in height and weight in early childhood. As noted in earlier chapters, economic differences tend to be large in developing countries; most have a relatively small middle- and upper-class and a large population of low-income people. Wealthier people have more access to nutritional foods, so their children are taller and weigh more than poorer children of the same age (Ogden et al., 2002). Given roughly equal levels of nutrition and health care, individual differences in height and weight gains during childhood are due to genetics (Chambers et al., 2001). By their third birthday, most children have a full set of 20 teeth (Eisenberg et al., 1996). These are their primary or “baby” teeth that will be replaced by 32 permanent teeth in the course of childhood, beginning at about age 6. However, this replacement process takes place slowly, lasting until about age 14, so children use their baby teeth for up to

231

232

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

By age 5, about 40% of North American children have at least one cavity.

10 years and have to learn how to take care of them to prevent tooth decay. In developed countries, children usually have their first visit to the dentist around age 3 (Bottenberg et al., 2008; Chi et al., 2011). Most children learn how to brush their teeth in early childhood, and in developed countries it is increasingly common for children’s dental care to include fluoride rinses and sealants (plastic tooth coatings). Some countries and local areas also add fluoride to the water system, which greatly reduces children’s rates of cavities. Nevertheless, about 40% of North American children have at least one dental cavity by age 5 (World Health Organization [WHO], 2008), primarily due to inconsistent dental care and to diets that are heavy in sugars and starches that cause cavities. Children in developing countries are less likely to have diets loaded with sugars and starches, but they are also less likely to have fluoride in their water systems and less likely to have access to regular dental care that would provide fluoride rinses and sealants. Overall, children in most developing countries have more tooth decay in early and middle childhood than children in developed countries do (WHO, 2008).

Brain Development and “Infantile” Amnesia

6.2

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

corpus callosum band of neural fibers connecting the two hemispheres of the brain cerebellum structure at the base of the brain involved in balance and motor movements reticular formation part of the lower brain, involved in attention

Describe the changes in brain development that take place during early childhood and the aspects of brain development that explain “infantile” amnesia. The size of the brain continues to increase gradually during early childhood. At age 3 the brain is about 70% of its adult weight, and at age 6, about 90% (Bauer et al., 2009). In contrast, the average 6-year-old’s body weight is less than 30% what it will be in adulthood, so the growth of the brain outpaces the rest of the body (Nihart, 1993). The frontal lobes grow faster than the rest of the cerebral cortex during early childhood (Anderson et al., 2008; Blumenthal et al., 1999). Growth in the frontal lobes underlies the advances in emotional regulation, foresight, and organizing that take place during the preschool years (Diamond, 2004). Throughout the cerebral cortex, growth from age 3 to 15 takes place not gradually but in spurts within the different lobes, followed by periods of vigorous synaptic pruning (Thompson et al., 2000). During early childhood the number of neurons continues the decline that began in toddlerhood via synaptic pruning. The increase in brain size and weight during early childhood is due to an increase in dendritic connections between neurons and to myelination (see Chapter 4 p. 131, if you need to refresh your memory about myelination). Four parts of the brain are especially notable for their myelination during early childhood (see Figure 6.1). In the corpus callosum, the band of neural fibers connecting the right and left hemispheres of the cerebral cortex, myelination peaks during early childhood, although it continues at a slower pace through adolescence. The corpus callosum allows for coordination of activity between the two hemispheres, so increased myelination of this area of the brain enhances the speed of functioning throughout the cerebral cortex. Substantial myelination also takes place in early childhood in the cerebellum, a structure at the base of the brain involved in balance and motor movements. Increased myelination enhances connections between the cerebellum and the cerebral cortex. This change underlies the child’s increasing abilities to jump, run, climb, and throw a ball. In the reticular formation, a part of the brain involved in attention, myelination is completed by age 5, which helps explain the increase in attention span that takes place in

Section 1 Physical Development

233

the course of early childhood. For example, by age 4 or 5 most children Corpus callosum Cerebellum Controls balance and motor could easily sit through a 10–15 minute period in preschool while a story Connects left and right hemispheres movements is read aloud, whereas most toddlers would be unable to sit still and pay of the brain attention for so long. Similarly, myelination in the hippocampus is completed by age 5. The hippocampus is involved in the transfer of information from short-term to long-term memory, so the completion of myelination by age 5 may explain why autobiographical memory (memory for personal events and experiences) is limited prior to this age (Rolls, 2000). However, myelination in the hippocampus is gradual, and most adults can remember some autobiographical events that happened before age 5 (Howe et al., 2009). For example, in one study children who had been hospitalized for a medical emergency at age 2–13 were interviewed 5 years later (Peterson & Whalen, 2001). Even the children who were only 2 years-old at the time of the injury recalled the main features of their injury experience accurately 5 years later, although memory for details of the experience improved with age. Hippocampus Reticular formation Other studies have found that many children and adults have au- Involved in transfer Controls attention tobiographical memories for events and experiences that happened as of information from short-term to long-term early as age 2, but remember little or nothing prior to this age (Cour- memory age & Cowan, 2009). The inability to remember anything prior to age 2 Figure 6.1 s Four Brain Structures with is known as infantile amnesia. One recent theory proposes that autoHigh Myelination in Early Childhood In which biographical memory before age 2 is limited because the awareness of self becomes stable structures is myelination completed by age 5? at about 2 years of age and serves as a new organizer around which events can be encoded, stored, and retrieved in memory as personal, that is, as having happened “to me” (Howe et al., 2009). Another perspective proposes that encoding memories is promoted by language development, because language allows us to tell ourselves a narrative of events and Explore the Concept Virtual Brain: experiences; consequently, most autobiographical memory is encoded only after language Learning and Memory development accelerates at age 2 (Newcombe et al., 2007). at MyDevelopmentLab Autobiographical memory may also be partly cultural. In a study comparing adults’ autobiographical memories, British and (White) American adults remembered more APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE events prior to age 5 than Chinese adults did, and their earliest memory was 6 months earlier on average (Wang et al., 2009). The interpretation proposed by the authors was What is your earliest memory? Is that the greater individualism of British and American cultures promotes greater atthere any way for you to tell if it really tention to individual experiences and consequently more and earlier autobiographical happened or how accurate it is? memories.

Health and Safety in Early Childhood Identify the main nutritional deficiencies and the primary sources of injury, illness, and mortality during early childhood in developed and developing countries.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

6.3

By early childhood, children are not as vulnerable to health threats as they were in infancy and toddlerhood (UNICEF, 2008). Nevertheless, there are many health and safety concerns associated with this period. Proper nutrition is essential to a child’s healthy development, yet in developing countries the rates of malnutrition are alarmingly high. Children in developing countries remain vulnerable to some illnesses and diseases, and children worldwide are subject to high rates of injuries compared to other periods of the life course.

NUTRITION AND MALNUTRITION As the rate of physical growth slows down in early childhood, food consumption diminishes as well. Children may have some meals, or even some whole days, where they eat little. This can be alarming to parents, but it is nothing to worry

hippocampus stucture involved in transfer of information from short-term to long-term memory infantile amnesia inability to remember anything that happened prior to age 2

234

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

anemia dietary deficiency of iron that causes problems such as fatigue, irritability, and attention difficulties

Watch the Video Kids and Food at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse How would you respond to a parent of an overweight 5-year-old who claimed that hot dogs, macaroni and cheese, and other high-fat foods are “the only things he’ll eat”?

Many children in developed countries have nutritional deficiencies despite an abundance of food. Here, a child in London eats a fast food meal that is high in fat and sugar.

about as long as it does not happen over an extended period and is not accompanied by symptoms that may indicate illness or disease. Appetites vary a lot from day to day in early childhood, and the 5-year-old who barely touched dinner one night may eat nearly as much as Mom and Dad the next night (Hursti, 1999). Children generally learn to like whatever foods the adults in their environment like and provide for them. In India kids eat rice with spicy sauces, in Japan kids eat sushi, in Mexico kids eat chili peppers. Nevertheless, a myth persists among many North American parents that kids in early childhood will only eat a small range of foods high in fat and sugar content, such as hamburgers, hot dogs, fried chicken, and macaroni and cheese (Zehle et al., 2007). This false belief then becomes a self-fulfilling prophecy, as children who eat foods high in sugar and fat lose their taste for healthier foods (Black et al., 2002). The assumption that young children like only high fat and sugar foods also leads parents to bribe their children to eat healthier foods—“If you eat three more bites of carrots, then you can have some pudding”—which leads the children to view healthy foods as a trial and unhealthy foods as a reward (Birch et al., 2003). These cultural practices contribute to high rates of childhood obesity in many developed countries, as we will see in more detail in Chapter 7. Because young children in developed countries often eat too much of unhealthy foods and too little of healthy foods, many of them have specific nutritional deficiencies despite living in cultures where food is abundant. Calcium is the most common nutritional deficiency in the United States, with one-third of American 3-year-olds consuming less than the amount recommended by health authorities (Wagner & Greer, 2008). Calcium is especially important for the growth of bones and teeth, and is found in foods such beans, peas, broccoli, and dairy products such as milk and cheese. Over the past 30 years, as children have consumed less milk and more soft drinks, calcium deficiencies in early childhood have become more common (Fox et al., 2004). In developing countries, malnutrition is the norm rather than the exception. The World Health Organization estimates that about 80% of children in developing countries lack sufficient food or essential nutrients (Van de Poel et al., 2008). The two most common types of malnutrition are lack of protein and lack of iron. Lack of protein is experienced by about 25% of children under age 5 worldwide, and can result in two fatal diseases described in Chapters 4 and 5, marasmus (in infancy) and kwashiorkor (in toddlerhood and early childhood). Iron deficiency, known as anemia, is experienced by the majority of children under age 5 in developing countries (WHO, 2002). Anemia causes fatigue, irritability, and difficulty sustaining attention, which in turn lead to problems in cognitive and social development (Kaplan et al., 2007; Rao & Georgieff, 2001). Foods rich in iron include most meats, as well as vegetables such as potatoes, peas, and beets, and grains such as oatmeal and brown rice. As noted in Chapter 5, young children in developed countries may also experience anemia if they do not eat enough healthy foods (Brotanek et al., 2007). ILLNESS AND DISEASE In developing countries, the causes of death in early childhood are usually illnesses and diseases, especially pneumonia, malaria, and measles (UNICEF, 2008). Malnutrition is believed to be indirectly responsible for about half of early childhood deaths, because lack of sufficient food reduces the effectiveness of the body’s immune system. Map 6.1 highlights global mortality rates and major causes of death in children under age 5. However, remarkable progress has been made in recent decades in reducing mortality in children under age 5. From 1960 to 2006, the number of deaths worldwide of children under age 5 declined from 20 million to under 10 million, even though the world’s population more than doubled during that time (UNICEF, 2008). The decline is due to a variety of factors, especially improved food production in developing countries and increased prevalence of childhood vaccinations.

Section 1 Physical Development

235

Europe Diarrhea-10% Measles-0% Malaria-0% Pneumonia-27% Other diseases-49% Injuries-12%

60°

Eastern Mediterranean Diarrhea-29% Measles-2% Malaria-5% Pneumonia-31% Other diseases-29% Injuries-5%

30°

30°

Americas Diarrhea-14% Measles-0% Malaria-0% Pneumonia-24% Other diseases-47% Injuries-12%



Africa

30°

150°



Southeast Asia Diarrhea-20% Measles-6% Malaria-2% Pneumonia-29% Other diseases-35% Injuries-6%

120°

90°

60°

Diarrhea-24% Measles-1% Malaria-21% Pneumonia-22% Other diseases-22% Injuries-3%

30°

30°

Number of deaths by age 5 per 1,000 live births

Western Pacific 0°

30°

60°

90°

120°

150°

WHO Region

Europe Americas Western Pacific Southeast Asia Eastern Mediterranean African 0

30

60 90 120 Under age 5 mortality rate

Diarrhea-7% Measles-0% 150° Malaria-0% Pneumonia-31% Other diseases-45% Injuries-16%

Top causes of death among children under 5 years of age (% of total) by World Health Organization region

150

Map 6.1 s Worldwide Mortality Rates and Causes of Death in Children Under Age 5 Which regions of the world have the lowest and highest rates of childhood deaths? How do the causes of death vary by region?

THINKING CULTURALLY In developed countries, where most children receive vaccinations and have access to adequate food and medical care, minor illnesses are common in early childhood, with most children experiencing 7–10 per year (Kesson, 2007). Minor illnesses help build up the immune system, so that children typically experience them less frequently with age.

INJURIES Do you remember becoming injured at all in early childhood? If you do, you are in good company. Most young children—and their parents—can count on spending a portion of their childhood nursing an injury; a minor “boo-boo” if they’re lucky, but in some cases something more serious. Children in early childhood have high activity levels and their motor development is advanced enough for them to be able to run, jump, and climb, but their cognitive development is not yet advanced enough for them to anticipate situations that might be dangerous. This combination leads to high rates of injuries in early childhood. In the United States each year, one-third of children under 10 become injured badly enough to receive medical attention (Field & Behrman, 2003). Boys are more likely than girls to become injured in early childhood, because their play tends to be rougher and more physically active. However, in developing countries, most of the injuries and deaths that take place in early childhood occur not due to high activity levels but as a consequence of the prevalence of automobile travel. In developed countries, the most common cause of injury and death in early childhood is motor

Consider the foods that you typically see on the “Kid’s Menu” in restaurants. How do these menus reflect cultural beliefs about food? Deaths worldwide among children age 5 and under have declined by half in the past 50 years, largely due to increased childhood vaccinations. Here, a Red Cross volunteer in El Salvador gives an oral vaccination to a 6-year-old boy.

236

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse Six-year-old Rosy from Mexico injured herself playing soccer. Her parents take this as evidence that girls should not play soccer, because it is too dangerous and they did not play soccer in the rural village they came from. What might you say to Rosy’s parents?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

vehicle accidents (National Highway Traffic Safety Administration [NHTSA], 2011; Safe Kids Worldwide, 2002). Other common causes of injury and death in early childhood are drowning, falls, fire, and choking (Overpeck et al., 1999). You might think that rates of injury and death due to accidents in early childhood would be lower in developing countries than in developed countries, since people in developing countries are less likely to own the cars that are the predominant source of early childhood injury and death in developed countries. However, rates of early childhood injury and death due to accidents are actually higher in developing countries. For example, rates of unintentional injury among 1- to 14-year-olds in South Africa are 5 times higher than in developed countries; in Vietnam, rates are 4 times higher, and in China 3 times higher (Safe Kids Worldwide, 2002). This is due to more stringent safety codes in developed countries, such as requiring child seats in cars, strict building codes to prevent fires, and lifeguards in public swimming areas where drowning is a potential danger. An organization called Safe Kids Worldwide (2009) is working to advocate safety measures for young children in both developed and developing countries. It currently has chapters in 16 countries, including China, Brazil, India, and Canada, and is expanding steadily. Despite the high rates of accidental injury among young children in developing countries, disease is a far greater danger. Only 3% of deaths of children under 5 in developing countries are due to injuries, and virtually all the other 97% are due to illness and disease (UNICEF, 2008). In contrast, even though rates of accidental injuries are much lower in developed countries than in developing countries, accidental injuries are the leading cause of death for young children in developed countries because so few of them die from illness or disease.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What are the average differences in height and weight between children in developed and developing countries? What accounts for these differences? 2. What parts of the brain experience the most notable changes in early childhood? 3. What is the main nutritional deficiency among young children in the United States? How can this deficiency be explained in an environment where food is available in abundance? 4. How has mortality for children age 5 and under changed in the past century worldwide?

Motor Development One thing for certain about motor activity in early childhood is that there is a lot of it. Children of this age are frequently on the move, enjoying and extending the development of their new motor abilities.

Gross and Fine Motor Skills

6.4

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe changes in gross and fine motor abilities during early childhood, and explain how these changes may have a cultural basis. In many ways, gross motor development in early childhood extends abilities that first appeared in toddlerhood. Toddlers can hop a step or two with both feet, but from age 3 to 6 young children learn to make more hops in a row and to hop on one foot. Toddlers can

Section 1 Physical Development jump, but from age 3 to 6 children learn to jump farther from a standing position and to make a running jump. Toddlers begin to climb stairs, but age 3 to 6 is when children learn to climb stairs without support, alternating their feet. Toddlers can throw a ball, but from age 3 to 6, children learn to throw a ball farther and more accurately, and they become better at catching a ball, too. They also increase their running speed and their ability to stop suddenly or change direction. Gender differences in gross motor development appear in early childhood, with boys generally becoming better at skills emphasizing strength or size, such as jumping and throwing a ball, and girls becoming better at body-coordination skills, such as balancing on one foot (Cratty, 1986; Lung et al., 2011). Fine motor development in early childhood involves a similar extension of skills that arose in toddlerhood, along with some new skills. As toddlers they could already pick up a small object using two fingers, but now they learn to do it more quickly and precisely. They could already hold a crayon and scribble on a piece of paper, but in early childhood they learn to draw something that is recognizable to others, such as a person, animal, or building. By age 6 they can even draw shapes such as a circle or triangle, and their first letters and some short words, perhaps including their own name. New fine motor skills learned in early childhood include putting on and removing their clothes, using scissors, and using a knife to cut soft food (Cratty, 1986; Piek et al., 2008). Their growing fine motor abilities allow children to learn to do many things their parents had been doing for them, such as using utensils to feed themselves, putting on a coat or shoes, and brushing their teeth. Of course, nearly all the research on this topic has been done in the West, and to some extent the gross and fine motor skills just described are culturally specific. How can using scissors be a milestone of motor development in a culture where people do not use scissors? In one interesting example of this, researchers asked 10- to 15-year-olds in a New Guinea tribe to draw a person (Martlew & Connolly, 1996). Because they had never tried to draw anything before—their tribe has no written language and no tools to write with or materials to write on—their drawings were very simple and unelaborated. But this does not mean their fine motor skills were less developed than those of much younger children in developed countries who are used to drawing from toddlerhood onward. It could be simply that the task was unfamiliar to them, and that there are finemotor skills specific to their own culture that they excel in. Recently, efforts have been made to develop assessments of gross and fine motor development that are culturally relevant, by basing the norms for motor milestones on local cultural patterns (Schertzer, 2009).

237

Gross motor skills advance from toddlerhood to early childhood.

Handedness Describe the development of handedness and identify the consequences and cultural views of left-handedness. Once children begin drawing or writing in early childhood, they show a clear preference for using their right or left hand, but handedness appears long before early childhood. In fact, even prenatally, fetuses show a definite preference for sucking the thumb of their right or left hand, with 90% preferring the right thumb (Hepper et al., 2005). The same 90% proportion of right-handers continues into childhood and throughout adulthood in most cultures (Hinojosa et al., 2003). If handedness appears so early, that must mean it is determined genetically, right? Actually, the evidence is mixed on this issue. Adopted children are more likely to resemble

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

6.5

handedness preference for using either the right or left hand in gross and fine motor activities

238

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse At their son Brahim’s 3 year checkup, his parents complain that he uses his left hand to eat and worry that he may develop left-handedness. They have tried to get him to use his right hand by restricting his left hand at meal times, but, when left to his own devices, he goes back to using his left hand. What can you tell them to help them not worry about this?

Why have so many cultures regarded being left-handed as evil or dangerous?

their biological parents than their adoptive parents in their handedness, suggesting a genetic origin (Carter-Salzman, 1980). On the other hand (pun intended), identical twins are more likely than ordinary siblings to differ in handedness, even though identical twins share 100% of their genotype and other siblings only about 50% (Derom et al., 1996). This appears to be due to the fact that twins usually lie in opposite ways within the uterus, whereas most singletons lie toward the left. Lying toward one side allows for greater movement and hence greater development of the hand on the other side, so most twins end up with one being right-handed and one being left-handed while most singletons end up right-handed. Nevertheless, as usual, culture is also a big part of the picture. Historically, many cultures have viewed left-handedness as dangerous and evil and have suppressed its development in children (Schacter & Ransil, 1996). In Western languages, the word sinister is derived from a Latin word meaning “on the left,” and many paintings in Western art depict the devil as left-handed. In many Asian and Middle Eastern cultures, only the left hand is supposed to be used for wiping up after defecation, and all other activities are supposed to be done mainly with the right hand. In Africa, even today, using the left hand is suppressed in many cultures from childhood onward, and the prevalence of left-handedness in some African countries is as low as 1%, far lower than the 10% figure in cultures where left-handedness is tolerated (Provins, 1997). Why do so many cultures regard left-handedness with such fear and contempt? Perhaps negative cultural beliefs about left-handedness developed because people noticed that left-handedness was associated with a greater likelihood of various problems. Lefthanded infants are more likely to be born prematurely or to experience an unusually difficult birth, and there is evidence that brain damage prenatally or during birth can contribute to left-handedness (Powls et al., 1996). In early and middle childhood, lefthanders are more likely to have problems learning to read and to have other verbal learning disabilities (Natsopoulos et al., 1998). This may have something to do with the fact about one-fourth of left-handers process language in both hemispheres rather than primarily in the left hemisphere (Knecht et al., 2000). In adulthood, people who are lefthanded have lower life expectancy and are more likely to die in accidents (Martin & Freitas, 2002).

Section 1 Physical Development However, this explanation is not entirely convincing because left-handedness is associated not only with greater likelihood of some types of problems but with excellence and even genius in certain fields. Left-handed children are more likely to show exceptional verbal and math abilities (Bower, 1985; Flannery & Leiderman, 1995). Left-handers are especially likely to have strong visual–spatial abilities, and consequently they are more likely than right-handers to become architects or artists (Holtzen, 2000). Some of the greatest artists in the Western tradition have been left-handed, including Leonardo da Vinci, Michaelangelo, and Pablo Picasso (Schacter & Ransil, 1996). It is worth keeping in mind that the majority of left-handers are in the normal range in their cognitive development, and show neither unusual problems nor unusual gifts. Hence the widespread cultural prejudice against left-handers remains mysterious.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. What kinds of changes in the ability to climb stairs occur in children between the ages of 3 and 6? 2. What gender differences in gross motor development appear in early childhood? 3. What new self-care skills accompany improvements in fine motor development in early childhood? 4. What are some genetic and environmental explanations for handedness?

Section 1 VIDEO GUIDE The Growing Child (Length: 1:13) This video explains many aspects of physical development in the early childhood years, including concepts such as lateralization, automaticity, and rates of growth.

1. In this video, the narrator mentions skills that children are better able to complete due to automaticity. Explain automaticity and list at least three activities that children are better able to perform. 2. What are some benefits of children gaining hand preference?

3. The narrator of this video tells us that the rate of physical growth slows in the early childhood years. What impact would this have on the food and nutritional requirements of children in this age group?

Watch the Video The Growing Child at MyDevelopmentLab

239

240

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

SECTION 2

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 6.6 Explain the features of Piaget’s preoperational stage of cognitive development. 6.7 Explain what “theory of mind” is and the evidence for how it develops during early childhood. 6.8 Identify the ways that cultural learning takes place in early childhood. 6.9 Identify the features that are most important in preschool quality. 6.10 Describe the distinctive practices of Japanese preschools and how they reflect cultural values. 6.11 Describe early intervention programs and their outcomes. 6.12 Explain how advances in vocabulary and grammar occur in early childhood. 6.13 Describe how children learn pragmatics in early childhood and identify to what extent these social rules are culturally based.

Theories of Cognitive Development In the course of early childhood, children make many remarkable advances in their cognitive development. Several theories shed light on these developments, including Piaget’s preoperational stage; “theory of mind,” which examines how children think about the thoughts of others; and theories of cultural learning that emphasize the ways that young children gain the knowledge and skills of their culture. These theories complement each other to provide a comprehensive picture of cognitive development in early childhood.

Piaget’s Preoperational Stage of Cognitive Development

6.6

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

preoperational stage cognitive stage from age 2 to 7 during which the child becomes capable of representing the world symbolically—for example, through the use of language—but is still very limited in ability to use mental operations

240

Explain the features of Piaget’s preoperational stage of cognitive development. In Piaget’s theory, early childhood is a crucial turning point in children’s cognitive development because this is when thinking becomes representational (Piaget, 1952). During the first 2 years of life, the sensorimotor stage, thinking takes place primarily in association with sensorimotor activities such as reaching and grasping. Gradually toward the end of the sensorimotor period, in the second half of the second year, children begin to internalize the images of their sensorimotor activities, marking the beginning of representational thought. However, it is during the latter part of toddlerhood and especially in early childhood that we become truly representational thinkers. Language requires the ability to represent the world symbolically, through words, and this is when language skills develop most dramatically. Once we can represent the world through language, we are freed from our momentary sensorimotor experience. With language we can represent not only the present but the past and the future, not only the world as we see it before us but the world as we previously experienced it and the world as it will be—the coming cold (or warm) season, a decline in the availability of food or water, and so on. We can even represent the world as it has never been, through mentally combining ideas—flying monkeys, talking trees, and people who have superhuman powers. These are marvelous cognitive achievements, and yet early childhood fascinated Piaget not only for what children of this age are able to do cognitively but also for the kinds of mistakes they make. In fact, Piaget termed the age period from 2 to 7 the preoperational stage, emphasizing that children of this age were not yet able to perform mental operations, that is, cognitive procedures that follow certain logical rules. Piaget specified a number

Section 2 Cognitive Development

241

of areas of preoperational cognitive mistakes that are characteristic of early childhood, including conservation, egocentrism, and animism, and classification.

conservation mental ability to understand that the quantity of a substance or material remains the same even if its appearance changes

CONSERVATION According to Piaget, children in early childhood lack the ability to understand conservation, the principle that the amount of a physical substance remains the same even if its physical appearance changes. In his best known demonstration of this mistake, Piaget showed young children two identical glasses holding equal amounts of water and asked them if the two amounts of water were equal. The children typically answered “yes”—they were capable of understanding that much. Then Piaget poured the contents from one of the glasses into a taller, thinner glass, and asked the children again if the two amounts of water were equal. Now most of the children answered “no,” failing to understand that the amount of water remained the same even though the appearance of the water changed. Piaget also demonstrated that children made this error with other substances besides water, as shown in Figure 6.2. Piaget interpreted children’s mistakes on conservation tasks as indicating two kinds of cognitive deficiencies. The first is centration, meaning that young children’s thinking is centered or focused on one noticeable aspect of a cognitive problem to the exclusion of other important aspects. In the conservation of liquid task, they notice the change in height

centration Piaget’s term for young children’s thinking as being centered or focused on one noticeable aspect of a cognitive problem to the exclusion of other important aspects

Type of Conservation

Modality

Change in Physical Appearance

Watch the Video The Preoperational and Concrete Operational Stage at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Conservation Tasks at MyDevelopmentLab

Average Age Conservation Is Grasped

Number

Number of elements in a collection

Rearranging or dislocating elements

6–7 years

Substance (mass)

Amount of a malleable substance (e.g., clay or liquid)

Altering shape

7–8 years

Length

Length of a line or object Altering shape or configuration

7–8 years

Area

Amount of surface covered by a set of plane figures

Rearranging the figures

8–9 years

Weight

Weight of an object

Altering shape

9–10 years

Volume

Volume of an object (in terms of water displacement)

Altering shape

14–15 years

Figure 6.2 s Various Substances Used in Piaget’s Conservation Task What cognitive limitations in young children lead to mistakes in these tasks?

242

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Preschool Teacher You are surprised that five-year-old Octaviana seems to understand conservation, successfully solving tasks involving conservation of number, mass, and volume. You thought that five-yearolds were still in the preoperational stage of development. What might explain her performance?

as the water is poured into the taller glass but neglect to observe the change in width that takes place simultaneously. Second, young children lack reversibility, the ability to reverse an action mentally. When the water is poured from the original glass to the taller glass in the conservation task, anyone who can reverse that action mentally can see that the amount of water would be the same. Young children cannot perform the mental operation of reversibility, so they mistakenly believe the amount of water has changed.

EGOCENTRISM Another cognitive limitation of the preoperational stage, in Piaget’s view, is egocentrism, the inability to distinguish between your own perspective and another person’s perspective. To demonstrate egocentrism, Piaget and his colleague Barbel Inhelder (1969) devised what they called the “three mountains task” (see Figure 6.3). In this task a child is shown a clay model of three different mountains of varying sizes, one with snow on top, one with a red cross, and one with a house. The child walks around the table to see what the mountain looks like from each side, then sits down while the experimenter View 1 View 2 moves a doll to different points around the table. At each of the doll’s locations, the child is shown a series of photographs and asked which one indicates the doll’s point of view. In the early years of the preoperational stage, children tend to pick the photo that matches their own perspective, not the doll’s. One aspect of egocentrism is animism, the tendency to attribute human thoughts and feelings to inanimate objects and forces. According to Piaget, when young children believe that the thunder is angry or the moon is followFigure 6.3 s Piaget’s Three Mountains Task ing them, it reflects their animistic thinking. It also reflects their egocentrism, How does performance on this task indicate egocentrism? in that they are attributing the thoughts and feelings that they might have themselves to things that are inanimate. Children’s play with stuffed animals and dolls is a good example of animistic thinking. When they play with these toys, children frequently attribute human thoughts and feelWatch the Video Egocentrism Task ings to them, often the thoughts and feelings they might have themselves. This is play, but at MyDevelopmentLab it is a kind of play they take seriously. At age 5, my daughter Paris would sometimes “find” a stuffed puppy or kitten on our porch that she would treat as if it were a live animal that would now be her pet. If you humorously suggested that this might be an especially easy pet to care for, being stuffed—as I made the mistake of doing one day—she took great offense and insisted it was a real animal. To her, at that moment, it was.

reversibility ability to reverse an action mentally egocentrism cognitive inability to distinguish between one’s own perspective and another person’s perspective animism tendency to attribute human thoughts and feelings to inanimate objects and forces classification ability to understand that objects can be part of more than one cognitive group, for example an object can be classified with red objects as well as with round objects symbolic function substage first substage of the preoperational stage, lasting from about age 2 to age 4, when the child first becomes capable of representational thought and of using symbols to represent the world

CLASSIFICATION Preoperational children also lack the capacity for classification, according to Piaget, meaning that they have difficulty understanding that objects can be simultaneously part of more than one “class” or group. He demonstrated this by showing children a drawing of 4 blue flowers and 12 yellow flowers and asking them, “Are there more yellow flowers, or more flowers?” In early childhood, children would typically answer “More yellow flowers,” because they did not understand that yellow flowers could be part of the class “yellow flowers” and simultaneously part of the class “flowers.” Here, as with conservation, the cognitive limitations of centration and lack of reversibility are at the root of the error, in Piaget’s view. Young children center on the fact that the yellow flowers are yellow, which leads them to overlook that the yellow flowers are also flowers. They also lack reversibility in that they cannot perform the mental operation of placing the yellow and blue flowers together into the “flowers” class and then moving them back into the “yellow flowers” and “blue flowers” classes, respectively. PREOPERATIONAL SUBSTAGES: SYMBOLIC FUNCTION AND INTUITIVE THOUGHT Age 2 to 7 is a long period with many changes in a child’s cognitive development. Although Piaget called this age span the preoperational stage, he also separated it into two substages. The symbolic function substage is the first substage, lasting from about age 2 to 4. This is when the child first becomes capable of representational thought and of using symbols to represent the world. As mentioned above, language is the most important indicator of the capacity to

Section 2 Cognitive Development

243

think in terms of symbols, because words are symbols. Play is another area where symbolic functions are evident early in the preoperational stage. Children of this age can use a stick to represent a magic wand, or dirt and water to represent chocolate pudding. The second substage of the preoperational stage is the intuitive thought substage, lasting from age 4 to 7. During this period children become highly curious about the world, frequently asking “Why?” when others provide them with information. This shows that they have begun to think logically, because their questions indicate that they are wondering about how one event leads to another event. Through their questions they learn more about the nature of the world, and they expand their knowledge. However, they are unable to explain how they know what they know. This is why Piaget called this substage intuitive; children in this substage do not know why they know something, they just know it. For example, even if they happen to state the correct answer when faced with a conservation or classification problem, they have difficulty explaining why their answer is correct. Here, too, the preoperational child’s cognitive functioning is framed by Piaget primarily in terms of what is yet to be learned. EVALUATING PIAGET’S THEORY Piaget’s theory of preoperational thought in early childhood has been challenged in the decades since he proposed it. The criticisms focus on two issues: claims that he underestimated children’s cognitive capabilities, and claims that development is more continuous and less stagelike than he proposed. Many studies over the past several decades have shown that children ages 2–7 are cognitively capable of more than Piaget recognized. With regard to conservation tasks, it has been shown that even 3-year-old children can give correct answers in conservation of number tasks, as long as only two or three items are used (Gelman, 1969; Vilette, 2002). By the time children learn to count to 10 or more, usually by age 4 or 5, they can use counting to solve conservation of number tasks involving larger numbers of items. By age 6—still in the preoperational stage, according to Piaget—they do not even need to count to solve the task, because they understand that the number of items remains the same if no items are added or removed (Klahr & MacWhinney, 1998). In other ways, too, children ages 2–7 are less prone to cognitive errors than Piaget proposed. Regarding egocentrism, when the Three Mountains task is modified so that familiar objects are used instead of the three-mountain model, children give less egocentric responses (Newcombe & Huttenlocher, 1992). Studies using other methods also show that 2- to 7-year-old children are less egocentric than Piaget thought. As described in Chapter 5, even toddlers show the beginnings of an ability to take others’ perspectives, when they discern what they can do to annoy a sibling (Dunn, 1988). By age 4, children switch to shorter, simpler sentences when talking to toddlers or babies, showing a distinctly unegocentric ability to take the perspective of the younger children (Bryant & Barrett, 2007). Regarding Piaget’s stage claims, research has shown that the development of cognitive skills in childhood is less stagelike and more continuous than Piaget believed (Bibok et al., 2009). Remember, Piaget’s stage theory asserts that movement from one stage to another represents a wholesale cognitive shift, a change not just in specific cognitive skills but in how children think. In this view, children ages 2–7 are incapable of performing mental operations, and then in the next stage they become able to do so. However, as we have just seen, research has generally shown that the ability to perform mental operations changes gradually over the course of childhood (Case, 1999).

How does animism reflect young children’s egocentrism?

intuitive thought substage second substage of the preoperational stage, lasting from age 4 to 7, during which children begin to understand how one event leads to another event but cannot say why they know what they know theory of mind ability to understand thinking processes in one’s self and others

Understanding Thinking: The Development of “Theory of Mind” Explain what “theory of mind” is and the evidence for how it develops during early childhood. Current research on cognitive development in early childhood has moved beyond Piaget’s theories. One popular area of research in recent years is theory of mind, the ability to understand thinking processes in one’s self and others.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

6.7

Watch the Video Theory of Mind at MyDevelopmentLab

244

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Parent When you complain of a headache, your three-year-old daughter offers you her teddy bear for comfort. How can you explain this?

Watch the Video False Belief Task at MyDevelopmentLab

Understanding how others think is a challenge even for adults, but the beginnings of theory of mind appear very early, in infancy. Through behavior such as joint attention and the use of prelanguage vocalizations, infants show that they understand that others have mental states such as intentionality (Tomasello & Rakoczy, 2003). By age 2, as they begin to use language more, children show increasing recognition that others have thoughts and emotions that can be contrasted with their own (e.g., “That man is mad!” or “I like applesauce. Brother no like applesauce.”). At age 2, children begin to use words that refer to mental processes, such as “think,” “remember,” and “pretend” (Flavell et al., 2002). By age 3, children know it is possible for them and others to imagine something that is not physically present (such as an ice cream cone). They can respond to an imaginary event as if it has really happened, and they realize that others can do the same (Andrews et al., 2003). This understanding becomes the basis of pretend play for many years to come. However, there are limits to 3-year-olds’ theory of mind, and crucial changes take place in the course of early childhood. They are better than 2-year-olds at understanding that others have thoughts and feelings that are different than their own, but they find it difficult to take others’ perspectives. Perspective-taking ability advances considerably from age 3 to 6 (Callahan et al., 2005). This change is vividly demonstrated in recent research involving false-belief tasks. In one experiment testing understanding of false beliefs, children are shown a doll named Maxi who places chocolate in a cabinet and then leaves the room (Amsterlaw & Wellman, 2006). Next another doll, his mother, enters the room and moves the chocolate to a different place. Children are then asked, where will Maxi look for the chocolate when he returns? Most 3-year-old children answer erroneously that Maxi will look for the chocolate in the new place, where his mother stored it. In contrast, by age 4 most children recognize that Maxi will believe falsely that the chocolate is in the cabinet where he left it. The proportion of children who understand this correctly rises even higher by age 5. In another well-known test of theory of mind, children are shown a box that appears to contain a kind of candy called “Smarties” and asked what they think is in the box (Gopnik & Astington, 1988). After they answer “candy” or “Smarties” they are shown that the box in fact contains pencils. Then they are asked what another person, who has not been shown the contents, will think is in the box. “Candy” or “Smarties” is the correct answer, showing theory of mind; “pencils” is incorrect. Most children pass the test by the time they are 4 or 5 years old. By age 6, nearly all children solve false-belief tasks easily. Notice the similarity to Piaget’s description of the developmental course of egocentrism. Poor understanding of theory of mind can be seen as a kind of egocentrism, and with Piaget’s egocentrism tasks as well as false-belief tasks, children make great advances in the course of early childhood. Some theory of mind research has now been done in other cultures, enough to show that the development of theory of mind depends strongly on cultural context and language. For example, Chinese languages have several different forms of the word belief, some of which signify that the belief is false; the use of these forms of belief in false-belief tasks make it easy for Chinese children to solve them (Tardif et al., 2004). Also, not all languages have words to signify mental states. Among the Quechua people of Peru studied by Penelope Vinden (1996), their language has no terms for mental states. Perhaps for this reason, children there do poorly on false-belief tasks not just in early childhood but through middle childhood as well.

Cultural Learning in Early Childhood

6.8

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Identify the ways that cultural learning takes place in early childhood. In Piaget’s depiction of cognitive development, the young child is like a solitary little scientist gradually mastering the concepts of conservation and classification and overcoming the errors of egocentrism and animism. Vygotsky’s sociocultural theory of learning takes

Section 2 Cognitive Development a much different approach, viewing cognitive development as a social and cultural process (see Chapter 5). Children learn not through their individual interactions with the environment but through the social process of guided participation, as they interact with a more knowledgeable member of the culture (often an older sibling or parent) in the course of daily activities. Early childhood is a period when this kind of cultural learning comes to the fore. More than in toddlerhood, young children have the capacity for learning culturally specific skills. The Mayan example that began this chapter provides one illustration. A 5-year-old can readily learn the skills involved in making tortillas, whereas a 2-year-old would not have the necessary learning abilities, motor skills, or impulse control (Rogoff, 2003). In many cultures, the end of early childhood, ages 5–6, is the time when children are first given important responsibilities in the family for food preparation, child care, and animal care (LeVine & New, 2008). During early childhood they acquire the cultural learning necessary for these duties, sometimes through direct instruction but more often through observing and participating in adults’ activities. It is not only in traditional cultures that cultural learning takes place via guided participation. For example, a child in an economically developed country might help his parents prepare a grocery shopping list, and in the course of this process learn culturally valued skills such as reading, using lists as tools for organization and planning, and calculating sums of money (Rogoff, 2003). Children in Western countries are also encouraged to speak up and hold conversations. For example, over dinner American parents often ask their young children a series of questions (“What songs did you sing at preschool? What did you have for a snack?”), thereby preparing them for the question-and-answer structure of formal schooling they will enter in middle childhood (Martini, 1996). This is in contrast to cultures from Asia to northern Canada in which silence is valued, especially in children, and children who talk frequently are viewed as immature and low in intelligence (Rogoff, 2003). Two factors make cultural learning in developed countries different from cultural learning in traditional cultures. One is that children in developed countries are often apart from their families for a substantial part of the day, in a preschool or another group-care setting. Cultural learning takes place in the preschool setting, of course—recall the example of Lars that began this chapter—but it is mostly a more direct kind of instruction (e.g., learning letters) rather than the cultural learning that takes place through guided participation in daily activities within the family. Second, the activities of adults in a complex economy are less accessible to children’s learning than the activities that children learn through guided participation in traditional cultures, such as child care, tending animals, and food preparation. Most jobs in a complex economy require advanced skills of reading, analyzing information, and using technology, so there is a limit to which children can learn these skills through guided participation, especially in early childhood.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. According to Piaget, what two kinds of cognitive deficiencies are evident in children’s mistakes on conservation tasks? 2. What are the two main issues raised by critics of Piaget’s theory of preoperational thought? 3. What advances in theory of mind take place between the ages of 2 and 3? 4. What two factors make cultural learning in developed countries different from cultural learning in traditional cultures?

245

How is cultural learning taking place here?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

246

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

Early Childhood Education

Watch the Video Early Literacy Development at MyDevelopmentLab

Traditionally in many cultures, formal schooling has started at about age 7. This is the age at which children have been viewed as first capable of learning the skills of reading, writing, and math. However, because the need to learn how to use words and numbers is so strong in the modern information-based economy, in many countries school now begins earlier than ever. In developed countries about three-fourths of 3- to 5-year-old children are enrolled in group child care, preschool, or kindergarten (UNESCO, 2006, p. 20). In developing countries, the percentages are lower but rising. In the United States, about half of American states now fund some preschool programs for 4-year-old children, usually focusing on children from low-income families.

The Importance of Preschool Quality

6.9

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Watch the Video Choosing the Right School at MyDevelopmentLab

Identify the features that are most important in preschool quality. What are the cognitive and social effects of attending preschool? For the most part, attending preschool is beneficial for young children (Campbell et al., 2002). Cognitive benefits of attending preschool include higher verbal skills and stronger performance on measures of memory and listening comprehension (Clarke-Steward & Allhusen, 2002). Children from low-income families especially benefit cognitively from preschool (Loeb et al., 2004; Vandell, 2004). They perform better on tests of school-readiness than children of similar backgrounds who did not attend preschool. There are also social benefits to attending preschool. Children who attend preschool are generally more independent and socially confident than children who remain home (National Institute of Child Health and Human Development [NICHD] Early Child Care Research Network, 2006). However, there appear to be social costs as well. Children attending preschool have been observed to be less compliant, less respectful toward adults, and more aggressive than other children (Belsky et al., 2006). Furthermore, these negative social effects may endure long past preschool age. In one large national (U.S.) longitudinal study, children who attended preschool for more than 10 hours per week were more disruptive in class once they entered school, in follow-ups extending through sixth grade (NICHD Early Child Care Research Network, 2006). Yet these findings concerning the overall positive or negative outcomes associated with preschool can be misleading. Preschool programs vary vastly in quality, and many studies have found that the quality of preschool child care is more important than simply the fact of whether children are in preschool or not (Clarke-Stewart & Allhusen, 2002; Maccoby & Lewis, 2003; NICHD Early Child Care Research Network, 2006). What factors should parents consider when searching for a high-quality preschool experience for their children? There is a broad consensus among scholars of early childhood development that the most important features include the following (Lavzer & Goodson, 2006; National Association for the Education of Young Children [NAEYC], 2010; Vandell et al, 2005): s

s

s

Education and training of teachers. Unlike teachers at higher grade levels, preschool teachers often are not required to have education or credentials specific to early childhood education. Preschool teachers who have training in early childhood education provide a better social and cognitive environment. Class size and child–teacher ratio. Experts recommend no more than 20 children in a classroom, and a ratio of children to preschool teachers no higher than five to ten 3-year-olds per teacher or seven to ten 4-year-olds per teacher. Age-appropriate materials and activities. In early childhood, children learn more through active engagement with materials rather than through formal lessons or rote learning.

Section 2 Cognitive Development s

247

Teacher–child interactions. Teachers should spend most of their time in interactions with the children rather than with each other. They should circulate among the children, asking questions, offering suggestions, and assisting them when necessary.

Notice that the criteria for high-quality preschools do not include intense academic instruction. Here again there is a broad consensus among early childhood scholars that preschool teaching should be based on developmentally appropriate educational practice (NAEYC, 2010). At the preschool age, this means that learning should involve exploring and discovering through relatively unstructured, hands-on experiences—learning about the physical world through playing in a water or sand area, for example, or learning new words through songs and nursery rhymes, as you will see in the Research Focus: The Montessori Preschool Program feature. In contrast, structured academic learning, with worksheets and memorization tasks, mostly in large groups, is discouraged as developmentally inappropriate for preschool children. Several studies have shown the benefits of developmentally appropriate educational practice for preschool children, both cognitively and socially (Hart et al., 1998; Huffman & Speer, 2000).

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Preschool Teacher The parent of one of your students questions why you spend so much time letting the children play with sand and sing songs rather than teaching them academic skills. How do you respond?

RESEARCH FOCUS The Montessori Preschool Program

A

and the other group attended other types of preschools. All bout a century ago, an Italian doctor named Maria the children in the non-Montessori group had originally apMontessori developed a new approach to enhancing plied to Montessori schools but were not able to enter due the cognitive development of young children. She had to space limitations, with admission determined by a random observed that children from poor families were often well lottery. This was a crucial aspect of the study design; do you behind their peers by the time they entered school, and she see why? If the researchers had simply compared children in sought to find a way to assist them in preschool so that they Montessori schools with children in non-Montessori schools, would have a better chance of school success. any differences would have been difficult to interpret, because Montessori (1964) was focused on making her approach there may have been many other appropriate for the developmental differences between the families of stage of early childhood. She believed children in the two types of schools that young children should not be (e.g., children in Montessori schools subjected to tests and grades. In her may have more-educated parents). view, children have a natural desire Because the families of children in to learn about the world that should the non-Montessori schools had be encouraged and enhanced. The also applied to get their children program she developed emphasizes into the Montessori schools, it can learning through self-directed explobe assumed that the family backration. Children are provided with a grounds of the children in the two variety of different materials and acgroups were similar. tivities, and they learn in a self-directThe children who attended ed way as they choose from among Montessori preschools were more the options. Teachers are present advanced in both cognitive and soand sometimes facilitate small-group cial development than the children activities to enhance children’s develwho attended the other preschools. opment of social skills, but the em- Children attending Montessori schools show cognitive Cognitively, the Montessori children phasis is on allowing children to learn and social advantages. scored higher on tests of reading through self-initiated discovery. and math skills than the other children. They also performed Montessori’s design for preschool programs proved instantly better on a card-sorting task that tested the ability to apply depopular, and remains popular today. There are thousands of cision rules. Socially, in playground observations the Montessori Montessori preschool programs worldwide, but until recently they children engaged more in cooperative play and less in rough, had not been evaluated systematically through research. Now studies chaotic play such as wrestling. In sum, the Montessori approach by developmental psychologist Angeline Lillard (2008; Lillard & Elseappears to provide children with a setting that encourages selfQuest, 2006) have demonstrated the validity of Montessori’s insights. initiated, active learning and thereby enhances cognitive and Lillard compared two groups of 3- to 6-year-old children. social development. One group of children had attended a Montessori preschool,

248

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

Cross-National Variations

6.10

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Japanese preschools emphasize group play and cooperation.

THINKING CULTURALLY How does the Japanese practice of having children wear identical uniforms in preschool represent a custom complex? That is, what cultural beliefs underlie this cultural practice?

Describe the distinctive practices of Japanese preschools and how they reflect cultural values. Although attending preschool has become a typical experience among children in developed countries, there is great variation in how countries structure preschool and what they wish young children to learn. In most countries, parents hope for social benefits from preschool, but there is variation between countries in the expectations of cognitive and academic benefits. In some countries, such as China and the United States, learning basic academic skills is one of the primary goals of having children attend preschool (Johnson et al., 2003; Tobin et al., 2009). In other countries, such as Japan and most of Europe, learning academic skills is a low priority in preschool (Hayashi et al., 2009). Rather, preschool is mainly a time for learning social skills such as how to function as a member of a group. Japan is of particular interest in this area, because Japanese students have long been at or near the top of international comparisons in reading, math, and science from middle childhood through high school (NCES, 2011). You might expect, then, that one reason for this success is that they begin academic instruction earlier than in other countries, but just the opposite turns out to be true. In one study of Japanese and American parents and preschool teachers, only 2% of the Japanese listed “to give children a good start academically” as one of the top three reasons for young children to attend preschool (Tobin et al., 2009). In contrast, over half the Americans named this as one of the top three reasons. There was a similarly sharp contrast in response to the item “to give children the experience of being a member of the group.” Sixty percent of Japanese endorsed this reason for preschool, compared to just 20% of the Americans. Preschools in Japan teach nothing about reading and numbers. Instead, the focus is on group play, so that children will learn the values of cooperation and sharing. Preschool children wear identical uniforms, with different colors to indicate their classroom membership. They each have the same equipment, which they keep in identical drawers. Through being introduced to these cultural practices in preschool, children also learn collectivistic Japanese values.

Preschool as a Cognitive Intervention

6.11

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

early intervention program program directed at young children who are at risk for later problems, intended to prevent problems from developing

Describe early intervention programs and their outcomes. One type of preschool experience that focuses intensively on cognitive development is the early intervention program. These are programs directed at young children who are at risk for later school problems because they come from low-income families. The goal of early intervention programs is to give these children extra cognitive stimulation in early childhood so that they will have a better opportunity to succeed once they enter school. By far the largest early intervention program in the United States is Project Head Start. The program began in 1965 and is still going strong, with about 1 million American children enrolled each year (Head Start Bureau, 2010). The program provides 1 or 2 years of preschool, but it also includes other services. Children in the program receive free meals

Section 2 Cognitive Development

Figure 6.4 s Major Findings of the High Scope Preschool Study High Scope participants showed better academic performance, IQ scores, and earning potential and were less likely to be arrested later in life than other children. Source: Schweinhart et al., 2005.

/V

T

H[   08

L^

VY

RH

[





]T H[ LU[  

OPL HJ ZPJ 

)H

\H [ OPN LKY O LN\ ZJ SH OV Y VS

HK

.Y

  H[ 2  

LK

YU

,H

( [PT YYLZ LZ [LK I  ` 

7LYJLU[

and health care. Parents receive health care as well as job-training services. Parents are also directly involved in the Head Start program, serving on councils that make policies for the centers and sometimes serving as teachers in the classroom. Canada has a similar program focusing on First Nations minority children who are often at risk for later school problems. Do these programs work? The answer is not simple. The main goal of Head Start originally was to raise the intelligence of children from low-income backgrounds so that their academic performance would be enhanced once they entered school. Children in Head Start show a boost in IQ and academic achievement after their participation in the program, compared to children from similar backgrounds who did not take part, so in this respect, yes, the program worked. However, a consistent pattern in Head Start and many other early intervention programs is that the IQ and achievement gains fade within 2 or 3 years of entering elementary school (Barnett & Hustedt, 2005). This is not surprising in view of the fact that children in the program typically enter poorly funded, low-quality public schools after their Head Start experience, but nevertheless the fading of the initial gains was unexpected and fell short of the original goals of the program. However, there have been some favorable results from the Head Start program, too (Brooks-Gunn, 2003; Resnick, 2010). Children who have participated in Head Start are less likely to be placed in special education or to repeat a grade. It should be kept in mind that Head Start is a program with a million children in tens of thousands of programs, and inevitably the programs vary in quality (Resnick, 2010; Zigler & Styfco, 2004). The more the mother is involved in the program, the more her child demonstrates benefits in terms of academic and social skills (Marcon, 1999). Head Start was designed to serve children ages 4-6 and give them a “head start” in school readiness, but in the 1990s a new program, Early Head Start, was initiated for lowincome families and their children under the age of 3 (Raikes et al., 2010). The goal of this program was to see if greater effects on cognitive and social development could be obtained by beginning the intervention at an earlier age. Sometimes the program entails center care, sometimes home visits by skilled child care workers, and sometimes a mix of the two. Research on the effects of Early Head Start is now in progress, but so far the mixed programs (center care combined with home visits) appears to have the strongest positive effects on cognitive and social development (Robinson et al., 2009). Some small-scale, intensive early intervention programs have shown a broader range of enduring effects. One of the best known is the High Scope Preschool Project, which entailed a full-day 2-year preschool  program for children from low-income 7YVNYHTNYV\W families (Schweinhart et al., 2004). The High 5VWYVNYHTNYV\W  Scope children showed the familiar pattern of an initial gain in IQ and academic achievement followed by a decline, but they  demonstrated many other benefits of the program, compared to a control group. In  adolescence, the girls were less likely to become pregnant and the boys were less likely to be arrested, and both boys and girls were  more likely to graduate from high school and attend college (see Figure 6.4). At age  27, the High Scope participants were more likely to be married and to own their home, less likely to have spent time in prison, and their monthly income was higher. At age 40, High Scope participants still displayed

249

250

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood benefits of the program in a wide range of areas, including income and family stability. This program shows that an intensive, high-quality early intervention program can have profound and lasting benefits.

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What constitutes developmentally appropriate educational practice for preschool children? 2. How do Japanese preschools differ from American preschools? 3. What is the goal of early intervention programs? 4. How have results of small-scale early intervention programs such as the High Scope Preschool Project differed from those of programs such as Head Start?

Language Development As we saw in Chapter 5, by age 3 children are remarkably adept at using language. Nevertheless, their language development from age 3 to 6 continues at a remarkable pace, in areas including vocabulary, grammar, and pragmatics.

Advances in Vocabulary and Grammar

6.12

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

sensitive period in the course of development, a period when the capacity for learning in a specific area is especially pronounced

Explain how advances in vocabulary and grammar occur in early childhood. Perhaps the most amazing advance at this age is the growth in children’s vocabulary. The average 3-year-old has a vocabulary of about 1,000 words; by age 6, the average vocabulary has increased to over 2,500 words (Bloom, 1998). This means they are adding words nearly every day (Clark, 1995). How do they do it? Clearly children’s brains are built for learning language, as noted in the previous chapter, and early childhood is a sensitive period for language learning, when the capacity for learning new words is especially pronounced (Pinker, 1994). As we learned in Chapter 5, young children add new words to their vocabulary through a process known as fast mapping (Ganger & Brent, 2004; Swingley, 2010). This means that as young children learn new words they begin to form a mental map of interconnected sets of word categories. When they hear a word the first time they instantly connect it to one of these categories based on how the word is used in a sentence and how it seems to be related to words they already know, to help discern its meaning. The kinds of words children fast-map earliest depend partly on the language. Children learning Eastern languages such as Chinese, Japanese, and Korean tend to learn more verbs than nouns at first, because sentences often emphasize verbs but only imply the nouns without speaking them (Kim et al., 2000). In contrast, children learning English and other Western languages fast-map nouns earlier than verbs, because nouns are prominent in these languages. In both Eastern and Western languages, modifiers (such as large, narrow, pretty, low) are added more slowly than nouns and verbs (Mintz, 2005).

Section 2 Cognitive Development As young children add new words to their vocabulary, they also continue to learn grammar, which is a language’s distinctive system of rules. Some examples of rules include single/plural forms; past, present, and future tense; word order; and use of articles (such as “a” and “the”) and prepositions (such as “under” and “by”). Without any formal training, young children grasp the grammatical rules of their language with few errors simply by hearing and using the language in daily interactions. By age 4, it is estimated that children use correct grammar in 90% of their statements (Guasti, 2000; Pinker, 1994). But how do we know they have really learned the rules of their language? Couldn’t they simply be repeating what they hear older children and adults say? In a classic study investigating this question, Jean Berko (1958) had young children respond to questions involving nonsense words (see Figure 6.5). Although they had never heard the words before—Berko had made them up—the children were able to apply the grammar of English and use nouns in plural and possessive forms. As noted in Chapter 5 (p. 196), the readiness with which children learn grammar indicates that they possess what Chomsky (1969) called a language acquisition device, which is an innate capacity for grasping quickly a language’s rules.

251

This is a wug.

Now there is another one. There are two of them. There are two .

Figure 6.5 s Berko’s Language Study How do the results of this study show young children’s grasp of grammar?” Source: Adapted from Berko, 1958.

Pragmatics: Social and Cultural Rules of Language Describe how children learn pragmatics in early childhood, and identify to what extent these social rules are culturally based. In order to use language effectively, children must learn not only vocabulary and grammar but the social rules or pragmatics for using language in interaction with others. Pragmatics guide us in knowing what to say—and what not to say—in a given social situation. For example, children learn to say “please” when asking for something and “thank you” when they receive something. Children begin learning pragmatics even before they begin speaking, through gestures, for example when they wave “bye-bye” to someone when leaving. By the age of 2, they know the pragmatics of a basic conversation, including taking turns speaking (Pan & Snow, 1999). However, at this age they have not yet grasped the pragmatics of sustaining a conversation on one topic, and they tend to change topics rapidly as new things occur to them, without much awareness of the other person’s perspective. By age 4, children are more sensitive to the characteristics of their conversational partner and will adjust their speech accordingly. In one study using hand puppets, 4-year-olds used different kinds of speech when acting out different puppet roles (Anderson, 2000). When playing a socially dominant role such as teacher or doctor they used commands frequently, whereas when playing subordinate roles such as student or patient they spoke more politely. The use of pragmatics represents not only social understanding but cultural knowledge. All cultures have their own rules for what kinds of speech can be used in what kinds of situations. For example, some cultures require children to address adults with respectful titles, such as “Mr.” for adult men. Many cultures have words that are classified as “bad words” that are not supposed to be spoken, especially by children. These are the kinds of pragmatics children learn in the course of early childhood, but while they are learning them there can be some embarrassing moments for parents along the way. One day when she was about 3 years old my daughter Paris and I were going through the check-out line in the grocery store, and she said to

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

6.13

grammar a language’s distinctive system of rules pragmatics social and cultural context of language that guides people as to what is appropriate to say and not to say in a given social situation

How might the language used in this kind of play demonstrate a grasp of pragmatics?

252

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

THINKING CULTURALLY Can you think of examples of how pragmatics have changed in your culture, compared to a century ago?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

the clerk, apropos of nothing, “When I grow to a mommy, I’m going to have a baby in my tummy!” On another occasion, at age 4 my son Miles was talking about how he planned to live to be 100 years old and asked me if I would still be around by then. “Probably not,” I said. “You’re only four years old, and I’m forty-six.” “Ooohhh,” he said with genuine concern in his voice, “then you don’t have many years left!” Adults understand intuitively that young children lack a sense of pragmatics, so they tend to find such moments amusing rather than offensive. By middle childhood, most children learn when it is culturally appropriate to speak and when it is best to keep your thoughts to yourself.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What changes to a child’s vocabulary occur between the ages of 3 and 6? 2. How do children learning Eastern languages differ from children learning Western languages in the kinds of words that they fast-map earliest? 3. Give an example of a young child showing an early understanding of pragmatics. 4. How do pragmatics represent cultural knowledge?

Section 2 VIDEO GUIDE Theory of Mind Across Cultures (Length: 6:44) This video contains several demonstrations of children from various countries performing tests of theory of mind.

1. How does acquiring a theory of mind impact a child’s social interactions? 2. According to this video, does acquiring a theory of mind occur at the same age across cultures?

3. Can you think of any interactions that may help or hinder a child in developing a theory of mind?

Watch the Video Theory of Mind Across Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab

SECTION 3

EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 6.14 Identify advances in emotional understanding and self-regulation during early childhood. 6.15 Describe moral development in early childhood, including empathy, modeling, and morality as cultural learning. 6.16 Describe the roles that parents and peers play in gender socialization and explain how gender schemas lead to self-socialization. 6.17 Describe the four types of parenting “styles” and the outcomes associated with each, and explain why those outcomes are complex. 6.18 Describe the major cultural variations in approaches to parenting. 6.19 Describe the main cultural variations in how parents discipline young children, and explain how cultural context influences children’s responses to discipline. 6.20 Identify the most common features of sibling relationships worldwide, and describe how children with no siblings differ from other children. 6.21 Explain how the quality of friendships changes from toddlerhood to early childhood, and describe the role of play and aggression in young children’s friendships. 6.22 Identify the rates and consequences of media use in early childhood.

Emotional Regulation and Gender Socialization After the emotional volatility and intensity of the toddler years, children make great advances in emotional self-regulation in early childhood. Also notable in their emotional development during this time is increasing empathy and a greater grasp of the moral system of their culture, learned in part by modeling their behavior after the behavior of others who are important in their lives. With regard to gender development, early childhood is a life stage of great importance, with children gaining a fuller understanding of the gender roles and expectations of their culture and beginning to enforce those gender roles on others as well on themselves.

Emotional Regulation Identify advances in emotional understanding and self-regulation during early childhood.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

6.14

Early childhood is a time of great advances in emotional development, specifically in emotional understanding and self-regulation. With respect to emotional understanding, in the course of early childhood children become adept at understanding the sources of other people’s expressed emotions (Eisenberg & Fabes, 2006). In studies that show children cards depicting expressed emotions, by age 5 children are usually accurate in explaining the emotions of the situation (e.g., “She’s happy because she got a present,” or “He’s sad because his mom scolded him”). They are also adept at understanding how emotional states are the basis of subsequent actions, for example that an angry child is more likely to hit someone (Kagan & Hershkowitz, 2005).

253

Extreme expressions of emotion decrease in the course of early childhood, as effortful control develops.

emotional self-regulation ability to exercise control over one’s emotions undercontrol trait of having inadequate emotional self-regulation externalizing problems problems that involve others, such as aggression overcontrol trait of having excessive emotional self-regulation internalizing problems problems that entail turning distress inward, toward the self, such as depression and anxiety initiative vs. guilt in Erikson’s lifespan theory, the early childhood stage, in which the alternatives are learning to plan activities in a purposeful way, or being afflicted with excess guilt that undermines initiative

Young children become more adept not only at understanding others’ emotions but at controlling their own. In fact, emotional self-regulation is considered to be one of the major developmental tasks of early childhood (Grolnick et al., 2006). Developing emotional self-regulation is crucial to social relations, because maintaining harmonious social relations often requires us to restrain our immediate impulses—to wait in line, to let others go first in a game or a conversation, or to take fewer pieces of candy than we really want. Across cultures, early childhood is a time when expectations for emotional selfregulation increase (Whiting & Edwards, 1988). From age 2 to 6, extremes of emotional expression such as temper tantrums, crying, and physical aggression decrease (Alink et al., 2006; Carlson, 2003). In the brain, the development of the frontal cortex promotes this process, because this is the part of the brain most involved in emotional self-regulation (Bell & Wolfe, 2007). Another key reason why emotional outbursts decline during early childhood is that children learn strategies for regulating their emotions (Grolnick et al., 2006). Experimental studies have identified the strategies that young children use when presented with an emotionally challenging situation, such as being given a disappointing prize after being led to expect a very attractive prize (Eisenberg & Fabes, 2007). Some of the most effective strategies are leaving the situation; talking to themselves; redirecting their attention to a different activity; and seeking comfort from an attachment figure. These strategies are part of what researchers call effortful control, when children focus their attention on managing their emotions (Cipriano & Stifter, 2010). Parents can help young children develop effortful control, by providing emotional and physical comfort when their children are upset, by suggesting possible strategies for managing emotions, and by modeling effortful control themselves (Katz & Windecker-Nelson, 2004). Children vary in their success at achieving emotional self-regulation in early childhood, depending both on their temperament and on the socialization for self-regulation provided by parents and others. Children who have problems of undercontrol in early childhood have inadequately developed emotional self-regulation. These children are at risk for externalizing problems, such as aggression and conflict with others, in early childhood and beyond (Cole et al., 2003). However, developing overcontrol, an excessive degree of self-regulation of emotions, is also problematic. This can lead to internalizing problems, such as anxiety and depression, in early childhood and beyond (Grolnick et al., 2006). Throughout life, internalizing problems are more common among females and externalizing problems are more common among males (Frick & Kimonis, 2008; Ollendick et al., 2008). Successful emotional regulation means developing a level of effortful control that is between the two extremes. As Erikson (1950) noted in proposing that early childhood is the stage of initiative vs. guilt, children need to learn emotional control but without being so tightly regulated that they feel excess guilt and their ability to initiate activities is undermined. But different cultures have different views of what the optimal level of emotional control is (Chen et al., 2007). Behavior that looks like undercontrol in one culture could be valued as a healthy expression of vigor in another culture, at least for boys (Levine & New, 2010). Behavior that looks like overcontrol in one culture could be valued as the virtue of reticence in another culture (Rogoff, 2003).

Moral Development

6.15

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe moral development in early childhood, including empathy, modeling, and morality as cultural learning. As described in Chapter 5, toddlerhood is when the sociomoral emotions first appear, such as guilt, shame, embarrassment, and pride. Even in toddlerhood, the sociomoral emotions are shaped by cultural standards. Toddlers feel guilt, shame, or embarrassment when they

254

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development violate the expected standards for behavior indicated by those in their social environment, and pride when they comply. One sociomoral emotion that is especially important to moral development in early childhood is empathy. As we have seen, toddlers and even infants show indications of empathy, but the capacity for empathy develops further in early childhood (Eisenberg & Valiente, 2004). Children become better at perspective-taking, and being able to understand how others think and feel makes them more empathic. Empathy promotes prosocial behavior such as being generous or helpful. It contributes to the moral understanding of principles such as avoiding harm and being fair, because through empathy children understand how their behavior would make another person feel. As empathy increases, prosocial behavior increases over the course of early childhood (Eisenberg et al., 2006). In early childhood, moral development advances further as children gain a more detailed and complex understanding of the rules and expectations of their culture. Toddlers know when others approve or disapprove of something they have done, and usually respond with the appropriate sociomoral emotion. However, in early childhood there is greater awareness of the rule or expectation that evoked the approval or disapproval. Also, young children are more capable than toddlers of anticipating the potential consequences of their actions and avoiding behaviors that would be morally disapproved (Grolnick et al., 2006). Young children do not inherently know the rules and expectations of their culture and must learn them, sometimes by unknowingly violating them and then observing the consequences in the responses of their parents and others. For example, one day when our twins were about 4 years old, they got into the laundry room in the basement and took cups of liquid detergent and spread it all over the basement furniture—sofa, table, loveseat, VCR, CD player—all of which were ruined! I don’t think they had any intention or awareness of doing something wrong, although after we found out what they had done they knew from our response they should never do it again. A good example of cultural learning of morality can be found in the research of Richard Shweder, who has compared children, adolescents, and adults in India and the United States (2009; Shweder et al., 1990). Shweder has found that by about age 5, children already grasp the moral standards of their culture, and their views change little from childhood to adolescence to adulthood. Shweder found that there are some similarities in moral views in early childhood in India and the United States, but also many differences. At age 5, children in both countries have learned that it is wrong to take others’ property (“steal flowers from a neighbor’s garden”) or to inflict harm intentionally (“kick a dog sleeping on the side of the road”). However, young children also view many issues with a different moral perspective depending on whether they live in India or the United States. Young children in the United States view it as acceptable to eat beef, but young children in India view it as wrong. Young children in India view it as acceptable for more of a father’s inheritance to go to his son than to his daughter, but young children in the United States view it as wrong. Young children in both cultures have the ability to understand their culture’s moral rules, even though the moral rules they have learned by early childhood are quite different. How do children learn moral rules so early in life? There are several ways. Sometimes moral rules are taught explicitly. The Ten Commandments of the Jewish and Christian religions are a good example of this. Sometimes morality is taught through stories. Barbara Rogoff (2003) gives examples of storytelling as moral instruction in a variety of cultures, including Canadian First Nations people, Native Americans, and the Xhosa people of South Africa. Among the Xhosa (pronounced ZOsa), it is usually the elders that tell the stories, but the stories have been told many times before, and even young children soon learn the stories and participate in the narrative.

255

Watch the Video Moral Development at MyDevelopmentLab

Moral lessons are often communicated through stories. Here, a village elder tells children stories in Tanzania.

256

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

THINKING CULTURALLY Can you think of a childhood story or fairy tale told in your culture that communicates a moral lesson?

Explore the Concept Bandura’s Study on Observation Learning at MyDevelopmentLab

Young children also learn morality through custom complexes (see Chapter 4). Remember, the essence of the custom complex is that every customary practice of a culture contains not just the customary practice itself but cultural beliefs, often including moral beliefs. Shweder (Shweder et al., 1990) gives an example of this kind of moral learning in India. Like people in many cultures, Indians believe that a woman’s menstrual blood has potentially dangerous powers. Consequently, a menstruating woman is not supposed to cook food or sleep in the same bed as her husband. By the end of early childhood, Indian children have learned not just that a menstruating woman does not cook food or sleep with her husband (the cultural practice) but that it would be wrong for her to do so (the moral belief). A variation on the custom complex can be found in American research on modeling. Research extending over more than 30 years has shown that young children tend to model their behavior after the behavior of others they observe (Bandura, 1977; Bussey & Bandura, 2004). Most of this research has been experimental, involving situations where children observe other children or adults behaving aggressively or kindly, selfishly or generously; then children’s own behavior in a similar experimental situation is observed. Children are especially likely to model their behavior after another person if the other person’s behavior is rewarded. Also, they are more likely to model their behavior after adults who are warm and responsive or who are viewed as having authority or prestige. According to modeling theory, after observing multiple occasions of others’ behavior being rewarded or punished, children conclude that the rewarded behavior is morally desirable and the punished behavior is forbidden (Bandura, 2002). So, by observing behavior (and its consequences) they learn their culture’s principles of moral conduct. In addition to grasping early their culture’s moral principles, young children begin to display the rudiments of moral reasoning. By the age of 3 or 4, children are capable of making moral judgments that involve considerations of justice and fairness (Helwig, 2008). By age 4 they understand the difference between telling the truth and lying, and they believe it is wrong to tell lies even when the liar is not caught (Bussey, 1992). However, their moral reasoning tends to be rigid at this age. They are more likely than older children to state that stealing and lying are always wrong, without regard to the circumstances (Lourenco, 2003). Also, their moral judgments tend to be based more on fear of punishment than is the case for older children and adults (Gibbs, 2003). Their moral reasoning will become more complex with age, as we will see in later chapters. Teaching moral rules is a large part of parenting young children. Sometimes the hardest part is keeping a straight face. My wife and I bought a nice leather chair for our living room when our twins turned 4 years old, thinking that by now they were old enough to know they should be gentle with a nice piece of furniture. Wrong! Within 2 weeks they had put several large scratches in it. When confronted, they confessed at first, but then retracted their confession and looked for an alibi. “We didn’t do it, Daddy,” claimed Paris, lawyer for the defense. “Well, then who did?” I demanded. She cast her eyes down, as if it were painful for her to reveal the true offender. “Santa Claus,” she said.

Gender Development

6.16

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe the roles that parents and peers play in gender socialization, and explain how gender schemas lead to self-socialization. In all cultures, gender is a fundamental organizing principle of social life. All cultures distinguish different roles and expectations for males and females, although the strictness of those roles and expectations varies widely. Of course, many other animals, including all our mammal relatives and certainly our primate cousins, have male–female differences in their typical patterns of behavior and development. What makes humans distinctive is that, unlike other animals, we require culture to tell us how males and females are supposed to behave.

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development GENDER IDENTITY AND GENDER SOCIALIZATION Early childhood is an especially important period with respect to gender development. Recall from Chapter 5 that even earlier, at age 2, children attain gender identity, that is, they understand themselves as being either male or female (Ruble et al., 2006). However, in early childhood, gender issues intensify. By age 3–4, children associate a variety of things with either males or females, including toys, games, clothes, household items, occupations, and even colors (Ruble et al., 2006). Furthermore, they are often adamant and rigid in their perceptions of maleness and femaleness, denying, for example, that it would be possible for a boy to wear a ponytail and still remain a boy, or for a girl to play roughly and still remain a girl (Blakemore, 2003)! One reason for their insistence on strict gender roles at this age may be cognitive. It is not until age 6 or 7 that children attain gender constancy, the understanding that maleness and femaleness are biological and cannot change (Ruble et al., 2006). Earlier, children may be so insistent about maintaining gender roles because they believe that changing external features like clothes or hair styles could result in a change in gender. The similarity of children’s gender roles and gender behavior across cultures is striking, and there is a biological basis to some gender differences, as we saw in Chapter 5. However, children in virtually all cultures are also subject to intense gender socialization.

GENDER SOCIALIZATION As we learned in Chapter 5, parents play an active role in delivering cultural gender messages to their children (Ruble et al., 2006; Whiting & Edwards, 1988). They may give their children distinctively male or female names, dress them in genderspecific colors and styles, and provide them with cars or dolls to play with (Bandura & Bussey, 2004). Parents’ important role in gender socialization continues in early childhood. They continue to give their children the clothes and toys they believe are gender appropriate. They express approval when their children behave in gender-appropriate ways, and disapproval when their children violate gender expectations (Gelman et al., 2004; Leaper & Smith, 2004). In conversations, parents sometimes communicate gender expectations directly (e.g., “Don’t cry, you’re not a little girl, are you?”). They also communicate indirectly, by approving or not contradicting their children’s gender statements. (“Only boys can be doctors, Mommy.”) Parents also provide models, through their own behavior, language, and appearance, of how males and females are supposed to be different in their culture (Bandura & Bussey, 2004). Fathers become especially important to gender socialization in early childhood and beyond. They are more insistent about conformity to gender roles than mothers are, especially for boys (David et al., 2004; Wood et al., 2002). They may not want their daughters to play rough and tumble games, but they are adamant that their boys not be “sissies” or “wimps.” As we will see in later chapters, males’ greater fear of violations of gender roles is something that continues throughout life in many cultures. Peers also become a major source of gender socialization in early childhood. Once children learn gender roles and expectations, they apply them not only to themselves but to each other. They reinforce each other for gender-appropriate behavior, and reject peers who violate gender roles (Matlin, 2004; Ruble et al., 2006). Here, too, the expectations are stricter for boys than for girls (Bandura & Bussey, 2004). Boys who cry easily or who like to play with girls and engage in girls’ games are likely to be ostracized by other boys (David et al., 2004).

GENDER SCHEMAS AND SELF-SOCIALIZATION As a result of gender socialization, from early childhood onward children use gender schemas as a way of understanding and interpreting the world around them. Recall from Chapter 4 that scheme is Piaget’s term for a cognitive structure for organizing and processing information. (scheme and schema are used interchangeably in psychology.) A gender schema is a gender-based cognitive structure for organizing and processing information (Martin & Ruble, 2004).

257

gender constancy understanding that maleness and femaleness are biological and cannot change gender roles cultural expectations for appearance and behavior specific to males or females gender schema gender-based cognitive structure for organizing and processing information, comprising expectations for males’ and females’ appearance and behavior

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse New grandmother Natalie wonders where newborn Nicole will receive male genderrole socialization while being raised by her two mothers. What can you tell her?

Fathers tend to promote conformity to gender roles more than mothers do.

258

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

Once children learn the gender roles of their culture, they may strive to conform to them. Here, girls in Cambodia attend a dance class.

THINKING CULTURALLY Give an example of a custom complex for gender—a cultural practice or custom that reflects cultural beliefs related to gender roles in your culture.

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

According to gender-schema theory, gender is one of our most important schemas from early childhood onward. By the time we reach the end of early childhood, on the basis of our socialization we have learned to categorize a wide range of activities and objects and personality characteristics as “female” or “male.” This includes not just the obvious— vaginas are female, penises are male—but many things that have no inherent “femaleness” or “maleness” and are nevertheless taught as possessing gender—the moon as “female” and the sun as “male” in traditional Chinese culture, or blue as a “boy color” and pink as a “girl color” (in Korea, pink is a “boy color,” which illustrates how cultural these designations are). Gender schemas influence how we interpret the behavior of others and what we expect from them (Frawley, 2008). This well-known story provides an example: “A little boy and his father were in a terrible automobile accident. The father died, but the boy was rushed to the hospital. As the boy was rushed into surgery, the doctor looked down at him and said, ‘I cannot operate on this boy—he is my son!’” How could the boy be the doctor’s son, if the father died in the accident? The answer, of course, is that the doctor is the boy’s mother. But people reading this story are often puzzled by it because their gender schemas have led them to assume the doctor was male. (This story is less effective than it used to be, because so many women are physicians today! Try it on someone.) In early childhood, children tend to believe that their own preferences are true for everyone in their gender (Liben & Bigler, 2002). For example, a boy who dislikes peas may justify it by claiming “boys don’t like peas.” Young children also tend to remember in ways that reflect their gender schemas. In one study (Liben & Signorella, 1993), children who were shown pictures that violated typical gender roles (e.g., a woman driving a truck) tended to remember them in accordance with their gender schemas (a man, not a woman, driving the truck). Throughout life, we tend to notice information that fits within our gender schemas and ignore or dismiss information that is inconsistent with them (David et al., 2004). Once young children possess gender schemas, they seek to maintain consistency between their schemas and their behavior, a process called self-socialization. Boys become quite insistent about doing things they regard as boy things and avoiding things that girls do; girls become equally intent on avoiding boy things and doing things they regard as appropriate for girls (Bandura & Bussey, 2004; Tobin et al., 2010). In this way, according to a prominent gender scholar, “cultural myths become self-fulfilling prophesies” (Bem, 1981, p. 355). By the end of early childhood, gender roles are enforced not only by socialization from others but by self-socialization, as children strive to conform to the gender expectations they perceive in the culture around them.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What can parents do to help children develop effortful control? 2. Why do children become more empathic during early childhood? 3. How do children learn morality through modeling? 4. Why are fathers especially important to gender socialization?

self-socialization process by which people seek to maintain consistency between their gender schemas and their behavior

5. How does gender-schema theory explain why Americans consider pink a “girl color”? 6. How does self-socialization lead to gender-typed behavior?

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

259

Parenting Parents are a key part of children’s lives everywhere, but how parents view their role and their approaches to discipline and punishment vary widely. First, we look at a popular model of parenting “styles” based on American parenting, then at more culturally based views of parenting.

Parenting “Styles” Describe the four types of parenting “styles” and the outcomes associated with each, and explain why those outcomes are complex. Have you heard the joke about the man who, before he had any children, had five theories about how they should be raised? Ten years later he had five children and no theories. Well, jokes aside, most parents do have ideas about how best to raise children, even after they have had children for awhile (Tamis-Lamonda et al., 2008). In research the investigation of this topic has involved the study of parenting styles, that is, the practices that parents exhibit in relation to their children and their beliefs about those practices. This research originated in the United States and has involved mainly American children and their parents, although it has now been applied in some other countries as well. For over 50 years, American scholars have engaged in research on this topic, and the results have been quite consistent (Collins & Laursen, 2004; Maccoby & Martin, 1983; Steinberg, 2001). Virtually all of the prominent scholars who have studied parenting have described it in terms of two dimensions: demandingness and responsiveness (also known by other terms such as control and warmth). Parental demandingness is the degree to which parents set down rules and expectations for behavior and require their children to comply with them. Parental responsiveness is the degree to which parents are sensitive to their children’s needs and express love, warmth, and concern for them. Various scholars have combined these two dimensions to describe different kinds of parenting styles. For many years, the best known and most widely used conception of parenting styles was the one articulated by Diana Baumrind (1968, 1971, 1991a, 1991b). Her research on middle-class White American families, along with the research of other scholars inspired by her ideas, has identified four distinct parenting styles (Collins & Laursen, 2004; Maccoby & Martin, 1983; Steinberg, 2000; see Table 6.1). Authoritative parents are high in demandingness and high in responsiveness. They set clear rules and expectations for their children. Furthermore, they make clear what the consequences will be if their children do not comply, and they make those consequences stick if necessary. However, authoritative parents do not simply “lay down the law” and then enforce it rigidly. A distinctive feature of authoritative parents is that they explain the reasons for their rules and expectations to their children, and they willingly engage in discussion with their children over issues of discipline, sometimes leading to negotiation and compromise. For example, a child who wants to eat a whole bag of candy would not simply be told “No!” by an authoritative parent but something like, “No, it wouldn’t be healthy and it would be bad for your teeth.” Authoritative parents are also loving and warm toward their children, and they respond to what their children need and desire.

TABLE 6.1 Parenting Styles and the Two Dimensions of Parenting Demandingness High

Low

High

Authoritative

Permissive

Low

Authoritarian

Disengaged

Responsiveness

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

6.17

Watch the Video Parenting Styles at MyDevelopmentLab

parenting styles practices that parents exhibit in relation to their children and their beliefs about those practices demandingness degree to which parents set down rules and expectations for behavior and require their children to comply with them responsiveness degree to which parents are sensitive to their children’s needs and express love, warmth, and concern for them authoritative parents in classifications of parenting styles, parents who are high in demandingness and high in responsiveness

260

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood Authoritarian parents are high in demandingness but low in responsiveness. They require obedience from their children, and they punish disobedience without compromise. None of the verbal give-and-take common with authoritative parents is allowed by authoritarian parents. They expect their commands to be followed without dispute or dissent. To continue with the candy example, the authoritarian parent would respond to the child’s request for a bag of candy simply by saying “No!” with no explanation. Also, authoritarian parents show little in the way of love or warmth toward their children. Their demandingness takes place without responsiveness, in a way that shows little emotional attachment and may even be hostile. Permissive parents are low in demandingness and high in responsiveness. They have few clear expectations for their children’s behavior, and they rarely discipline them. Instead, their emphasis is on responsiveness. They believe that children need love that is truly “unconditional.” They may see discipline and control as having the potential to damage their children’s healthy tendencies for developing creativity and expressing themselves however they wish. They provide their children with love and warmth and give them a great deal of freedom to do as they please. Disengaged parents are low in both demandingness and responsiveness. Their goal may be to minimize the amount of time and emotion they devote to parenting. Thus, they require little of their children and rarely bother to correct their behavior or place clear limits on what they are allowed to do. They also express little in the way of love or concern for their children. They may seem to have little emotional attachment to them. THE EFFECTS OF PARENTING STYLES ON CHILDREN A great deal of research has been conducted on how parenting styles influence children’s development. A summary of the results is shown in Table 6.2. In general, authoritative parenting is associated with the most favorable outcomes, at least by American standards. Children who have authoritative parents tend to be independent, self-assured, creative, and socially skilled (Baumrind, 1991a, 1991b; Collins & Larsen, 2004; Steinberg, 2000; Williams et al., 2009). They also tend to do well in school and to get along well with their peers and with adults (Hastings et al., 2007; Spera, 2005). Authoritative parenting helps children develop characteristics such as optimism and self-regulation that in turn have positive effects on a wide range of behaviors (Jackson et al., 2005; Purdie et al., 2004). All the other parenting styles are associated with some negative outcomes, although the type of negative outcome varies depending on the specific parenting style (Baumrind, 1991a, 1991b; Snyder et al., 2005). Children with authoritarian parents tend to be less selfassured, less creative, and less socially adept than other children. Boys with authoritarian parents are more often aggressive and unruly, whereas girls are more often anxious and unhappy (Russell et al., 2003). Children with permissive parents tend to be immature and lack self-control. Because they lack self-control, they have difficulty getting along with peers and teachers (Linver et al., 2002). Children with disengaged parents also tend to be impulsive. Partly as a consequence of their impulsiveness, and partly because disengaged parents do little to monitor their activities, children with disengaged parents tend to have higher rates of behavior problems (Pelaez et al., 2008).

authoritarian parents in classifications of parenting styles, parents who are high in demandingness but low in responsiveness permissive parents in classifications of parenting styles, parents who are low in demandingness and high in responsiveness disengaged parents in classifications of parenting styles, parents who are low in both demandingness and responsiveness

TABLE 6.2 Outcomes Associated With Parenting Styles in White Middle-Class Families Authoritative

Authoritarian

Permissive

Disengaged

Independent

Dependent

Irresponsible

Impulsive

Creative

Passive

Conforming

Behavior problems

Self-assured

Conforming

Immature

Early sex, drugs

Socially skilled

A MORE COMPLEX PICTURE OF PARENTING EFFECTS Although parents undoubtedly affect their children profoundly by their parenting, the process is not nearly as simple as the causeand-effect model just described. Sometimes discussions of parenting make it sound as though Parenting Style A automatically and inevitably produces Child Type X. However, enough research has taken place by now to indicate that the relationship between parenting styles and children’s development is considerably more complex than that (Lamb & Lewis, 2005; Parke & Buriel, 2006). Not only are children affected by their parents, but parents are affected by their children. This principle is referred to by scholars as reciprocal or bidirectional effects between parents and children (Combs-Ronto et al., 2009). Recall our discussion of evocative genotype m environment effects in Chapter 2. Children are not like billiard balls that head predictably in the direction they are propelled. They have personalities and desires of their own that they bring to the parent–child relationship. Thus, children may evoke certain behaviors from their parents. An especially aggressive child may evoke authoritarian parenting; perhaps the parents find that authoritative explanations of the rules are simply ignored, and their responsiveness diminishes as a result of the child’s repeated disobedience and disruptiveness. An especially mildtempered child may evoke permissive parenting, because parents may see no point in laying down specific rules for a child who has no inclination to do anything wrong anyway. Does this research discredit the claim that parenting styles influence children? No, but it does modify it. Parents certainly have beliefs about what is best for their children, and they try to express those beliefs through their parenting behavior (Alwin, 1988; Way et al., 2007). However, parents’ actual behavior is affected not only by what they believe is best but also by how their children behave toward them and respond to their parenting. Being an authoritative parent is easier if your child responds to your demandingness and responsiveness with compliance and love, and not so easy if your love is rejected and your rules and the reasons you provide for them are ignored. Parents whose efforts to persuade their children through reasoning and discussion fall on deaf ears may be tempted either to demand compliance (and become more authoritarian) or to give up trying (and become permissive or disengaged).

How does the idea of reciprocal effects complicate claims of the effects of parenting styles?

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE Did your mother and father have the same parenting style, or not? To what extent did their parenting reflect a “style” and to what extent do you think you evoked their parenting behavior?

Parenting in Other Cultures Describe the major cultural variations in approaches to parenting. So far we have looked at the parenting styles research based mainly on American families. What does research in other cultures indicate about parenting and its effects in early childhood? One important observation is how rare the authoritative parenting style is in nonWestern cultures. Remember, a distinctive feature of authoritative parents is that they do not rely on the authority of the parental role to ensure that children comply with their commands and instructions. They do not simply lay down the law and expect to be obeyed. On the contrary, authoritative parents explain the reasons for what they want children to do and engage in discussion over the guidelines for their children’s behavior (Baumrind, 1971, 1991a; Steinberg & Levine, 1997). Outside of the West, however, this is an extremely rare way of parenting. In traditional cultures, parents expect that their authority will be obeyed, without question and without requiring an explanation (LeVine et al., 2008). This is true not only in nearly all developing countries but also in developed countries outside the West, most notably Asian countries such as Japan and and South Korea (Tseng, 2004; Zhang & Fuligni, 2006). Asian cultures have a tradition of filial piety, meaning that children are expected to respect, obey, and revere their parents throughout life (Lieber et al., 2004). The role of parent carries greater inherent authority than it does in the West. Parents are not supposed to provide reasons why they should be respected and obeyed. The simple fact that they are parents and their children are children is viewed as sufficient justification for their authority.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

6.18

Read the Document An Alternative Classification of Parenting Styles at MyDevelopmentLab

reciprocal or bidirectional effects in relations between two persons, the principle that each of them affects the other filial piety belief that children should respect, obey, and revere their parents throughout life; common in Asian cultures

261

262

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

In most cultures, parents expect to be respected and obeyed without justifying their actions. Here, a mother and daughter in Japan.

familismo cultural belief among Latinos that emphasizes the love, closeness, and mutual obligations among family members

In Latin American cultures, too, the authority of parents is viewed as paramount. The Latino cultural belief system places a premium on the idea of respeto, which emphasizes respect for and obedience to parents and elders, especially the father (Cabrera & GarciaColl, 2004; Halgunseth et al., 2006; Harwood et al. 2002). The role of the parent is considered to be enough to command authority, without requiring that the parents explain their rules to their children. Another pillar of Latino cultural beliefs is familismo, which emphasizes the love, closeness, and mutual obligations of Latino family life (Halgunseth et al., 2006; Harwood et al., 2002). Does this mean that the typical parenting style in non-Western cultures is authoritarian? No, although sometimes scholars have come to this erroneous conclusion. It would be more accurate to state that the parenting-styles model is a cultural model, rooted in the American majority culture, and does not apply well to most other cultures. Of course, children everywhere need to have parents or other caregivers provide care for them in early childhood and beyond, and across cultures parents provide some combination of warmth and control. However, “responsiveness” is a distinctly American kind of warmth, emphasizing praise and physical affection, and “demandingness” is a distinctly American kind of control, emphasizing explanation and negotiation rather than the assertion of parental authority. Other cultures have their own culturally based forms of warmth and control, but across cultures, warmth rarely takes the American form of praise, and control rarely takes the American form of explanation and negotiation (Matsumoto & Yoo, 2006; Miller, 2004; Wang & Tamis-Lamonda, 2003). Even within American society, the authoritative style is mainly dominant among White, middle-class families (Steinberg, 1996). Most American minority cultures, including African Americans, Latinos, and Asian Americans, have been classified by researchers as “authoritarian,” but this is inaccurate and results from applying to them a model that was based on the White majority culture (Chao & Tseng, 2002). Each minority culture has its own distinctive form of warmth, but all tend to emphasize obeying parental authority rather than encouraging explanation and negotiation. Hence they have warmth as “authoritative” parents do but they view parental authority as “authoritarian” parents do; the American model of parenting styles cannot really be applied to them. Within cultures, parenting varies depending on the personalities of the parents, their goals for their children, and the characteristics of the children that evoke particular parenting responses. Overall, however, the dominant approach to parenting in a culture reflects certain things about the underlying cultural beliefs, such as the value of independence versus independence and the status of parental authority over children (Giles-Sims & Lockhart, 2005; Hulei et al., 2006). The cultural context of parenting is so crucial that what looks like the same parental behavior in two different cultures can have two very different effects, as we will see in the next section.

Discipline and Punishment

6.19

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe the main cultural variations in how parents discipline young children, and explain how cultural context influences children’s responses to discipline. In many cultures, early childhood is when issues of discipline for disapproved behavior first arise. As we have seen, it is common for cultures to be indulgent of infants and toddlers, because they are seen to be too young to exercise much judgment or self-control. However, by early childhood children become more capable of emotional and behavioral self-regulation, and when they disobey or defy the authority of others they are believed to have enough understanding to know what they were doing and to be responsible for the

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

263

consequences. For this reason, early childhood is usually the age when children are first disciplined for not following expectations or not doing what is required of them. CULTURAL VARIATIONS IN DISCIPLINE All cultures require children to learn and follow cultural rules and expectations, and all cultures have some system of discipline for misbehavior. However, cultures vary widely in the nature of the discipline, and the consequences of discipline vary depending on the cultural beliefs that underlie the approach. In Western cultures the approach to discipline in early childhood tends to emphasize the authoritative style of explaining the consequences of misbehavior and the reasons for discipline (Huang et al., 2009; Tamis-Lamonda et al., 2008). “Michael, if you don’t stop banging that toy against the floor I’m going to take it away! Okay, now I’m going to take it away until you can learn to play with it nicely.” Western parents also tend to use a lot of praise for compliant and obedient behavior, which is notable because the use of praise is very rare in other cultures (LeVine et al., 2008; Whiting & Edwards, 1988). Discipline for misbehavior may involve taking away privileges (as in the example just given) or a time out in which the child is required to sit still in a designated place for a brief period, usually only a few minutes (Morawska & Sanders, 2011). Little research has been conducted on the effectiveness of time out under normal family circumstances, but it has been shown to be effective with young children who have behavioral problems (Everett & Bryk, 2007; Everett et al., 2007; Fabiano et al., 2004). In addition to using time out, parenting researchers recommend (1) explaining the reasons for discipline; (2) being consistent so that the consequences will be predictable to the child (and hence avoidable); and (3) exercising discipline at the time of the misbehavior (not later on) so that the connection will be clear to the child (Klass et al., 2008). One popular approach suggests that if a parent’s request to a young child is ignored or disobeyed, the parent counts a warning: “One-twothree,” and if the request is not obeyed by “three” the child is then put in time out, 1 minute for each year of their age (Phelan, 2010). I can tell you, my wife and I found that this worked like magic with our twins in early childhood; we almost never got to “three.” Other cultures have different approaches to discipline. Japan provides an interesting example of a culture where shame and withdrawal of love is the core of discipline in early childhood. Recall that amae, introduced in Chapter 5, is a Japanese word that describes the close attachment between mother and child (Rothbaum et al., 2000). During infancy, amae takes the form of an emotionally indulgent and physically close relationship between the Japanese mother and her baby. However, in toddlerhood and early childhood, a new element, shame and withdrawal of love, is added. Japanese mothers rarely respond to their children’s misbehavior with loud reprimands or physical punishment. Instead, they express disappointment and withdraw their love temporarily. The child feels shame, which is a powerful inducement not to disobey again. This system of early childhood socialization seems to work well in Japan. Japanese children have low rates of behavioral problems, and high rates of academic achievement (Stevenson & Zusho, 2002). They grow up to be Japanese adults who have low rates of crime and social problems and high levels of economic productivity, making Japan one of the most stable and economically successful societies in the world. However, the same parental behaviors appear to have a different, more negative effect in Western countries. Among American researchers, parenting that uses shame and withdrawal of love has been described using the term psychological control (Barber, 2002). This kind of parenting has been found in American studies to be related to negative outcomes in early childhood and beyond, including anxious, withdrawn, and aggressive behavior, as well as problems with peers (Barber et al., 2005; Silk et al., 2003). In Finland, too, a longitudinal study that began in early childhood found psychological control to predict negative outcomes in later childhood and adolescence, especially when psychological control was combined with physical affection, as it is in amae (Aunola & Nurmi, 2004).

“Time out” is a popular discipline strategy among middle-class American parents.

time out disciplinary strategy in which the child is required to sit still in a designated place for a brief period psychological control parenting strategy that uses shame and withdrawal of love to influence children’s behavior

264

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

Three-year-old Midori is ashamed when her Japanese mother expresses disappointment in her. How can you explain this feeling of shame from a developmental and cultural point of view?

What explains this difference? Why does amae appear to work well in Japan but not in the West? It is difficult to say, since this question has not been researched directly. However, the answer may be some kind of interaction between the parents’ behavior and the cultural belief system. In Japan, amae fits neatly into a larger system of cultural beliefs about duty and obligations to others, especially to family. In the West, psychological control contrasts and perhaps collides with cultural beliefs about the value of thinking and behaving independently. It may be this friction between the parental practices and the cultural beliefs that results in negative outcomes, not the parental practices in themselves.

corporal punishment physical punishment of children

PHYSICAL PUNISHMENT AND ITS CONSEQUENCES Research on physical punishment (also known as corporal punishment) suggests a similar kind of interaction between parenting practices and cultural beliefs. Physical punishment of young children is common in most parts of the world (Curran et al., 2001). This approach to punishment has a long history, as you will see in the Historical Focus: Beat a Child, Save a Soul feature. Most adults in most countries around the world remember experiencing physical punishment as children. Although most countries still allow parents to spank their young children, nearly all outlaw beatings and other harsh forms of physical punishment, which the historical record shows was quite common until about 100 years ago (Straus, 1994). Is physical punishment destructive to young children, or is it a form of instruction that teaches them to respect and obey adults? Here, as with amae, the answer appears to be very different depending on the cultural context. Many studies in the United States and Europe have been conducted on physical punishment of young children, and these studies have found a correlation between physical punishment and a wide range of antisocial behavior in children, including telling lies, fighting with peers, and disobeying parents (Alaggia & Vine, 2006; Kazdin & Benjet, 2003). Furthermore, several longitudinal studies have reported that physical punishment in early childhood increases the likelihood of bullying and delinquency in adolescence and aggressive behavior (including spousal abuse) in adulthood (Jaffee et al., 2004). On the basis of these studies, some scholars have concluded that physical punishment in early childhood increases children’s compliance in the short run but damages their moral and mental health in the long run (Amato & Fowler, 2002; Gershoff, 2002). However, studies that cast a wider cultural net report considerably more complicated findings. In one longitudinal study, White and African American families were studied when the children were in early childhood and then 12 years later, when the children were in adolescence (Lansford et al., 2004). The White children showed the familiar pattern: physical punishment in early childhood predicted aggressive and antisocial behavior in adolescence. However, for African American children, nearly the opposite pattern was found. The more physical punishment the children experienced in early childhood, the less likely they were to be aggressive and antisocial in adolescence. Other studies have reported similar findings of the generally beneficial results of early childhood physical punishment among African Americans (Bluestone & Tamis-Lamonda, 1999; Brody & Flor, 1998; Steele et al., 2005). Similarly, studies of traditional cultures have found that many of the parents in these cultures use physical punishment on young children, and the children nevertheless grow up to be well-behaved, productive, mentally healthy adults (Levine et al., 2008; Whiting & Edwards, 1988). Like the findings regarding amae, the findings on physical punishment show the crucial role of cultural context in how young children respond to their parents’ behavior. In White American and European cultures, physical punishment is generally disapproved and not widely or frequently used (Graziano & Hamblen, 1996). In these cultures, physical punishment is likely to be combined with anger (Gunnoe & Mariner, 1997; McLoyd & Smith, 2002). In contrast, among African Americans, and in traditional cultures, the use of physical punishment in early childhood is widespread (Brody & Flor, 1998; Ispa & Halgunseth, 2004; Pinterhughes et al., 2000). Usually, it is mild in degree and is delivered not in an angry rage but calmly and sternly, as part of a “no-nonsense” parenting style

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

265

(Brody & Flor, 1998). Physical punishment is often combined with parental warmth, so that children understand their parents’ behavior not as a frightening and threatening loss of parental control but as a practice intended to teach them right from wrong and the importance of obeying their parents (Gunnoe & Mariner, 1997; Mosby et al., 1999). This cultural context makes the meaning and the consequences of physical punishment much different than it is in White American and European cultures.

HISTORICAL FOCUS Beat a Child, Save a Soul

P

Another influential figure of the Enlightenment who had much hysical punishment is a widespread parenting practice to say about parenting and punishment was the French philosowith young children, and it has a long history. It is recpher Jean Jacques Rousseau (1712–1778). Like Locke, Rousseau ommended in the Bible, in the book of Proverbs written was no model father. He had at least five children by a variety of over 2,000 years ago: “Do not be afraid to beat your child. women but was never involved in the care of any of them. NeverYou shall beat him with the rod, and save his soul from hell.” theless, for over two centuries he was tremendously influential in Notice that physical punishment is not meant to be harmful European views of parenting and punishbut helpful, a form of moral instruction ment. In his book Emile (1763), he laid out that will “save [the child’s] soul.” what he believed to be an ideal program For much of the next 1,500 years, the for raising children. He argued that they Bible was the basis of the cultural beliefs of should be given as much freedom as posmost of the West, including beliefs regardsible to allow their goodness and curiosity ing family relations. Physical punishment to flourish. Locke believed children were was a standard part of parenting. It was born as blank slates, but Rousseau went only during the Enlightenment, beginning further and proposed that children are about 400 years ago, that Western cultural born naturally good, only to be corruptbeliefs began to broaden, and as part of ed and warped by misguided parenting that process came new ideas about parentmethods, including physical punishment. ing. One influential figure in this change In Rousseau’s view, physical punishment was John Locke (1632–1704), the British is unnecessary because children are born philosopher who wrote the first known good and innocent, and it is wrong beparenting manual, even though he was a cause it damages children’s natural prolifelong bachelor with no children himself pensity for kindness. (insert your own punch line here). Locke’s Primarily due to Locke’s and Rousrevolutionary idea was that all children are seau’s influence, over the course of the born as a tabula rasa, a blank slate, rather John Locke was a childless bachelor who wrote 18th and 19th centuries support for physithan being filled with sin that needs to be the first parenting manual in the 17th century. cal punishment gradually declined in the beat out of them. Consequently, Locke West (Straus, 1994). In recent years, physidiscouraged physical punishment and cal punishment of children has even become prohibited by law in advocated explanation and negotiation instead, much as Western 24 countries, mainly in Europe (Curran et al., 2001). Nevertheless, psychologists do today. He believed that if parents rewarded good physical punishment remains common in most parts of the world, behavior with esteem and made shame the consequence of bad beas this chapter shows. havior they would not have to resort to physical punishment.

CHILD ABUSE AND NEGLECT Although there are wide cultural variations in discipline and punishment of young children, today there is a widespread view across cultures that children should not be physically harmed and that parents have a responsibility to provide for their children’s physical and emotional needs (UNICEF, 2011). However, there are all kinds of parents in the world, and in all cultures there are some who fail to meet these basic requirements. Child maltreatment includes both abuse and neglect of children, specifically: s s

Physical abuse, which entails causing physical harm to a child, including hitting, kicking, biting, burning, or shaking the child; Emotional abuse, including ridicule and humiliation as well as behavior causing emotional trauma to children such as locking them in a dark closet;

child maltreatment abuse or neglect of children, including physical, emotional, or sexual abuse

266

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood s s

Sexual abuse, meaning any kind of sexual contact with a minor; and Neglect, which is failure to meet children’s basic needs of food, shelter, clothing, medical attention, and supervision.

Most research on maltreatment of young children has focused on physical abuse (Cicchetti, 2001). A variety of risk factors for physical abuse have been identified, involving characteristics of children as well as characteristics of parents. Young children are at risk for physical abuse if they are temperamentally difficult or if they are unusually aggressive or active and hence more difficult for parents to control (Li et al., 2010). Parental risk factors for physical abuse of children include poverty, unemployment, and single motherhood, all of which contribute to stress, which may in turn trigger abuse (Geeraert et al., 2004; Zielinski, 2009). Stepfathers are more likely to be abusive than biological fathers are, and child abuse is correlated with spouse abuse, suggesting that the abuser has a problem with anger management and self-control that is expressed in multiple ways (Asawa et al., 2008). Abusive parents often view their children as somehow deserving the abuse because of disobedience or because they are “no good” and will not respond to anything else (Bugental & Happaney, 2004). Parents who abuse their children were abused by their own parents in about one-third of cases (Cicchetti & Toth, 1998). Watch the Video Childhood Sexual Abuse at MyDevelopmentLab Physical abuse is destructive to young children in a wide variety of ways. It impairs emotional and self-development, including self-regulation, empathy, and self-concept (Haugaard & Hazen, 2004). It is damaging to the development of friendships and social skills, because abused children find it difficult to trust others (Elliott et al., 2005). It also interferes with school performance, as abused children are often low in academic motivation and have behavior problems in the classroom (Boden et al., 2007). Furthermore, children who are abused are at risk for later emotional, social, and academic problems in adolescence and beyond (Fergusson et al., 2008; Herrenkohl et al., 2004). What can be done to help abused children? In most cultures, there is some kind of system that removes children from their parents’ care when the parents are abusive. In traditional cultures, the system tends to be informal. Children with abusive parents may go to live with relatives with whom they have a more positive, less conflictual relationship (LeVine et al., 2008). In Western countries, it is more often the formal legal system that intervenes in cases of child abuse. A state agency investigates reports of abuse, and if the report is verified the child is removed from the home. The agency may then place the child in foster care, in which adults approved by the agency take over the care of the child (Pew Commission on Foster Care, 2004). In the United States, about half of children in foster care are placed with relatives through the formal system (U.S. Dept. of Health & Human Services [DHHS], 2004). In addition, three times as many children are estimated to live with nonparental relatives, similar to the informal system of traditional cultures. Sometimes children in foster care return home after a period, sometimes they are adopted by their foster family, and sometimes they “age out” of foster care when they turn age 18 (Smith, 2011). Children in foster care are at high risk for academic, social, and behavioral problems, especially if they experience Watch the Video Adoption and multiple foster-home placements (Crum, 2010; Plant & Siegel, 2008; Vig et al., 2005). Foster Care at MyDevelopmentLab Another alternative is for children to live in a group home staffed by the state agency that oversees child abuse and neglect cases (Dunn et al., 2010). I worked in a group home when I was an emerging adult, years ago. I still remember many of the kids vividly, especially one boy who had scars all over his back from where his parents had beaten and burned him. Group homes are usually a temporary alternative until the child can be placed in foster care or with relatives (DeSena et al., 2005). Programs have also been developed to prevent child maltreatment. In the United States, one notable program is the Nurse–Family Partnership (NFP), with sites in 22 states (DHHS, 2005). In this program, expectant mothers who have many of the risk factors for abuse receive regular home visits by a trained nurse for 2 years. The nurse provides information and advice about how to manage crises, how to manage children’s behavior without physical punishment, and how to access community agencies that provide services for families (Olds, 2010). In a 15-year followfoster care for maltreated children, approach in up comparing families who participated in the NFP to other families with similar risks, the NFP which adults approved by a state agency take over group showed a 79% reduction in child abuse and neglect (Eckenrode et al., 2001). the care of the child

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. How do Baumrind’s four parenting styles differ on the dimensions of demandingness and responsiveness? 2. What are the outcomes associated with authoritative parenting? 3. Give an example of a reciprocal or bidirectional effect between parent and child. 4. How does the Asian tradition of filial piety translate into a parenting style that differs from Western authoritative parenting? 5. What are three characteristics of effective discipline, according to American parenting researchers? 6. What are some of the negative effects of child maltreatment?

The Child’s Expanding Social World Across cultures, the social world expands considerably in early childhood. Infants and toddlers need a great deal of care, nurturance, and supervision. And, as we have seen in the previous two chapters, infants and toddlers are usually kept in close proximity to someone who will provide this for them, usually the mother, sometimes in collaboration with a father, grandmother, aunt, or older sibling. When they reach early childhood, children still need a considerable amount of care, but they no longer need to be constantly watched by others. The anthropologist Margaret Mead (1935) proposed a general scheme many decades ago that still applies well to how most of the world’s children experience the social changes of childhood (see Table 6.3). Recall from Chapter 5 that Mead designated children ages 0–2 with the term lap child, to denote their near-constant dependence on the care and monitoring of others. For early childhood, Mead proposed two terms. At ages 3–4 is the knee child, who is still cared for mainly by the mother but also spends time with other children, especially of the same gender. At ages 5–6 is the yard child, who is given more scope to venture beyond the immediate family area and into the “yard,” that is, into a social world where parents are nearby but not always directly present. Margaret Mead’s scheme was the basis of a classic study of young children across cultures conducted by anthropologists Beatrice Whiting and Carolyn Edwards (1988). Whiting and Edwards studied children ages 2–10 in twelve different cultures in places around the world, including Africa, Asia, South America, and the United States. Their goal was to see what kinds of similarities and differences exist in the social worlds of children across cultures. They found substantial similarities worldwide in how cultures socialize young children and structure their social environments. From lap children to knee children to yard children, there is a gradual lessening of dependence on the mother and a gradual move into the social orbit of peers and older children. Like lap children, knee children receive a great deal of nurturance from mothers and from older children. However, more is required of

TABLE 6.3 Mead’s Classifications of Childhood Stages Age

Term

Features

0–2

Lap child

Needs constant care; doted on by others

3–4

Knee child

Still cared for mainly by mothers, but spends more time with other children

5–6

Yard child

More time spent with same-sex peers; sometimes unsupervised

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

267

268

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

Across cultures, children are given more autonomy and more responsibility in the course of early childhood. Here, a girl washes dishes outside her Guatemalan home.

knee children than of lap children. Knee children are expected to stop breast feeding and to have less bodily contact with the mother. Parents and older children expect knee children to be toilet trained, to have basic manners (such as waiting their turn), and to perform minor chores. Older children exercise more dominance over knee children than over lap children, because knee children are perceived as better able to understand and follow commands. Yard children are allowed more freedom than knee children. Yard children spend most of their time close to home, as knee children do, but 20% of the time they are outside of their immediate home area doing errands or playing. However, most cultures share a view that children cannot reason very well until about age 6 and this limits how far a yard child can be away from home or supervision. The cultures studied by Mead and by Whiting and Edwards were mostly in developing countries, but many of the same patterns apply in developed countries. Across countries and cultures, the social world expands in early childhood to include more time and more interactions with siblings, peers, and friends. In developed countries the media world expands as well, as children not only watch TV as they have from infancy but many also begin to play electronic games as well.

Siblings and “Only Children”

6.20

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Identify the most common features of sibling relationships worldwide, and describe how children with no siblings differ from other children. A gap of 2–4 years between children is common worldwide, traditionally. In developing countries, especially in rural areas, breast feeding often lasts at least 2 years, and as we have seen, breast feeding acts as a natural contraceptive by suppressing the mother’s ovulation. In economically developed countries, parents often choose to space their children by 2–4 years (maybe it takes them that long to forget how much work it is to take care of an infant!). Consequently, it is often in early childhood that children experience the birth of a younger sibling. How do young children respond to a baby brother or sister? As we learned in Chapter 5, jealousy is the predominant emotion, initially. In their study of 12 cultures, Whiting and Edwards (1988) found a great deal of variability on most issues, but in all 12 cultures jealousy was recognized as a common response to the birth of a younger sibling. Nevertheless, there was great variability in how parents responded to the jealousy of young children, from physical punishment in Africa to trying to comfort and reassure the jealous child in the United States. From the outset, young children expressed love as well as jealousy toward their younger siblings. Like people of other ages, they enjoyed doting on the lap child. More recent American studies show this same pattern of ambivalence toward younger siblings. Aggressive and hostile behavior is common, but so is helping, sharing, and teaching (Kramer & Kowal, 2005; Martin & Ross, 2005; Natsuaki et al., 2009). Ambivalence continues with age, when there is a younger sibling in early childhood and an older sibling in middle childhood. Middle-childhood siblings care for and teach their younger siblings, but also command and dominate them, and sometimes physically punish them (Howe & Recchia, 2009; Pike et al., 2005; Volling, 2003). Younger siblings admire their older siblings and model their behavior after them, trying to learn to do what their older siblings can do, although sometimes resenting their authority. But even conflict

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development between siblings can have positive effects. Studies indicate that young children with older siblings possess more advanced theory of mind understanding than children who have no older sibling (McAlister & Peterson, 2007; Randell & Peterson, 2009). One explanation of this is that, as siblings argue, compete, and cooperate they learn better how to understand the thinking of others and accept that others have a point of view that may be different than their own. What about children who have no siblings? This has become an increasingly common condition over the past half century, as birthrates have fallen worldwide. In the United States, about 20% of children have no siblings. In some parts of Europe and Asia birthrates are just 1.1–1.4 children per woman, meaning that there are more children who do not have a sibling than do have one (Population Reference Bureau, 2010). What is it like to be an only child? Having siblings is a mixed blessing, and having no siblings has mixed effects as well. In general, “only children” fare at least as well as children with siblings (Brody, 2004). Their self-esteem, social maturity, and intelligence tend to be somewhat higher than children with siblings, perhaps because they have more interactions with adults (Dunn, 2004). However, in American studies they are somewhat less successful in social relations with peers, perhaps because children with siblings gain peerlike practice in social relations (Kitzmann et al., 2002). Only children have been especially common in China in recent decades. Beginning in 1978, in response to fears of overpopulation, the Chinese government instituted a “one-child policy” making it illegal for parents to have more than one child without special government approval. There were fears that this policy would create a generation of “little emperors and empresses” who were overindulged and selfish, but those fears appear to be unfounded. Like only children in the United States, only children in China demonstrate several advantages over children with siblings, including higher cognitive development, higher emotional security, and higher likeability (Jiao et al.,1996; Wang & Fong, 2009; Yang et al., 1995). Unlike their American counterparts, Chinese only children show no deficits is social skills or peer acceptance (Hart et al., 2003). One unexpected benefit of the one-child policy is that girls, who in Chinese tradition have often been less favored than boys, have more opportunities in education than they did when they had to compete with brothers for family resources (Fong, 2002).

269

Because of its “one-child” policy, China today has many children without siblings.

Peers and Friends Explain how the quality of friendships changes from toddlerhood to early childhood, and describe the role of play and aggression in young children’s friendships. As described in Chapter 5, even toddlers are capable of forming friendships (Rubin et al., 2005). They delight in each other’s company, they enjoy favorite shared activities, and they provide each other with companionship and emotional support. In early childhood, friendships also have these qualities, but by this age children are more capable than toddlers of understanding and describing what a friendship entails. They regard a friend as someone you like and who likes you, and as someone who plays with you and shares toys with you (Hartup & Abecassis, 2004). By age 5 or 6, they also understand that friendship is characterized by mutual trust and support, and that a friend is someone you can rely on over time (Hay et al., 2004; Park et al., 1993). Before proceeding further, it is important to distinguish between friends and peers. Friends, as you know, are people with whom you develop a valued, mutual relationship.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

only child child who has no siblings

6.21

270

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

peers persons who share some aspect of their status in common, such as age

Watch the Video Play Styles at MyDevelopmentLab

In most cultures, the proportion of samegender play rises during early childhood. Here, young girls in India play a clapping game together.

Peers are persons who share some aspect of their status in common, such as age. So, in social science research on human development, a child’s peers are the same-age children who are part of the daily environment, such as the other children in the child’s class at school. Some of those children may become the child’s friends, others may not; a child’s friends are usually peers, but not all peers become friends. Across cultures, relations with both peers and friends tend to become more strictly segregated by gender in the course of early childhood. Boys tend to have other boys as their peers and friends, and the social world of girls is populated mostly by other females. However, cultures differ substantially in the mix of ages in peer groups. A striking difference in early childhood peer relations between traditional cultures and Western cultures is that in the West, mixed-age peer play groups are relatively rare. By age 3 or 4, most children are in some kind of preschool setting for at least part of their typical week, and preschool is the main context for their peer interactions. In contrast, children in traditional cultures often play in mixed-age groups that may include children in toddlerhood, early childhood, and middle childhood (LeVine et al., 2008). Two of the most researched topics concerning peers and friends in early childhood are play and aggression. PLAY IN EARLY CHILDHOOD As mentioned in Chapter 5, in toddlerhood and early childhood there are several distinct types of play, including solitary play, parallel play, simple social play, and cooperative pretend play. From toddlerhood through early childhood, solitary play and parallel play decline somewhat while simple social play and cooperative pretend play increase (Hughes & Dunn, 2007). Cooperative pretend play becomes more complex in the course of early childhood, as children’s imaginations bloom and they become more creative and adept at using symbols, for example using a stick to represent a sword and a blanket over two chairs to represent a castle (Dyer & Moneta, 2006). However, even at age 5 or 6 most children display a variety of types of play, engaging in cooperative play for awhile and then making a transition to solitary play or parallel play (Robinson et al., 2003). In the course of early childhood, children become more sex-segregated in their play. In the 12-cultures study by Whiting and Edwards (1988), across cultures children played in same-sex groups 30–40% of the time at ages 2–3, rising to over 90% of the time by age 11. American studies report similar results (Fabes et al., 2003). In one observational study, the percent of time playing in same-sex groups was 45% for 4-year-old children and 73% for 6-year-old children (Martin & Fabes, 2001). Furthermore, numerous studies have found that boys generally engage in high-activity, aggressive, competitive “rough and tumble” play in their groups, whereas girls’ play tends to be quieter, more cooperative, and more likely to involve fantasy and role play (Ruble et al., 2006). Children vary in their levels of sociability from infancy onward, and by early childhood there are distinct differences among children in how successful they are in using the social skills required for play in a group setting. Preschool social life rewards the bold, and children who are temperamentally inhibited spend a lot of their preschool time watching others play without taking part themselves (Coplan et al., 2004; Rubin et al., 2002). However, for some children it simply takes time to become accustomed to the preschool social environment. The more preschool experience children have, the more successful they are at taking part in social play (Dyer & Moneta, 2006). Sometimes children observe other children’s play as a prelude to entering the play themselves (Lindsey & Colwell, 2003). Also, some children simply enjoy playing by themselves. They may spend more time than others in solitary play, but it could be an indication of an unusually lively and creative imagination rather than a

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

271

70

60

Lessons Work Play Conversation

Time spent (%)

50

40

30

20

10

0 European Americans

African Americans

Kenyans

Brazilians

Figure 6.6 s Play in Four Cultures Across cultures, play is the most common activity in early childhood. Source: Based on Tudge et al. (2006)

sign of being withdrawn or rejected (Coplan et al., 2004). There are also cultural differences in how shyness in early childhood is regarded by peers, as you will see in the Cultural Focus: Shyness in China and Canada feature on page 273. Play in early childhood is widespread across cultures, especially in the first years of this life stage. Figure 6.6 shows the results of a study comparing four cultural groups, and in all four groups the 3-year-old children spent more time in play than in any other activity (Tudge et al., 2006). However, anthropologists have observed some cultures where play is rare even in early childhood, such as the Maya of Guatemala (Gaskins, 2000). In general, the more work parents have to do, the earlier they involve children in work and the less time children have for play (Rogoff, 2003). Nevertheless, in general, children in traditional cultures have some time for play. Often their play is structured and directed by the older children in the mixed-age peer group. Outside of the West, it is rare for children to play with adults (LeVine et al., 2008). Sometimes children’s play involves imitation of adult activity, such as going to the market (Rogoff, 2003; Roopnarine et al., 1994). Other times, play is purely for fun. For example, in India, young girls play a game that involves clapping hands in time to a song. They clap against each other’s hands in a complex pattern as they sing, going faster and faster as the song proceeds. The song goes through 11 verses that describe a girl’s likely course through life at each age, ending with turning into a spirit. In early childhood, girls learn first by observing and listening as the older girls play, then by gradually taking part in the clapping song themselves. AGGRESSION Early childhood is an important time for the development of aggression. As young children move more into the world of peers, they encounter more competition for resources—toys, play companions, adult attention, the last cookie—and this competition sometimes leads to conflict and aggression (Tremblay, 2002). Scholars distinguish between several different types of aggression (Underwood, 2003). Instrumental aggression is involved when a child wants something (toys, food, attention) and uses aggressive behavior or words to get it. A child may also exhibit signs of anger and intend to inflict pain or harm on others. This is known as hostile aggression. Instrumental

Physical aggression peaks in early childhood.

Simulate the Experiment Aggression and Prosocial Behavior at MyDevelopmentLab instrumental aggression type of aggression when a child wants something and uses aggressive behavior or words to get it hostile aggression type of aggression that entails signs of anger and intent to inflict pain or harm on others

272

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

Watch the Video Relational Aggression at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse Do you think the 1-2-3 approach to discipline would be likely to work with a young child who has a problem with physical aggression? If not, what approach would you recommend to a parent with an aggressive child?

relational aggression type of aggression that involves damaging another person’s reputation among peers through social exclusion and malicious gossip

and hostile aggression can each be expressed in several ways. Physical aggression includes hitting, kicking, pushing, or striking with an object. Verbal aggression is the use of words to hurt others, through yelling at them, calling them names, or hostile teasing. Relational aggression (or social aggression) involves damaging another person’s reputation among peers through social exclusion and malicious gossip. Physical aggression among young children has been a target of a great deal of research. There is abundant evidence that physical aggression peaks in toddlerhood and early childhood (Alink et al., 2006). One top aggression researcher, Richard Tremblay (2004), summarized a wide range of longitudinal studies extending from infancy to adulthood across many countries and found a common pattern that physical aggression peaks at 24 to 42 months—the second year of toddlerhood and the first year of early childhood— then declines. Boys are consistently more physically aggressive than girls, in early childhood and throughout the life span. However, there is a great deal of variation around this average pattern. Not all boys are aggressive in early childhood, and not all boys and girls show a decline in aggression after age 3. One national study in the United States followed the course of physical aggression in a longitudinal study of children from age 2 to 9 (NICHD Early Childhood Research Network, 2004). The researchers identified five different “trajectory groups” with regard to aggression. The largest group declined steeply in physical aggression from age 2 to 9. However, two other groups were “low trajectory” groups that never showed much physical aggression, one was a “moderate trajectory” group that remained moderate, and one was a “high trajectory” group that remained high. In general, individual differences in physical aggression remain stable across time, that is, children who rarely display physical aggression in early childhood are unlikely to display it in middle childhood and adolescence, and children who are especially aggressive in early childhood tend to be more aggressive than their peers in later periods as well (Brame et al., 2001; Lansford et al., 2006; Schaeffer et al., 2003; Vaillancourt et al., 2003). However, longitudinal studies show that parents who are especially patient, sensitive, and involved can reduce high aggression in early childhood to moderate aggression by middle childhood (NICHD Early Childhood Research Network, 2004; Tremblay, 2002). Early childhood is a crucial time for addressing physical aggression, because when aggression is still high at the end of early childhood it is a strong predictor of later aggressive behavior in adolescence and adulthood (Loeber et al., 2005; Tremblay & Nagin, 2005). Across cultures, aggression is frequently a component of children’s play in early and middle childhood, especially for boys (Edwards, 2005). Physical “rough-and-tumble” play such as wrestling is common among boys of the same age when they are brought together in school and playground settings (Scott & Panksepp, 2003). This aggressive play occurs in other mammals as well, and is in part a way of establishing a dominance hierarchy (Hassett et al., 2008). Aggressive play establishes who is on top and who is not, and in this way serves to avoid more serious aggression. In contrast to physical aggression, verbal aggression rises across early childhood, at least in the Western countries where this research has been done (Dodge et al., 2006; Underwood, 2003). As children become more adept at using words, they grow capable of applying their verbal abilities to a wide range of purposes, including aggression. Also, verbal aggression becomes substituted for physical aggression across the years of early childhood as children learn that adults regard physical aggression toward peers as unacceptable and as children become more capable of restraining their physically aggressive impulses (Tremblay, 2000, 2004; Tremblay & Nagin, 2005). Relational aggression also becomes more common in the course of early childhood (Crick et al., 2006). Like the increase in verbal aggression, the increase in relational aggression reflects children’s growing cognitive and social understanding. They become more capable of understanding the complexities of social relationships, and more aware of the

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

273

ways that social weapons can be used to hurt others and gain social status. They learn that a punch on the shoulder does not hurt nearly as much, or last nearly as long, as the pain of being the only one not invited to a birthday party or being the subject of a nasty rumor (Murray-Close et al., 2007; Nelson et al., 2005). Verbal and relational aggression are slightly more common among girls than among boys in early childhood, but the differences are minor, much smaller than the gap between boys and girls in physical aggression (Underwood, 2003).

CULTURAL FOCUS

I

Shyness in China and Canada

children were more often supportive and n studies of young children in the West, shyness has long been RRUSSIA USSIA KAZAKHSTAN cooperative. associated with negative characteristics such as anxiety, insecuNORTH MONGOLIA However, Chen and his colleagues rity, and social incompetence (Rubin & Coplan, 2010). ConsisKOREA have been conducting research in tently, shy children have been found to experience problems in their CHINA China for over 20 years now, and relations with peers and to be prone to negative self-perceptions INDIA they have recorded striking shifts in and depression (Rubin et al.,1995). Shyness in young children has MYANMAR (BURMA) VIETNAM the social implications of shyness for been viewed by Western researchers as a problem to be cured. LAOS young Chinese children over that time. But what about in other cultural contexts? Xinyin Chen, a deThe past 20 years have been a period of velopmental psychologist who grew up in China and now lives in dramatic social change in China, as the Canada, hypothesized that shyness would have a different meanGreenland country has moved rapidly from a stateing in the Chinese cultural context, and set out to compare the (DEN.) controlled Communist economy to a consequences of shyness among Chinese and Canadian children Alaska CANADA (U.S.) free-market economy. This transition (Chen et al., 2006). has resulted in changes in values as In one study conducted by Chen and his colleagues, 4-yearUNITED STATES well, with a decline in the traditional old children in China and Canada were invited into a laboratory Chinese collectivistic values of duty, setting in groups of four and observed in two 15-minute free-play respect, and obligation, and a rise in interactions. Shy children were identified as those who spent the individualistic values of self-assertion and most time in onlooker behavior (watching the activities of othindependence. ers) or unoccupied behavior (wandering around the room alone The change in values has been reflected in Chen’s research or sitting alone doing nothing). Through this process, 50 of 200 on peers’ responses to shy Chinese children and 45 of 180 Chinese children. In the 1990 Canadian children were classisample Chen studied, shyness fied as shy. was positively associated with Although the proportion a variety of favorable aspects of shy children to non-shy chilof adjustment, including peer dren was identical in the two acceptance, leadership, and countries, the responses shy academic achievement. Howchildren received from their ever, by the time Chen repeers was very different. When peated the study in 2002, the shy Canadian children made correlation had flipped. Now attempts to interact with their shyness was associated with peers, the peers often reacted negative adjustment, including negatively (e.g., “No!” or “I peer rejection and depression. won’t do it”) and rarely reacted In just a 12-year period, the positively with encouragement cultural meaning of shyness and support. In contrast, peers had reversed. As Chen obof shy children in China re- Shyness has had different social meanings in China than it does in served, “the extensive change sponded much more positively Western countries, at least until recently. toward the capitalistic system when shy children initiated in the economic reform and the introduction of Western ideolocontact, often inviting them to play or allowing them to join a gies may have led to the decline in the adaptive value of shyness” game. Overall, peers in Canada tended to be antagonistic or non(Chen et al., 2006, p. 139). responsive toward shy children, whereas in China, peers of shy

274

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood

Media Use in Early Childhood

6.22

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Identify the rates and consequences of media use in early childhood. Early childhood is a period when children’s media world expands greatly, especially in developed countries. Many types of media use increase from toddlerhood to early childhood (Lemish, 2007). The major types of media use in early childhood are television, electronic games, and recorded music.

Simulate the Experiment Media Violence at MyDevelopmentLab

THE NEGATIVE IMPACTS OF TELEVISION USE: VIOLENCE AND ADVERTISING Television is popular with people all over the world, including young children. In early childhood, TV-viewing time per day varies from about 1½ hours in Sweden and Germany to about 3 hours in Hungary, Turkey, and the United States (Hasebrink, 2007a). In the United States, over 30% of children ages 2–7 have a TV set in their bedroom (Scheibe, 2007). African Americans are especially high in TV consumption, with rates of over 4 hours a day in childhood compared to about 3 hours a day in other American ethnic groups (Roberts & Foehr, 2004). The most popular shows among young children are the ones made especially for them, such as cartoons and educational shows like Sesame Street (Lemish, 2007). Although television is embraced everywhere for its entertainment value, many people have concerns about the effects of television, especially on children and especially with respect to violence. Content analyses have found that children’s programs are even more violent than programs for adults. One study found that two-thirds of all children’s programs contained violence, and about half the violence took place in cartoons (Aikat, 2007). Violence was portrayed as funny about two-thirds of the time, and in most cases the victims were not shown experiencing pain and the perpetrator of the violence was not punished. What are the effects of witnessing so much TV violence on young children’s development? More than 5 decades of research, including more than 300 studies using a variety of methods, has led to a strong consensus among scholars that watching TV violence increases children’s aggression (Bushman & Chandler, 2007). The more aggressive children are, the more they like to watch TV violence, but TV violence inspires aggressive thoughts and behavior even in children who are not usually aggressive (Bushman & Huesmann, 2001). Experimental studies indicate that causation is involved, not just correlation. For example, in one early study, children in a preschool were randomly assigned to two groups (Steur et al., 1971). Over 11 days, one group watched violent cartoons, whereas the other group saw the same cartoons but with the violence removed. During playground observations following this 11-day experiment, children who had seen the violent cartoons were more likely than children in the nonviolent cartoon group to kick and hit their peers. Young children ages 3–6 are believed to be especially vulnerable to the effects of TV violence (Bushman & Chandler, 2003). They are more likely than younger or older children to model their behavior after the behavior of others, including TV characters. Also, they are less likely than older children to have a clear understanding of the boundary between fantasy and reality, and so more likely to believe that what they witness on TV is real. Another important effect of TV watching in early childhood concerns advertising. In the United States, the average child sees about 40,000 TV commercials each year, mostly for toys, cereal, candy, and fast food (Scheibe, 2007). Young children are especially susceptible to advertising, as they are less aware of advertising intent than older children are. Most do not perceive a distinction between a program and an advertisement until about age 5 (Jennings, 2007). The more TV young children watch, the more they attempt to influence their parents to buy the advertised products (Valkenburg & Buijzen, 2007). Because most

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

275

of the products children see advertised are unhealthy foods, concern has grown that TV advertising is one influence behind the growing international epidemic of obesity in children (Bergstrom, 2007a). THE BENEFICIAL EFFECTS OF EDUCATIONAL TELEVISION TV has also been found to have some beneficial effects on young children. In recent decades, educational programs have been developed that are highly popular among young children. Perhaps most notable is the Sesame Street program, which is broadcast in 120 countries worldwide (Truglio, 2007). The content of the program is based on knowledge from developmental psychology of what will be most appealing to young children and most effective at teaching them the academic skills that will prepare them for school (Bergstrom, 2007b). Content is adapted to the culture in which the program is shown, for example addressing the stigma of AIDS in South Africa and promoting cross-cultural respect and understanding among children in the Middle East (Truglio, 2007). Sesame Street and other programs have shown impressive positive effects on young children’s development. In one study, viewing Sesame Street at ages 2 and 3 predicted higher scores at age 5 on tests of language development and math skills, even controlling for parents’ education and income (Scantlin, 2007). In another study, children who viewed Sesame Street at age 5 were recontacted at ages 15 and 19 and were found to have higher grades in English, math, and science than children in the comparison group (Anderson et al., 2001). Studies of Sesame Street and other educational programs have shown the programs to have other positive effects as well, such as promoting imaginative play (Scantlin, 2007) and prosocial behavior such as cooperation (Bergstrom, 2007b). ELECTRONIC GAMES AND MUSIC Although the focus of most media research concerning young children has been on television, other media are also important in their lives, notably electronic games and recorded music. Television is now nearly universal, but playing electronic games usually depends on access to a computer, and computer access is much more variable across countries. In one international study, over 60% of households in developed countries reported having a computer, but this percentage was much lower in other regions, including eastern Europe (25%), Latin America (about 10%), and Africa (about 5%) (Hasebrink, 2007b). In U.S. studies, 70% of 4- to 6-year-olds have used a computer, and 38% of 5- to 7-year olds use a computer on a typical day, mostly for playing electronic games (Foehr, 2007). Boys play electronic games more than girls do, overall, and the kinds of games they prefer differ, with boys preferring fighting and sports games and girls preferring adventure and learning games (Kubisch, 2007). These gender differences endure through childhood and adolescence, as we will see in later chapters. Electronic games can also be played on handheld devices and mobile phones, but access to these media tends to come in middle childhood and beyond. Listening to recorded music is also part of the daily media diet of most children in developed countries (Kinnally, 2007). Over half of parents of young children report singing to or playing music for them each day. On average, children ages 2–7 listen to music for about 45 minutes per day. Children ages 3–5 listen mostly to children’s songs, but by age 6 children pay more attention to popular music and start to recognize and prefer the latest “hit songs” of the day. Music evokes a positive response even from infants, but early childhood is an especially important time for the development of responses to music (Kinnally, 2007). It is during early childhood that children first connect musical sounds with specific emotions, for example recognizing songs in major keys as happy and songs in minor keys as sad. By age 5, children show distinct preferences for music that is harmonious rather than dissonant and has a steady rather than erratic beat. There is little research

Listening to recorded music is a common part of children’s lives in developed countries.

276

C h ap ter 6

Early Childhood on the effects of music on young children. Research on music effects is concentrated on adolescence because of concerns about the effects of violent music on adolescent development, as we will see later in the book.

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. Across cultures, what is the predominant emotional response to the birth of a new sibling? 2. How do “only children” compare to children with siblings in terms of their self-esteem, intelligence, and social relations with peers? 3. How are friends different from peers? 4. How does play in traditional cultures differ from play in Western cultures during early childhood? 5. Give an example of relational aggression. 6. What gender differences exist in electronic game use during childhood? 7. Why is early childhood an especially important time for the development of responses to music?

Section 3 VIDEO GUIDE Mandatory Reporting (Length: 3:39) This video explains the concept of mandatory reporting and includes interviews with both a doctor and a child care worker.

1. Why is mandatory reporting so important? 2. The narrator of this video lists several occupations who are held to legal standards for mandatory reporting. Do you feel that any occupation is missing from the list? Why or why not? 3. If you were in an occupation that held you to legal mandatory reporting and you were faced with a child that you felt might be being psychologically abused, what are some ways you might try to inquire about the abuse?

Watch the Video Mandatory Reporting at MyDevelopmentLab

Summing Up Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab Listen at MyDevelopmentLab

Listen to an audio file of your chapter at MyDevelopmentLab

SECTION 1 PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT 6.1 Describe the physical growth and change that takes place during early childhood. The pace of physical development slows in early childhood. From ages 3 to 6 the typical American child grows 2–3 inches per year and adds 5–7 pounds. Average heights and weights in early childhood are considerably lower in developing countries, due to inadequate nutrition and higher likelihood of childhood diseases.

6.2 Describe the changes in brain development that take place during early childhood and the aspects of brain development that explain “infantile” amnesia. The most notable changes in brain development during early childhood take place in the connections between neurons and in myelination. Most people experience infantile amnesia (the inability to remember anything prior to age 2) and have limited memory for personal events that happened before age 5.

6.3 Identify the main nutritional deficiencies and the primary sources of injury, illness, and mortality during early childhood in developed and developing countries. About 80% of children in developing countries experience nutritional deficiencies, but a surprisingly high percentage of children in developed countries experience them as well. Calcium is the most common nutritional deficiency in the United States, whereas the two most common types of malnutrition in developing countries are lack of protein and lack of iron. Mortality

rates in early childhood are much higher in developing countries than in developed countries but have declined substantially in recent years. In developed countries, the most common cause of injury and death by far in early childhood is motor vehicle accidents.

6.4 Describe changes in gross and fine motor abilities during early childhood, and explain how these changes may have a cultural basis. From age 3 to 6, young children learn to: make more hops in a row and hop on one foot; jump farther from a standing position and to make a running jump; climb stairs without support, alternating their feet; throw a ball farther and more accurately; become better at catching a ball; and increase their running speed and their ability to stop suddenly or change direction. In their fine motor development, children learn to pick up small objects more quickly and precisely, to draw something that is recognizable to others, to write their first letters and some short words, to put on and remove their clothes, to use scissors, and to use a knife to cut soft food. Gross and fine motor skills are culturally specific and depend on what types of activities children are exposed to.

6.5 Describe the development of handedness and identify the consequences and cultural views of left-handedness. About 10% of children are left-handed. Being lefthanded has been stigmatized in many cultures, perhaps due to its association with higher risk of developmental problems.

KEY TERMS corpus callosum p. 232

reticular formation p. 232

infantile amnesia p. 233

cerebellum p. 232

hippocampus p. 233

anemia p. 234

handedness p. 237

SECTION 2 COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT 6.6 Explain the features of Piaget’s preoperational stage of cognitive development. Piaget viewed the preoperational stage of cognitive development (ages 2–7) as prone to a variety of errors, including centration, lack of reversibility, egocentrism, and animism. Research has shown that Piaget underestimated the cognitive abilities of early childhood.

6.7 Explain what “theory of mind” is and the evidence for how it develops during early childhood. Theory of mind is the ability to understand thinking processes in one’s self and others. By age 2, as they begin to use language more, children show increasing recognition that others have thoughts and emotions that can be contrasted with their own. By age 3, children know it is possible for them and others to

277

278

C h ap ter 6

S U M M A RY

imagine something that is not physically present, an understanding that becomes the basis of pretend play for many years to come. While 3-year-olds are better than 2-year-olds at understanding that others have thoughts and feelings that are different from their own, they still find it difficult to take others’ perspectives. Perspectivetaking ability advances considerably from age 3 to 6.

6.8 Identify the ways that cultural learning takes place in early childhood. A great deal of cultural learning takes place in early childhood through observing and working alongside parents or siblings, and in many cultures children make important work contributions to the family during this stage.

6.9 Identify the features that are most important in preschool quality. Children generally benefit cognitively from attending preschool, but the social effects of preschool are more mixed and in some ways negative. Key features of high-quality preschool programs include education and training of teachers, class size and child–teacher ratio, age-appropriate materials and activities, and teacher– child interactions.

6.10 Describe the distinctive practices of Japanese preschools and how they reflect cultural values.

Preschools in Japan focus not on academic objectives but rather on group play, so that collectivist Japanese values, such as cooperation and sharing, are reinforced.

6.11 Describe early intervention programs and their outcomes. Early intervention programs have often resulted in a rise in IQ that fades after a few years. Some early interventions via preschool have had long-term positive effects on children’s development, but the effects depend greatly on the quality of the program.

6.12 Explain how advances in vocabulary and grammar occur in early childhood. Children’s vocabularies expand immensely in early childhood, from about 1,000 words at age 3 to about 2,500 words at age 6, and they readily grasp the grammatical rules of their culture with few errors by age 4.

6.13 Describe how children learn pragmatics in early childhood, and identify to what extent these social rules are culturally based. Pragmatics guide us in knowing what to say—and what not to say—in a given social situation, and by age 4, children are sensitive to the characteristics of their conversational partner and will adjust their speech accordingly All cultures have their own rules for what kinds of speech can be used in what kinds of situations.

KEY TERMS preoperational stage p. 240

egocentrism p. 242

intuitive thought substage p. 243

grammar p. 251

conservation p. 241

animism p. 242

theory of mind p. 243

pragmatics p. 251

centration p. 241

classification p. 242

early intervention program p. 248

reversibility p. 242

symbolic function substage p. 242

sensitive period p. 250

SECTION 3 EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT 6.14 Identify advances in emotional understanding and self-regulation during early childhood. Early childhood is a key time for the development of emotional self-regulation, as children improve at effortful control.

6.15 Describe moral development in early childhood, including empathy, modeling, and morality as cultural learning. The capacity for empathy increases in early childhood, which leads in turn to an increase in prosocial behavior. Children learn morality in part through modeling, i.e., observing the behavior of others and its consequences. Early childhood is also a time when children begin to show a capacity for moral reasoning.

6.16 Describe the roles that parents and peers play in gender socialization, and explain how gender schemas lead to self-socialization. Children learn gender identity by age 2, but do not learn gender constancy until age 6 or 7. During early childhood they often become rigid in their views of gender roles. Parents are key agents of gender socialization, especially fathers, and conformity to gender roles is enforced by peers as well. Once young children possess gender schemas, they seek to maintain consistency between their schemas and their behavior, a process called self-socialization.

Chapt er 6

6.17 Describe the four types of parenting “styles” and the outcomes associated with each, and explain why those outcomes are complex. American parenting research has emphasized the dimensions of demandingness and responsiveness, in combinations resulting in four categories of “parenting styles”: authoritative, authoritarian, permissive, and disengaged. By American standards, authoritative parenting is associated with the most favorable outcomes. However, the relationship between parenting styles and children’s development is complex due to reciprocal effects between parents and children.

6.18 Describe the major cultural variations in approaches to parenting. The effects of parenting on young children depend substantially on cultural context. The authoritative parenting style is very rare in non-Western cultures because parents expect that their authority will be obeyed without question and without requiring an explanation.

6.19 Describe the main cultural variations in how parents discipline young children, and explain how cultural context influences children’s responses to discipline. In Western cultures the approach to discipline in early childhood tends to emphasize the authoritative approach of explaining the consequences of misbehavior and the reasons for discipline. Physical punishment and the close interdependent amae mother–child relationship have quite different effects on children depending on the cultural context.

SUMMARY

6.20 Identify the most common features of sibling relationships worldwide, and describe how children with no siblings differ from other children. Jealousy toward young siblings is very common worldwide in early childhood. “Only children” fare very well compared to children with siblings, even in China where there has been concern about the social effects of the government’s “one-child” population policy.

6.21 Explain how the quality of friendships changes from toddlerhood to early childhood, and describe the role of play and aggression in young children’s friendships. Children engage in cooperative pretend play more in early childhood than in toddlerhood. Physical aggression peaks in toddlerhood and the first year of early childhood, then declines as verbal aggression rises.

6.22 Identify the rates and consequences of media use in early childhood. In early childhood, TV-viewing time per day varies from about 1½–3 hours across developed countries. Abundant evidence shows that violent television promotes aggressive behavior in young children. Boys most often play electronic games involving fighting and sports, whereas girls prefer adventure and learning games. Early childhood is an especially important time for the development of responses to music, as children learn to connect musical sounds with specific emotions.

KEY TERMS emotional self-regulation p. 254

gender schema p. 257

disengaged parents p. 260

child maltreatment p. 265

undercontrol p. 254

self-socialization p. 258

foster care p. 266

externalizing problems p. 254

parenting styles p. 259

reciprocal or bidirectional effects p. 261

overcontrol p. 254

demandingness p. 259

filial piety p. 261

peers p. 270

internalizing problems p. 254

responsiveness p. 259

familismo p. 262

instrumental aggression p. 271

initiative vs. guilt p. 254

authoritative parents p. 259

time out p. 263

hostile aggression p. 271

gender constancy p. 257

authoritarian parents p. 260

psychological control p. 263

relational aggression p. 272

gender roles p. 257

permissive parents p. 260

corporal punishment p. 264

only child p. 269

Practice Test Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab 1. Which of the following best describes the physical changes that take place during early childhood? a. Most children lose their baby fat and become more like adults in terms of their body proportions. b. Physical development occurs at a more rapid pace than it did in the first 3 years. c. Girls are slightly taller and heavier than boys. d. Cross-cultural comparisons have shown that only genetics plays a role in individual differences in height and weight.

279

2. The limited memory for personal events and experiences prior to age 5 is probably due to incomplete myelination of the a. reticular formation. b. corpus callosum. c. cerebellum. d. hippocampus.

280

C h ap ter 6

S U M M A RY

3. Which of the following is the most common nutritional problem among young children in the United States? a. marasmus b. anemia c. calcium deficiency d. protein deficiency 4. How does motor development change between ages 3–6? a. Children’s fine motor skills become refined, but their gross motor skills remain the same as they were in toddlerhood. b. Children’s fine motor skills have been found to develop at the same rate all over the world. c. Children develop the same motor skills at the same pace, regardless of gender. d. Fine motor skill development allows children to become more independent by doing things such as dressing and feeding themselves. 5. Children who are left-handed a. will be more likely to learn to be right-handed in an Asian or African culture than in the United States. b. likely first developed this tendency during the preschool years. c. are often praised for their uniqueness in non-Western cultures. d. will always have a left-handed twin if they are monozygotic (MZ) twins. 6. A 5-year-old child draws a yellow sun in the upper corner of her paper complete with a smiley face and sunglasses. This is an example of a. sensorimotor thought. b. animism. c. gross motor skill refinement. d. centered thinking. 7. Which of the following is true regarding theory of mind? a. Children show a decrease in this ability from 4 to 6 years of age because they are becoming more independent. b. It develops the same way in all cultures with spoken language. c. It begins to develop, in rudimentary form, some time in infancy. d. A child who demonstrates theory of mind is not yet able to think about thinking. 8. Cultural learning skills, such as learning to set the table in a developed country or to help prepare food in a traditional culture, a. develop as part of a social and cultural process, according to Vygotsky. b. must be learned in the sensorimotor stage first or they never fully develop. c. cannot be appropriately acquired until early adolescence. d. usually develop best if they take place in a formal setting.

9. As a parent of a 3-year-old you have visited several preschool programs to determine the one that will provide the highest quality experience. Which of the following should NOT be heavily weighted in your decision about which preschool to pick? a. whether there is a small class size b. whether the teachers have been formally trained and have educational credentials c. whether they are making good use of time by providing worksheets to practice numbers and letters d. whether the teachers spend a lot of time interacting with the children rather than with each other 10. In Japan a. learning academic skills is the number one goal of having children attend preschool. b. preschool is mainly a time for learning social skills. c. parents and preschool teachers list the same top reasons for young children to attend preschool as do their counterparts in the United States. d. individuality is stressed from the time children enter preschool as a way to encourage children to reach their full potential. 11. Compared to a comparison group of children with low SES who did not attend Head Start, those children who did a. were less likely to be placed in special education classes. b. improved their academic performance, but were still more likely to repeat at least two grades. c. showed a boost in IQ and achievement that lasted throughout their school years. d. showed no differences in academic performance and success. 12. Young children’s use of grammar a. is entirely dependant on formal instruction in preschool. b. develops more quickly in traditional cultures. c. develops simply by hearing and using the language in daily interactions. d. is mostly incorrect until the age of 6. 13. When a 4-year-old uses infant-directed speech when talking to her neighbor’s new baby, this demonstrates a. a sensitive period. b. fast mapping. c. classification. d. pragmatics. 14. A key reason why emotional outbursts decline in early childhood is that children a. learn strategies for regulating their emotions, in a practice known as effortful control. b. have a more sophisticated theory of mind at this age. c. at this age are no longer at risk for externalizing problems. d. have learned the skill of overcontrolling their emotions.

Chapt er 6 15. Which of the following statements accurately describes moral development in early childhood? a. Children at this age are not yet able to experience empathy. b. Socioemotional emotions such as shame and pride first appear. c. Perspective taking and being able to understand how others think and feel make children more empathic at this age. d. Young children inherently know the rules and expectations of their culture without needing to be taught. 16. The way we organize and process information in terms of gender-based categories is referred to as a. gender identity. b. gender constancy. c. self-socialization. d. gender schemas. 17. Research on parenting has found that a. the two main dimensions of parenting are demandingness and strictness. b. children of permissive parents tend to do better in school than children of other parenting styles because they learn to think for themselves. c. there are bidirectional effects between parents and their children. d. the outcomes for children of authoritative parents are virtually identical to outcomes for children of permissive parents. 18. Which of the following is the most accurate statement based on existing research? a. The typical parenting style in non-Western cultures is authoritarian. b. The American model of parenting does not apply well in other cultures. c. Providing explanations to their children is most common among non-Western parents who spend more time with their children than do American parents. d. Permissive parenting would be most likely in cultures that have a tradition of filial piety.

SUMMARY

281

19. The use of shame as a form of discipline a. has resulted in positive outcomes in both the United States and Finland. b. is referred to as psychological control by American researchers. c. is associated with high rates of behavior problems in Japanese children. d. is universally accepted as the best method of discipline because it does not include physical punishment. 20. Which of the following is true regarding siblings? a. A gap of 4–8 years between children is common in many cultures across the world. b. “Only children” are maladjusted, meaning they are more prone to depression behavior disorders. c. Jealousy is a common response to the birth of a younger sibling across cultures. d. Research has shown that young children with older siblings have a more advanced theory of mind than those who are only children. 21. If you were a researcher observing 5-year-old children on a playground during kindergarten recess in the United States, what would you be most likely to observe? a. boys playing with children from other kindergarten classes rather than older boys b. girls playing kickball with the boys (with the girls serving as referees to be sure the boys follow the rules) c. boys engaging in cooperative, fantasy play d. the boys challenging the girls to a wrestling match 22. Watching TV during young childhood a. has not been associated with any positive effects on development. b. is a popular leisure activity all over the world. c. has been correlated with aggressive thoughts and behaviors, but only among males who were already extremely aggressive before viewing. d. has not been studied experimentally, therefore no conclusions about causation can be made.

7 282

Middle Childhood

Section 1 PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT Growth in Middle Childhood Physical Growth and Sensory Development Nutrition and Malnutrition Illness and Injuries

Motor Development Gross Motor Development Fine Motor Development

Section 2 COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT Theories of Cognitive Development Concrete Operations Information Processing Intelligence and Intelligence Tests Learning the Cognitive Skills of School: Reading and Mathematics

Language Development Vocabulary, Grammar, and Pragmatics Bilingualism

Section 3 EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT Emotional and Self-Development Smooth Sailing: Advances in Emotional Self-Regulation Self-Understanding Gender Development

The Social and Cultural Contexts of Middle Childhood Family Relations Friends and Peers School Experiences Work Media Use

Summing Up

283

EVER SINCE MY TWINS, PARIS AND MILES, WERE BORN 11 YEARS AGO, I’VE KEPT A JOURNAL OF THE NOTABLE EVENTS IN THEIR DEVELOPMENT. To open this chapter on middle childhood, the life stage they have recently passed through, I present some scenes from their years ages 6 through 9.

the cost of a new microwave, breakfast and lunch out that day, and the increased heating bill from having to leave the kitchen windows open in February, it cost us about $200 for them to make us breakfast. Age 7 Paris is awfully excited over the gift of a stuffed “webkinz” cat she

Age 6

received for Christmas from a friend. A substantial amount of her con-

Actual conversation:

sciousness since then has been devoted to that cat, whom she named

Miles: Daddy, I have something important to ask you.

“Flower.” With a “webkinz” pet, you get the stuffed animal as well

Me: What is it?

as a virtual version of it at a website on the Internet. With the virtual

Miles: How many people are there in the world?

version, you can decorate its room and buy it various toys (Flower es-

Me: About 7 billion.

pecially enjoys the trampoline) with “kinz cash” that you earn from

Miles: (long pause) I can only count to 300.

playing various games on the site. Both Miles and Paris love playing

They have been very keen lately on doing more things for themselves and for us, and one Saturday morning they announced that they

the games so much that they would do it pretty much all day, every day, if we let them.

were going to make breakfast. They forbade us from going downstairs

Both twins had words of wisdom to share this month. Paris’s came

until they were done. We laid in bed listening as they scurried around

when we were walking home from school one day and she started talk-

the kitchen, talking excitedly, getting things ready. Suddenly Paris ran

ing about a scene in a book she read recently, when locusts suddenly

up the stairs, shouting, “Daddy, Mommy, the downstairs to find the microwave oven belching black smoke. Boy did it stink! We quickly opened up all the windows and whisked the microwave out the door into the backyard. The twins explained that they had been attempting to heat up rolls for breakfast in the



One Saturday morning the twins announced that they were going to make us breakfast...

microwave oven. A bad idea, and to make it



whole kitchen is filled with smoke!” We ran

swarm down from the sky and eat the crops the family has spent months carefully nurturing. I spoke gravely about how awful this was, all that hard work for naught, now what would they eat, etc. Then Paris observed, cheerfully, “Well, at least the locusts were happy!” Miles’s words of wisdom came one Sunday during brunch. We were listening to music and I went into the other room to change the CD,

worse, Miles set the timer for 3:56 for no particular reason. That is,

and during that process I banged my head hard on a shelf. Thinking

of course, closer to what it takes to cook a chicken than to heat up a

no one else could hear me, I began cursing colorfully and passionately.

small item, so the rolls he put in there were reduced to little clumps of

When I walked back into the dining room the twins were staring wide-

charcoal by the end of it, along with all the black smoke. Thankfully,

eyed, wondering about the meaning of all these new words. I apolo-

no real harm was done, except for a week of the kitchen stinking to

gized, explaining how I had hit my head and it REALLY hurt. “Next

high heaven and a ruined microwave oven. We figure that, between

time,” Miles advised, “just say ‘Ow!’”

284

This morning Miles crawled into bed with me and Lene, as he often does, and said with a sigh, “When I cuddle with you two, I feel like I own the whole world.” Age 8 Miles and Paris have now figured out that Santa Claus is actually me and Lene. I’ve heard of some kids bursting into tears at this revelation, but Miles and Paris were very matter-of-fact about it, even seeing it as humorous. “It’s really you and Mom, isn’t it Dad?” Paris asked me one day while we were driving somewhere, with a wry smile, as if she’d just figured out how an amusing magic trick was performed. Paris has become increasingly interested in doing solo baking projects. She’s always helped me make bread, since she was tiny, and now she’s decided that she wants to do her own baking. One day last week she made bread by herself, following a recipe in a kids’ cookbook my aunt gave to her. I offered to help, fearing an inedible result that would discourage her, but she insisted on doing it on her own, and it actually turned out to be quite good. Since then she’s made cookies and biscuits, with mixed results, but she’s learning and clearly very keen on doing more. Age 9 My, how they’re growing up. They are now in charge of setting the table and unloading the dishwasher, and Miles makes coffee every morning. We no longer have to take them to school or walk them home. They can handle the half-mile route on their own with no problem. There was another milestone on Halloween, when they went trick-or-treating separately for the first time, with friends instead of with us and each other. Miles went with a group of boys who are his friends from school. Paris invited a girl from her class over, and they went with Lene. Both brought home massive amounts of candy, far more than any sane person would eat in a year. Scenes from two children’s middle childhood, in one place and time, yet many of the themes resonate more broadly. Across cultures, the transition from early childhood to middle childhood is recognized as an important shift in children’s development, when they become capable of greater cognitive challenges and personal responsibility (Sameroff & Haith, 1996). In developing countries, middle childhood is often the age when children are first given important family duties, such as taking care of younger siblings, buying or selling goods, maintaining a fire, or caring for domestic animals (Weisner, 1996). According to Roy D’Andrade (1987), middle childhood is when children first show a grasp of cultural models, which are cognitive structures pertaining to common activities, for example buying something, herding cattle, taking care of an infant, making bread, or delivering a message to a relative’s house. Children in both developed and developing countries begin formal schooling in middle childhood, which includes cultural models of “listen to the teacher,” “wait your turn,” and “do your homework.” Children begin to grasp cultural models as early as toddlerhood, but during middle childhood their understanding of cultural models acquires greater complexity, so that they become capable of taking on a much broader range of tasks (Weisner, 1996). In these journal excerpts, notice how the twins’ practical skills improved from age 6 to age 9. Here as elsewhere in the human life span, how we experience a given stage of life depends greatly on cultural context. Children in all cultures become more capable of useful work in middle childhood, but the nature of their work varies greatly. For many children throughout human history it has been mainly farm work—tending the fields, herding the cows, and feeding the horses. For today’s children, it might be school work or household work in developed countries, and any of a wide range of work in developing countries, from household work to factory work to herding and feeding domestic animals. In this chapter we explore a wide range of cultural variations in children’s experiences of middle childhood.

cultural models cognitive structures pertaining to common cultural activities

285

286

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

SECTION 1 PHYSICAL DEVELOPMENT LEARNING OBJECTIVES 7.1 Identify the changes in physical and sensory development that take place during middle childhood. 7.2 Describe the negative effects of both malnutrition and obesity on development, and identify the causes of obesity. 7.3 Explain why rates of illness and injury are relatively low in middle childhood. 7.4 Explain how children’s gross motor skills develop in middle childhood and how these advancements are related to participation in games and sports. 7.5 Describe the new skills that demonstrate children’s advances in fine motor development in middle childhood.

Growth in Middle Childhood body mass index (BMI) measure of the ratio of weight to height

Middle childhood is an exceptionally healthy time of life, as children become less susceptible to disease, less vulnerable to the effects of malnutrition, and less likely to have accidents that result in injury or death. However, several types of physical problems become more common in middle childhood than they were in early childhood, including near-sightedness, obesity, and asthma.

Physical Growth and Sensory Development

7.1

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Identify the changes in physical and sensory development that take place during middle childhood.

Middle childhood is the time of life when people are most likely to be slim.

286

In middle childhood, physical growth continues at a slow but steady pace, about 2–3 inches (5–8 cm) per year in height and about 5–7 pounds (2½–3 kg) per year in weight. Boys continue to be slightly taller and to weigh slightly more than girls, on average. For both boys and girls, middle childhood is the time of life when they are mostly likely to be slim. Of all age groups in the life span, 6- to 10-yearolds have the lowest body mass index (BMI), a measure of the ratio of weight to height (Gillaume & Lissau, 2002). Boys continue to have somewhat more muscle than girls do in middle childhood, and girls continue to have somewhat more body fat, so the average boy is stronger than the average girl. However, both boys and girls grow stronger during this stage. For example, the average 10-year-old can throw a ball twice as far as the average 6-year-old. Children run faster and longer, too, over the course of middle childhood, as lung capacity expands (Malina et al., 2004). From age 6 to 12, children lose all 20 of their “primary teeth” and new, permanent teeth replace them. The two top front teeth are usually the first to go. The permanent teeth are adult-sized teeth that do not grow much once they come in, giving children in middle childhood a toothy smile that sometimes looks a little too big for their mouths. Sight and hearing both change in middle childhood, hearing usually for the better, sight more likely for the worse. Hearing often improves because the tube in the

Section 1 Physical Development

287

inner ear that is the site of ear infections in toddlerhood and early childhood has now matured and is longer and narrower than it was before (Bluestone, 2007). This structural change makes it less likely for fluid containing bacteria to flow from the mouth to the ear, which in turn makes inner ear infections less likely. With regard to sight, the incidence of myopia, also known as being nearsighted, rises sharply in middle childhood. This is a problem that is more likely to occur in developed countries than in developing countries. The more children read, write, and use computers, the more likely they are to develop myopia (Feldkamper & Schaeffel, 2003; Saw et al., 2002). Consequently, rates of myopia are highest in the developed countries where children are mostly likely to have access to books and computers. Myopia is also partly genetic, as MZ twins have a higher concordance rate (see Chapter 1) than DZ twins do (Pacella et al., 1999). About one-fourth of children in developed countries need glasses by the end of middle childhood (Mutti et al., 2002).

Nutrition and Malnutrition Describe the negative effects of both malnutrition and obesity on development, and identify the causes of obesity.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.2

By middle childhood, children have grown large enough that they are less vulnerable to the effects of malnutrition than they were earlier. Even if they are deprived of food for a period of time, their bodies have enough resources to weather the deprivation without the effects being as severe as in earlier life stages. Nevertheless, malnutrition can have enduring negative effects in middle childhood. Obesity also becomes a problem for many children in middle childhood, especially those in developed countries. MALNUTRITION As we have seen in previous chapters, malnutrition in early development often results in illness, disease, or death. In middle childhood, bodies are stronger and more resilient, and immune systems are better developed. Nevertheless, malnutrition has effects in middle childhood as well. Even for children who survive early malnutrition, the damage to their physical and cognitive development accumulates by middle childhood (Liu et al., 2003). One longitudinal study in Guatemala showed how nutrition in the early years contributes to cognitive and social functioning in middle childhood (Barrett & Frank, 1987). Children who were classified in early childhood as having “high nutrient levels” were more likely than children with “low nutrient levels” to explore new environments in middle childhood and to persist in a frustrating situation. They were also more energetic, less anxious, and showed more positive emotion. A more recent study, in Ghana, reported similar results, with children who experienced mild-to-moderate malnutrition in their early years demonstrating lower levels of cognitive development in middle childhood on standardized tests and in teacher ratings, compared to children who were not malnourished (Appoh & Krekling, 2004). The malnourished children were also more likely to be rated by teachers as anxious, sad, and withdrawn (Appoh, 2004). Other studies in other countries have found similar results, with better-nourished children scoring higher than malnourished children on a wide range of cognitive and social measures in middle childhood (Grigorenko, 2003; Wachs, 2002). However, there is a consensus that the sensitive period for long-term effects of malnutrition is from the second trimester of pregnancy through age 3 (Galler et al., 2005). Malnutrition that begins after this period does not appear to result in permanent cognitive or behavioral deficits. OBESITY Children in developed countries have a different kind of nutritional problem, not malnutrition but overnutrition. In other words, not too few calories but too many. Although middle childhood is the stage of life when the body tends to be slimmest, for many children in developed countries being overweight is a problem. Internationally, children ages

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Policy Maker In India, many children in middle childhood have trouble sitting still in class because they are anxious and jumpy. How might you institute a nutrition program to help these children do better in school?

myopia visual condition of being unable to see distant objects clearly; also known as being nearsighted

288

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

6–10 are considered to be overweight if their BMI exceeds 18 and obese if their BMI exceeds 21 (Cole et al., 2000). Across countries, rates of overweight and obesity are highest in the most affluent re gions (North America and Europe) and lowest in the poorest regions  (Africa and Southeast Asia), as Figure 7.1 shows (Wang & Lobstein, 2006). However, within the United States, rates are especially high in  the least affluent ethnic minority groups, including African Ameri cans, Latinos, and Native Americans, as shown in Map 7.1 (Kim et  al., 2002). Rates of overweight and obesity have risen sharply worldwide in recent decades (World Press Review, 2004).  A variety of changes have contributed to the rise in childhood  obesity. Most important is the change in diets. Over recent decades people have become less likely to prepare meals at home and more  likely to buy meals away from home, especially “fast foods” like  hamburgers, french fries, and pizza that are high in fat content; (MYPJH :V\[OLHZ[(ZPH ,\YVWL 5VY[O(TLYPJH then they wash it down with soft drinks high in sugar content Figure 7.1 s Rates of Childhood Overweight and Obesity Worldwide (Nielson et al., 2002). This change reflects other social changes: The highest rates occur in the most affluent regions. Parents are less likely to prepare meals at home because they are Based on: Wang & Lobstein (2006). more likely than in the past to be single parents or to be part of a Note: The figure is based on rates for children ages 6–18. dual-earner couple. Rates of overweight and obesity are rising in the populations of developing countries in part because their diets are becoming more THINKING CULTURALLY like the diets of people in developed countries (Gu et al., 2005; Wrotniak et al., 2004). Why do you think overweight and Another contributor is television. Most children in most developed countries watch at obesity are most common among lowleast 2 hours of television a day (Roberts & Foehr, 2004). In a longitudinal study that followed income American ethnic groups even a sample of American children from age 4 to 11, TV watching predicted gains in body fat though, internationally, overweight (Proctor et al., 2003). Specifically, children who watched at least 3 hours of TV a day gained and obesity are highest in the highest 40% more body fat over the course of the study than children who watched less than 1½ income countries? hours a day. Other studies have shown that the more time children watch TV the less time they spend in physical exercise (Institute of Medicine, 2005; Williams, 2005). Watching TV also exposes children to numerous advertisements for high-fat, high-sugar foods, which overweight in children, defined as having a BMI exceeding 18 they then lobby their parents to buy (Kelly et al., 2010). Rates of overweight and obesity are especially high among African American and Latino children in part because those are also obese in children, defined as having a BMI exceeding 21 the children that tend to watch the most TV per day (Roberts & Foehr, 2004). The allure of 9H[LVMV]LY^LPNO[

9H[LVMVILZP[`

7LYJLU[HNLVMV]LY^LPNO[HUKVILZL JOPSKYLUHNLK



VT

ND MN

MI

WV

SC MS

TX

AL

GA

LA

AK

FL

HI

Percentage of children who are obese Less than 12%

12–18%

More than 18%

T

LY

AR

(T

NM

(S

OK



Z NC

TN AZ

VA

KY

MO



HU

KS

NJ DE MD D.C.

YPJ

CO

OH IN

JL

IL

UT



(M

NE

NV

PA

IA



SYH

WY

CA

NH MA RI CT

NY

WI

SD

OP[

ID



(

OR



>

MT

ME

LY L PJH 3H U 5H PJH 4 [P] U0U (Z P_L [PUV L/ K PH K H^ PHU U( 9HJ  L HPP ( T HU SHZ LYPJ 7 RH HU HJ 5 PMPJ H[P 0Z ]L SHU KL Y

WA

6ILZP[`WYL]HSLUJL HTVUNJOPSKYLU 



Map 7.1 s Childhood Obesity in the United States What explains why some states and regions have higher childhood obesity rates than others? How do the rates of obesity vary by ethnicity?

Section 1 Physical Development the Internet and electronic games gives children additional reasons to stay inside rather than getting outside and playing active physical games (Anderson & Butcher, 2006). Genetics also make a contribution to obesity. Concordance rates for obesity are higher among MZ twins than DZ twins. Adopted children tend to have BMIs that are closer to their biological parents than to their adoptive parents (Whitaker et al., 1997). Recent research has even identified a specific gene, called FTO, that sharply increases children’s risk for obesity (Frayling et al., 2007). However, genetics cannot explain recent rises in obesity rates. Genetics provide only a risk for overweight and obesity, not a definite destiny. A compelling demonstration of this comes from a naturalistic study of the Pima Indians in Arizona and Mexico (Gladwell, 1998). The Pima of Mexico live in a remote region and still maintain their traditional ways, including a traditional cultural diet that is high in vegetables and low in fats and sugars. In contrast, the Pima of Arizona have changed in recent decades and their diets have become more like the American mainstream. Consequently, they have an average BMI that is 50% higher than their counterparts in Mexico, even though the two groups are very similar genetically. Obesity has both social and physical consequences for children. Being obese increases the likelihood that a child will be socially excluded and the object of ridicule by peers (Janssen et al., 2004; Strauss & Pollack, 2004). Other children tend to associate obesity with undesirable characteristics such as being lazy, sloppy, ugly, and stupid (Tiggemann & Anesbury, 2000). By middle childhood obesity is a risk factor for a variety of emotional and behavioral problems (Dietz, 2004; Mustillo et al., 2003; Schwimmer et al., 2003). Physically, the consequences of obesity are equally serious. Even in middle childhood, obesity can result in diabetes, which can eventually lead to problems such as blindness, kidney failure, and stroke (Hannon et al., 2005; Ramchamdani, 2004). Obesity also proves hard to shake from childhood to adulthood. About 80% of obese children remain overweight as adults (Oken & Lightdale, 2000). For adults, the range of health problems resulting from obesity is even greater—including high blood pressure, heart attack, and cancer—and more likely to be fatal (Calle et al., 2003). What can be done to reverse the sharp increase in childhood obesity? One step is recognizing the problem. Perhaps because obese children tend to have obese parents, studies indicate that fewer than half of parents of obese children view their children as overweight (Jeffrey, 2004; Young-Hyman et al., 2003). Public policies have begun to address the problem of childhood obesity. In the United States, school lunches have been notoriously unhealthy for decades but national standards are currently being revised to provide healthier school lunches that are lower in fats and sugars (Jalonick, 2010).

289

Rates of obesity are rising in developing countries as diets become more like those in the developed world. This photo was taken in Mexico, which has one of the highest child obesity rates in the world.

Watch the Video The Problem of Childhood Obesity at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse Given that half of parents of obese children do not regard their children as obese, how would you address this issue if you were treating children who were overweight or obese?

Illness and Injuries Explain why rates of illness and injury are relatively low in middle childhood. Middle childhood is in many ways the safest, healthiest time of life. In both developed countries and developing countries, death rates are lower during middle childhood than at any other period of the life span (Hyder & Lunnen, 2009; National Center for Health Statistics [NCHS], 2009). In developed countries, by middle childhood nearly all children have been vaccinated against the diseases that may have been fatal in earlier eras, such as smallpox, typhus, and diphtheria. In developing countries, an increasing proportion of children receive vaccinations in infancy, toddlerhood, and early childhood (World Health Organization [WHO], 2010). Even children who do not receive vaccinations are less susceptible to fatal diseases in middle childhood than they were earlier in their development. Their natural immune systems have become stronger, and their bodies are bigger, stronger, and more resilient. In developed countries, even rates of minor illnesses have declined in middle childhood in recent decades, due to public health policies. Over time, food production

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.3

290

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

Middle childhood is when rates of asthma are highest. This Indian girl is using an inhaler to relieve the symptoms.

asthma chronic illness of the lungs characterized by wheezing, coughing, and shortness of breath

has become cleaner and safer, and food content more closely regulated by government agencies. The air and water have become cleaner in developed countries due to laws and restrictions by governments. For example, according to national U.S. studies, in 1978 nearly 30% of children ages 5–10 had dangerously elevated levels of lead in their blood, which can cause brain damage; by 2001, the rate had fallen to 1% (Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report [MMWR], 2005). This decline reflects government policies that eliminated lead from gasoline and household paint. One exception to this trend in recent decades toward healthier development in middle childhood is asthma, a chronic illness of the lungs characterized by wheezing, coughing, and shortness of breath. A person with asthma has periodic “asthma attacks” in which breathing is especially difficult (Israel, 2005). An asthma attack can be triggered by cold weather, exercise, illnesses, allergies, emotional stress, or for no clear reason (Akinbami & Schoendorf, 2002). Asthma attacks can be reduced through the use of medical injections and inhalers (Glauber et al., 2001; Yoos et al., 2006). Rates of asthma are highest in middle childhood, and are increasing worldwide (Bousquet et al., 2007; Dey & Bloom, 2005). Boys are at higher risk than girls, for reasons that are not clear (Federico & Liu, 2003). Other risk factors are low birth weight, having a parent who smokes, living in poverty, and obesity (Saha et al., 2005). Susceptibility to asthma is also transmitted genetically (Bosse & Hudson, 2007). Why are rates of asthma higher now than in the past? The answer appears to be different for developed countries than for developing countries. In developed countries, common features of today’s family households contribute to asthma, including carpets, hairy pets, and airtight windows (Tamay et al., 2007). There is also a “hygiene hypothesis” suggesting that high standards of cleanliness and sanitation expose children to fewer viruses and bacteria, and consequently they have fewer illnesses in their early years that would strengthen their immune systems and make them less susceptible to asthma (Tedeschi & Airaghi, 2006). In developing countries, air pollution has become worse as a result of increased industrialization, and air pollution can trigger asthma. One study in Mongolia compared people in rural and urban areas and found substantially higher rates of asthma in urban areas, due mainly to poorer air quality (Viinanen et al., 2007). Rates of asthma are especially high among African American children, because they often live in urban neighborhoods where the air quality is poor (Pearlman et al., 2006). African Americans also have especially high rates of risk factors for asthma such as low birth weight and obesity. However, one study found that among children with asthma, the families of African American children were more likely than White families to take steps to change the environment in order to reduce risk factors that can trigger asthma attacks, with steps including use of mattress covers, use of pillow covers, cigarette smoke avoidance, pet avoidance, and carpet removal (Roy & Wisnivesky, 2010). Like illness rates, injury rates are relatively low in middle childhood (Hyder & Lunnen, 2011; U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, 2005). Compared to younger children, children in middle childhood are more agile and better at anticipating situations that may cause injury; compared to older children, children in middle childhood are kept closer to home and so are less likely to become involved in risky situations. The most common cause of injury in middle childhood is automobile accidents, followed by bicycle accidents (Schiller & Bernadel, 2004). The use of bicycle helmets has become common in middle childhood in recent decades, and this practice has led to a sharp decrease in the number of head injuries experienced during these years (Scheiber & Sacks, 2001).

Section 1 Physical Development

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

291

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. What is myopia and why is it more likely to occur in developed countries than in developing countries? 2. Why are children in middle childhood less vulnerable to the effects of malnutrition than they were when they were younger? 3. What is the cultural basis of obesity? What are some social consequences? 4. Why are rates of asthma higher now than in the past?

Motor Development Children advance in both gross and fine motor development during middle childhood, nearly reaching maturity in their fine motor abilities. Children become stronger and more agile, and as their gross motor skills develop, they spend more of their days in active play and organized sports. They also become capable of complex fine motor activities such as writing.

Gross Motor Development Explain how children’s gross motor skills develop in middle childhood and how these advancements are related to participation in games and sports. Watch a group of children on the playground of an elementary school, and you will see lots of activity. In one corner, a group of girls practices a dance routine one of them has learned from watching a TV show. In another, boys play four square, bouncing a ball into each other’s square and attempting to defend their own by knocking the ball to someone else’s square. In the middle, a group of boys and girls play tag, the perennial favorite. In a variety of ways, gross motor development advances from early to middle childhood. Children’s balance improves, allowing them to stay steady on a bike without training wheels or walk on a board across a river. They become stronger, so that they can jump higher and throw a ball farther. Their coordination advances so that they can perform movements in activities such as swimming and skating that require the synchronization of different body parts. They have greater agility so that they can move more quickly and precisely, for example when changing directions while playing soccer. Finally, their reaction time becomes faster, allowing them to respond rapidly to changing information, for example when hitting a tennis ball over the net or when catching or hitting a baseball (Kail, 2003). Increasing myelination of the corpus callosum connecting the two hemispheres of the brain (see Chapter 6) accelerates reaction time in middle childhood for both gross motor and fine motor tasks (Roeder et al., 2008). As their gross motor development advances, children can enjoy a wide range of games and sports. All over the world, middle childhood is a time of playing physically active games with siblings and friends, from tag and hide-and-seek to soccer, cricket, baseball, and basketball. Most of their play is informal, and takes place on the street or in a park or in the school yard when a few kids gather and decide to start a game (Kirchner, 2000). However, middle childhood is also the time when children are most likely to be involved in organized sports. For example, Little League baseball is played in 75 countries around the world during the middle childhood years. In the United States and Canada, about half of children are involved in organized sports at least once between the ages of 5 and 14 (National Council of Youth Sports, 2002; Sport Canada, 2003). Boys are slightly more likely than girls

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.4

Middle childhood is when children are most likely to be involved in organized sports.

292

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood to play on sports teams in middle childhood, but the rate of participation among girls has risen worldwide in recent decades, especially in sports such as soccer, swimming, gymnastics, and basketball (American Academy of Pediatrics, 2004; Raudsepp & Liblik, 2002; Vilhjalmsson & Krisjansdottir, 2003). Nevertheless, in the view of public health advocates, children do not get nearly as much gross motor activity as they should, leading to high rates of obesity, as we have just seen. Middle childhood may be a time of great advancements in gross motor abilities, but physically active games and sports compete today with the electronic allurements of TV and computer games (Anderson & Butcher, 2006). In some places, schools are less likely than in the past to be a setting for physical activity. In the United States, the percentage of children involved in daily “physical education” programs during middle childhood decreased from 80% in 1969 to just 8% in 2005 (Centers for Disease Control and Prevention [CDC], 2006; Health Management Resources, 2001). Health authorities recommend 60 minutes of physical activity a day for children ages 6–17, but few American children get that much (see http://www.cdc.gov/physicalactivity/everyone/guidelines/index.html).

Fine Motor Development

7.5

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe the new skills that demonstrate children’s advances in fine motor development in middle childhood. Fine motor development also makes great advances from early childhood to middle childhood. Not many 3- or 4-year-olds can tie their shoes successfully, but nearly all 8- to 9-year-olds can. In Asian cultures, only about half of 4-year-olds can use chopsticks successfully, but for children 6 years old and up it comes easily (Wong et al., 2002). In many developing countries, children become valuable as factory workers in middle childhood because of their abilities to perform intricate fine motor tasks such as weaving rugs (International Labor Organization [ILO], 2002). Across cultures, advances in fine motor development are especially evident in two areas, drawing and writing. In early childhood, drawing skills are limited to crude depictions of two-dimensional figures. However, in the course of middle childhood children learn to indicate three-dimensional depth by overlapping objects and making near objects smaller than distant ones (Braine et al., 1993). They also learn to draw objects in greater detail and to adjust the size and relation of objects in a drawing so that they fit together into one coherent whole (see Figure 7.2; Case & Okamoto, 1996).

Figure 7.2 s Change in Drawing Abilities from Early to Middle Childhood Drawings become more realistic as fine motor development advances during middle childhood. Here are drawings that my daughter, Paris, made at ages 3 (top), 5 (left), and 7 (right).

Section 1 Physical Development With regard to writing, in early childhood most children learn to write a few letters and numbers in rough form. In middle childhood, their skills greatly advance (Berninger et al., 2006). Even by age 6 most children are able to write the letters of the alphabet, their own names, and numbers from 1 to 10. In the course of the next several years, as their fine motor abilities develop, they are able to make their letters smaller and neater with more consistent height and spacing. By age 8 or 9 most children can learn to write in cursive. More generally, by the end of middle childhood their fine motor abilities have nearly reached adult maturity, whereas gross motor development will continue to advance for many years to come.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. Name three ways in which gross motor skills advance during middle childhood. 2. What are some possible reasons why many children at this age are not as physically active as they should be? 3. In which two areas are advances in fine motor development most evident at this age? 4. How do writing skills improve between ages 6 and 9?

Section 1 VIDEO GUIDE Physical Fitness (Length: 3:45) In this video, a sports and recreation director is interviewed about many aspects of physical development in the middle childhood years.

1. According to this video, what are some of the benefits of sports camps to children?

2. The person interviewed in this video discusses playing tennis versus video games. Compare and contrast these two activities. The world of gaming has changed considerably since this video was filmed; do you feel that video gaming is still a detriment to the physical health of children of this age?

3. What were some of the reasons mentioned in this video why some children are better at certain sports than others?

Watch the Video Physical Fitness at MyDevelopmentLab

293

294

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

SECTION 2

COGNITIVE DEVELOPMENT

LEARNING OBJECTIVES 7.6 Explain the major cognitive advances that occur during Piaget’s concrete operations stage. 7.7 Describe how attention and memory change from early childhood to middle childhood, and identify the characteristics of children who have ADHD. 7.8 Describe the main features and critiques of intelligence tests, and compare and contrast Gardner’s and Sternberg’s approaches to conceptualizing intelligence. 7.9 Describe how reading and math skills develop from early childhood to middle childhood and the variations in approaches to teaching these skills. 7.10 Identify the advances in vocabulary, grammar, and pragmatics during middle childhood. 7.11 Explain the consequences for cognitive development of growing up bilingual.

Theories of Cognitive Development As we have seen in previous chapters, Piaget’s approach and the information processing approach offer two different but complementary ways of understanding cognitive development. First we examine Piaget’s ideas about concrete operations, then we discuss information processing advances in attention and memory.

Concrete Operations

7.6

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Watch the Video Individual Differences in Cognitive Flexibility at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Concrete Operational Thinking at MyDevelopmentLab concrete operations in Piaget’s theory, the cognitive stage in which children become capable of using mental operations

294

Explain the major cognitive advances that occur during Piaget’s concrete operations stage. If you grew up in a Western country, perhaps you believed in Santa Claus when you were a young child. According to the story, Santa Claus rides a sleigh borne by flying reindeer around the world on Christmas Eve, and at each house he comes down the chimney and delivers toys to all the good girls and boys. Do you remember when you stopped believing it? For most children, the story starts to seem far-fetched once they get to be 7 or 8 years old (Sameroff & Haith, 1996). How could one person make it all the way around the world in one night, even with flying reindeer? How could a large man make it down a narrow chimney, dragging a sack full of toys? And what if you don’t have a chimney? The loss of belief in this myth reflects gains in cognitive development, as children develop a more trueto-life understanding of the world. Middle childhood is when children develop a better grasp of what the physical world is really like and what is and is not possible, like flying reindeer. Recall from Chapter 6 that according to Piaget’s theory of cognitive development, early childhood is the preoperational stage. In Piaget’s view, children ages 2–6 are most notable cognitively for what they cannot do—they cannot perform mental operations—and for the kinds of mistakes they make. Around age 7, children make an important cognitive advance toward becoming more systematic, planful, and logical thinkers. Piaget termed the cognitive stage from age 7 to 11 the stage of concrete operations. During this stage children become capable of using mental operations, which allow them to organize and manipulate information mentally instead of relying on physical and sensory associations. According to Piaget, the advances of concrete operations are evident in new abilities for performing tasks of conservation, classification, and seriation.

Section 2 Cognitive Development

295

ADVANCES IN CONCRETE OPERATIONS Before age 7 children usually make mistakes when performing tasks requiring an understanding of conservation. For example, in a task involving conservation of matter, a child may be shown two round balls of clay equal in size. The child watches as the experimenter rolls one ball into a long sausage shape and asks which shape has more clay. The preoperational child usually answers “the long one,” mistaking a change in shape for a change in quantity, whereas by age 7 or 8 most children will answer “the same,” realizing that the quantity remains the same even if the shape changes. In the preoperational stage children are centered on one obvious feature of a problem, but the concrete operational child has abilities for decentering that the preoperational child lacks. This advance makes it possible to take more than one aspect of a problem into account, in this case width as well as length. The concrete operational child can also perform the mental operation of reversibility to confirm that the quantity has not changed, thus understanding that if the long shape were rolled into a ball again it would be the same size as the other ball. Conservation of matter and liquid are attained by most children by ages 7 or 8, with conservation of length, area, weight, and volume following over the next few years (refer back to Chapter 6, p. 241, Figure 6.2 ). Conservation is a key milestone of cognitive development because it enables the child to perceive regularities and principles in the natural world, which is the basis of being able to think logically about how the world works. A second important cognitive achievement of concrete operations is classification. Although in early childhood young children can sort objects or events that share common characteristics into the same class—red, round, sweet, dog, for example—and can also add classes into more general categories—elephants and rabbits are both part of the larger class “animals”—they run into difficulty when a classification problem requires a mental operation. For example, in one experiment, Piaget showed a 5-year-old boy a drawing of 12 girls and 2 boys, and this exchange followed (Piaget, 1965, p. 167): Piaget: Are there more girls or more children? Boy: More girls. Piaget: But aren’t the girls children? Boy: Yes. Piaget: Then are there more children or more girls? Boy: More girls. Amusing, no doubt, at your age, but if you think about it answering this question requires a fairly challenging mental operation, at least for a 5-year-old. He must separate the girls and boys in the drawing into 2 classes (girls and boys), add them to form a larger class (children), and understand that the larger class (children) can be broken down again into each of its subclasses (girls and boys). Crucially, this must be done mentally. The number of girls can be compared to the number of boys visually, but comparing the number of children to the number of girls cannot, because girls are part of both categories. For this reason the 5-year-old trips up on the problem, but by age 8 or 9 most children perform this mental operation easily. In another experiment, Piaget interviewed a 9-year-old boy, showing him a drawing of 12 yellow tulips, 3 red tulips, and 6 daisies: Piaget: Which would make a bigger bunch, all the tulips or the yellow tulips? Boy: All the tulips, of course. You’d be taking the yellow tulips as well. Piaget: And which would be bigger, all the tulips or all the flowers? Boy: All the flowers. If you take all the flowers, you take all the tulips, too. (adapted from Ginsburg & Opper, 1979, p. 123) Seriation, the third achievement of concrete operations emphasized by Piaget, is the ability to arrange things in a logical order (e.g., shortest to longest, thinnest to thickest, lightest to darkest). Piaget found that preoperational children have an incomplete grasp of concepts such as longer than or smaller than. For example, when asked to arrange a set of sticks from shortest to longest, children in the preoperational age period would typically

decentering cognitive ability to take more than one aspect of a problem into account, such as width as well as length seriation ability to arrange things in a logical order, such as shortest to longest, thinnest to thickest, or lightest to darkest

start with a short stick, then pick a long stick—but then pick another short stick, then another long stick, and so on. However, by age 7 most children can accurately arrange six to eight sticks by length. This kind of seriation task can be done visually—that is, it does not require a mental operation—but Piaget also found that during concrete operations children developed the ability to seriate mentally. Take this problem, for example. If Julia is taller than Anna and Anna is taller than Lynn, is Julia taller than Lynn? To get this right, the child has to be able to order the heights mentally from tallest to shortest: Julia, Anna, Lynn. Piaget called this transitive inference, the mental ability to place objects in a logical order, and he considered the achievement of this skill to be a key part of learning to think logically and systematically.

Seriation is one of the key cognitive abilities that develops during middle childhood, according to Piaget.

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE What are the social implications of learning seriation? That is, how might it be related to social hierarchies in middle childhood?

EVALUATING PIAGET’S THEORY Research testing Piaget’s theory has found that, for concrete operations as for the preoperational stage, children are capable of performing some tasks at an earlier age than Piaget had claimed (Vilette, 2002). However, for Piaget it was not enough for a child to grasp some aspects of conservation, classification, and seriation in order to be considered a concrete operational thinker; the child had to have complete mastery of the tasks associated with the stage (Piaget, 1965). Thus, the difference between Piaget and his critics on this issue is more a matter of definition—”What qualifies a child as a concrete operational thinker?”—than of empirical findings. Piaget also claimed that teaching a child the principles of concrete operations would not work because their grasp of the principles of the stage has to occur naturally as part of their interaction with their environment (Piaget, 1965). Here his critics appear to be right, with many studies showing that with training and instruction, children under age 7 can learn to perform the tasks of concrete operations and also understand the underlying principles well enough to apply them to new tasks (Parameswaran, 2003). Transporting Piaget’s tasks across cultures shows that acquiring an understanding of concrete operations depends on exposure to similar tasks and materials. For example, in one study of 4- to 13-year-old children in the Maya culture of Mexico and in Los Angeles, the children in Los Angeles performed better than the Mayan children on standard tests of concrete operations, whereas the Mayan children performed better on similar concrete operations tasks that involved materials used in weaving, because these materials were familiar from their daily lives (Maynard & Greenfield, 2003).

Information Processing

7.7

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Describe how attention and memory change from early childhood to middle childhood, and identify the characteristics of children who have ADHD. Ever try to play a board game with a 3-year-old? If you do, it better be short and simple. But by middle childhood, children can play a wide variety of board games that adults enjoy, too, because their powers of attention and memory have advanced. This is one reflection of how information processing improves during middle childhood. Due to increased myelination in the brain, especially of the corpus callosum connecting the two hemispheres, speed of processing information increases (Roeder et al., 2008). Consequently, the amount of time required to perform various tasks decreases in the course of middle childhood (Kail & Park, 1992). Advances are also made in the two key areas of information processing: attention and memory.

transitive inference ability to place objects in a logical order mentally selective attention ability to focus attention on relevant information and disregard what is irrelevant

296

ATTENTION AND ADHD In middle childhood, children become more capable of focusing their attention on relevant information and disregarding what is irrelevant, an ability termed selective attention (Goldberg et al., 2001). For example, in one line of research, children of various ages were shown a series of cards, each containing one animal and one household item, and told to try and remember where the animal on each card was

Section 2 Cognitive Development located (Hagen & Hale, 1973). Nothing was mentioned about the household items. Afterward, when asked about the location of the animals on each card, older children performed better than younger children. However, when asked how many of the household items they could remember, younger children performed better than older children. The older children were capable of focusing on the information they were told would be relevant, the location of the animals, and capable of ignoring the household items as irrelevant. In contrast, the poorer performance of the younger children in identifying the locations of the animals was partly due to being distracted by the household items. Being able to maintain attention becomes especially important once children enter school at about age 6 or 7, because the school setting requires children to pay attention to their teachers’ instructions. Children with especially notable difficulties in maintaining attention may be diagnosed with attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD), which includes problems of inattention, hyperactivity, and impulsiveness (American Academy of Pediatrics [AAP], 2005). Children with ADHD have difficulty following instructions and waiting their turn. In the United States, it is estimated that 3–7% of children are diagnosed with ADHD. Boys are about 4 times more likely than girls to have ADHD (Guyer, 2000). The diagnosis is usually made by a pediatrician after evaluation of the child and consultation with parents and teachers (Sax & Kautz, 2003). ADHD is usually first diagnosed in middle childhood, once children enter school and are required to sit still for much of the day, but the majority of children with ADHD still have the disorder in adolescence (Barkley, 2002; Whalen, 2000). The causes of ADHD are unclear, but it appears to be at least partly inherited, as nearly 50% of children and adolescents with ADHD also have a sibling or parent with the disorder and MZ twins are more likely than DZ twins to be concordant for it (Guyer, 2000; Ramussen et al., 2004). Exposure to prenatal teratogens such as alcohol and tobacco is a risk factor for ADHD (Voeller, 2004). The brains of children with ADHD are slightly smaller and grow more slowly, compared to other children’s brains (Durston et al., 2004). Studies using fMRI techniques have found abnormalities in the brain functioning of children with ADHD, including restricted blood flow to the frontal cortex, which controls attention and inhibits behavior (Castellanos et al., 2003). In the United States, nearly 9 of 10 children and adolescents diagnosed with ADHD receive Ritalin or other medications to suppress their hyperactivity and help them concentrate better (Kaplan et al., 2004). Medications are often effective in controlling the symptoms of ADHD, with 70% of children showing improvements in academic performance and peer relations (HMHL, 2005). However, there are concerns about side effects, including slower physical growth and higher risk of depression (Reeves & Schweitzer, 2004). Behavioral therapies are also effective, and the combination of medication and behavioral therapy is more effective than either treatment alone (American Academy of Pediatrics, 2005). Effective behavioral therapies include parent training, classroom interventions, and summer programs (Hoza et al., 2008). Although most research on ADHD has taken place in the United States, recently a large study of ADHD was completed in Europe, involving over 1,500 children and adolescents (ages 6–18) in 10 countries (Rotheberger et al., 2006). In this Attention-deficit/ hyperactivity Disorder Observational Research in Europe (ADORE) study, pediatricians and child psychiatrists across Europe collected observational data on children and adolescents at seven time points over 2 years, with data including diagnosis, treatment, and outcomes. Parents also participated, and their assessments showed high agreement with the assessments of the pediatricians and child psychiatrists. Like the American studies, ADORE found higher rates of ADHD among boys than among girls, but the ratios varied widely among countries, from 3:1 to 16:1 (Novik et al., 2006). Symptoms of ADHD were similar among boys and girls, but girls with ADHD were more likely than boys to have additional emotional problems and to be bullied by their peers, whereas ADHD boys were more likely than girls to have conduct problems. For both boys and girls,

297

attention-deficit/hyperactivity disorder (ADHD) diagnosis that includes problems of inattention, hyperactivity, and impulsiveness

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE Think of any sport or game popular among children in your culture. Does speed of information processing contribute to better performance in middle childhood?

Watch the Video Attention Deficit Disorder at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Speaking Out: Jimmy: ADHD at MyDevelopmentLab

ADHD is usually first diagnosed in middle childhood, when children are required to sit still for long periods in school.

298

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood having ADHD resulted in frequent problems in their relations with peers, teachers, and parents (Coghill et al., 2006). Parents reported frequent stresses and strains due to children’s and adolescents’ ADHD behavior, including frequent disruptions of family activities and worries about the future (Riley et al., 2006). In contrast to the American approach of relying heavily on Ritalin and other medications, the European approaches to treatment were diverse: medications (25%), psychotherapy (19%), combination of medications and psychotherapy (25%), other therapy (10%) and no treatment (21%) (Preuss et al., 2006).

mnemonics memory strategies, such as rehearsal, organization, and elaboration rehearsal mnemonic that involves repeating the same information over and over organization mnemonic that involves placing things mentally into meaningful categories elaboration mnemonic that involves transforming bits of information in a way that connects them and hence makes them easier to remember

MEMORY In early childhood, memory is often fleeting, as any parent can attest who has ever asked a 4-year-old what happened to those nice new mittens he wore out to play that morning. Mittens? What mittens? In middle childhood the capacity of working memory enlarges. On memory tests for sequences of numbers, the length of the sequence recalled is just 4 numbers for the typical 7-year-old, but for the typical 12-year-old it has increased to 7, equal to adults (Kail, 2003). More importantly, middle childhood is the period when children first learn to use mnemonics (memory strategies) such as rehearsal, organization, and elaboration. Rehearsal, which involves repeating the information over and over, is a simple but effective mnemonic. You probably use it yourself, for example when someone tells you a phone number and you are trying to remember it between the time you hear it and the time you dial it. In a classic study, John Flavell and his colleagues (1966) showed how rehearsal emerges as a memory strategy in middle childhood. They outfitted children ages 5 and 10 in a space helmet with a dark visor and displayed seven pictures of familiar objects in front of them. Each child was told that the researcher was going to point to three objects that the child was to remember (in order), pull down the space helmet visor so the child could not see for 15 seconds, then lift the visor and ask the child to point to the three objects. During the 15-second delay, nearly all of the 10-year-olds but only a few of the 5-year-olds moved their lips or recited the names of the objects aloud, showing that they were using rehearsal. At each age, rehearsers recalled the objects much more accurately than non-rehearsers. Organization—placing things into meaningful categories—is another effective memory strategy that is used more commonly in the course of middle childhood (Schneider, 2002). Studies typically test this ability by giving people a list of items to remember, for example, shoes, zebra, baseball, cow, tennis racket, dress, raccoon, soccer goal, hat. Numerous studies have shown that if children are given a list of items to remember, they are more likely to group them into categories—clothes, animals, sports items—in middle childhood than in early childhood (Sang et al., 2002). Organization is a highly effective memory strategy, because each category serves as a retrieval cue for the items within the category, so that if the category can be remembered, all the items within the category are likely to be remembered as well (Schneider, 2002). A third memory strategy that comes into greater use in middle childhood is elaboration, which involves transforming bits of information in a way that connects them and hence makes them easier to remember (Terry, 2003). One example of this is the standard way of teaching children the lines of the treble clef in music, EGBDF: Every Good Boy Does Fine. Or, if you were going to the grocery store and wanted to remember to buy butter, lettuce, apples, and milk, you could arrange the first letters of each of the items into one word, BLAM. The word BLAM serves as a retrieval cue for the items represented by each letter of the word. Although children are more likely to use organization and elaboration in middle childhood than in early childhood, even in middle childhood and beyond, relatively few people use memory strategies on a regular basis. Instead, they rely on more concrete, practical methods. In one study, children in kindergarten and first, third, and fifth grade were asked how they would remember to bring their ice skates to a party the next day (Kreutzer, Leonard, & Flavell, 1975). At all three ages, children came up with sensible approaches such as putting the skates where they would be easy to see, writing themselves a note, and tying a string to their finger.

Section 2 Cognitive Development Another reason why memory improves from early childhood to middle childhood is that children’s knowledge base expands, and the more you know, the easier it is to remember new information that is related to what you know. In a classic study illustrating this, 10-year-old chess masters and college student novice chess players were compared in their ability to remember configurations of pieces on a chess board (Chi, 1978). The 10-year-old chess masters performed far better than the college student novices, even though the college students were better at recalling a series of random numbers. In another study, 9- and 10-year-olds were separated into two groups, soccer “experts” and soccer “novices,” and asked to try to remember lists of soccer items and non-soccer items (Schneider & Bjorklund, 1992). The soccer experts remembered more items on the soccer list but not the non-soccer list. Middle childhood is not only a time of advances in memory abilities but of advances in understanding how memory works, or metamemory. Even by age 5 or 6, most children have some grasp of metamemory (DeMarie et al., 2001; Lyon & Flavell, 1993). They recognize that it is easier to remember something that happened yesterday than something that happened long ago. They understand that short lists are easier to remember than long lists, and that familiar items are more easily remembered than unfamiliar items. However, their appraisal of their own memory abilities tends to be inflated. When children in early childhood and middle childhood were shown a series of 10 pictures and asked if they could remember all of them, more than half of the younger children but only a few older children claimed they could (none of them actually could!) (Flavell et al., 1970). In the course of middle childhood, children develop more accurate assessments of their memory abilities (Schneider & Pressley, 1997).

299

Why do young chess masters remember chess configurations better than older novices do?

Intelligence and Intelligence Tests Describe the main features and critiques of intelligence tests, and compare and contrast Gardner’s and Sternberg’s approaches to conceptualizing intelligence.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.8

Both the Piagetian approach and the information-processing approach describe general patterns of cognitive development and functioning, intended to apply to all children. However, at any given age there are also individual differences among children in their cognitive functioning. Within any group of same-age children, some will perform relatively high in their cognitive functioning and some relatively low. Even in infancy, toddlerhood, and early childhood, individual differences in cognitive development are evident, as children reach various cognitive milestones at different times, such as saying their first word. However, individual differences become more evident and more important in middle childhood, when children enter formal schooling and begin to be tested and evaluated by their teachers on a regular basis. In the study of human development, the examination of individual differences in cognitive development has focused mainly on measurements of intelligence. Definitions of intelligence vary, but it is generally understood to be a person’s capacity for acquiring knowledge, reasoning, and solving problems (Sternberg, 2004). Intelligence tests usually provide an overall score of general intelligence as well as several subscores that reflect different aspects of intelligence. Let us begin by looking at the characteristics of one of the most widely used intelligence tests, and follow with an exploration of the genetic and environmental sources of individual differences. Then, we will consider two alternative ways of conceptualizing and measuring intelligence. THE WECHSLER INTELLIGENCE TESTS The most widely used intelligence tests are the Wechsler scales, including the Wechsler Intelligence Scale for Children (WISC-IV) for ages 6 to 16 and the Wechsler Adult Intelligence Scale (WAIS-IV) for ages 16 and up.

metamemory understanding of how memory works intelligence capacity for acquiring knowledge, reasoning, and solving problems

300

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

TABLE 7.1 The WISC-IV: Sample Items Verbal Subtests Information

General knowledge questions, for example, “Who wrote Huckleberry Finn?”

Vocabulary

Give definitions, for example, “What does formulate mean?”

Similarities

Describe relationship between two things, for example, “In what ways are an apple and an orange alike?” and “In what ways are a book and a movie alike?”

Arithmetic

Verbal arithmetic problems, for example, “How many hours does it take to drive 140 miles at a rate of 30 miles per hour?”

Comprehension

Practical knowledge, for example, “Why is it important to use zip codes when you mail letters?”

Digit Span

Short-term memory test. Sequences of numbers of increasing length are recited, and the person is required to repeat them.

Performance Subtests For all the performance tests, scores are based on speed as well as accuracy of response. Picture arrangement

Cards depicting various activities are provided, and the person is required to place them in an order that tells a coherent story.

Picture completion

Cards are provided depicting an object or scene with something missing, and the person is required to point out what is missing (for example, a dog is shown with only three legs).

Matrix reasoning

Patterns are shown with one piece missing. The person chooses from five options the one that will fill in the missing piece accurately.

Block design

Blocks are provided having two sides all white, two sides all red, and two sides half red and half white. Card is shown with a geometrical pattern, and the person must arrange the blocks so that they match the pattern on the card.

Digit symbol

At top of sheet, numbers are shown with matching symbols. Below, sequences of symbols are given with an empty box below each symbol. The person must place matching number in the box below each symbol.

THINKING CULTURALLY Looking at the sample IQ test items in Table 7.1, are there any that you think may reflect a cultural bias?

Simulate the Experiment Creativity at MyDevelopmentLab

intelligence quotient (IQ) score of mental ability as assessed by intelligence tests, calculated relative to the performance of other people the same age

The Wechsler scales consist of 11 subtests, of which 6 are Verbal subtests and 5 are Performance subtests. The results provide an overall intelligence quotient, or IQ score, which is calculated relative to the performance of other people of the same age, with 100 as the median score. The overall IQ can be broken down into a Verbal IQ score, a Performance IQ score, and scores for each of the 11 subtests. More detail on each of the subscales of the WISC-IV is provided in Table 7.1, so you can get an idea of what IQ tests really measure. How accurate are the Wechsler IQ tests? IQ tests were originally developed to test children’s abilities as they entered school, and IQ has proven to be a good predictor of children’s school performance. One study of children in 46 countries found that across countries, IQ scores and school achievement scores were highly correlated (Lynn & Mikk, 2007). IQ scores are also quite good predictors of success in adulthood, as Chapter 10 will explore in more detail (Benbow & Lubinski, 2009). IQ tests have been criticized on a variety of grounds. Critics have complained that IQ tests assess only a narrow range of abilities, and miss some of the most important aspects of intelligence, such as creativity. IQ tests have also been attacked as culturally biased, because some of the vocabulary and general knowledge items would be more familiar to someone who was part of the middle-class culture (Ogbu, 2002). However, attempts to develop “culture-fair” tests have found the same kinds of group differences as standard IQ tests have found (Johnson et al., 2008). It may not be possible to develop a culture-fair or culture-free IQ test, because by the time people are able to take the tests (age 6) their cognitive development has already been shaped by living in a particular cultural and social environment. Although IQ tests aspire to test raw intellectual abilities, this would not really be possible unless everyone was exposed to essentially the same environment in the years before taking the test, which is obviously not the case. However, new approaches to studying intelligence have provided important insights into the relation between genetics and environment in performance on IQ tests, as we will discuss next.

Section 2 Cognitive Development

301

)P

(K

VW [

LK :

PI SPU NZ VS VN 7H PJH YL S* U[Z OP HU SK K )P YL VS U VN PJH S: PI SPU NZ +A 4 A ; ;^ ^ PU PU Z Z 9 4 H A P Z LK ;^ ( PU WH Z 9H Y[ PZL K ;V NL [O LY

08*VYYLSH[PVU

INFLUENCES ON INTELLIGENCE IQ scores for a population-based sample usually fall into a normal distribution or bell curve, in which most people are near the middle of the distribution and the proportions decrease at the low and high extremes, as shown in Figure 7.3. 4LU[HS Persons with IQs below 70 are classified as 5VYTHS .PM[LK YL[HYKH[PVU having mental retardation, and those with        IQs above 130 are classified as gifted. But what determines whether a person’s score is low, high, or somewhere in the middle? Is         intelligence mainly an inherited trait, or is it 08ZJVYL shaped mainly by the environment? As noted in Chapter 2, social scientists increasingly regard the old nature–nurture Figure 7.3 s Bell Curve for Intelligence debates as sterile and obsolete. Nearly all accept that both genetics and environment are IQ scores for a population-based sample usually involved in development, including in the development of intelligence. A variety of new fall into this kind of pattern. findings presented in the past 20 years provide insights into how genetics and environments interact and how both contribute to intelligence. Most of these studies use the natural experiments of adoption studies or twin studies in order to avoid the problem of passive normal distribution typical distribution of genotype 4 environment effects. When parents provide both genetics and environment, characteristics of a population, resembling a bell curve in which most cases fall near the middle as they do in most families, it is very difficult to judge the relative contribution of each. and the proportions decrease at the low and high Adoption and twin studies help unravel that tangle. extremes One important conclusion from adoption and twin studies is that the more two mental retardation level of cognitive abilities of people in a family are alike genetically, the higher the correlation in their IQs (Brant et persons who score 70 or below on IQ tests al., 2009). As shown in Figure 7.4, adopted siblings, who have none of their genotype gifted in IQ test performance, persons who score in common, have a relatively low correlation for IQ, about .24. The environmental influ- 130 or above ence is apparent—ordinarily, the correlation between two genetically unrelated children would be zero—but limited. Parents and their biological children, who share half of their genotype in common, are correlated for IQ at about .30 to .40, slightly higher Figure 7.4 s IQ and Genetics The closer the if they live together than if they live apart. The correlation for biological siblings is genetic relationship, the higher the correlation higher, about .50, and slightly higher still for DZ twins. Biological siblings and DZ twins in IQ. Based on: Brant et al., 2009. share the same proportion of their genotype in common as parents  and biological children do (again, about half), so the greater IQ similarity in DZ twins must be due to greater environmental similarity,  from the womb onward. The highest IQ correlation of all, about .85, is among MZ twins, who have exactly the same genotype. Even  when they are adopted by separate families and raised apart, the  correlation in IQ scores of MZ twins is about .75 (Brant et al., 2009). The results of these studies leave little doubt that genetics contrib ute strongly to IQ scores. It is especially striking that the correlation in  IQ is much lower for adopted siblings, who have grown up in the same family and neighborhood and attended the same schools, than it is for  MZ twins who have been raised separately and have never even known each other.  However, other adoption studies show that both environment  and genetics have a strong influence on intelligence. In one study, researchers recruited a sample of adopted children whose bio logical mothers were at two extremes, either under 95 or above 120  (remember, 100 is the median population IQ) (Loehlin et al 1997). All the children were adopted at birth by parents who were above average in education and income. When tested in middle childhood, children in both groups were above average in IQ. If we can assume that the high-education, high-income adoptive parents provided a healthy, stable, stimulating environment, this shows the influence

302

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

Median IQ scores

of the environment for the children whose biological mothers all had IQs less than 95. On the basis of their biological mother’s IQs, none of them would have been predicted to have an IQ above 95, and yet on average they were above 100, due to the advantages of an environment provided by higheducation, high-income parents. However, the children whose biological mothers had IQs above 120 were significantly higher in IQ than the children whose biological mothers had IQs less than 95, even though children in both groups had an advantaged environment. Taken together, the adoption and twin IQ studies show that both genetics and environment contribute to the development of intelligence. Specifically, every child has a genetically based reaction range for intelligence, meaning a range of possible developmental paths (refer back to Chapter 2). With a healthy, stimulating environment, children reach the top of their reaction range for intelligence; with a poor, unhealthy, or chaotic environment, children are likely to develop a level of intelligence toward the bottom of the reaction range. There is both an upper and a lower limit to the reaction range. Even with an optimal environment, children with relatively Identical twins have similar IQs, even low intellectual abilities are unlikely to develop superior intelligence; even with a subnorwhen reared apart. Here, 6-year-old MZ mal environment, children with relatively high intellectual abilities are unlikely to end up twin sisters in Thailand. well below average in IQ. Recent research has revealed new insights into the intricate relations between genetics and environment in the development of intelligence. Specifically, research indicates that the influence of the environment on IQ is stronger for poor children than for children of affluent families (Nesbitt, 2009; Turkheimer et al., 2009). The less stimulating the environment, the less genetics influences IQ, because all children’s potentials are suppressed in an unstimulating environment. In contrast, an affluent environment generally allows children to receive the cognitive stimulation necessary to reach the top of their reaction range for IQ. One other highly important finding that attests to the importance of environmental Flynn effect steep rise in the median IQ score in Western countries during the 20th century, named influences on intelligence is that the median IQ score in Western countries rose dramatiafter James Flynn, who first identified it cally in the course of the 20th century, a phenomenon known as the Flynn effect after the scholar who first noted it, James Flynn (1999). From 1932 to 1997 the median IQ score among children in the United States rose by 20 points (Howard, 2001). This is a huge difference. It means that a child whose IQ was average in 1932 would be way below average by today’s standard. It means that half of children today would have scored at least 120 by 1932 scoring, placing them in the “superior intelligence” range, and about one-fourth of children today would be considered by 1932 standards to have “very superior intelligence”—a classification actually held by only 3% of children in 1932 (Horton, 2001). As shown in Figure 7.5, similar results have been found in other countries as well (Flynn, 1999). Figure 7.5 s Flynn Effect IQ scores have risen What explains the Flynn effect? The causes must be environmental, rather than geacross developed countries in recent decades. netic; the genes of the human population could not have changed so dramatically in such Source: Flynn (1999) a short time. But what about the environment improved so much in the course of the 20th century as to explain such a dramatic rise in median IQ Britain 100100 100 100 100 scores? Several possibilities have been identified (Rodgers & Wanstrom, 100 Netherlands 2007). Prenatal care is better now than in the early 20th century, and better Israel 95 Norway prenatal care leads to better intellectual development, including higher 93 91 Belgium IQs. Families are generally smaller now than in the early 20th century, 90 88.5 and in general the fewer children in a family the higher their IQs. Far 85 more children attend preschool now than was true in 1932, and preschool 79 enhances young children’s intellectual development. It has even been 80 suggested that the invention of television may be one of the sources of 75 the Flynn effect. Although television and other media are often blamed for societal ills, there is good evidence that watching educational television 1992 1942 1952 1962 1972 1982 enhances young children’s intellectual development (Scantlin, 2007).

Section 2 Cognitive Development

OTHER CONCEPTIONS OF INTELLIGENCE: GARDNER’S AND STERNBERG’S THEORIES IQ testing has dominated research on children’s intellectual development for nearly a century. However, in recent decades alternative theories of intelligence have been proposed. These theories have sought to present a conception of intelligence that is much broader than the traditional one. Two of the most influential alternative theories of intelligence have been presented by Howard Gardner and Robert Sternberg. Gardner’s (1983, 2004) theory of multiple intelligences includes eight types of intelligence. In Gardner’s view only two of them, linguistic and logical–mathematical intelligences, are evaluated by intelligence tests. The other intelligences are spatial (the ability to think three-dimensionally); musical; bodily–kinesthetic (the kind that athletes and dancers excel in); naturalist (ability for understanding natural phenomena); interpersonal (ability for understanding and interacting with others); and intrapersonal (self-understanding). As evidence for the existence of these different types of intelligence, Gardner argues that each involves distinct cognitive skills, that each can be destroyed by damage to a particular part of the brain, and that each appears in extremes in geniuses as well as in idiots savant (the French term for people who are low in general intelligence but possess an extraordinary ability in one specialized area). Gardner argues that schools should give more attention to the development of all eight kinds of intelligence and design programs that would be tailored to each child’s individual profile of intelligences. He has proposed methods for assessing different intelligences, such as measuring musical intelligence by having people attempt to sing a song, play an instrument, or orchestrate a melody (Gardner, 1999). However, thus far neither Gardner nor others have developed reliable and valid methods (see Chapter 1) for analyzing the intelligences he proposes (Kornhaber, 2004). Gardner has also been criticized for extending the boundaries of intelligence too widely. When an adolescent displays exceptional musical ability, is this an indication of musical “intelligence” or simply of musical talent? Gardner himself has been critical of the concept of “emotional intelligence” proposed by Daniel Goleman and others (Goleman, 1997), arguing that the capacity to empathize and cooperate with others is better viewed as “emotional sensitivity” rather than intelligence (Gardner, 1999). However, Gardner is vulnerable to a similar criticism for proposing “interpersonal” and “intrapersonal” intelligences. Sternberg’s (1983, 1988, 2002, 2003, 2005) triarchic theory of intelligence includes three distinct but related forms of intelligence. Analytical intelligence is Sternberg’s term for the kind of intelligence that IQ tests measure, which involves acquiring, storing, analyzing, and retrieving information. Creative intelligence involves the ability to combine information in original ways to produce new insights, ideas, and problem-solving strategies. Practical intelligence is the ability to apply information to the kinds of problems faced in everyday life, including the capacity to evaluate social situations. Sternberg has conducted extensive research to develop tests of intelligence that measure the three types of intelligence he proposes. These tests involve solving problems, applying

 (]LYHNL08ZJVYL

An especially persuasive explanation has recently been proposed: the decline of infectious diseases (Eppig et al., 2010). Christopher Eppig and his colleagues note that the brain requires a great deal of the body’s physical energy—87% in newborns, nearly half in 5-year-olds, and 25% in adults. Infectious diseases compete for this energy by activating the body’s immune system and interfering with the body’s processing of food during years when the brain is growing and developing rapidly. If this explanation is true, there should be an inverse relationship between IQ and infectious disease rates, and this pattern was evident in the researchers’ analysis of data from 113 countries (as shown in Figure 7.6). The higher a country’s infectious disease burden, the lower the country’s median IQ. Thus the Flynn effect may have been primarily due to the elimination of major infectious diseases in developed countries. A Flynn effect of the future may be awaiting developing countries as they reduce and eliminate infectious diseases.

303

     













0UMLJ[PV\ZKPZLHZLYH[L

Figure 7.6 s Inverse Relation Between IQ and Disease Could this explain the Flynn effect? Source: Eppig et al. (2010)

Watch the Video Robert Sternberg on Cultural Influences at MyDevelopmentLab

Explore the Concept Gardner’s Multiple Intelligences at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE Do you agree that all the mental abilities described by Gardner are different types of intelligence? If not, which types would you remove? Are there other types you would add?

theory of multiple intelligences Gardner’s theory that there are eight distinct types of intelligence triarchic theory of intelligence Sternberg’s theory that there are three distinct but related forms of intelligence

knowledge, and developing creative strategies. Sternberg’s research on Americans has demonstrated that each person has a different profile on the three intelligences that can be assessed (Sternberg, 2005, 2007). He proposes that the three components are universal and contribute to intelligent performance in all cultures (Sternberg, 2005), but so far the theory has been tested little outside the United States. Neither Sternberg’s nor Gardner’s tests are widely used among psychologists, in part because they take longer to administer and score than standard IQ tests do (Gardner, 1999). The underlying issue in judging alternative theories of intelligence is the question of how intelligence should be defined. If intelligence is defined simply as the mental abilities required to succeed in school, the traditional approach to conceptualizing and measuring intelligence is generally successful. However, if one wishes to define intelligence more broadly, as the entire range of human mental abilities, the traditional approach may be seen as too narrow, and an approach such as Gardner’s or Sternberg’s may be preferred. Is musical ability a type of intelligence?

Learning the Cognitive Skills of School: Reading and Mathematics

7.9

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Watch the Video The School-Age Child at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Child Struggling with Reading at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Literacy at MyDevelopmentLab phonics approach method of teaching reading that advocates breaking down words in their component sounds, called phonics, then putting the phonics together into words

304

Describe how reading and math skills develop from early childhood to middle childhood and the variations in approaches to teaching these skills. In most cultures, middle childhood is when children first learn how to read and how to do math. However, there are variations in the timing and methods of teaching these skills, both within and between cultures. APPROACHES TO READING Children learn language with remarkable proficiency without being explicitly taught or instructed, just from being around others who use the language and interacting with them. However, when they reach middle childhood, children must learn a whole new way of processing language, via reading, and for most children learning to read takes direct instruction. Learning to read is a relatively new development in human history. Until about 200 years ago, most people were illiterate all their lives. For example, in the United States in 1800, only about half of army recruits were even able to sign their own names on the enlistment documents (Rogoff et al., 2005). Because most human economic activity involved simple agriculture or hunting or fishing, learning to read was unnecessary for most people. They could learn what they needed to know from observing others and working alongside them, through guided participation. Today, of course, in a globalized, information-based economy, learning to read is an essential skill for most economic activity, across cultures. Consequently, children almost everywhere learn to read, usually beginning around age 6 or 7, when they enter school. Think for a moment about the cognitive skills reading requires, so that you can appreciate how complex and challenging it is. In order to read, you have to recognize that letters are symbols of sounds, and then match a speech sound to each letter or letter combination. You have to know the meanings of whole words—one or two at first, then dozens, then hundreds, eventually many thousands. As you read a sentence, you have to keep the meanings of individual words or combinations of words in working memory while you continue to read the rest of the sentence. At the end of the sentence, you must put all the word and phrase meanings together into a coherent meaning for the sentence as a whole. Then you have to combine sentences into paragraphs and derive meanings of paragraphs from the relations between the sentences; then combine paragraphs for still larger meanings; and so on. By now this process no doubt comes naturally to you, after so many years of reading. We perform the complex cognitive tasks of reading automatically after reading for some years, without thinking about the components that go into it. But what is the best way to teach children who are first learning to read? Two major approaches have emerged in educational research over the years. The phonics approach advocates teaching children

Section 2 Cognitive Development by breaking down words into their component sounds, called phonics, then putting the phonics together into words (Gray et al., 2007). Reading in this approach involves learning gradually more complex units: phonics, then single words, then short sentences, then somewhat longer sentences, and so on. After mastering their phonics and being able to read simple words and sentences, children begin to read longer materials such as poems and stories. The other major approach to teaching reading is the whole-language approach (Donat, 2006). In this view, the emphasis should be on the meaning of written language in whole passages, rather than breaking down each word into its smallest components. This approach advocates teaching children to read using complete written material, such as poems, stories, and lists of related items. Children are encouraged to guess at the meaning of words they do not know, based on the context of the word within the written material. In this view, if the material is coherent and interesting, children will be motivated to learn and remember the meanings of words they do not know. Which approach works best? Each side has advocates, but evidence is substantial that the phonics approach is more effective at teaching children who are first learning to read (Berninger et al., 2003; Rayner et al., 2002). Children who have fallen behind in their reading progress using other methods improve substantially when taught with the phonics approach (Shawitz et al., 2004; Xue & Meisels, 2004). However, once children have begun to read they can also benefit from supplementing phonics instruction with the whole-language approach, with its emphasis on the larger meanings of written language and on using material from school subjects such as history and science to teach reading as well (Pressley et al., 2002; Silva & Martins, 2003). Although learning to read is cognitively challenging, most children become able readers by Grade 3 (Popp, 2005). However, some children find learning to read unusually difficult. One condition that interferes with learning to read is dyslexia, which includes difficulty sounding out letters, difficulty learning to spell words, and a tendency to misperceive the order of letters in words (Snowling, 2004; Spafford &Grosser, 2005). Dyslexia is one of the most common types of learning disabilities, which are cognitive disorders that impede the development of learning a specific skill such as reading or math. As with other learning disabilities, children with dyslexia are not necessarily any less intelligent than other children; their cognitive problem is specific to the skill of reading. The causes of dyslexia are not known, but boys are about 3 times as likely as girls to have the disability, suggesting a genetic link to the Y chromosome (Hensler et al., 2010; Vidyasagar, 2004). LEARNING MATH SKILLS There has been far more research on the development of reading than on the development of math skills (Berch & Mazzoccoco, 2007). Nevertheless, some interesting aspects of math development have been discovered. One is that even some nonhuman animals have a primitive awareness of numeracy, which means understanding the meaning of numbers, just as literacy means understanding the meaning of written words (Posner & Rothbart, 2007). Rats can be taught to discriminate between a two-tone and an eight-tone sequence, even when the sequences are matched in total duration. Monkeys can learn that the numbers 0 through 9 represent different quantities of rewards. In human infants the beginning of numeracy appears surprisingly early. When they are just 6 weeks old, if they are shown a toy behind a screen and see a second toy added, when the screen is then lowered they look longer and appear more surprised if one or three toys are revealed rather than the two toys they expected. From toddlerhood through middle childhood, the development of math skills follows a path parallel to the development of language and reading skills (Doherty & Landells, 2006). Children begin to count around age 2, the same age at which their language development accelerates dramatically. They begin to be able to do simple addition and subtraction around age 5, about the same age they often learn to read their first words. In the course of middle childhood, as they become more adept readers they typically advance in their math skills, moving from addition and subtraction to multiplication and division, and

305

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Teacher You work in a school with many Latino children who seem to want to share stories rather than work on their own. How might you adapt literacy training to these children’s inclinations?

Watch the Video Dyslexia Detector at MyDevelopmentLab

Watch the Video Hands-On Learning in Elementary Math at MyDevelopmentLab

whole-language approach method of teaching reading in which the emphasis is on the meaning of written language in whole passages, rather than breaking down words to their smallest components dyslexia learning disability that includes difficulty sounding out letters, difficulty learning to spell words, and a tendency to misperceive the order of letters in words learning disability cognitive disorder that impedes the development of learning a specific skill such as reading or math numeracy understanding of the meaning of numbers

306

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood increasing their speed of processing in response to math problems (Posner & Rothbart, 2007). Children who have problems learning to read frequently have problems mastering early math skills as well. Cultures vary in their timing and approach to teaching math skills to children, with consequences for the pace of children’s learning. One study compared 5-year-old children in China, Finland, and England (Aunio et al., 2008). The children in China scored highest, with children in Finland second, and the English children third. The authors related these variations to cultural differences in how math is taught and promoted. Children in China learn math beginning in preschool, and there is a strong cultural emphasis on math as an important basis of future learning and success. In contrast, English preschools usually make little attempt to teach children math skills, in the belief that they are not ready to learn math until they enter formal schooling. Most children learn math skills within school, but sometimes math skills can be learned effectively in a practical setting. In a study of Brazilian street children, Geoffrey Saxe (2002) found that in selling candy they worked out complex calculations of prices and profits. Some had attended school and some had not, and the ones who had been to school were more advanced in some math skills but not in the skills necessary for them to succeed in their candy selling on the street.

Street children may learn math from the transactions involving the objects they sell. Here, a boy sells candy in a park in Rio de Janeiro, Brazil.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What advances in children’s classification skills are evident during middle childhood? 2. How do American approaches to treating ADHD differ from European approaches? 3. What are some critiques of intelligence tests? 4. What are some explanations for the Flynn effect?

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

5. What is currently considered the best way to teach children to read?

Language Development In middle childhood, advances in language development may not be as noticeable as in the earliest years of life, but they are nevertheless dramatic. There are important advances in vocabulary, grammar, and pragmatics. Bilingual children face special challenges in language development but also benefit in some ways.

Vocabulary, Grammar, and Pragmatics

7.10

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Identify the advances in vocabulary, grammar, and pragmatics during middle childhood. Once they enter formal school at age 5–7 and begin reading, children’s vocabulary expands as never before, as they pick up new words not just from conversations but from books. At age 6 the average child knows about 10,000 words, but by age 10 or 11 this sum has increased fourfold, to about 40,000. Part of this growth comes from children’s growing abilities to understand the different forms words can take. A child who learns the meaning of calculate will also now understand calculating, calculated, calculation, and miscalculate (Anglin, 1993). The grammar of children’s language use becomes more complex in middle childhood. For example, they are more likely than younger children to use conditional sentences such as “If you let me play with that toy, I’ll share my lunch with you.”

Section 2 Cognitive Development

307

Another important aspect of language that improves in middle childhood is pragmatics, the social context and conventions of language. As noted in Chapter 6, even in early childhood children have begun to understand pragmatics. For example, they realize that what people say is not always just what they mean, and that interpretation is required. They understand that “How many times do I have to tell you not to feed the dog off your plate?” is not really a question. However, in middle childhood the understanding of pragmatics grows substantially. This can be seen vividly in children’s use of humor. A substantial amount of humor in middle childhood involves violating the expectations set by pragmatics. For example, here is an old joke that made my son Miles howl with laughter when he first learned it at age 8: Man: “Waiter, what’s that fly doing in my soup?” Waiter: “I believe he’s doing the backstroke, sir.” For this to be funny, you have to understand pragmatics. Specifically, you have to understand that by asking “What’s that fly doing in my soup?” the man means “What are you going to do about that disgusting fly floating in my soup?” The waiter, a bit slow on his pragmatics, interprets the man to mean, “What activity is that fly engaged in?” What makes it funny is that your understanding of pragmatics leads you to expect the first response, and the second response comes as a surprise. By substituting the expected pragmatic meaning of the question with an unexpected meaning, the joke creates a humorous effect (at least if you are 8 years old). Pragmatics are always culturally grounded, which is one reason why jokes don’t travel well between cultures. To know the pragmatics of a language, you have to know well the culture of the people using the language. For example, many languages have two forms of the word “you,” one form used when there is a close attachment (such as with family and close friends) and the other used with unfamiliar persons and persons with whom there is a professional but not personal relationship (such as employers or students). Knowing when and with whom to use each form of “you” requires extensive familiarity not just with the language but with the cultural norms for using the two forms in the appropriate social contexts.

Bilingualism Explain the consequences for cognitive development of growing up bilingual. A rising number of children around the world grow up knowing two languages, that is, they are bilingual. There are two main reasons for this trend. First, with increased migration between countries, children are more likely to be exposed early to two languages, one spoken at home and one spoken with friends, teachers, and others outside the home. Second, school systems increasingly seek to teach children a second language to enhance their ability to participate in the global economy. Because the United States is the most influential country in the world economy, English is the most common second language for children around the world. For example, in China all children now begin learning English in primary school (Chang, 2008). There are many bilingual families living within the United States as well, due to the large number of immigrants that have come to the U.S. in recent decades, and they speak a variety of languages (see Map 7.2 on page 308). As we have seen in previous chapters, children are marvelously well-suited to learning a language. But what happens when they try to learn two languages? Does learning two languages enhance their language development or impede it? For the most part, becoming bilingual is favorable to language development. When children learn two languages, they usually become adept at using both (Genessee, 2001). Learning a secondary language does not interfere with mastering the primary language (Lessow-Hurley, 2005). One minor problem that does arise is that in early childhood there is sometimes a tendency to intermix the syntax of the two languages. For example, in Spanish

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.11

Watch the Video Bilingual Family at MyDevelopmentLab

bilingual capable of using two languages

308

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

Map 7.2 s Bilingualism in the United States Which states have the highest percentage of bilingual families? How might this relate to the ethnic diversity that exists within these states (refer back to Map 1.1)?

WA VT

ND

MT

MN

OR ID

MI

7VSPZO 7VY[\N\LZL 0[HSPHU

PA

IA

NE

NV

IL

UT

CA

CO

KS

6[OLY 

OK

NM

WV

VA

KY

TX

:WHUPZO 

SC

During Soroya’s checkup, her American grandmother expresses concern that Soroya is being exposed to too many languages and won’t be able to speak any of them well. She’s learning Arabic from her mother, Turkish from her grandfather, and English from her father. What can you tell her?

Figure 7.7 s Age and Grammatical Knowledge The challenge of learning a second language rises with age. Source: Johnson & Newport (1989)

270 260 250 240 230 220 210 200 3-7

8-10 Age of arrival

AL

GA

LA FL

AK

HI

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse

NJ DE MD D.C.

NC

AR

Percentage of population who spoke a language other than English at home Less than 10%

Mean score

IN

MO

MS

9\ZZPHU 2VYLHU .LYTHU =PL[UHTLZL ;HNHSVN -YLUJO *OPULZL

Native

OH

TN AZ

NH MA RI CT

NY

WI

SD WY

3HUN\HNLZZWVRLUH[OVTL V[OLY[OHU,UNSPZO

ME

10– 19.9%

20– 29.9%

30% or more

dropping the subject in a sentence is grammatically correct, as in no quiero ir. However, if a child who is bilingual in Spanish applies this rule to English it comes out as no want go, which is not correct. By middle childhood, children can easily keep their two languages separate, although they may intentionally import some words from one language when speaking in the other, to create “Spanglish” (a blend of Spanish and English) or “Chinglish” (a blend of Chinese and English), for example. When children learn their second language after already becoming fluent in a first language, it takes longer to master the second language, usually 3–5 years (Hakuta, 1999). Even so, learning a second language comes much easier in early and middle childhood than it does at later ages. For example, in one study adults who had immigrated to the United States from China or Korea at various ages were tested on their grammatical knowledge of English (Johnson & Newport, 1991). The participants who had arrived in the United States in early or middle childhood scored as well on the test as native English speakers, but beyond those periods the older the age at immigration, the less the person’s grammatical knowledge (see Figure 7.7). Other studies have shown that beyond the age of about 12 it is difficult for people to learn a language well enough to sound like a native speaker, that is, to speak without a noticeable accent (Birdsong, 2006). Clearly, children have a biological readiness for learning a new language that adults lack, but the decline with age is gradual and steady from childhood to adulthood (DeKeyser & Larson-Hall, 2005; Hakuta et al., 2003). Becoming bilingual has a variety of benefits. Children who are bilingual have better metalinguistic skills than single-language children, meaning that they have greater awareness of the underlying structure of language (Schwartz et al., 2008). In one early study (Oren, 1981), researchers compared bilingual and single-language children ages 4–5 on metalanguage skills by instructing them to use nonsense words for familiar objects (e.g., dimp for dog, wug for car) and by asking them questions about the implications of changing object labels (if we call a dog a cow, does it give milk?). The bilingual children were consistently better than the single-language children in metalanguage understanding. Specifically, they were better at applying grammatical rules to nonsense words (one wug, two wugs) and at understanding that words are 11-15 17-39 symbols for objects (calling a dog a cow won’t make it give milk). Other

Section 2 Cognitive Development studies have confirmed that bilingual children are better than single-language children at detecting mistakes in grammar and meaning (Bialystok, 1993, 1997). Bilingual children also score higher on more general measures of cognitive ability, such as analytical reasoning, cognitive flexibility, and cognitive complexity, indicating that becoming bilingual also has general cognitive benefits (Bialystok, 1999, 2001; Swanson et al., 2004). In some countries, such as India, many children are not just bilingual but multilingual. Indian children first learn their local language, of which there are over a thousand across India (MacKenzie, 2009). Then they learn Hindi, which is the official national language, and many also learn English as well, in order to participate in the global economy. Studies indicate that by middle childhood, Indian children exposed to multiple languages use their different languages effectively in different contexts (Bhargava & Mendiratta, 2007). For example, they might use their local language at home, Hindi with friends at school, and English in their school work. However, language diversity can be an obstacle to learning for children who come to school knowing only their local language and are then faced with a school curriculum that is entirely in a new and unfamiliar language (MacKenzie, 2009). Currently, some Indian schools are changing their curriculum in the early school years to the local language before introducing Hindi or English, but others are emphasizing English from the outset of schooling in an effort to prepare children for participation in the global economy.

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED? 1. What explains the huge growth in vocabulary during middle childhood?

metalinguistic skills in the understanding of language, skills that reflect awareness of the underlying structure of language multilingual capable of using three or more languages

Many Indian children learn several languages.

2. What does a child’s use of humor tell us about his or her language development? 3. What are some of the benefits of becoming bilingual? 4. What does it mean to be multilingual? Give an example of a culture where this is the case.

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

Section 2 VIDEO GUIDE School and Education in Middle Childhood Across Cultures (Length: 6:49) This video contains several interviews from various countries with children and a teacher discussing experiences with education and schooling.

1. What common educational threads do you see among the individuals in this video? 2. If you did not know that the teacher in this video was from Africa, would you think (based on her responses) that she could have been discussing teaching in the U.S.? 3. What are your thoughts on the American mother’s comments that it “takes a village” to raise a child?

Watch the Video School and Education in Middle Childhood Across Cultures at MyDevelopmentLab

309

SECTION 3 EMOTIONAL AND SOCIAL DEVELOPMENT LEARNING OBJECTIVES 7.12 Describe the main features of emotional self-regulation and understanding in middle childhood and how other life stages compare. 7.13 Explain how different ways of thinking about the self are rooted in cultural beliefs, and summarize how self-concept and self-esteem change in middle childhood. 7.14 Describe how beliefs and behavior regarding gender change in middle childhood, including cultural variations. 7.15 Explain the distinctive features of family relations in middle childhood, and describe the consequences of parental divorce and remarriage. 7.16 Explain the main basis of friendships in middle childhood, and describe the four categories of peer social status and the dynamics between bullies and victims. 7.17 Summarize the international variations in school enrollment during middle childhood, and compare and contrast the school socialization practices of Eastern and Western cultures. 7.18 Describe the kinds of work children do in middle childhood, and explain why work patterns differ between developed and developing countries. 7.19 Summarize the rates of daily TV-watching among children worldwide, and describe the positive and negative effects of television, especially the hazards related to TV violence.

Emotional and Self-Development Children advance in their emotional self-regulation in middle childhood and experience relatively few emotional extremes. They grow in their self-understanding, and their self-esteem is generally high, although it depends on cultural context. They grow in their understanding of gender roles, too, but in some respects they become more rigid about those roles.

Smooth Sailing: Advances in Emotional Self-Regulation

7.12

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Experience Sampling Method (ESM) research method that involves having people wear beepers, usually for a period of 1 week; when they are beeped at random times during the day, they record a variety of characteristics of their experience at that moment

310

Describe the main features of emotional self-regulation and understanding in middle childhood and how other life stages compare. Middle childhood is in some ways a golden age emotionally, a time of high well-being and relatively low volatility. In infancy, toddlerhood, and even early childhood, there are many emotional highs, but plenty of emotional lows, too. Outbursts of crying and anger are fairly frequent in the early years of life, but by middle childhood the frequency of such negative emotions has declined substantially (Shipman et al., 2003). Negative emotions will rise again in adolescence, as we will see in the Chapter 8, but during middle childhood most days are free of any negative emotional extremes. One valuable source of information about emotions in middle childhood is research using the Experience Sampling Method (ESM) pioneered by Reed Larson and his colleagues (Larson & Richards, 1994; Larson et al., 2002; Richards et al., 2002). The ESM involves having people wear wristwatch beepers that randomly beep during the day so that people can record their thoughts, feelings, and behavior. Each time they are “beeped,” participants rate the degree to which they currently feel happy to unhappy, cheerful to irritable, and friendly to angry, as well as how hurried, tired, and competitive they are

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development feeling. The focus of Larson’s research has been on adolescence, so we’ll discuss the ESM method in more detail in Chapter 8, but some of his research has included middle childhood in order to chart the emotional changes that take place from middle childhood to adolescence. The overall conclusion of ESM research with regard to middle childhood is that it is time of remarkable contentment and emotional stability (Larson & Richards, 1994). When beeped, children in middle childhood report being “very happy” 28% of the time, a far higher percentage than for adolescents or adults. Children at this age mostly have “quite enjoyable lives” in which they “bask in a kind of naïve happiness” (Larson & Richards, 1994, p. 85). Sure, they are sad or angry occasionally, but it is almost always due to something concrete and immediate such as getting scolded by a parent or losing a game, “events that pass quickly and are forgotten” (p.85). Emotional self-regulation improves from early childhood to middle childhood in part because the environment requires it (Rubin, 2000). Middle childhood is often a time of moving into new contexts: primary school, civic organizations (such as the Boy Scouts and Girl Scouts), sports teams, and music groups. All of these contexts make demands for emotional self-regulation. Children are required to do what they are told (whether they feel like it or not), to wait their turn, and to cooperate with others. Expressions of emotional extremes are disruptive to the functioning of the group and are discouraged. Most children are capable of meeting these demands by middle childhood. Emotional understanding also advances from early to middle childhood. Children become better able to understand both their own and others’ emotions. They become aware that they can experience two contradictory emotions at once, an emotional state known as ambivalence, for example being both happy (because my team won the game) and sad (because my best friend was on the losing team) (Pons et al., 2003). They also learn how to conceal their emotions intentionally (Saarni, 1999). This allows them to show a socially acceptable emotion such as gratitude when, for example, they open a birthday present they didn’t really want. In Asian cultures, children in middle childhood learn the concept of “face,” which means showing to others the appropriate and expected emotion regardless of how you actually feel (Han, 2011). In the same way that children become able to suppress or conceal their own true emotions, they come to understand that other people may display emotional expressions that do not indicate what they actually feel (Saarni, 1999). Children’s understanding of others’ emotions is also reflected in increased capacity for empathy (Hoffman, 2000). By middle childhood, children become better cognitively at perspective-taking, and the ability to understand how others view events fosters the ability to understand how they feel, too.

311

Middle childhood is an exceptionally happy time of life.

Self-Understanding Explain how different ways of thinking about the self are rooted in cultural beliefs, and summarize how self-concept and self-esteem change in middle childhood.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.13

Sociologist George Herbert Mead (1934) made a distinction between what he called the I-self (how we believe others view us) and the me-self (how we view ourselves). Both the I-self and the me-self change in important ways in middle childhood. We discuss the me-self first, then the I-self, then we look at the cultural basis of conceptions of the self. SELF-CONCEPT Our self-concept, that is, how we view and evaluate ourselves, changes during middle childhood from the external to the internal and from the physical to the psychological (Lerner et al., 2005; Marsh & Ayotte, 2003; Rosenberg, 1979). Up until the age of 7 or 8, most children describe themselves mainly in terms of external, concrete,

ambivalence emotional state of experiencing two contradictory emotions at once self-concept person’s perception and evaluation of him- or herself

312

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

In middle childhood, children become more accurate in comparing themselves to others.

Watch the Video Black Doll White Doll at MyDevelopmentLab

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Therapist You are seeing Hiroki, a lively Japanese boy who appears to be having selfesteem problems related to his school work. How might you help him in his school work and encourage his parents to support his efforts?

social comparison how persons view themselves in relation to others with regard to status, abilities, or achievements self-esteem person’s overall sense of worth and well-being

physical characteristics. (“My name is Mona. I’m 7 years old. I have brown eyes and short black hair. I have two little brothers.”) They may mention specific possessions (“I have a red bicycle.”) and activities they like (“I like to dance.” “I like to play sports.”) In the course of middle childhood, they add more internal, psychological, personality-related traits to their self-descriptions. (“I’m shy.” “I’m friendly.” “I try to be helpful.”). They may also mention characteristics that are not me. (“I don’t like art.” “I’m not very good at math.”) Toward the end of middle childhood their descriptions become more complex, as they recognize that they may be different on different occasions (Harter, 2003). (“Mostly I’m easy to get along with, but sometimes I lose my temper.”) Another important change in self-concept in middle childhood is that children engage in more accurate social comparison, in which they describe themselves in relation to others (Guest, 2007). A 6-year-old might describe himself by saying, “I’m really good at math,” whereas a 9-year-old might say “I’m better than most kids at math, although there are a couple of kids in my class who are a little better.” These social comparisons reflect advances in the cognitive ability of seriation, discussed earlier in the chapter. In the same way that children learn how to arrange sticks accurately from shortest to tallest in middle childhood, they also learn to rank themselves more accurately in abilities relative to other children. The age grading of schools promotes social comparisons, as it places children in a setting where they spend most of a typical day around other children their age. Teachers compare them to one another by giving them grades, and they notice who is relatively good and relatively not so good at reading, math, and so on. SELF-ESTEEM Self-esteem is a person’s overall sense of worth and well-being. A great deal has been written and discussed about self-esteem in American society in the past 50 years. Even among Western countries, Americans value high self-esteem to a greater extent than people in other countries, and the gap between Americans and non-Western countries in this respect is especially great (Triandis, 1995). For example, in traditional Japanese culture, self-criticism is a virtue and high self-esteem is a character problem (Heine et al., 1999). The belief in the value of high self-esteem is part of American individualism (Bellah et al., 1985; Rychlak, 2003). Self-esteem declines slightly in the transition from early childhood to middle childhood, as children enter a school environment in which social comparisons are a daily experience (Lerner et al., 2005; Wigfield et al., 1997). The decline is mild, and simply reflects children’s more realistic appraisal of their abilities as they compare themselves to others and are rated by teachers. For the rest of middle childhood, overall self-esteem is high for most children, reflecting the generally positive emotional states mentioned earlier. In Western countries, having low self-esteem in middle childhood is related to anxiety, depression, and antisocial behavior (Robins et al., 2001). An important change in self-esteem in middle childhood is that it becomes more differentiated. In addition to overall self-esteem, children have self-concepts for several specific areas, including academic competence, social competence, athletic competence, and physical appearance (Harter, 2003; Marsh & Ayotte, 2003). Within each of these areas, selfconcept is differentiated into sub-areas. For example, children may see themselves as good at baseball but not basketball, while also having an overall high or low evaluation of their athletic competence. Children combine their different areas of self-concept into an overall level of selfesteem. For most children and adolescents, physical appearance is the strongest contributor to overall self-esteem (Harter, 2003; Klomsten et al., 2004). However, in other areas, children’s self-concept contributes to overall self-esteem only if they value doing well in that area. For example, a child may be no good at sports, but not care about sports, in which case low athletic self-concept would have no effect on overall self-esteem.

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development CULTURE AND THE SELF The conception of the self that children have by middle childhood varies substantially among cultures. In discussing cultural differences in conceptions of the self scholars typically distinguish between the independent self promoted by individualistic cultures and the interdependent self promoted by collectivistic cultures (Cross & Gore, 2003; Markus & Kitayama, 1991; Shweder et al., 2006). Cultures that promote an independent, individualistic self also promote and encourage reflection about the self. In such cultures it is seen as a good thing to think about yourself, to consider who you are as an independent person, and to think highly of yourself (within certain limits, of course—no culture values selfishness or egocentrism). Americans are especially known for their individualism and their focus on self-oriented issues. It was an American who first invented the term self-esteem (William James, in the late 19th century), and the United States continues to be known to the rest of the world as a place where the independent self is valued and promoted (Green et al., 2005; Triandis, 1995). However, not all cultures look at the self in this way or value the self to the same extent. In collectivistic cultures, an interdependent conception of the self prevails. In these cultures, the interests of the group—the family, the kinship group, the ethnic group, the nation, the religious institution—are supposed to come first, before the needs of the individual. This means that it is not necessarily a good thing, in these cultures, to think highly of yourself. People who think highly of themselves, who possess a high level of self-esteem, threaten the harmony of the group because they may be inclined to pursue their personal interests regardless of the interests of the groups to which they belong. Cultural variations in views of the self influence approaches to parenting. Parents in most places and times have been more worried that their children would become too selfish than that they would have low self-esteem. As a result, parents have discouraged self-inflation as part of family socialization (LeVine, 2008). However, this kind of parenting works differently if it is part of a cultural norm than if it is an exception within a culture. For example, children from Asian cultures are discouraged from valuing the self highly, yet they generally have high levels of academic performance and low levels of psychological problems (Twenge & Crocker, 2002). In contrast, children within the American majority culture who are exposed to parenting that is critical and negative show negative effects such as depression and poor academic performance (Bender et al., 2007; DeHart et al., 2006). It may be that children in Asian cultures learn to expect criticism if they show signs of high self-esteem, and they see this as normal in comparison to other children, whereas American children learn to expect frequent praise, and hence they suffer more if their parents are more critical than the parents of their peers (Rudy & Grusec, 2006). It should be added that most cultures are not purely either independent or interdependent in their conceptions of the self, but have elements of each (Killen & Wainryb, 2000). Also, with globalization, many cultures that have a tradition of interdependence are changing toward a more independent view of the self (Arnett, 2002).

313

THINKING CULTURALLY Based on what you have learned so far in this book, what would you say are the economic reasons traditional cultures would promote an interdependent self?

Gender Development Describe how beliefs and behavior regarding gender change in middle childhood, including cultural variations. As described in Chapter 6, cultural beliefs about gender become well established by the end of early childhood. Gender roles become even more sharply divided during middle childhood. In traditional cultures, the daily activities of men and women are very different, and the activities of boys and girls become more differentiated in middle childhood as they begin to take part in their parents’ work. In the human past, and still today in many developing countries, men have been responsible for hunting, fishing, caring for domestic animals, and fighting off animal and human attackers (Gilmore, 1990). Women have been

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.14

In developing countries, the kinds of work children and adults do is often divided strictly by gender. Here, a girl in Mozambique helps prepare cassava, a local food.

responsible for caring for young children, tending the crops, food preparation, and running the household (Shlegel & Barry, 1991). During middle childhood, boys increasingly learn to do what men do and girls increasingly learn to do what women do. Boys and girls not only learn gender-specific tasks in middle childhood, they are socialized to develop personality characteristics that enhance performance on those tasks: independence and toughness, for boys, and nurturance and compliance for girls. In an early study of 110 traditional cultures, boys and girls were socialized to develop these genderspecific traits in virtually all cultures (Barry et al., 1957). More recent analyses of gender socialization in traditional cultures have found that these patterns persist (Banerjee, 2005; LeVine, 2008). In modern developed countries, too, children’s gender attitudes and behavior become more stereotyped in middle childhood. Children increasingly view personality traits as associated with one gender or the other rather than both. Traits such as “gentle” and “dependent” become increasingly viewed as feminine, and traits such as “ambitious” and “dominant” become increasingly viewed as masculine (Best, 2001; Heyman & Legare, 2004). Both boys and girls come to see occupations they associate with men (such as firefighter or astronomer) as having higher status than occupations they associate with women (such as nurse or librarian) (Liben et al., 2001). Furthermore, children increasingly perceive some school subjects as boys’ areas (such as math and science) and others as girls’ areas (such as reading and art) (Guay et al., 2010; Jacobs & Wiesz, 1994). Teachers may bring gender biases into the classroom, perhaps unknowingly, in ways that influence children’s perceptions of which areas are gender-appropriate for them (Sadker & Sadker, 1994). Accordingly, boys come to feel more competent than girls at math and science and girls come to feel more competent than boys at verbal skills—even when they have equal abilities in these areas (Hong et al., 2003). Socially, children become even more gender-segregated in their play groups in middle childhood than they were in early childhood. In traditional cultures, gender-segregated play is a consequence of the gender-specific work boys and girls are each doing by middle childhood. In the 12-culture analysis by Whiting and Edwards (1988; see Chapter 6, page 267), same-gender play groups rose from a proportion of 30–40% at age 2–3 to 94% by age 8–11. However, the same pattern is true in developed countries where boys and girls are in the same schools engaged in the same daily activities (McHale et al., 2003). When boys’ and girls’ play groups do interact in middle childhood, it tends to be in a manner that is at once quasi-romantic and antagonistic, such as playing a game in which the girls chase the boys, or tossing mild insults at each other like the one my daughter Paris came home chanting one day at age 7: GIRLS go to COllege to get more KNOWledge. BOYS go to JUpiter to get more STUpider.

Why are interactions between boys and girls often quasi-romantic and antagonistic in middle childhood?

314

Thorne (1986) calls this kind of gender play “border work” and sees its function as clarifying gender boundaries during middle childhood. It can also be seen as the first tentative step toward the romantic relations that will develop in adolescence. In terms of their gender self-perceptions, boys and girls head in different directions in middle childhood (Banerjee, 2005). Boys increasingly describe themselves in terms of “masculine” traits (Serbin et al., 1993). They become more likely to avoid activities that might be considered feminine, because their peers become increasingly intolerant of anything that threatens to cross gender boundaries (Blakemore, 2003). In contrast, girls become more likely to attribute “masculine” characteristics such as “forceful” and “selfreliant” to themselves in the course of middle childhood. They do not become less likely to describe themselves as having “feminine” traits such as “warm” and “compassionate,” but they add “masculine” traits to their self-perceptions. Similarly, they become more likely during middle childhood to consider future occupations usually associated with men, whereas boys become less likely to consider future occupation associated with women (Liben & Bigler, 2002).

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

WHAT HAVE YOU LEARNED?

315

Study and Review at MyDevelopmentLab

1. What kinds of emotional changes accompany the move into new contexts that often occurs in middle childhood? 2. What characterizes the interdependent conception of the self that is prevalent in collectivistic cultures? 3. Why is there such a sharp division of gender roles during middle childhood in traditional cultures? 4. How do boys and girls differ in their self-perceptions during middle childhood?

The Social and Cultural Contexts of Middle Childhood There is both continuity and change in social contexts from early to middle childhood. Nearly all children remain within a family context, although the composition of the family may change in some cultures due to parents’ divorce or remarriage. A new social context is added, as children in nearly all cultures begin formal schooling when they enter this life stage. For children in developing countries today, middle childhood may also mean entering a work setting such as a factory. In all countries, media have become an important socialization context, especially television.

Family Relations Explain the distinctive features of family relations in middle childhood, and describe the consequences of parental divorce and remarriage. Middle childhood represents a key turning point in family relations. Up until that time, children in all cultures need, and receive, a great deal of care and supervision, from parents and older siblings and sometimes from extended family members. They lack sufficient emotional and behavioral self-regulation to be on their own for even a short period of time. However, in middle childhood they become much more capable of going about their daily activities without constant monitoring and control by others. From early childhood to middle childhood, parents and children move away from direct parental control and toward coregulation, in which parents provide broad guidelines for behavior but children are capable of a substantial amount of independent, self-directed behavior (Maccoby, 1984; McHale et al., 2003). Parents continue to provide assistance and instruction, and they continue to know where their children are and what they are doing nearly all the time, but there is less need for direct, moment-to-moment monitoring. This pattern applies across cultures. In developed countries, studies have shown that children spend substantially less time with their parents in middle childhood than in early childhood (Parke, 2004). Children respond more to parents’ rules and reasoning, due to advances in cognitive development and self-regulation, and parents in turn use more explanation and less physical punishment (Collins et al., 2002; Parke, 2004). Parents begin to give their children simple daily chores such as making their own beds in the morning and setting the table for dinner. In traditional cultures, parents and children also move toward coregulation in middle childhood. Children have learned family rules and routines by middle childhood and will often carry out their family duties without having to be told or urged by their parents (Weisner, 1996). Also, children are allowed to play and explore further from home once

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.15

coregulation relationship between parents and children in which parents provide broad guidelines for behavior but children are capable of a substantial amount of independent, self-directed behavior

316

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

Sibling conflict remains high during middle childhood.

Watch the Video A Family with Two Fathers at MyDevelopmentLab

Poverty is common in single-parent families.

they reach middle childhood (Whiting & Edwards, 1988). Boys are allowed more of this freedom than girls are, in part because girls are assigned more daily responsibilities in middle childhood. However, girls also are allowed more scope for independent activity in middle childhood. For example, in the Mexican village described by Beverly Chinas (1992), when they reach middle childhood girls have responsibility for going to the village market each day to sell the tortillas they and their mothers have made that morning. By middle childhood they are capable of going to the market without an adult to monitor them, and they are also capable of making the monetary calculations required in selling the tortillas and providing change. Sibling relationships also change in middle childhood. Children with an older sibling often benefit from the sibling’s help with academic, peer, and parent issues (Brody, 2004). Both older and young siblings benefit from mutual companionship and assistance. However, the sibling rivalry and jealousy mentioned in Chapter 6 continues in middle childhood. In fact, sibling conflict peaks in middle childhood (Cole & Kerns, 2001). In one study that recorded episodes of conflict between siblings, the average frequency of conflict was once every 20 minutes they were together (Kramer et al., 1999). The most common source of conflict is personal possessions (McGuire et al., 2000). Sibling conflict is especially high when one sibling perceives the other as receiving more affection and material resources from the parents (Dunn, 2004). Other factors contributing to sibling conflict are family financial stress and parents’ marital conflict (Jenkins et al., 2003). DIVERSE FAMILY FORMS Children worldwide grow up in a wide variety of family environments. Some children have parents who are married while others are in single-parent, divorced, or blended families; some children are raised by heterosexual parents while others are raised by gay or lesbian parents; and still others live with extended family members or in multigenerational families. Some are adopted or live with relatives other than their parents. Gay couples are now allowed to adopt children in some American states and some European countries, and lesbian couples often adopt children or become artificially inseminated. In the latest U.S. census, over 20% of gay couples and one-third of lesbian couples were living with children, a dramatic increase over the past 20 years (U.S. Bureau of the Census, 2010). Studies of the children of gay and lesbian couples have found that they are highly similar to other children (Goldberg, 2010; Patterson, 2002). In adolescence nearly all are heterosexual, despite the homosexual model their parents provide (Hyde & DeLamater, 2005). Over the past 50 years, it has become increasingly common in some countries for children to be born to a single mother. The United States is one of the countries where the increase has been greatest. Single motherhood has increased among both Whites and African Americans, but is now highest among African Americans; over 70% of African American children are born to a single mother (U.S. Bureau of the Census, 2010). Rates of single motherhood are also high in northern Europe (Lestaeghe & Moors, 2000). However, it is more likely in northern Europe than in the United States for the father to be in the home as well, even though the mother and father may not be married. If we combine those children born to single mothers with those living with a single parent as a result of divorce, fewer than half of American children live with both biological parents throughout their entire childhood (Harvey & Fine, 2004). What are the consequences of growing up with in a single-parent household? Because there is only one parent to carry out household responsibilities such as cooking and cleaning, children in single-parent households often contribute a great deal to the functioning of the family, much like their counterparts in traditional cultures. However, the most important consequence of growing up in a single-parent family is that it greatly increases the likelihood of growing up in poverty, and growing up in poverty, in turn, has a range of negative

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development effects on children (Harvey & Fine, 2004). Children in single-parent families generally are at higher risk for behavior problems and low school achievement when compared to their peers in two-parent families (Ricciuti, 2004). Single-parent families are diverse, and many children who grow up in single-parent families function very well. When the mother makes enough money so the family is not in poverty, children in single-parent families function as well as children in two-parent families (Lipman et al., 2002). Single-father families are relatively rare, but children with a single father are no different than their peers in middle childhood on social and academic functioning (Amato, 2000). It should also be noted that having a single parent does not always mean there is only one adult in the household. In many African American families the grandmother is highly involved and provides child care, household help, and financial support to the single mother (Crowther & Rodrigues, 2003). In about one-fourth of families with an African American single mother, the grandmother also lives in the household (Lee et al., 2005).

317

family process quality of the relationships between family members

APPLYING YOUR KNOWLEDGE . . . as a Nurse A Filipino widow comes to your clinic with her twins, concerned that their father is not in their lives, but happy that they live with her parents, the twins’ grandparents, who help with their care. What can you tell her?

Sw

ed Un F en i n i Un te la ite d S nd Cz d K tat ec ing es h do Re m p G ubl er ic m a Fr ny an Ca ce n Hu ada Sw ng itz ary er la Po nd la G nd re ec Sp e ain Isr ae l Ita ly

Percent of marriages ending in divorce

CHILDREN’S RESPONSES TO DIVORCE Rates of divorce have risen dramatically over the past half century in the United States, Canada, and northern Europe. Currently, close to half of children in many of these countries experience their parents’ divorce by the time they reach middle childhood (see Figure 7.8). In contrast, divorce remains rare in southern Watch the Video Pam: Divorced Europe and in non-Western countries. Mother of Nine-Year-Old How do children respond to their parents’ divorce? A wealth of American and Euat MyDevelopmentLab ropean research has addressed this question, including several excellent longitudinal studies. Overall, children respond negatively in a variety of ways, especially boys and especially in the first 2 years following divorce. Children display increases in both externalizing problems (such as unruly behavior and conflict with mothers, siblings, peers, THINKING CULTURALLY and teachers) and internalizing problems (such as depressed mood, anxieties, phobias, What patterns do you see among the and sleep disturbances) (see Chapter 6; Amato, 2000; Clarke-Stewart & Brentano, 2006). European countries shown in Figure If the divorce takes place during early childhood, children often blame themselves, but 7.8? What hypothesis would you by middle childhood most children are less egocentric and more capable of understandpropose to explain the patterns? ing that their parents may have reasons for divorcing that have nothing to do with them (Hetherington & Kelly, 2002). 60 In one renowned longitudinal study of divorces that took place when the children were in middle childhood, the researchers classified 55 25% of the children in divorced families as having severe emotional 50 or behavioral problems, compared to 10% of children in two-parent 45 nondivorced families (Hetherington & Kelly, 2002). The low point for most children came 1 year after divorce. After that point, most children 40 gradually improved in functioning, and by 2 years post-divorce, girls 35 were mostly back to normal. However, boys’ problems were still evi30 dent even 5 years after divorce. Problems continue for some children into adolescence, and new consequences appear, as we shall see in the 25 Chapter 8. 20 Not all children react negatively to divorce. Even if 25% have severe 15 problems, that leaves 75% who do not. What factors influence how a divorce will affect children? Increasingly researchers have focused on 10 family process, that is, the quality of the relationships between family 5 members before, during, and after the divorce. In all families, whether 0 divorced or not, parental conflict is linked to children’s emotional and behavioral problems (Kelly & Emery, 2003). When parents divorce with minimal conflict, or when parents are able to keep their conflicts private, children show far fewer problems (Amato, 2006). If divorce results in a transition from a high-conflict household to a low-conflict house- Figure 7.8 s Divorce Rates, Selected Countries In many countries hold, children’s functioning often improves rather than deteriorates divorce rates have risen in recent decades. (Davies et al., 2002). Based on: http://www.divorcemag.com/statistics/statsWorld.shtml

Relationships between mothers and sons sometimes go downhill following divorce.

Watch the Video Divorce and Co-parenting at MyDevelopmentLab

coercive cycle pattern in relations between parents and children in which children’s disobedient behavior evokes harsh responses from parents, which in turn makes children even more resistant to parental control, evoking even harsher responses divorce mediation arrangement in which a professional mediator meets with divorcing parents to help them negotiate an agreement that both will find acceptable stepfamily family with children in which one of the parents is not biologically related to the children but has married a parent who is biologically related to the children

318

Another aspect of family process is children’s relationship to the mother after divorce. Mothers often struggle in numerous ways following divorce (Wallerstein & Johnson-Reitz, 2004). In addition to the emotional stress of the divorce and conflict with ex-husbands, they now have full responsibility for household tasks and child care. There is increased financial stress, with the father’s income no longer coming directly into the household. Most countries have laws requiring fathers to contribute to the care of their children after leaving the household, but despite these laws mothers often receive less than full child support from their ex-husbands (Children’s Defense Fund, 2005; Statistics Canada, 2010). Given this pile-up of stresses, it is not surprising that the mother’s parenting often takes a turn for the worse in the aftermath of divorce, becoming less warm, less consistent, and more punitive (Hetherington & Kelly, 2002). Relationships between boys and their mothers are especially likely to go downhill after divorce. Mothers and boys sometimes become sucked into a coercive cycle following divorce, in which boys’ less compliant behavior evokes harsh responses from mothers, which in turn makes boys even more resistant to their mothers’ control, evoking even harsher responses, and so on (Patterson, 2002). However, when the mother is able to maintain a healthy balance of warmth and control despite the stresses, her children’s response to divorce is likely to be less severe (Leon, 2003). Family processes involving fathers are also important in the aftermath of divorce. In about 90% of cases (across countries) mothers retain custody of the children, so the father leaves the household and the children no longer see him on a daily basis. They may stay with him every weekend or every other weekend, and perhaps see him one evening during the week, in addition to talking to him on the phone. Now fathers must get used to taking care of the children on their own, without mothers present, and children must get used to two households that may have two different sets of rules. For most children, contact with the father diminishes over time, and only 35–40% of children in mother-custody families still have at least weekly contact with their fathers within a few years of the divorce (Kelly, 2003). When the father remarries, as most do, his contact with children from the first marriage declines steeply (Dunn, 2002). However, when fathers remain involved and loving, children have fewer post-divorce problems (Dunn et al., 2004; Finley & Schwartz, 2010). In recent decades, divorce mediation has developed as a way of minimizing the damage to children that may take place due to heightened parental conflict during and after divorce (Emery et al., 2005; Sbarra & Emery, 2008). In divorce mediation, a professional mediator meets with divorcing parents to help them negotiate an agreement that both will find acceptable. Research has shown that mediation can settle a large percentage of cases otherwise headed for court and lead to better functioning in children following divorce and improved relationships between divorced parents and their children, even 12 years after the settlement (Emery et al., 2005). OUT OF THE FRYING PAN: CHILDREN’S RESPONSES TO REMARRIAGE Most adults who divorce remarry. Consequently, most children who experience their parents’ divorce spend part of their childhood in a stepfamily. Because mothers retain custody of the children in about 90% of divorces, most stepfamilies involve the entrance of a stepfather into the family. You might expect that the entrance of a stepfather would be a positive development in most cases, given the problems that face mother-headed families following divorce. Low income is a problem, and when the stepfather comes into the family this usually means a rise in overall family income. Mothers’ stress over handling all the household and child care responsibilities is a problem, and after a stepfather enters the family he can share some of the load. Mothers’ emotional well-being is a problem, and her well-being is typically enhanced by remarriage, at least initially (Visher et al., 2003). If mothers’ lives improve in all these ways, their children’s lives must improve, too, right? Unfortunately, no. Frequently, children take a turn for the worse once a stepfather enters the family. Compared to children in nondivorced families, children in stepfamilies have lower academic achievement, lower self-esteem, and greater behavioral problems

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

319

(Coleman et al., 2000; Nicholson et al., 2008). According to one estimate, about 20% of children in stepfamilies have serious problems in at least one aspect of functioning in middle childhood, compared to 10% of their peers in nondivorced families (Hetherington & Kelly, 2002). Girls respond more negatively than boys to remarriage, a reversal of their responses to divorce (Bray, 1999). If the stepfather also has children of his own that he brings into the household, making a blended stepfamily, the outcomes for children are even worse than in other stepfamilies (Hetherington & Kelly, 2002). There are a number of reasons for children’s negative responses to remarriage. First, remarriage represents another disruption that requires adjustment, usually at a point when the family had begun to stabilize following the earlier disruption of divorce (Hetherington & Stanley-Hagan, 2002). Second, stepfathers may be perceived by children as coming in between them and their mothers, especially by girls, who may have become closer to their mothers following divorce (Bray, 1999). Third, and perhaps most importantly, children may resent and resist their stepfathers’ attempts to exercise authority and discipline (Robertson, 2008). Stepfathers may be attempting to support the mother in parenting and to fulfill the family role of father, but children may refuse to regard him as a “real” father and may in fact regard him as taking their biological father’s rightful place (Weaver & Coleman, 2010). When asked to draw a picture of their families, many children in stepfamilies literally leave their stepfathers out of the picture (Stafford, 2004). However, it is important to add that here as elsewhere, family process counts for as much as family structure. Many stepfathers and stepchildren form harmonious, close relationships (Coleman et al., 2000). The likelihood of this outcome is enhanced if the stepfather is warm and open to his stepchildren and does not immediately try to assert stern authority (Visher et al., 2003). Also, the younger the children are, the more open they tend to be to accepting the stepfather (Jeynes, 2007). The likelihood of conflict between stepfathers and stepchildren increases with the children’s age from early childhood to middle childhood and again from middle childhood to adolescence (Hetherington & Kelly, 2002).

Friends and Peers Explain the main basis of friendships in middle childhood, and describe the four categories of peer social status and the dynamics between bullies and victims.

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.16

Friends rise in importance from early childhood to middle childhood, as greater freedom of movement allows children to visit and play with friends. Also, the entrance into formal schooling takes children away from the family social environment and places them in an environment where they spend a substantial amount of most days around many other children of similar age. Daily contact with other children makes it possible for them to develop friendships. In this discussion of friends and peers we will first examine the characteristics of friendships in middle childhood, then look at popularity and bullying in peer groups.

Watch the Video Parental Control of Friendships in India at MyDevelopmentLab

MAKING FRIENDS Why do children become friends with some peers but not others? An abundance of research over several decades has shown that the main basis of friendship is similarity, not just during middle childhood but at all ages (Rubin et al., 2008). People tend to prefer being around others who are like themselves, a principle called selective association (Popp et al., 2008). We have already seen how gender is an especially important basis of selective association in middle childhood. Boys tend to play with boys and girls with girls, more than at either younger or older ages. Other important criteria for selective association in middle childhood are sociability, aggression, and academic orientation (Hartup, 1996). Sociable kids are attracted to each other as friends, as are shy kids; aggressive kids tend to form friendships with each other, as do kids who refrain from aggression; kids who care a lot about school tend to become friends, and so do kids who dislike school.

selective association in social relations, the principle that people tend to prefer being around others who are like themselves

320

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

Trust becomes more important to friendships in middle childhood.

Although selective association is an important basis of friendship at all ages, over the course of childhood friendships change in other ways. An important change from early to middle childhood is in the relative balance of activities and trust (Rubin et al., 2008). Friendships in early childhood are based mainly on shared activities. Your friends are the kids who like to do the same things you like to do. Consequently, young children usually claim they have lots of friends, and their friends are more or less interchangeable. If you like to ride bikes, whoever is available to ride bikes with you is your friend; if you like to play with plastic action figures, your friend is whoever happens to be available to play a game with you involving those action figures. When they describe their friends, young children talk mainly about their shared activities (Damon, 1983; Rubin et al., 2008). In middle childhood, shared activities are still an important part of friendships, but now trust, too, becomes important. Children name fewer of their peers as friends, and friendships last longer, often several years (Rose & Asher, 1999). Your friends are kids who not only like to do things you like to do, but also whom you can rely on to be nice to you almost all the time, and whom you can trust with information you would not reveal to just anyone. In one study of children in Grades 3 to 6, the expectation that a friend would keep a secret increased from 25% to 72% across that age span among girls; among boys the increase came later and did not rise as high (Azmitia et al., 1998). This finding reflects a more general gender difference found in many other studies, that girls prize trust in middle childhood friendships more than boys do, and that boys’ friendships focus more on shared activities, although for both genders trust is more important in middle childhood than in early childhood (Rubin et al., 2008). As trust becomes more important to friendships in middle childhood, breaches of trust (such as breaking a promise or failing to provide help when needed ) also become the main reason for ending friendships (Hartup & Abecassis, 2004). PLAYING WITH FRIENDS Even though trust becomes a more important part of friendship in early childhood, friends continue to enjoy playing together in shared activities. Recall from Chapter 6 that play in early childhood most often takes the form of simple social play or cooperative pretend play. These types of play continue in middle childhood. For example, children might play with dolls or action figures together, or they might pretend to be superheroes or animals. What is new about play in middle childhood is that it becomes more complex and more rule-based. Children in early childhood may play with action figures, but in middle childhood there may be elaborate rules about the powers and limitations of the characters. For example, Japanese games involving Pokemon action figures are popular in middle childhood play worldwide, especially among boys (Ogletree et al., 2004). These games involve characters with an elaborate range of powers and provide children with the enjoyment of competition and mastering complex information and rules. In early childhood the information about the characters would be too abundant and the rules too complex for children to follow, but by middle childhood this cognitive challenge is exciting and pleasurable. In addition to games such as Pokemon, many of the games with rules that children play in middle childhood are more cognitively challenging than the games younger children play. Card games and board games become popular, and often these games require children to count, remember, and plan strategies. Middle childhood is also a time when many children develop an interest in hobbies such as collecting certain types of objects (e.g., coins, dolls) or constructing and building things (such as LEGOs, a Danish invention that is popular around the world in middle childhood). These hobbies also provide enjoyable cognitive challenges of organizing and planning (McHale et al., 2001). Recently, electronic games have become a highly popular type of game in middle childhood, and these games also present substantial cognitive challenges (Olson et al., 2008).

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development Although the complexity and cognitive challenges of play in middle childhood distinguish it from play in early childhood, children continue to enjoy simple games as well (Manning, 1998). According to cross-cultural studies, games such as tag and hide-and-seek are popular all over the world in middle childhood (Edwards, 2000). Children also play simple games that are drawn from their local environment, such as the herding games played by boys in Kenya in the course of caring for cattle. Middle childhood games also reflect children’s advances in gross motor development. As children develop greater physical agility and skill in middle childhood, their games with rules include various sports that require greater physical challenges than their early childhood games did. As noted earlier in the chapter, in many countries middle childhood is the time when children first join organized teams to play sports such as soccer, baseball, or basketball. Many children also play sports in games they organize themselves, often including discussions of the rules of the game (Davies, 2004).

321

age graded social organization based on grouping persons of similar ages social status within a group, the degree of power, authority, and influence that each person has in the view of the others social skills behaviors that include being friendly, helpful, cooperative, and considerate

POPULARITY AND UNPOPULARITY In addition to having friendships, children are also part of a larger social world of peers, especially once they enter primary school. Schools are usually age graded, which means that students at a given grade level tend to be the same age. When children are in a social environment with children of different ages, age is a key determinant of social status, in that older children tend to have more authority than younger children. However, when all children are about the same age, they find other ways of establishing who is high in social status and who is low. One aspect of social status in middle childhood is popularity among peers. Based on children’s ratings of who they like or dislike among their peers, researchers have described four categories of social status (Cillessen & Mayeux, 2004; Rubin et al., 2008): s P opular children are the ones who are most often rated as “liked” and rarely rated as “disliked.” s Rejected children are most often disliked and rarely liked by other children. Usually, rejected children are disliked mainly for being overly aggressive, but in about 10–20% of cases rejected children are shy and withdrawn (Hymel et al., 2004; Sandstrom & Zakriski, 2004). Boys are more likely than girls to be rejected. s Neglected children are rarely mentioned as either liked or disliked; other children have trouble remembering who they are. Girls are more likely than boys to be neglected. s Controversial children are liked by some children but disliked by others. They may be aggressive at times but are friendly at other times. About two-thirds of children in American samples fall into one of these categories in middle childhood, according to most studies (Wentzel, 2003). The rest are rated in mixed ways by other children and are classified by researchers as “average.” What characteristics determine a child’s social status? Abundant research indicates that the strongest influence on popularity is social skills such as being friendly, helpful, cooperative, and considerate (Chan et al., 2000; Cillessen & Bellmore, 2004). Children with social skills are good at perspective-taking; consequently they are good at understanding and responding to other children’s needs and interests (Cassidy et al., 2003). Other important influences on popularity are intelligence, physical appearance, and (for boys) athletic ability (McHale et al., 2003). Despite the popular idea of the “nerd” or “geek” as a kid who is unpopular for being smart, in general, intelligence enhances popularity in middle childhood (in adolescence it becomes a bit more complicated, as we will see in Chapter 8). “Nerds” and “geeks” are unpopular because they lack social skills, not because of their intelligence. Rejected children are usually more aggressive than other children, and their aggressiveness leads to conflicts (Coie, 2004). They tend to be impulsive and have difficulty controlling their emotional reactions, which disrupts group activities, to the annoyance of their peers. In addition to this lack of self-control, their lack of social skills and social understanding leads to conflict with others. According to Kenneth Dodge (2008), who has done decades of research on this topic, rejected children often fail in their

What makes some children popular in middle childhood?

322

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

social information processing (SIP) in social encounters, evaluations of others’ intentions, motivations, and behavior bullying pattern of maltreatment of peers, including aggression; repetition; and power imbalance

The prevalence of bullying rises through middle childhood across countries.

social information processing (SIP). That is, they tend to interpret their peers’ behavior as hostile even when it is not, and they tend to blame others when there is conflict. For rejected children who are withdrawn rather than aggressive, the basis of their rejection is less clear. They may be shy and even fearful of other children, but these characteristics are also found often in neglected children. What distinguishes between rejectedwithdrawn and neglected children? Rejected-withdrawn children are more likely to have internalizing problems such as low self-esteem and anxiety. In contrast, neglected children are usually quite well-adjusted (Wentzel, 2003). They may not engage in social interactions with peers as frequently as other children do, but they usually have social skills equal to average children, are not unhappy, and report having friends. Controversial children often have good social skills, as popular children do, but they are also high in aggressiveness, like rejected children (DeRosier & Thomas, 2003). Their social skills make them popular with some children, and their aggressiveness makes them unpopular with others. They may be adept at forming alliances with some children and excluding others. Sometimes they defy adult authority in ways their peers admire but do not dare to emulate (Vaillancourt & Hymel, 2006). Social status is related to other aspects of children’s development, in middle childhood and beyond, especially for rejected children. Because other children exclude them from their play and they have few or no friends, rejected children often feel lonely and they dislike going to school (Bush & Ladd, 2002). Their aggressiveness and impulsiveness cause problems in their other social relationships, not just with peers, and they have higher rates of conflict with parents and teachers than other children do (Coie, 2004). According to longitudinal studies, being rejected in middle childhood is predictive of later conduct problems in adolescence and emerging adulthood (Miller-Johnson et al., 2003). This does not necessarily mean that being rejected causes later problems; rather, it may indicate that the aggressiveness that inspires rejection from peers in middle childhood often remains at later ages and causes problems that take other forms. Nevertheless, being rejected by peers makes it more difficult for children to develop the social skills that would allow them to overcome a tendency toward aggressiveness. Because rejected children are at risk for a downward spiral of problems in their social relationships, psychologists have developed interventions to try to ameliorate their low social status. Some of these interventions focus on social skills, training rejected children how to initiate friendly interactions with their peers (Asher & Rose, 1997). Other programs focus on social information processing, and seek to teach rejected children to avoid jumping to the conclusion that their peers’ intentions toward them are negative (Bierman, 2004). As part of the intervention, rejected children may be asked to role play hypothetical situations with peers, or watch a videotape of peer interactions with an instructor and talk about why the peers in the video acted as they did (Ladd et al., 2004). These programs have often shown success in the short term, improving rejected children’s social understanding and the quality of their peer interactions, but it is unknown whether the gains from the programs are deep enough to result in enduring improvements in rejected children’s peer relations. BULLIES AND VICTIMS An extreme form of peer rejection in adolescence is bullying. Bullying is defined by researchers as having three components (Olweus, 2000; Wolak et al., 2007): aggression (physical or verbal); repetition (not just one incident but a pattern over time); and power imbalance (the bully has higher peer status than the victim). The prevalence of bullying rises through middle childhood and peaks in early adolescence, then declines substantially by late adolescence (Pepler et al., 2006). Bullying is an international phenomenon, observed in many countries in Europe (Dijkstra et al., 2008; Eslea et al., 2004; Gini et al., 2008), Asia (Ando et al., 2005; Hokoda et al., 2006; Kanetsuna et al., 2006), and North America (Espelage & Swearer, 2004; Pepler et al., 2008; Volk et al., 2006). Estimates vary depending on age and country, but overall about 20% of children are victims of bullies at some point during middle childhood. Boys are more often bullies as well as victims (Berger, 2007). Boys bully using both physical and verbal attacks, but girls can be bullies, too, most often using verbal methods (Pepler et al., 2004; Rigby, 2004).

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development There are two general types of bullies in middle childhood. Some are rejected children who are bully–victims, that is, they are bullied by children who are higher in status and they in turn look for lower-status victims to bully (Kochenderfer-Ladd, 2003). Bully–victims often come from families where the parents are harsh or even physically abusive (Schwartz et al., 2001). Other bullies are controversial children who may have high peer status for their physical appearance, athletic abilities, or social skills, but who are also resented and feared for their bullying behavior toward some children (Vaillancourt et al., 2003). Bullies of both types tend to have a problem controlling their aggressive behavior toward others, not just toward peers but in their other relationships, during middle childhood and beyond (Olweus, 2000). Bullies are also at higher risk than other children for depression (Fekkes et al., 2004; Ireland & Archer, 2004). Victims of bullying are most often rejected-withdrawn children who are low in selfesteem and social skills (Champion et al., 2003). Because they have few friends, they often have no allies when bullies begin victimizing them (Goldbaum et al., 2003). They cry easily in response to bullying, which makes other children regard them as weak and vulnerable and deepens their rejection. Compared to other children, victims of bullying are more likely to be depressed and lonely (Baldry & Farrington, 2004; Rigby, 2004). Their low moods and loneliness may be partly a response to being bullied, but these are also characteristics that may make bullies regard them as easy targets. How do other children respond when they witness one of their peers being bullied? One study observed American children in grades 1–6 on playgrounds and recorded bullying episodes (Hawkins et al., 2001). Other children intervened to help a victim about half the time, and when they did the bullies usually backed off. However, a study in Finland found that in 20–30% of bullying episodes, peer actually encouraged bullies and sometimes even joined in against the victim (Salmivalli & Voeten, 2004).

323

Watch the Video Bullying at MyDevelopmentLab

School Experiences LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Summarize the international variations in school enrollment during middle childhood, and compare and contrast the school socialization practices of Eastern and Western cultures.

)V`Z

7.17

.PYSZ

 

7LYJLU[H[[LUKPUNZJOVVS

       

I :H

O (M HYH YPJ U PK KS H 5V L, Y[O HZ[ ( HU MYP K J :V H \[ O (Z PH ,H Z[ ( ZPH 3H [PU ( T LY PJH JV + \U L] [YP LSV LZ W [ PU V[ N JV + HS \U L [YP ]LS LZ VW [ L V[ K HS



4

:\

For people who have grown up in a place where going to school is a routine part of children’s development in middle childhood, it is easy to assume that this has always been the case. Indeed, many developmental psychologists refer to children in middle childhood as “school-age children,” as if going to school is a natural, universal, and inevitable part of children’s development once they reach the age of 6 or 7. However, attending school in childhood has been a typical part of children’s socialization experiences in most countries only for less than 200 years. In the United States, for example, it is estimated that prior to 1800 only about half of children attended school, and even for those who did, it lasted only a few years (Rogoff et al., 2005). Enrollment increased steadily over the 19th century, as industrialization created jobs that required literacy and people migrated from farms to urban areas, and by 1900 most children completed several years of schooling. The school year remained quite short in the late 19th century, taking place mostly during the winter months when children’s labor was not needed on the farm. In 1870, the average child attending school spent only 78 days per year in school. Classrooms often mixed children of a wide range of ages. Today, going to a school has become a typical part of middle childhood, but it still is not universal, as Figure 7.9 shows (UNICEF, 2008). In Africa and South Asia, 20–40% of children ages 6–10 are not enrolled in primary school. Overall in developing countries, about one-fourth of children do not attend primary school. Until recently, boys were more

Figure 7.9 s Primary School Attendance in World Regions Attending primary school is common but not universal, worldwide. Based on: UNICEF (2008).

324

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

Children in many Asian countries are required to wear school uniforms, such as these children in Nepal. How is the requirement of wearing school uniforms a custom complex?

likely than girls to attend primary school. School attendance requires school fees in many countries, and some poor families would use their extremely limited resources for the boys’ education. Girls were often kept home because it was believed that boys’ education would be of greater benefit to the family. However, in recent years this gender difference has disappeared, and boys and girls are now equally likely to obtain primary education (UNICEF, 2008). In addition to the variations in primary-school attendance, schools around the world also have different approaches to socialization. Although all schooling shifts children’s socialization away from family and toward a peer-intensive environment, there are differences among countries based on individualistic or collectivistic cultural beliefs. For instance, Barbara Rogoff has described the collectivistic socialization contexts of schools in Guatemala, as we’ll explore in the Cultural Focus: School Socialization in Guatemala feature. A great deal of research has focused on comparisons between schools in the United States and in Asian countries such as Japan, China, and South Korea. These Asian countries have cultural traditions going back over 2 millennia emphasizing the importance and value of education, and the traditions remain strong today. High standards are applied to all children, as people in these countries believe that educational success is derived mainly from hard work and any child can succeed who tries hard enough (Stevenson et al., 2000). In contrast, Americans tend to believe that educational success is due mainly to innate ability, so when a child does poorly they tend to believe there is not much that can be done. Another difference is that Asian children tend to view academic striving as something they do not just for themselves but as a moral obligation to their families (Bempechat & Drago-Severson, 1999). In contrast, American children tend to view academic achievement as a mark of individual success. Several features of Asian schools reflect collectivistic cultural beliefs emphasizing obedience and cooperation. Children are required to wear uniforms, a classic custom complex (see Chapter 1) underscoring diminished individuality and emphasizing conformity to the group. Children are also required to help to maintain the cleanliness and order of the school, emphasizing the collectivistic cultural value of contributing to the well-being of the community. Furthermore, children often work in groups, with students who have mastered a concept instructing those who have yet to grasp it (Shapiro & Azuma, 2004). In contrast, children in American schools typically do not wear uniforms (except in some private schools), are not required to help with school maintenance, and spend more time working alone (Stevenson & Zusho, 2002). There are other important differences between the United States and Asian countries in the structure of the school day and year. Asian children spend more time on a typical school day learning academic subjects than American children do; Americans spend only about half as much of their school time in academic activities as children in China and Japan do, and spend more school time in art, music, and sports (Shapiro & Azuma, 2004). Both the school day and the school year are longer in Asian countries. The school year in Japan, Korea, and China is about 50 days longer than in the United States and about 30 days longer than in Canada (World Education Services, 2005). How are these differences in school socialization and structure related to children’s academic performance? In recent years, several excellent cross-national studies of academic performance have been conducted at regular intervals, including the Progress in International Reading Literacy Study (PIRLS) and the Trends in International Mathematics and Science Study (TIMSS). On the basis of these results, it appears that academic performance in fourth grade is related mainly to countries’ economic development rather than to differences in cultural beliefs and (consequently) in educational practices (NCES, 2008). The highest-performing countries have widely varying educational approaches, but they all have high levels of economic development. As a result, they are most able to afford the resources that contribute to high academic performance, from good prenatal care to highquality preschools to well-funded primary schools.

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

CULTURAL FOCUS

325

School Socialization in Guatemala

E

arlier in the chapter we considered the ways that children learn reading, writing, and mathematics in school. But what about school as a socialization environment? What do schools teach about cultural values, beliefs, and behavior? According to cultural psychologist Barbara Rogoff, an important effect of schooling on children’s socialization is that it separates them from the world of adults for a substantial part of each school day and places them in a children’s world with their age peers where they engage in daily social comparison and competition (Rogoff et al., 2005). In traditional cultures where children do not attend school, by middle childhood their work makes a substantial contribution to their families, in care of younger children, meal preparation, care of domestic animals, and assisting in whatever work parents do. School takes them out of that family-focused work environment and into a peer-focused book-learning environment. Rogoff has been conducting ethnographic research in the same Guatemalan village for over 30 years, and her observations provide a vivid example of how school can change children’s daily socialization experiences. Over the course of just one generation, children’s experiences were transformed (see Table 7.2; Rogoff et al., 2005). For example, not a single village girl today has learned weaving, even though nearly all their mothers weaved as girls. For

TABLE 7.2 From Work to School in Guatemalan Children and Parents Girls learn weaving Boys learn to care for younger children Boys do farm work Expect education beyond Grade 6 (boys) Expect education beyond Grade 6 (girls) Expect to weave as adults (girls) Expect to do farm work as adults (boys)

boys, the percentage who helped care for younger children dropped from BELIZE MEXICO HONDURAS 53% to 7% in just one generation. GUATEMALA The percentage of boys helping EL SALVADOR with farm work also dropped from the parents’ generation to the current generation. The change in their focus from work to school was reflected in the change in their aspirations. In the parents’ generation, few expected as children to continue education past Grade 6; for today’s children, about three-fourths expect to go beyond Grade 6, and over half expect to go beyond Grade 12. Both boys and girls today envisioned a wider range of future occupations than their parents could have imagined, including accountant, teacher, pastor, and doctor. The introduction of schooling changes the socialization environment not only for “school-age” children but for younger children. As attending school becomes normative, parents begin to prepare their children in toddlerhood and early childhood for the verbal give-and-take of the school environment by exchanging questions and answers with them rather than issuing commands and expecting the children to participate in collaborative family work (Rogoff et One Generation: al., 2005). Children’s socialization environment also changes because they have fewer siblings, as attending school makes children less of an Parents % Children % economic asset and more of an economic li87 0 ability, and also because raising verbally active children is more taxing. 53 7 In sum, the spread of school attendance has 57 36 made the lives—and futures—of Guatemalan chil7 71 dren vastly different from the lives their parents 3 76 knew. 43 15 77

22

Based on Rogoff et al., 2005

Work Describe the kinds of work children do in middle childhood, and explain why work patterns differ between developed and developing countries. Increasingly in the course of middle childhood, my twins came up with ways to put themselves to work and earn money, especially my daughter Paris. For example, when she was 7-years-old she invented a drink she called “Raspberry Ramble,” made of apple juice, spiced tea, and crushed raspberries. She claimed we could sell large quantities of it and make a fortune. That same year, on a trip to Denmark she collected dozens of rocks on the beach and announced she was opening a “rock museum” on her bed that we could enjoy

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

7.18

326

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

Children in developing countries often work long hours in poor conditions by middle childhood. Here, a young boy works in a factory in Bangladesh.

industry versus inferiority Erikson’s middle childhood stage, in which the alternatives are to learn to work effectively with cultural materials or, if adults are too critical, develop a sense of being incapable of working effectively

for a very reasonable price. Erik Erikson (1950), whose lifespan theory we have been discussing in each chapter (see Chapter 1), called middle childhood the stage of industry versus inferiority, when children become capable of doing useful work as well as their own self-directed projects, unless the adults around them are too critical of their efforts, leading them to develop a sense of inferiority instead. This part of Erikson’s theory has received little research. However, it is possible to see some verification of it in the way children across cultures are regarded as more capable than they were in early childhood and in the way they are often given important work responsibilities (Rogoff, 2003; Weisner, 1996). In developing countries, the work that children do in middle childhood is often not merely a form of play as it was for my daughter but a serious and sometimes perilous contribution to the family. In most developed countries, it is illegal to employ children in middle childhood (United Nations Development Programme [UNDP], 2010). However, in a large proportion of the world middle childhood is the time when productive work begins. Children who do not attend school are usually working, often for their families on a farm or family business, but sometimes in industrial settings. With the globalization of the world economy, many large companies have moved much of their manufacturing to developing countries, where labor costs are cheaper. Cheapest of all is the labor of children. Before middle childhood, children are too immature and lacking in self-regulation to be useful in manufacturing. Their gross and fine motor skills are limited, their attention wanders too much, and they are too erratic in their behavior and their emotions. However, by age 6 or 7 children have the motor skills, the cognitive skills, and the emotional and behavioral self-regulation to be excellent workers at many jobs. The International Labor Organization (ILO) has estimated that about 200 million children and adolescents are employed worldwide, and that 95% of them are in developing countries (ILO, 2002, 2004, 2006, 2008). As shown in Map 7.3, a substantial proportion of children work in Latin America, Asia, and the Middle East/North Africa, but the greatest number of child workers is found in sub-Saharan Africa. Agricultural work is the most common form of child employment, usually on commercial farms or plantations, often working alongside parents but for only one-third to one-half the pay (ILO, 2002). Children can quickly master the skills needed to plant, tend, and harvest agricultural products. In addition, many children in these countries work in factories and shops where they perform labor such as weaving carpets, sewing clothes, gluing shoes, curing leather, and polishing gems. The working conditions are often miserable—crowded garment factories where the doors are locked and children (and adults) work 14-hour shifts, small poorly-lit huts where they sit at a loom weaving carpets for hours on end, glass factories where the temperatures are unbearably hot and children carry rods of molten glass from one station to another (ILO, 2004). Other children work in cities in a wide variety of jobs including domestic service, grocery shops, tea stalls, and delivering messages and packages. Children in developed countries are generally prohibited from work, but as you will see in the Historical Focus: Work Among British Children in the 19th Century feature on page 328, this is a relatively recent development. If children’s work is often so often difficult and dangerous, why do parents allow their children to work, and why do governments not outlaw child labor? For parents, the simple answer is that they need the money. As we have seen, billions of people worldwide are very poor. Poor families in developing countries often depend on children’s contributions to the family income for basic necessities like food and clothing. Children’s work may be difficult and dangerous, but so is the work of adults; often, adults and children work in the same factories. As for governments, nearly all countries do have laws prohibiting child labor, but some developing countries do not enforce them, because of bribes from the companies

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development Percentage of children aged 5–14 engaged in labor More than 30% 10–30% Less than 10% No data 30°

Child Labor

30°





30°

30°

150° 60°

120°

90°

60°

30°



30°

60°

90°

120°

150°

Gross Domestic Product (GDP) Per Capita

GDP Per Capita Income More than $25,000 $12,000–$25,000 $4,000–$11,999 30° $1,000–$3,999 Less than $1,000 No data

30°





30°

30°

150° 60°

120°

90°

60°

30°



30°

60°

90°

120°

150°

Map 7.3 s Child Labor Rates and GDP Worldwide What is the relationship between the rate of child labor and the GDP of a given country? How can you explain this relationship? employing the children or because they do not wish to incur the wrath of parents who need their children’s income (Chaudary & Sharma, 2007). Although the exploitation of children’s labor in developing countries is widespread and often harsh, signs of positive changes can be seen. According to the International Labor Organization, the number of child laborers ages 5–11 is declining (ILO, 2006). This decline has taken place because the issue of child and adolescent labor has received increased attention from the world media, governments, and international organizations such as the ILO and the United Nations Children’s Fund (UNICEF). Furthermore, legislative action has been taken in many countries to raise the number of years children are legally required to attend school and to enforce the often-ignored laws against employing children younger than their midteens (ILO, 2008). Amid such signs of progress, it remains true that millions of children work in unhealthy conditions all around the world (ILO, 2002, 2004, 2006, 2008).

327

328

C h ap ter 7

Middle Childhood

HISTORICAL FOCUS

A

Work Among British Children in the 19th Century

for abolishing child labor, and labor restrictions were fiercely resisted s we have seen in this chapter, the working conditions curby parents who depended on their children’s income. Thus, the first rently experienced by children in developing countries are in law, the Health and Morals of Apprentices Act of 1802, simply limmany ways dangerous, unhealthy, underpaid, and exploitited young workers to 12 hours of labor a day! The act also manative. Children in developed countries are generally excluded from dated minimum standards of ventilation and sanitation in the mills, paid employment, but this is a relatively recent development. In fact, but these provisions were widely ignored by mill owners. the working conditions of children in the 19th century in developed In addition, the act required employers to provide daily schooling countries were remarkably similar to the conditions experienced toto young workers. Employers generally complied with this, because day by children in developing countries. they believed that educated children would be more compliant and Information on child labor in the 19th century is especially productive, so the result was a significant increase in literacy among abundant in Great Britain, where government statistics were kept young workers. This requirement spread to other industries over the much more systematically and accurately than in the United States. following decades and became the basis of the half-time system, in The history of child labor in Great Britain is described in a book by which young workers in factories received schooling for a half day Pamela Horn (1994), Children’s Work and Welfare, 1780–1890. and worked for a half day. This system survived in British society until Because Britain was the first country in which industrialization the end of the 19th century. took place, it was also the first country in which child and adolescent In the 1830s, regulatory atlabor was widely used. Textile manutention turned to mining. Just as facturing (the making of cloth and changes in textile production had clothing) was the first industry to use created a boom in jobs in the late child labor, beginning in the 1770s. 1700s, an increase in the need for For the first time textiles were being coal in the early 1800s created a mass produced in factories rather mining boom. Once again, children than made one at a time in homes. were sought as workers because they Children were especially attractive were cheap, manageable, and could to employers, partly because there do some jobs better than adults. was a shortage of adult workers Once again, parents urged their chiland partly because younger workers dren to become laborers as early as could be paid lower wages, and with possible to contribute to the family their nimble fingers they could perincome, even though the work in the form much of the work even better mines was especially hazardous. than adults. A workday of 12 to 14 hours 6 Many of these children had no days a week was common for young parents and were sent to the textile A young miner in England fixes the ropes for the miners. Many of them descended mills by officials in city orphanages coal carts. into the mine before sunrise and and institutions for the poor, who came up again after sunset, so that they never saw daylight for weeks were glad to be relieved of the cost of caring for them. Children had at a time except on Sundays. Accidents were common, and coal dust no choice but to go and were not free to leave until they reached damaged young miners’ lungs. The first reforms, in the 1842 Mines age 21. For those who did have parents, their parents usually did not Act, prohibited boys under 10 from working in mines and required object to them working in textile mills, but encouraged it in order to boys over age 10 to be provided with schooling by the mine owners, increase the family’s income. but did nothing about the working conditions in the mines. Working conditions varied in the mills, but 12- to 14-hour Over the second half of the 19th century, legal regulations on workdays were common, with an hour break for lunch. The work child labor slowly and gradually reduced the exploitation of young was monotonous, exhausting, and dangerous. A momentary lapse workers in British industrial settings. Regulations increased conof attention could lead to serious injury, and crushed hands and cerning the work children could be required to do. The half-time fingers were common. Dust and residue from the production prosystem, once celebrated as a way of protecting young workers cess damaged workers’ lungs and caused stomach illnesses and eye from exploitation, became viewed as an obstacle to their eduinfections. cational opportunities. Public schools were established, and atThe first attempts at government regulation of the mills were tendance at school became legally required for all children in the tentative, to say the least. Because the British economy depended 1880s. This essentially marked the end of child labor in Great so heavily on the young millworkers, even reformers were reluctant Britain. to advocate an end to their labor. There was also little public support

Section 3 Emotional and Social Development

329

Media Use

7.19

LEARNING OBJECTIVE

Summarize the rates of daily TV-watching among children worldwide, and describe the positive and negative effects of television, especially the hazards related to TV violence.

LU

`

LK

HU T

LY .

:^

JL

U WH

HU -Y

T KV

K